|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 2 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | certified the economic development
project area, each year |
2 | | after the date of the certification by the county clerk
of the |
3 | | "total initial equalized assessed value" until economic |
4 | | development
project costs and all municipal obligations |
5 | | financing economic development
project costs have been paid, |
6 | | the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from the
levies upon the |
7 | | taxable real property in the economic development project area
|
8 | | by taxing districts and tax rates determined in the manner |
9 | | provided in
subsection (b) of Section 6 of this Act shall be |
10 | | divided as follows:
|
11 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable lot, |
12 | | block, tract
or parcel of real property which is attributable |
13 | | to the lower of the current
equalized assessed value or the |
14 | | initial equalized assessed value of each such
taxable lot, |
15 | | block, tract, or parcel of real property existing at the time |
16 | | tax
increment allocation financing was adopted, shall be |
17 | | allocated to and when
collected shall be paid by the county |
18 | | collector to the respective affected
taxing districts in the |
19 | | manner required by law in the absence of the adoption
of tax |
20 | | increment allocation financing.
|
21 | | (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes which is |
22 | | attributable to the
increase in the current equalized assessed |
23 | | valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of real |
24 | | property in the economic development project
area, over and |
25 | | above the initial equalized assessed value of each property
|
26 | | existing at the time tax increment allocation financing was |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 3 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | adopted,
shall be allocated to and when collected shall be paid |
2 | | to the municipal
treasurer, who shall deposit those taxes into |
3 | | a special fund called the special
tax allocation fund of the |
4 | | municipality for the purpose of paying economic
development |
5 | | project costs and obligations incurred in the payment thereof.
|
6 | | The municipality, by an ordinance adopting tax increment |
7 | | allocation
financing, may pledge the funds in and to be |
8 | | deposited in the special tax
allocation fund for the payment of |
9 | | obligations issued under this Act and for
the payment of |
10 | | economic development project costs. No part of the current
|
11 | | equalized assessed valuation of each property in the economic |
12 | | development
project area attributable to any increase above the |
13 | | total initial equalized
assessed value, of such properties |
14 | | shall be used in calculating the general
State school aid |
15 | | formula, provided for in Section 18-8 of the School Code, or |
16 | | the evidence-based funding formula, provided for in Section |
17 | | 18-8.15 of the School Code,
until such time as all economic |
18 | | development projects costs have been paid as
provided for in |
19 | | this Section.
|
20 | | When the economic development project costs, including |
21 | | without
limitation all municipal obligations financing |
22 | | economic development project
costs incurred under this Act, |
23 | | have been paid, all surplus funds then
remaining in the special |
24 | | tax allocation fund shall be distributed by being
paid by the |
25 | | municipal treasurer to the county collector, who shall
|
26 | | immediately thereafter pay those funds to the taxing districts |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 4 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | having
taxable property in the economic development project |
2 | | area in the same
manner and proportion as the most recent |
3 | | distribution by the county
collector to those taxing districts |
4 | | of real property taxes from real
property in the economic |
5 | | development project area.
|
6 | | Upon the payment of all economic development project costs, |
7 | | retirement of
obligations and the distribution of any excess |
8 | | monies pursuant to this
Section the municipality shall adopt an |
9 | | ordinance dissolving the special
tax allocation fund for the |
10 | | economic development project area,
terminating the economic |
11 | | development project area, and terminating the use
of tax |
12 | | increment allocation financing for the economic development |
13 | | project
area. Thereafter the rates of the taxing districts |
14 | | shall be extended and taxes
levied, collected and distributed |
15 | | in the manner applicable in the absence of
the adoption of tax |
16 | | increment allocation financing.
|
17 | | Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving |
18 | | property in
economic development project areas from being |
19 | | assessed as provided in the
Property Tax Code, or as relieving
|
20 | | owners of that property from paying a uniform rate of taxes, as |
21 | | required by
Section 4 of Article IX of the Illinois |
22 | | Constitution.
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13.)
|
24 | | Section 10. The State Finance Act is amended by changing |
25 | | Section 13.2 as follows:
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 5 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (30 ILCS 105/13.2) (from Ch. 127, par. 149.2)
|
2 | | Sec. 13.2. Transfers among line item appropriations. |
3 | | (a) Transfers among line item appropriations from the same
|
4 | | treasury fund for the objects specified in this Section may be |
5 | | made in
the manner provided in this Section when the balance |
6 | | remaining in one or
more such line item appropriations is |
7 | | insufficient for the purpose for
which the appropriation was |
8 | | made. |
9 | | (a-1) No transfers may be made from one
agency to another |
10 | | agency, nor may transfers be made from one institution
of |
11 | | higher education to another institution of higher education |
12 | | except as provided by subsection (a-4).
|
13 | | (a-2) Except as otherwise provided in this Section, |
14 | | transfers may be made only among the objects of expenditure |
15 | | enumerated
in this Section, except that no funds may be |
16 | | transferred from any
appropriation for personal services, from |
17 | | any appropriation for State
contributions to the State |
18 | | Employees' Retirement System, from any
separate appropriation |
19 | | for employee retirement contributions paid by the
employer, nor |
20 | | from any appropriation for State contribution for
employee |
21 | | group insurance. During State fiscal year 2005, an agency may |
22 | | transfer amounts among its appropriations within the same |
23 | | treasury fund for personal services, employee retirement |
24 | | contributions paid by employer, and State Contributions to |
25 | | retirement systems; notwithstanding and in addition to the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 6 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this Section, the |
2 | | fiscal year 2005 transfers authorized in this sentence may be |
3 | | made in an amount not to exceed 2% of the aggregate amount |
4 | | appropriated to an agency within the same treasury fund. During |
5 | | State fiscal year 2007, the Departments of Children and Family |
6 | | Services, Corrections, Human Services, and Juvenile Justice |
7 | | may transfer amounts among their respective appropriations |
8 | | within the same treasury fund for personal services, employee |
9 | | retirement contributions paid by employer, and State |
10 | | contributions to retirement systems. During State fiscal year |
11 | | 2010, the Department of Transportation may transfer amounts |
12 | | among their respective appropriations within the same treasury |
13 | | fund for personal services, employee retirement contributions |
14 | | paid by employer, and State contributions to retirement |
15 | | systems. During State fiscal years 2010 and 2014 only, an |
16 | | agency may transfer amounts among its respective |
17 | | appropriations within the same treasury fund for personal |
18 | | services, employee retirement contributions paid by employer, |
19 | | and State contributions to retirement systems. |
20 | | Notwithstanding, and in addition to, the transfers authorized |
21 | | in subsection (c) of this Section, these transfers may be made |
22 | | in an amount not to exceed 2% of the aggregate amount |
23 | | appropriated to an agency within the same treasury fund.
|
24 | | (a-2.5) During State fiscal year 2015 only, the State's |
25 | | Attorneys Appellate Prosecutor may transfer amounts among its |
26 | | respective appropriations contained in operational line items |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 7 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | within the same treasury fund. Notwithstanding, and in addition |
2 | | to, the transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this Section, |
3 | | these transfers may be made in an amount not to exceed 4% of |
4 | | the aggregate amount appropriated to the State's Attorneys |
5 | | Appellate Prosecutor within the same treasury fund. |
6 | | (a-3) Further, if an agency receives a separate
|
7 | | appropriation for employee retirement contributions paid by |
8 | | the employer,
any transfer by that agency into an appropriation |
9 | | for personal services
must be accompanied by a corresponding |
10 | | transfer into the appropriation for
employee retirement |
11 | | contributions paid by the employer, in an amount
sufficient to |
12 | | meet the employer share of the employee contributions
required |
13 | | to be remitted to the retirement system. |
14 | | (a-4) Long-Term Care Rebalancing. The Governor may |
15 | | designate amounts set aside for institutional services |
16 | | appropriated from the General Revenue Fund or any other State |
17 | | fund that receives monies for long-term care services to be |
18 | | transferred to all State agencies responsible for the |
19 | | administration of community-based long-term care programs, |
20 | | including, but not limited to, community-based long-term care |
21 | | programs administered by the Department of Healthcare and |
22 | | Family Services, the Department of Human Services, and the |
23 | | Department on Aging, provided that the Director of Healthcare |
24 | | and Family Services first certifies that the amounts being |
25 | | transferred are necessary for the purpose of assisting persons |
26 | | in or at risk of being in institutional care to transition to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 8 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | community-based settings, including the financial data needed |
2 | | to prove the need for the transfer of funds. The total amounts |
3 | | transferred shall not exceed 4% in total of the amounts |
4 | | appropriated from the General Revenue Fund or any other State |
5 | | fund that receives monies for long-term care services for each |
6 | | fiscal year. A notice of the fund transfer must be made to the |
7 | | General Assembly and posted at a minimum on the Department of |
8 | | Healthcare and Family Services website, the Governor's Office |
9 | | of Management and Budget website, and any other website the |
10 | | Governor sees fit. These postings shall serve as notice to the |
11 | | General Assembly of the amounts to be transferred. Notice shall |
12 | | be given at least 30 days prior to transfer. |
13 | | (b) In addition to the general transfer authority provided |
14 | | under
subsection (c), the following agencies have the specific |
15 | | transfer authority
granted in this subsection: |
16 | | The Department of Healthcare and Family Services is |
17 | | authorized to make transfers
representing savings attributable |
18 | | to not increasing grants due to the
births of additional |
19 | | children from line items for payments of cash grants to
line |
20 | | items for payments for employment and social services for the |
21 | | purposes
outlined in subsection (f) of Section 4-2 of the |
22 | | Illinois Public Aid Code. |
23 | | The Department of Children and Family Services is |
24 | | authorized to make
transfers not exceeding 2% of the aggregate |
25 | | amount appropriated to it within
the same treasury fund for the |
26 | | following line items among these same line
items: Foster Home |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 9 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | and Specialized Foster Care and Prevention, Institutions
and |
2 | | Group Homes and Prevention, and Purchase of Adoption and |
3 | | Guardianship
Services. |
4 | | The Department on Aging is authorized to make transfers not
|
5 | | exceeding 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated to it within |
6 | | the same
treasury fund for the following Community Care Program |
7 | | line items among these
same line items: purchase of services |
8 | | covered by the Community Care Program and Comprehensive Case |
9 | | Coordination. |
10 | | The State Treasurer is authorized to make transfers among |
11 | | line item
appropriations
from the Capital Litigation Trust |
12 | | Fund, with respect to costs incurred in
fiscal years 2002 and |
13 | | 2003 only, when the balance remaining in one or
more such
line |
14 | | item appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which |
15 | | the
appropriation was
made, provided that no such transfer may |
16 | | be made unless the amount transferred
is no
longer required for |
17 | | the purpose for which that appropriation was made. |
18 | | The State Board of Education is authorized to make |
19 | | transfers from line item appropriations within the same |
20 | | treasury fund for General State Aid , and General State Aid - |
21 | | Hold Harmless, Evidence-Based Funding, provided that no such |
22 | | transfer may be made unless the amount transferred is no longer |
23 | | required for the purpose for which that appropriation was made, |
24 | | to the line item appropriation for Transitional Assistance when |
25 | | the balance remaining in such line item appropriation is |
26 | | insufficient for the purpose for which the appropriation was |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 10 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | made. |
2 | | The State Board of Education is authorized to make |
3 | | transfers between the following line item appropriations |
4 | | within the same treasury fund: Disabled Student |
5 | | Services/Materials (Section 14-13.01 of the School Code), |
6 | | Disabled Student Transportation Reimbursement (Section |
7 | | 14-13.01 of the School Code), Disabled Student Tuition - |
8 | | Private Tuition (Section 14-7.02 of the School Code), |
9 | | Extraordinary Special Education (Section 14-7.02b of the |
10 | | School Code), Reimbursement for Free Lunch/Breakfast Program, |
11 | | Summer School Payments (Section 18-4.3 of the School Code), and |
12 | | Transportation - Regular/Vocational Reimbursement (Section |
13 | | 29-5 of the School Code). Such transfers shall be made only |
14 | | when the balance remaining in one or more such line item |
15 | | appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which the |
16 | | appropriation was made and provided that no such transfer may |
17 | | be made unless the amount transferred is no longer required for |
18 | | the purpose for which that appropriation was made. |
19 | | The Department of Healthcare and Family Services is |
20 | | authorized to make transfers not exceeding 4% of the aggregate |
21 | | amount appropriated to it, within the same treasury fund, among |
22 | | the various line items appropriated for Medical Assistance. |
23 | | (c) The sum of such transfers for an agency in a fiscal |
24 | | year shall not
exceed 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated |
25 | | to it within the same treasury
fund for the following objects: |
26 | | Personal Services; Extra Help; Student and
Inmate |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 11 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Compensation; State Contributions to Retirement Systems; State
|
2 | | Contributions to Social Security; State Contribution for |
3 | | Employee Group
Insurance; Contractual Services; Travel; |
4 | | Commodities; Printing; Equipment;
Electronic Data Processing; |
5 | | Operation of Automotive Equipment;
Telecommunications |
6 | | Services; Travel and Allowance for Committed, Paroled
and |
7 | | Discharged Prisoners; Library Books; Federal Matching Grants |
8 | | for
Student Loans; Refunds; Workers' Compensation, |
9 | | Occupational Disease, and
Tort Claims; and, in appropriations |
10 | | to institutions of higher education,
Awards and Grants. |
11 | | Notwithstanding the above, any amounts appropriated for
|
12 | | payment of workers' compensation claims to an agency to which |
13 | | the authority
to evaluate, administer and pay such claims has |
14 | | been delegated by the
Department of Central Management Services |
15 | | may be transferred to any other
expenditure object where such |
16 | | amounts exceed the amount necessary for the
payment of such |
17 | | claims. |
18 | | (c-1) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2003. |
19 | | Notwithstanding any
other provision of this Section to the |
20 | | contrary, for State fiscal year 2003
only, transfers among line |
21 | | item appropriations to an agency from the same
treasury fund |
22 | | may be made provided that the sum of such transfers for an |
23 | | agency
in State fiscal year 2003 shall not exceed 3% of the |
24 | | aggregate amount
appropriated to that State agency for State |
25 | | fiscal year 2003 for the following
objects: personal services, |
26 | | except that no transfer may be approved which
reduces the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 12 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | aggregate appropriations for personal services within an |
2 | | agency;
extra help; student and inmate compensation; State
|
3 | | contributions to retirement systems; State contributions to |
4 | | social security;
State contributions for employee group |
5 | | insurance; contractual services; travel;
commodities; |
6 | | printing; equipment; electronic data processing; operation of
|
7 | | automotive equipment; telecommunications services; travel and |
8 | | allowance for
committed, paroled, and discharged prisoners; |
9 | | library books; federal matching
grants for student loans; |
10 | | refunds; workers' compensation, occupational disease,
and tort |
11 | | claims; and, in appropriations to institutions of higher |
12 | | education,
awards and grants. |
13 | | (c-2) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2005. |
14 | | Notwithstanding subsections (a), (a-2), and (c), for State |
15 | | fiscal year 2005 only, transfers may be made among any line |
16 | | item appropriations from the same or any other treasury fund |
17 | | for any objects or purposes, without limitation, when the |
18 | | balance remaining in one or more such line item appropriations |
19 | | is insufficient for the purpose for which the appropriation was |
20 | | made, provided that the sum of those transfers by a State |
21 | | agency shall not exceed 4% of the aggregate amount appropriated |
22 | | to that State agency for fiscal year 2005.
|
23 | | (c-3) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2015. |
24 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for State |
25 | | fiscal year 2015, transfers among line item appropriations to a |
26 | | State agency from the same State treasury fund may be made for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 13 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | operational or lump sum expenses only, provided that the sum of |
2 | | such transfers for a State agency in State fiscal year 2015 |
3 | | shall not exceed 4% of the aggregate amount appropriated to |
4 | | that State agency for operational or lump sum expenses for |
5 | | State fiscal year 2015. For the purpose of this subsection, |
6 | | "operational or lump sum expenses" includes the following |
7 | | objects: personal services; extra help; student and inmate |
8 | | compensation; State contributions to retirement systems; State |
9 | | contributions to social security; State contributions for |
10 | | employee group insurance; contractual services; travel; |
11 | | commodities; printing; equipment; electronic data processing; |
12 | | operation of automotive equipment; telecommunications |
13 | | services; travel and allowance for committed, paroled, and |
14 | | discharged prisoners; library books; federal matching grants |
15 | | for student loans; refunds; workers' compensation, |
16 | | occupational disease, and tort claims; lump sum and other |
17 | | purposes; and lump sum operations. For the purpose of this |
18 | | subsection (c-3), "State agency" does not include the Attorney |
19 | | General, the Secretary of State, the Comptroller, the |
20 | | Treasurer, or the legislative or judicial branches. |
21 | | (d) Transfers among appropriations made to agencies of the |
22 | | Legislative
and Judicial departments and to the |
23 | | constitutionally elected officers in the
Executive branch |
24 | | require the approval of the officer authorized in Section 10
of |
25 | | this Act to approve and certify vouchers. Transfers among |
26 | | appropriations
made to the University of Illinois, Southern |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 14 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Illinois University, Chicago State
University, Eastern |
2 | | Illinois University, Governors State University, Illinois
|
3 | | State University, Northeastern Illinois University, Northern |
4 | | Illinois
University, Western Illinois University, the Illinois |
5 | | Mathematics and Science
Academy and the Board of Higher |
6 | | Education require the approval of the Board of
Higher Education |
7 | | and the Governor. Transfers among appropriations to all other
|
8 | | agencies require the approval of the Governor. |
9 | | The officer responsible for approval shall certify that the
|
10 | | transfer is necessary to carry out the programs and purposes |
11 | | for which
the appropriations were made by the General Assembly |
12 | | and shall transmit
to the State Comptroller a certified copy of |
13 | | the approval which shall
set forth the specific amounts |
14 | | transferred so that the Comptroller may
change his records |
15 | | accordingly. The Comptroller shall furnish the
Governor with |
16 | | information copies of all transfers approved for agencies
of |
17 | | the Legislative and Judicial departments and transfers |
18 | | approved by
the constitutionally elected officials of the |
19 | | Executive branch other
than the Governor, showing the amounts |
20 | | transferred and indicating the
dates such changes were entered |
21 | | on the Comptroller's records. |
22 | | (e) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the |
23 | | State Comptroller, may transfer line item appropriations for |
24 | | General State Aid or Evidence-Based Funding between the Common |
25 | | School Fund and the Education Assistance Fund. With the advice |
26 | | and consent of the Governor's Office of Management and Budget, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 15 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the State Board of Education, in consultation with the State |
2 | | Comptroller, may transfer line item appropriations between the |
3 | | General Revenue Fund and the Education Assistance Fund for the |
4 | | following programs: |
5 | | (1) Disabled Student Personnel Reimbursement (Section |
6 | | 14-13.01 of the School Code); |
7 | | (2) Disabled Student Transportation Reimbursement |
8 | | (subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of the School Code); |
9 | | (3) Disabled Student Tuition - Private Tuition |
10 | | (Section 14-7.02 of the School Code); |
11 | | (4) Extraordinary Special Education (Section 14-7.02b |
12 | | of the School Code); |
13 | | (5) Reimbursement for Free Lunch/Breakfast Programs; |
14 | | (6) Summer School Payments (Section 18-4.3 of the |
15 | | School Code); |
16 | | (7) Transportation - Regular/Vocational Reimbursement |
17 | | (Section 29-5 of the School Code); |
18 | | (8) Regular Education Reimbursement (Section 18-3 of |
19 | | the School Code); and |
20 | | (9) Special Education Reimbursement (Section 14-7.03 |
21 | | of the School Code). |
22 | | (Source: P.A. 98-24, eff. 6-19-13; 98-674, eff. 6-30-14; 99-2, |
23 | | eff. 3-26-15.)
|
24 | | Section 15. The Property Tax Code is amended by changing |
25 | | Sections 18-200 and 18-249 as follows:
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 16 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (35 ILCS 200/18-200)
|
2 | | Sec. 18-200. School Code. A school district's State aid |
3 | | shall not be
reduced under the computation under subsections |
4 | | 5(a) through 5(h) of Part A of
Section 18-8 of the School Code |
5 | | or under Section 18-8.15 of the School Code due to the |
6 | | operating tax rate falling from
above the minimum requirement |
7 | | of that Section of the School Code to below the
minimum |
8 | | requirement of that Section of the School Code due to the |
9 | | operation of
this Law.
|
10 | | (Source: P.A. 87-17; 88-455.)
|
11 | | (35 ILCS 200/18-249)
|
12 | | Sec. 18-249. Miscellaneous provisions.
|
13 | | (a) Certification of new property. For the 1994 levy year, |
14 | | the chief county
assessment officer shall certify to the county |
15 | | clerk, after all changes by the
board of review or board of |
16 | | appeals, as the case may be, the assessed value of
new property |
17 | | by taxing district for the 1994 levy year under rules |
18 | | promulgated
by the Department.
|
19 | | (b) School Code. A school district's State aid shall not be |
20 | | reduced under
the computation under subsections 5(a) through |
21 | | 5(h) of Part A of Section 18-8
of the School Code or under |
22 | | Section 18-8.15 of the School Code due to the
operating tax |
23 | | rate falling from above the minimum requirement of that Section
|
24 | | of the School Code to below the minimum requirement of that |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 17 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Section of the
School Code due to the operation of this Law.
|
2 | | (c) Rules. The Department shall make and promulgate |
3 | | reasonable rules
relating to the administration of the purposes |
4 | | and provisions of Sections
18-246 through 18-249 as may be |
5 | | necessary or appropriate.
|
6 | | (Source: P.A. 89-1, eff. 2-12-95.)
|
7 | | Section 17. The Illinois Pension Code is amended by |
8 | | changing Section 16-158 as follows:
|
9 | | (40 ILCS 5/16-158)
(from Ch. 108 1/2, par. 16-158)
|
10 | | (Text of Section WITHOUT the changes made by P.A. 98-599, |
11 | | which has been held unconstitutional)
|
12 | | Sec. 16-158. Contributions by State and other employing |
13 | | units.
|
14 | | (a) The State shall make contributions to the System by |
15 | | means of
appropriations from the Common School Fund and other |
16 | | State funds of amounts
which, together with other employer |
17 | | contributions, employee contributions,
investment income, and |
18 | | other income, will be sufficient to meet the cost of
|
19 | | maintaining and administering the System on a 90% funded basis |
20 | | in accordance
with actuarial recommendations.
|
21 | | The Board shall determine the amount of State contributions |
22 | | required for
each fiscal year on the basis of the actuarial |
23 | | tables and other assumptions
adopted by the Board and the |
24 | | recommendations of the actuary, using the formula
in subsection |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 18 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (b-3).
|
2 | | (a-1) Annually, on or before November 15 until November 15, |
3 | | 2011, the Board shall certify to the
Governor the amount of the |
4 | | required State contribution for the coming fiscal
year. The |
5 | | certification under this subsection (a-1) shall include a copy |
6 | | of the actuarial recommendations
upon which it is based and |
7 | | shall specifically identify the System's projected State |
8 | | normal cost for that fiscal year.
|
9 | | On or before May 1, 2004, the Board shall recalculate and |
10 | | recertify to
the Governor the amount of the required State |
11 | | contribution to the System for
State fiscal year 2005, taking |
12 | | into account the amounts appropriated to and
received by the |
13 | | System under subsection (d) of Section 7.2 of the General
|
14 | | Obligation Bond Act.
|
15 | | On or before July 1, 2005, the Board shall recalculate and |
16 | | recertify
to the Governor the amount of the required State
|
17 | | contribution to the System for State fiscal year 2006, taking |
18 | | into account the changes in required State contributions made |
19 | | by this amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly.
|
20 | | On or before April 1, 2011, the Board shall recalculate and |
21 | | recertify to the Governor the amount of the required State |
22 | | contribution to the System for State fiscal year 2011, applying |
23 | | the changes made by Public Act 96-889 to the System's assets |
24 | | and liabilities as of June 30, 2009 as though Public Act 96-889 |
25 | | was approved on that date. |
26 | | (a-5) On or before November 1 of each year, beginning |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 19 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | November 1, 2012, the Board shall submit to the State Actuary, |
2 | | the Governor, and the General Assembly a proposed certification |
3 | | of the amount of the required State contribution to the System |
4 | | for the next fiscal year, along with all of the actuarial |
5 | | assumptions, calculations, and data upon which that proposed |
6 | | certification is based. On or before January 1 of each year, |
7 | | beginning January 1, 2013, the State Actuary shall issue a |
8 | | preliminary report concerning the proposed certification and |
9 | | identifying, if necessary, recommended changes in actuarial |
10 | | assumptions that the Board must consider before finalizing its |
11 | | certification of the required State contributions. On or before |
12 | | January 15, 2013 and each January 15 thereafter, the Board |
13 | | shall certify to the Governor and the General Assembly the |
14 | | amount of the required State contribution for the next fiscal |
15 | | year. The Board's certification must note any deviations from |
16 | | the State Actuary's recommended changes, the reason or reasons |
17 | | for not following the State Actuary's recommended changes, and |
18 | | the fiscal impact of not following the State Actuary's |
19 | | recommended changes on the required State contribution. |
20 | | (b) Through State fiscal year 1995, the State contributions |
21 | | shall be
paid to the System in accordance with Section 18-7 of |
22 | | the School Code.
|
23 | | (b-1) Beginning in State fiscal year 1996, on the 15th day |
24 | | of each month,
or as soon thereafter as may be practicable, the |
25 | | Board shall submit vouchers
for payment of State contributions |
26 | | to the System, in a total monthly amount of
one-twelfth of the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 20 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | required annual State contribution certified under
subsection |
2 | | (a-1).
From the
effective date of this amendatory Act of the |
3 | | 93rd General Assembly
through June 30, 2004, the Board shall |
4 | | not submit vouchers for the
remainder of fiscal year 2004 in |
5 | | excess of the fiscal year 2004
certified contribution amount |
6 | | determined under this Section
after taking into consideration |
7 | | the transfer to the System
under subsection (a) of Section |
8 | | 6z-61 of the State Finance Act.
These vouchers shall be paid by |
9 | | the State Comptroller and
Treasurer by warrants drawn on the |
10 | | funds appropriated to the System for that
fiscal year.
|
11 | | If in any month the amount remaining unexpended from all |
12 | | other appropriations
to the System for the applicable fiscal |
13 | | year (including the appropriations to
the System under Section |
14 | | 8.12 of the State Finance Act and Section 1 of the
State |
15 | | Pension Funds Continuing Appropriation Act) is less than the |
16 | | amount
lawfully vouchered under this subsection, the |
17 | | difference shall be paid from the
Common School Fund under the |
18 | | continuing appropriation authority provided in
Section 1.1 of |
19 | | the State Pension Funds Continuing Appropriation Act.
|
20 | | (b-2) Allocations from the Common School Fund apportioned |
21 | | to school
districts not coming under this System shall not be |
22 | | diminished or affected by
the provisions of this Article.
|
23 | | (b-3) For State fiscal years 2012 through 2045, the minimum |
24 | | contribution
to the System to be made by the State for each |
25 | | fiscal year shall be an amount
determined by the System to be |
26 | | sufficient to bring the total assets of the
System up to 90% of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 21 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the total actuarial liabilities of the System by the end of
|
2 | | State fiscal year 2045. In making these determinations, the |
3 | | required State
contribution shall be calculated each year as a |
4 | | level percentage of payroll
over the years remaining to and |
5 | | including fiscal year 2045 and shall be
determined under the |
6 | | projected unit credit actuarial cost method.
|
7 | | For State fiscal years 1996 through 2005, the State |
8 | | contribution to the
System, as a percentage of the applicable |
9 | | employee payroll, shall be increased
in equal annual increments |
10 | | so that by State fiscal year 2011, the State is
contributing at |
11 | | the rate required under this Section; except that in the
|
12 | | following specified State fiscal years, the State contribution |
13 | | to the System
shall not be less than the following indicated |
14 | | percentages of the applicable
employee payroll, even if the |
15 | | indicated percentage will produce a State
contribution in |
16 | | excess of the amount otherwise required under this subsection
|
17 | | and subsection (a), and notwithstanding any contrary |
18 | | certification made under
subsection (a-1) before the effective |
19 | | date of this amendatory Act of 1998:
10.02% in FY 1999;
10.77% |
20 | | in FY 2000;
11.47% in FY 2001;
12.16% in FY 2002;
12.86% in FY |
21 | | 2003; and
13.56% in FY 2004.
|
22 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of this Article, the |
23 | | total required State
contribution for State fiscal year 2006 is |
24 | | $534,627,700.
|
25 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of this Article, the |
26 | | total required State
contribution for State fiscal year 2007 is |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 22 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | $738,014,500.
|
2 | | For each of State fiscal years 2008 through 2009, the State |
3 | | contribution to
the System, as a percentage of the applicable |
4 | | employee payroll, shall be
increased in equal annual increments |
5 | | from the required State contribution for State fiscal year |
6 | | 2007, so that by State fiscal year 2011, the
State is |
7 | | contributing at the rate otherwise required under this Section.
|
8 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of this Article, the |
9 | | total required State contribution for State fiscal year 2010 is |
10 | | $2,089,268,000 and shall be made from the proceeds of bonds |
11 | | sold in fiscal year 2010 pursuant to Section 7.2 of the General |
12 | | Obligation Bond Act, less (i) the pro rata share of bond sale |
13 | | expenses determined by the System's share of total bond |
14 | | proceeds, (ii) any amounts received from the Common School Fund |
15 | | in fiscal year 2010, and (iii) any reduction in bond proceeds |
16 | | due to the issuance of discounted bonds, if applicable. |
17 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of this Article, the
|
18 | | total required State contribution for State fiscal year 2011 is
|
19 | | the amount recertified by the System on or before April 1, 2011 |
20 | | pursuant to subsection (a-1) of this Section and shall be made |
21 | | from the proceeds of bonds
sold in fiscal year 2011 pursuant to |
22 | | Section 7.2 of the General
Obligation Bond Act, less (i) the |
23 | | pro rata share of bond sale
expenses determined by the System's |
24 | | share of total bond
proceeds, (ii) any amounts received from |
25 | | the Common School Fund
in fiscal year 2011, and (iii) any |
26 | | reduction in bond proceeds
due to the issuance of discounted |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 23 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | bonds, if applicable. This amount shall include, in addition to |
2 | | the amount certified by the System, an amount necessary to meet |
3 | | employer contributions required by the State as an employer |
4 | | under paragraph (e) of this Section, which may also be used by |
5 | | the System for contributions required by paragraph (a) of |
6 | | Section 16-127. |
7 | | Beginning in State fiscal year 2046, the minimum State |
8 | | contribution for
each fiscal year shall be the amount needed to |
9 | | maintain the total assets of
the System at 90% of the total |
10 | | actuarial liabilities of the System.
|
11 | | Amounts received by the System pursuant to Section 25 of |
12 | | the Budget Stabilization Act or Section 8.12 of the State |
13 | | Finance Act in any fiscal year do not reduce and do not |
14 | | constitute payment of any portion of the minimum State |
15 | | contribution required under this Article in that fiscal year. |
16 | | Such amounts shall not reduce, and shall not be included in the |
17 | | calculation of, the required State contributions under this |
18 | | Article in any future year until the System has reached a |
19 | | funding ratio of at least 90%. A reference in this Article to |
20 | | the "required State contribution" or any substantially similar |
21 | | term does not include or apply to any amounts payable to the |
22 | | System under Section 25 of the Budget Stabilization Act. |
23 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, the |
24 | | required State
contribution for State fiscal year 2005 and for |
25 | | fiscal year 2008 and each fiscal year thereafter, as
calculated |
26 | | under this Section and
certified under subsection (a-1), shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 24 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | not exceed an amount equal to (i) the
amount of the required |
2 | | State contribution that would have been calculated under
this |
3 | | Section for that fiscal year if the System had not received any |
4 | | payments
under subsection (d) of Section 7.2 of the General |
5 | | Obligation Bond Act, minus
(ii) the portion of the State's |
6 | | total debt service payments for that fiscal
year on the bonds |
7 | | issued in fiscal year 2003 for the purposes of that Section |
8 | | 7.2, as determined
and certified by the Comptroller, that is |
9 | | the same as the System's portion of
the total moneys |
10 | | distributed under subsection (d) of Section 7.2 of the General
|
11 | | Obligation Bond Act. In determining this maximum for State |
12 | | fiscal years 2008 through 2010, however, the amount referred to |
13 | | in item (i) shall be increased, as a percentage of the |
14 | | applicable employee payroll, in equal increments calculated |
15 | | from the sum of the required State contribution for State |
16 | | fiscal year 2007 plus the applicable portion of the State's |
17 | | total debt service payments for fiscal year 2007 on the bonds |
18 | | issued in fiscal year 2003 for the purposes of Section 7.2 of |
19 | | the General
Obligation Bond Act, so that, by State fiscal year |
20 | | 2011, the
State is contributing at the rate otherwise required |
21 | | under this Section.
|
22 | | (c) Payment of the required State contributions and of all |
23 | | pensions,
retirement annuities, death benefits, refunds, and |
24 | | other benefits granted
under or assumed by this System, and all |
25 | | expenses in connection with the
administration and operation |
26 | | thereof, are obligations of the State.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 25 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | If members are paid from special trust or federal funds |
2 | | which are
administered by the employing unit, whether school |
3 | | district or other
unit, the employing unit shall pay to the |
4 | | System from such
funds the full accruing retirement costs based |
5 | | upon that
service, which, beginning July 1, 2017 2014 , shall be |
6 | | at a rate, expressed as a percentage of salary, equal to the |
7 | | total employer's minimum contribution
to the System to be made |
8 | | by the State for that fiscal year, including both normal cost |
9 | | and unfunded liability components , expressed as a percentage of |
10 | | payroll, as determined by the System under subsection (b-3) of |
11 | | this Section . Employer contributions, based on
salary paid to |
12 | | members from federal funds, may be forwarded by the |
13 | | distributing
agency of the State of Illinois to the System |
14 | | prior to allocation, in an
amount determined in accordance with |
15 | | guidelines established by such
agency and the System. Any |
16 | | contribution for fiscal year 2015 collected as a result of the |
17 | | change made by this amendatory Act of the 98th General Assembly |
18 | | shall be considered a State contribution under subsection (b-3) |
19 | | of this Section.
|
20 | | (d) Effective July 1, 1986, any employer of a teacher as |
21 | | defined in
paragraph (8) of Section 16-106 shall pay the |
22 | | employer's normal cost
of benefits based upon the teacher's |
23 | | service, in addition to
employee contributions, as determined |
24 | | by the System. Such employer
contributions shall be forwarded |
25 | | monthly in accordance with guidelines
established by the |
26 | | System.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 26 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | However, with respect to benefits granted under Section |
2 | | 16-133.4 or
16-133.5 to a teacher as defined in paragraph (8) |
3 | | of Section 16-106, the
employer's contribution shall be 12% |
4 | | (rather than 20%) of the member's
highest annual salary rate |
5 | | for each year of creditable service granted, and
the employer |
6 | | shall also pay the required employee contribution on behalf of
|
7 | | the teacher. For the purposes of Sections 16-133.4 and |
8 | | 16-133.5, a teacher
as defined in paragraph (8) of Section |
9 | | 16-106 who is serving in that capacity
while on leave of |
10 | | absence from another employer under this Article shall not
be |
11 | | considered an employee of the employer from which the teacher |
12 | | is on leave.
|
13 | | (e) Beginning July 1, 1998, every employer of a teacher
|
14 | | shall pay to the System an employer contribution computed as |
15 | | follows:
|
16 | | (1) Beginning July 1, 1998 through June 30, 1999, the |
17 | | employer
contribution shall be equal to 0.3% of each |
18 | | teacher's salary.
|
19 | | (2) Beginning July 1, 1999 and thereafter, the employer
|
20 | | contribution shall be equal to 0.58% of each teacher's |
21 | | salary.
|
22 | | The school district or other employing unit may pay these |
23 | | employer
contributions out of any source of funding available |
24 | | for that purpose and
shall forward the contributions to the |
25 | | System on the schedule established
for the payment of member |
26 | | contributions.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 27 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | These employer contributions are intended to offset a |
2 | | portion of the cost
to the System of the increases in |
3 | | retirement benefits resulting from this
amendatory Act of 1998.
|
4 | | Each employer of teachers is entitled to a credit against |
5 | | the contributions
required under this subsection (e) with |
6 | | respect to salaries paid to teachers
for the period January 1, |
7 | | 2002 through June 30, 2003, equal to the amount paid
by that |
8 | | employer under subsection (a-5) of Section 6.6 of the State |
9 | | Employees
Group Insurance Act of 1971 with respect to salaries |
10 | | paid to teachers for that
period.
|
11 | | The additional 1% employee contribution required under |
12 | | Section 16-152 by
this amendatory Act of 1998 is the |
13 | | responsibility of the teacher and not the
teacher's employer, |
14 | | unless the employer agrees, through collective bargaining
or |
15 | | otherwise, to make the contribution on behalf of the teacher.
|
16 | | If an employer is required by a contract in effect on May |
17 | | 1, 1998 between the
employer and an employee organization to |
18 | | pay, on behalf of all its full-time
employees
covered by this |
19 | | Article, all mandatory employee contributions required under
|
20 | | this Article, then the employer shall be excused from paying |
21 | | the employer
contribution required under this subsection (e) |
22 | | for the balance of the term
of that contract. The employer and |
23 | | the employee organization shall jointly
certify to the System |
24 | | the existence of the contractual requirement, in such
form as |
25 | | the System may prescribe. This exclusion shall cease upon the
|
26 | | termination, extension, or renewal of the contract at any time |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 28 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | after May 1,
1998.
|
2 | | (f) If the amount of a teacher's salary for any school year |
3 | | used to determine final average salary exceeds the member's |
4 | | annual full-time salary rate with the same employer for the |
5 | | previous school year by more than 6%, the teacher's employer |
6 | | shall pay to the System, in addition to all other payments |
7 | | required under this Section and in accordance with guidelines |
8 | | established by the System, the present value of the increase in |
9 | | benefits resulting from the portion of the increase in salary |
10 | | that is in excess of 6%. This present value shall be computed |
11 | | by the System on the basis of the actuarial assumptions and |
12 | | tables used in the most recent actuarial valuation of the |
13 | | System that is available at the time of the computation. If a |
14 | | teacher's salary for the 2005-2006 school year is used to |
15 | | determine final average salary under this subsection (f), then |
16 | | the changes made to this subsection (f) by Public Act 94-1057 |
17 | | shall apply in calculating whether the increase in his or her |
18 | | salary is in excess of 6%. For the purposes of this Section, |
19 | | change in employment under Section 10-21.12 of the School Code |
20 | | on or after June 1, 2005 shall constitute a change in employer. |
21 | | The System may require the employer to provide any pertinent |
22 | | information or documentation.
The changes made to this |
23 | | subsection (f) by this amendatory Act of the 94th General |
24 | | Assembly apply without regard to whether the teacher was in |
25 | | service on or after its effective date.
|
26 | | Whenever it determines that a payment is or may be required |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 29 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | under this subsection, the System shall calculate the amount of |
2 | | the payment and bill the employer for that amount. The bill |
3 | | shall specify the calculations used to determine the amount |
4 | | due. If the employer disputes the amount of the bill, it may, |
5 | | within 30 days after receipt of the bill, apply to the System |
6 | | in writing for a recalculation. The application must specify in |
7 | | detail the grounds of the dispute and, if the employer asserts |
8 | | that the calculation is subject to subsection (g) or (h) of |
9 | | this Section, must include an affidavit setting forth and |
10 | | attesting to all facts within the employer's knowledge that are |
11 | | pertinent to the applicability of that subsection. Upon |
12 | | receiving a timely application for recalculation, the System |
13 | | shall review the application and, if appropriate, recalculate |
14 | | the amount due.
|
15 | | The employer contributions required under this subsection |
16 | | (f) may be paid in the form of a lump sum within 90 days after |
17 | | receipt of the bill. If the employer contributions are not paid |
18 | | within 90 days after receipt of the bill, then interest will be |
19 | | charged at a rate equal to the System's annual actuarially |
20 | | assumed rate of return on investment compounded annually from |
21 | | the 91st day after receipt of the bill. Payments must be |
22 | | concluded within 3 years after the employer's receipt of the |
23 | | bill.
|
24 | | (g) This subsection (g) applies only to payments made or |
25 | | salary increases given on or after June 1, 2005 but before July |
26 | | 1, 2011. The changes made by Public Act 94-1057 shall not |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 30 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | require the System to refund any payments received before
July |
2 | | 31, 2006 (the effective date of Public Act 94-1057). |
3 | | When assessing payment for any amount due under subsection |
4 | | (f), the System shall exclude salary increases paid to teachers |
5 | | under contracts or collective bargaining agreements entered |
6 | | into, amended, or renewed before June 1, 2005.
|
7 | | When assessing payment for any amount due under subsection |
8 | | (f), the System shall exclude salary increases paid to a |
9 | | teacher at a time when the teacher is 10 or more years from |
10 | | retirement eligibility under Section 16-132 or 16-133.2.
|
11 | | When assessing payment for any amount due under subsection |
12 | | (f), the System shall exclude salary increases resulting from |
13 | | overload work, including summer school, when the school |
14 | | district has certified to the System, and the System has |
15 | | approved the certification, that (i) the overload work is for |
16 | | the sole purpose of classroom instruction in excess of the |
17 | | standard number of classes for a full-time teacher in a school |
18 | | district during a school year and (ii) the salary increases are |
19 | | equal to or less than the rate of pay for classroom instruction |
20 | | computed on the teacher's current salary and work schedule.
|
21 | | When assessing payment for any amount due under subsection |
22 | | (f), the System shall exclude a salary increase resulting from |
23 | | a promotion (i) for which the employee is required to hold a |
24 | | certificate or supervisory endorsement issued by the State |
25 | | Teacher Certification Board that is a different certification |
26 | | or supervisory endorsement than is required for the teacher's |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 31 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | previous position and (ii) to a position that has existed and |
2 | | been filled by a member for no less than one complete academic |
3 | | year and the salary increase from the promotion is an increase |
4 | | that results in an amount no greater than the lesser of the |
5 | | average salary paid for other similar positions in the district |
6 | | requiring the same certification or the amount stipulated in |
7 | | the collective bargaining agreement for a similar position |
8 | | requiring the same certification.
|
9 | | When assessing payment for any amount due under subsection |
10 | | (f), the System shall exclude any payment to the teacher from |
11 | | the State of Illinois or the State Board of Education over |
12 | | which the employer does not have discretion, notwithstanding |
13 | | that the payment is included in the computation of final |
14 | | average salary.
|
15 | | (h) When assessing payment for any amount due under |
16 | | subsection (f), the System shall exclude any salary increase |
17 | | described in subsection (g) of this Section given on or after |
18 | | July 1, 2011 but before July 1, 2014 under a contract or |
19 | | collective bargaining agreement entered into, amended, or |
20 | | renewed on or after June 1, 2005 but before July 1, 2011. |
21 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, any |
22 | | payments made or salary increases given after June 30, 2014 |
23 | | shall be used in assessing payment for any amount due under |
24 | | subsection (f) of this Section.
|
25 | | (i) The System shall prepare a report and file copies of |
26 | | the report with the Governor and the General Assembly by |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 32 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | January 1, 2007 that contains all of the following information: |
2 | | (1) The number of recalculations required by the |
3 | | changes made to this Section by Public Act 94-1057 for each |
4 | | employer. |
5 | | (2) The dollar amount by which each employer's |
6 | | contribution to the System was changed due to |
7 | | recalculations required by Public Act 94-1057. |
8 | | (3) The total amount the System received from each |
9 | | employer as a result of the changes made to this Section by |
10 | | Public Act 94-4. |
11 | | (4) The increase in the required State contribution |
12 | | resulting from the changes made to this Section by Public |
13 | | Act 94-1057.
|
14 | | (j) For purposes of determining the required State |
15 | | contribution to the System, the value of the System's assets |
16 | | shall be equal to the actuarial value of the System's assets, |
17 | | which shall be calculated as follows: |
18 | | As of June 30, 2008, the actuarial value of the System's |
19 | | assets shall be equal to the market value of the assets as of |
20 | | that date. In determining the actuarial value of the System's |
21 | | assets for fiscal years after June 30, 2008, any actuarial |
22 | | gains or losses from investment return incurred in a fiscal |
23 | | year shall be recognized in equal annual amounts over the |
24 | | 5-year period following that fiscal year. |
25 | | (k) For purposes of determining the required State |
26 | | contribution to the system for a particular year, the actuarial |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 33 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | value of assets shall be assumed to earn a rate of return equal |
2 | | to the system's actuarially assumed rate of return. |
3 | | (Source: P.A. 96-43, eff. 7-15-09; 96-1497, eff. 1-14-11; |
4 | | 96-1511, eff. 1-27-11; 96-1554, eff. 3-18-11; 97-694, eff. |
5 | | 6-18-12; 97-813, eff. 7-13-12; 98-674, eff. 6-30-14.)
|
6 | | Section 20. The Innovation Development and Economy Act is |
7 | | amended by changing Section 33 as follows: |
8 | | (50 ILCS 470/33)
|
9 | | Sec. 33. STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust |
10 | | Fund. |
11 | | (a) The STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust |
12 | | Fund is created as a trust fund in the State treasury. Deposits |
13 | | into the Trust Fund shall be made as provided under this |
14 | | Section. Moneys in the Trust Fund shall be used by the |
15 | | Department of Revenue only for the purpose of making payments |
16 | | to school districts in educational service regions that include |
17 | | or are adjacent to the STAR bond district. Moneys in the Trust |
18 | | Fund are not subject to appropriation and shall be used solely |
19 | | as provided in this Section. All deposits into the Trust Fund |
20 | | shall be held in the Trust Fund by the State Treasurer as ex |
21 | | officio custodian separate and apart from all public moneys or |
22 | | funds of this State and shall be administered by the Department |
23 | | exclusively for the purposes set forth in this Section. All |
24 | | moneys in the Trust Fund shall be invested and reinvested by |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 34 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the State Treasurer. All interest accruing from these |
2 | | investments shall be deposited in the Trust Fund. |
3 | | (b) Upon approval of a STAR bond district, the political |
4 | | subdivision shall immediately transmit to the county clerk of |
5 | | the county in which the district is located a certified copy of |
6 | | the ordinance creating the district, a legal description of the |
7 | | district, a map of the district, identification of the year |
8 | | that the county clerk shall use for determining the total |
9 | | initial equalized assessed value of the district consistent |
10 | | with subsection (c), and a list of the parcel or tax |
11 | | identification number of each parcel of property included in |
12 | | the district. |
13 | | (c) Upon approval of a STAR bond district, the county clerk |
14 | | immediately thereafter shall determine (i) the most recently |
15 | | ascertained equalized assessed value of each lot, block, tract, |
16 | | or parcel of real property within the STAR bond district, from |
17 | | which shall be deducted the homestead exemptions under Article |
18 | | 15 of the Property Tax Code, which value shall be the initial |
19 | | equalized assessed value of each such piece of property, and |
20 | | (ii) the total equalized assessed value of all taxable real |
21 | | property within the district by adding together the most |
22 | | recently ascertained equalized assessed value of each taxable |
23 | | lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property within the |
24 | | district, from which shall be deducted the homestead exemptions |
25 | | under Article 15 of the Property Tax Code, and shall certify |
26 | | that amount as the total initial equalized assessed value of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 35 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the taxable real property within the STAR bond district. |
2 | | (d) In reference to any STAR bond district created within |
3 | | any political subdivision, and in respect to which the county |
4 | | clerk has certified the total initial equalized assessed value |
5 | | of the property in the area, the political subdivision may |
6 | | thereafter request the clerk in writing to adjust the initial |
7 | | equalized value of all taxable real property within the STAR |
8 | | bond district by deducting therefrom the exemptions under |
9 | | Article 15 of the Property Tax Code applicable to each lot, |
10 | | block, tract, or parcel of real property within the STAR bond |
11 | | district. The county clerk shall immediately, after the written |
12 | | request to adjust the total initial equalized value is |
13 | | received, determine the total homestead exemptions in the STAR |
14 | | bond district as provided under Article 15 of the Property Tax |
15 | | Code by adding together the homestead exemptions provided by |
16 | | said Article on each lot, block, tract, or parcel of real |
17 | | property within the STAR bond district and then shall deduct |
18 | | the total of said exemptions from the total initial equalized |
19 | | assessed value. The county clerk shall then promptly certify |
20 | | that amount as the total initial equalized assessed value as |
21 | | adjusted of the taxable real property within the STAR bond |
22 | | district. |
23 | | (e) The county clerk or other person authorized by law |
24 | | shall compute the tax rates for each taxing district with all |
25 | | or a portion of its equalized assessed value located in the |
26 | | STAR bond district. The rate per cent of tax determined shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 36 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be extended to the current equalized assessed value of all |
2 | | property in the district in the same manner as the rate per |
3 | | cent of tax is extended to all other taxable property in the |
4 | | taxing district. |
5 | | (f) Beginning with the assessment year in which the first |
6 | | destination user in the first STAR bond project in a STAR bond |
7 | | district makes its first retail sales and for each assessment |
8 | | year thereafter until final maturity of the last STAR bonds |
9 | | issued in the district, the county clerk or other person |
10 | | authorized by law shall determine the increase in equalized |
11 | | assessed value of all real property within the STAR bond |
12 | | district by subtracting the initial equalized assessed value of |
13 | | all property in the district certified under subsection (c) |
14 | | from the current equalized assessed value of all property in |
15 | | the district. Each year, the property taxes arising from the |
16 | | increase in equalized assessed value in the STAR bond district |
17 | | shall be determined for each taxing district and shall be |
18 | | certified to the county collector. |
19 | | (g) Beginning with the year in which taxes are collected |
20 | | based on the assessment year in which the first destination |
21 | | user in the first STAR bond project in a STAR bond district |
22 | | makes its first retail sales and for each year thereafter until |
23 | | final maturity of the last STAR bonds issued in the district, |
24 | | the county collector shall, within 30 days after receipt of |
25 | | property taxes, transmit to the Department to be deposited into |
26 | | the STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust Fund 15% |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 37 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of property taxes attributable to the increase in equalized |
2 | | assessed value within the STAR bond district from each taxing |
3 | | district as certified in subsection (f). |
4 | | (h) The Department shall pay to the regional superintendent |
5 | | of schools whose educational service region includes Franklin |
6 | | and Williamson Counties, for each year for which money is |
7 | | remitted to the Department and paid into the STAR Bonds School |
8 | | Improvement and Operations Trust Fund, the money in the Fund as |
9 | | provided in this Section. The amount paid to each school |
10 | | district shall be allocated
proportionately, based on each |
11 | | qualifying school district's
fall enrollment for the |
12 | | then-current school year, such that the school
district with |
13 | | the largest fall enrollment receives the largest
proportionate |
14 | | share of money paid out of the Fund or by any other method or |
15 | | formula that the regional superintendent of schools deems fit, |
16 | | equitable, and in the public interest. The regional |
17 | | superintendent may allocate moneys to school districts that are |
18 | | outside of his or her educational service region or to other |
19 | | regional superintendents. |
20 | | The Department shall determine the distributions under |
21 | | this Section using its best judgment and information. The |
22 | | Department shall be held harmless for the distributions made |
23 | | under this Section and all distributions shall be final. |
24 | | (i) In any year that an assessment appeal is filed, the |
25 | | extension of taxes on any assessment so appealed shall not be |
26 | | delayed. In the case of an assessment that is altered, any |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 38 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | taxes extended upon the unauthorized assessment or part thereof |
2 | | shall be abated, or, if already paid, shall be refunded with |
3 | | interest as provided in Section 23-20 of the Property Tax Code. |
4 | | In the case of an assessment appeal, the county collector shall |
5 | | notify the Department that an assessment appeal has been filed |
6 | | and the amount of the tax that would have been deposited in the |
7 | | STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust Fund. The |
8 | | county collector shall hold that amount in a separate fund |
9 | | until the appeal process is final. After the appeal process is |
10 | | finalized, the county collector shall transmit to the |
11 | | Department the amount of tax that remains, if any, after all |
12 | | required refunds are made. The Department shall pay any amount |
13 | | deposited into the Trust Fund under this Section in the same |
14 | | proportion as determined for payments for that taxable year |
15 | | under subsection (h). |
16 | | (j) In any year that ad valorem taxes are allocated to the |
17 | | STAR Bonds School Improvement and Operations Trust Fund, that |
18 | | allocation shall not reduce or otherwise impact the school aid |
19 | | provided to any school district under the general State school |
20 | | aid formula provided for in Section 18-8.05 of the School Code |
21 | | or the evidence-based funding formula provided for in Section |
22 | | 18-8.15 of the School Code .
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 96-939, eff. 6-24-10.) |
24 | | Section 25. The County Economic Development Project Area |
25 | | Property
Tax Allocation Act is amended by changing Section 7 as |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 39 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | follows:
|
2 | | (55 ILCS 85/7) (from Ch. 34, par. 7007)
|
3 | | Sec. 7. Creation of special tax allocation fund. If a |
4 | | county has
adopted property tax allocation financing by |
5 | | ordinance for an economic
development project area, the |
6 | | Department has approved and certified the
economic development |
7 | | project area, and the county clerk has thereafter
certified the |
8 | | "total initial equalized value" of the taxable real property
|
9 | | within such economic development project area in the manner |
10 | | provided in
subsection (b) of Section 6 of this Act, each year |
11 | | after the date of the
certification by the county clerk of the |
12 | | "initial equalized assessed value"
until economic development |
13 | | project costs and all county obligations
financing economic |
14 | | development project costs have been paid, the ad valorem
taxes, |
15 | | if any, arising from the levies upon the taxable real property |
16 | | in
the economic development project area by taxing districts |
17 | | and tax rates
determined in the manner provided in subsection |
18 | | (b) of Section 6 of this Act
shall be divided as follows:
|
19 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable |
20 | | lot, block, tract
or parcel of real property which is |
21 | | attributable to the lower of the current
equalized assessed |
22 | | value or the initial equalized assessed value of each
such |
23 | | taxable lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property |
24 | | existing at the
time property tax allocation financing was |
25 | | adopted shall be allocated and
when collected shall be paid |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 40 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | by the county collector to the respective
affected taxing |
2 | | districts in the manner required by the law in the absence
|
3 | | of the adoption of property tax allocation financing.
|
4 | | (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes which is |
5 | | attributable to the
increase in the current equalized |
6 | | assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or |
7 | | parcel of real property in the economic development
project |
8 | | are, over and above the initial equalized assessed value of |
9 | | each
property existing at the time property tax allocation |
10 | | financing was
adopted shall be allocated to and when |
11 | | collected shall be paid to the
county treasurer, who shall |
12 | | deposit those taxes into a special fund called
the special |
13 | | tax allocation fund of the county for the purpose of paying
|
14 | | economic development project costs and obligations |
15 | | incurred in the payment
thereof.
|
16 | | The county, by an ordinance adopting property tax |
17 | | allocation financing,
may pledge the funds in and to be |
18 | | deposited in the special tax allocation
fund for the payment of |
19 | | obligations issued under this Act and for the
payment of |
20 | | economic development project costs. No part of the current
|
21 | | equalized assessed valuation of each property in the economic |
22 | | development
project area attributable to any increase above the |
23 | | total initial equalized
assessed value of such properties shall |
24 | | be used in calculating the general
State school aid formula, |
25 | | provided for in Section 18-8 of the School Code, or the |
26 | | evidence-based funding formula, provided for in Section |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 41 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 18-8.15 of the School Code,
until such time as all economic |
2 | | development projects costs have been paid
as provided for in |
3 | | this Section.
|
4 | | Whenever a county issues bonds for the purpose of financing |
5 | | economic
development project costs, the county may provide by |
6 | | ordinance for the
appointment of a trustee, which may be any |
7 | | trust company within the State,
and for the establishment of |
8 | | the funds or accounts to be maintained by such
trustee as the |
9 | | county shall deem necessary to provide for the security and
|
10 | | payment of the bonds. If the county provides for the |
11 | | appointment of a
trustee, the trustee shall be considered the |
12 | | assignee of any payments
assigned by the county pursuant to the |
13 | | ordinance and this Section. Any
amounts paid to the trustee as |
14 | | assignee shall be deposited in the funds or
accounts |
15 | | established pursuant to the trust agreement, and shall be held |
16 | | by
the trustee in trust for the benefit of the holders of the |
17 | | bonds, and the
holders shall have a lien on and a security |
18 | | interest in those bonds or
accounts so long as the bonds remain |
19 | | outstanding and unpaid. Upon
retirement of the bonds, the |
20 | | trustee shall pay over any excess amounts held
to the county |
21 | | for deposit in the special tax allocation fund.
|
22 | | When the economic development project costs, including |
23 | | without limitation
all county obligations financing economic |
24 | | development project costs
incurred under this Act, have been |
25 | | paid, all surplus funds then remaining
in the special tax |
26 | | allocation funds shall be distributed by being paid by
the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 42 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | county treasurer to the county collector, who shall immediately
|
2 | | thereafter pay those funds to the taxing districts having |
3 | | taxable property
in the economic development project area in |
4 | | the same manner and proportion
as the most recent distribution |
5 | | by the county collector to those taxing
districts of real |
6 | | property taxes from real property in the economic
development |
7 | | project area.
|
8 | | Upon the payment of all economic development project costs, |
9 | | retirement of
obligations and the distribution of any excess |
10 | | monies pursuant to this
Section and not later than 23 years |
11 | | from the date of adoption of the
ordinance adopting property |
12 | | tax allocation financing, the county shall
adopt an ordinance |
13 | | dissolving the special tax allocation fund for the
economic |
14 | | development project area and terminating the designation of the
|
15 | | economic development project area as an economic development |
16 | | project area; however, in relation to one or more contiguous |
17 | | parcels not exceeding a total area of 120 acres within which an |
18 | | electric generating facility is intended to be constructed, and |
19 | | with respect to which the owner of that proposed electric |
20 | | generating facility has entered into a redevelopment agreement |
21 | | with Grundy County on or before July 25, 2017, the ordinance of |
22 | | the county required in this paragraph shall not dissolve the |
23 | | special tax allocation fund for the existing economic |
24 | | development project area and shall only terminate the |
25 | | designation of the economic development project area as to |
26 | | those portions of the economic development project area |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 43 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | excluding the area covered by the redevelopment agreement |
2 | | between the owner of the proposed electric generating facility |
3 | | and Grundy County; the county shall adopt an ordinance |
4 | | dissolving the special tax allocation fund for the economic |
5 | | development project area and terminating the designation of the |
6 | | economic development project area as an economic development |
7 | | project area with regard to the electric generating facility |
8 | | property not later than 35 years from the date of adoption of |
9 | | the ordinance adopting property tax allocation financing.
|
10 | | Thereafter the rates of the taxing districts shall be extended |
11 | | and taxes
levied, collected and distributed in the manner |
12 | | applicable in the absence
of the adoption of property tax |
13 | | allocation financing.
|
14 | | Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving |
15 | | property in
economic development project areas from being |
16 | | assessed as provided in the
Property Tax Code or as relieving |
17 | | owners of that
property from paying a uniform rate of taxes, as |
18 | | required by Section 4 of
Article IX of the Illinois |
19 | | Constitution of 1970.
|
20 | | (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 99-513, eff. 6-30-16.)
|
21 | | Section 30. The County Economic Development Project Area |
22 | | Tax Increment
Allocation Act of 1991 is amended by changing |
23 | | Section 50 as follows:
|
24 | | (55 ILCS 90/50) (from Ch. 34, par. 8050)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 44 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 50. Special tax allocation fund.
|
2 | | (a) If a county clerk has certified the "total initial |
3 | | equalized
assessed value" of the taxable real property within |
4 | | an economic development
project area in the manner provided in |
5 | | Section 45, each year
after the date of the certification by |
6 | | the county clerk of the "total
initial equalized assessed |
7 | | value", until economic development project costs
and all county |
8 | | obligations financing economic development
project costs have |
9 | | been paid, the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from
the |
10 | | levies upon the taxable real property in the economic |
11 | | development
project area by taxing districts and tax rates |
12 | | determined in the manner
provided in subsection (b) of Section |
13 | | 45 shall be divided as follows:
|
14 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable |
15 | | lot, block,
tract, or parcel of real property that is |
16 | | attributable to the lower of the
current equalized assessed |
17 | | value or the initial equalized assessed value of
each |
18 | | taxable lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property |
19 | | existing at
the time tax increment financing was adopted |
20 | | shall be allocated to (and
when collected shall be paid by |
21 | | the county collector to) the respective
affected taxing |
22 | | districts in the manner required by law in the absence of
|
23 | | the adoption of tax increment allocation financing.
|
24 | | (2) That portion, if any, of the taxes that is |
25 | | attributable to the
increase in the current equalized |
26 | | assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 45 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | parcel of real property in the economic development
project |
2 | | area, over and above the initial equalized assessed value |
3 | | of each
property existing at the time tax increment |
4 | | financing was adopted, shall be
allocated to (and when |
5 | | collected shall be paid to) the county treasurer,
who shall |
6 | | deposit the taxes into a special fund (called the special |
7 | | tax
allocation fund of the county) for the purpose of |
8 | | paying economic development
project costs and obligations |
9 | | incurred in the payment of those costs.
|
10 | | (b) The county, by an ordinance adopting tax increment
|
11 | | allocation financing, may pledge the monies in and to be |
12 | | deposited into the
special tax allocation fund for the payment |
13 | | of obligations issued under
this Act and for the payment of |
14 | | economic development project costs. No
part of the current |
15 | | equalized assessed valuation of each property in the
economic |
16 | | development project area attributable to any increase above the
|
17 | | total initial equalized assessed value of those properties |
18 | | shall be used in
calculating the general State school aid |
19 | | formula under Section
18-8 of the School Code or the |
20 | | evidence-based funding formula under Section 18-8.15 of the |
21 | | School Code until all economic development
projects costs have |
22 | | been paid as provided for in this Section.
|
23 | | (c) When the economic development projects costs, |
24 | | including without
limitation all county obligations financing |
25 | | economic
development project costs incurred under this Act, |
26 | | have been paid, all
surplus monies then remaining in the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 46 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | special tax allocation fund shall be
distributed by being paid |
2 | | by the county treasurer to the
county collector, who shall |
3 | | immediately pay the monies to the
taxing districts having |
4 | | taxable property in the economic development
project area in |
5 | | the same manner and proportion as the most recent
distribution |
6 | | by the county collector to those taxing districts of real
|
7 | | property taxes from real property in the economic development |
8 | | project area.
|
9 | | (d) Upon the payment of all economic development project |
10 | | costs,
retirement of obligations, and distribution of any |
11 | | excess monies
under this Section, the county shall adopt an |
12 | | ordinance dissolving the
special tax allocation fund for the |
13 | | economic development project area and
terminating the |
14 | | designation of the economic development project area as an
|
15 | | economic development project area. Thereafter, the rates of the |
16 | | taxing
districts shall be extended and taxes shall be levied, |
17 | | collected, and
distributed in the manner applicable in the |
18 | | absence of the adoption of tax
increment allocation financing.
|
19 | | (e) Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving |
20 | | property in
the economic development project areas from being |
21 | | assessed as provided in
the Property Tax Code or as relieving |
22 | | owners of
that property from paying a uniform rate of taxes as |
23 | | required by Section 4 of
Article IX of the Illinois |
24 | | Constitution.
|
25 | | (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13.)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 47 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 35. The Illinois Municipal Code is amended by |
2 | | changing Sections 11-74.4-3, 11-74.4-8, and 11-74.6-35 as |
3 | | follows:
|
4 | | (65 ILCS 5/11-74.4-3) (from Ch. 24, par. 11-74.4-3)
|
5 | | Sec. 11-74.4-3. Definitions. The following terms, wherever |
6 | | used or
referred to in this Division 74.4 shall have the |
7 | | following respective meanings,
unless in any case a different |
8 | | meaning clearly appears from the context.
|
9 | | (a) For any redevelopment project area that has been |
10 | | designated pursuant
to this
Section by an ordinance adopted |
11 | | prior to November 1, 1999 (the effective
date of Public Act
|
12 | | 91-478), "blighted area" shall have the meaning set
forth in |
13 | | this Section
prior to that date.
|
14 | | On and after November 1, 1999,
"blighted area" means any |
15 | | improved or vacant area within the boundaries
of a |
16 | | redevelopment project area located within the territorial |
17 | | limits of
the municipality where:
|
18 | | (1) If improved, industrial, commercial, and |
19 | | residential buildings or
improvements are detrimental to |
20 | | the public safety, health, or welfare
because of a |
21 | | combination of 5 or more of the following factors, each of |
22 | | which
is (i) present, with that presence documented, to a |
23 | | meaningful extent so
that a municipality may reasonably |
24 | | find that the factor is clearly
present within the intent |
25 | | of the Act and (ii) reasonably distributed throughout
the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 48 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | improved part of the redevelopment project area:
|
2 | | (A) Dilapidation. An advanced state of disrepair |
3 | | or neglect of
necessary
repairs to the primary |
4 | | structural components of buildings or improvements in
|
5 | | such a combination that a documented building |
6 | | condition analysis determines
that major repair is |
7 | | required or the defects are so serious and so extensive
|
8 | | that the buildings must be removed.
|
9 | | (B) Obsolescence. The condition or process of |
10 | | falling into disuse.
Structures have become ill-suited |
11 | | for the original use.
|
12 | | (C) Deterioration. With respect to buildings, |
13 | | defects
including, but not limited to, major defects in
|
14 | | the secondary building components such as doors, |
15 | | windows, porches, gutters and
downspouts, and fascia. |
16 | | With respect to surface improvements, that the
|
17 | | condition of roadways, alleys, curbs, gutters, |
18 | | sidewalks, off-street parking,
and surface storage |
19 | | areas evidence deterioration, including, but not |
20 | | limited
to, surface cracking, crumbling, potholes, |
21 | | depressions, loose paving material,
and weeds |
22 | | protruding through paved surfaces.
|
23 | | (D) Presence of structures below minimum code |
24 | | standards. All structures
that do not meet the |
25 | | standards of zoning, subdivision, building, fire, and
|
26 | | other governmental codes applicable to property, but |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 49 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | not including housing and
property maintenance codes.
|
2 | | (E) Illegal use of individual structures. The use |
3 | | of structures in
violation of applicable federal, |
4 | | State, or local laws, exclusive of those
applicable to |
5 | | the presence of structures below minimum code |
6 | | standards.
|
7 | | (F) Excessive vacancies. The presence of
buildings |
8 | | that are unoccupied or under-utilized and that |
9 | | represent an adverse
influence on the area because of |
10 | | the frequency, extent, or duration of the
vacancies.
|
11 | | (G) Lack of ventilation, light, or sanitary |
12 | | facilities. The absence of
adequate ventilation for |
13 | | light or air circulation in spaces or rooms without
|
14 | | windows, or that require the removal of dust, odor, |
15 | | gas, smoke, or other
noxious airborne materials. |
16 | | Inadequate natural light and ventilation means
the |
17 | | absence of skylights or windows for interior spaces or |
18 | | rooms and improper
window sizes and amounts by room |
19 | | area to window area ratios. Inadequate
sanitary |
20 | | facilities refers to the absence or inadequacy of |
21 | | garbage storage and
enclosure,
bathroom facilities, |
22 | | hot water and kitchens, and structural inadequacies
|
23 | | preventing ingress and egress to and from all rooms and |
24 | | units within a
building.
|
25 | | (H) Inadequate utilities. Underground and overhead |
26 | | utilities
such as storm sewers and storm drainage, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 50 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | sanitary sewers, water lines, and
gas, telephone, and
|
2 | | electrical services that are shown to be inadequate. |
3 | | Inadequate utilities are
those that are: (i) of |
4 | | insufficient capacity to serve the uses in the
|
5 | | redevelopment project area, (ii) deteriorated,
|
6 | | antiquated, obsolete, or in disrepair, or (iii) |
7 | | lacking within the
redevelopment project area.
|
8 | | (I) Excessive land coverage and overcrowding of |
9 | | structures and community
facilities. The |
10 | | over-intensive use of property and the crowding of |
11 | | buildings
and accessory facilities onto a site. |
12 | | Examples of problem conditions
warranting the |
13 | | designation of an area as one exhibiting excessive land |
14 | | coverage
are: (i) the presence of buildings either |
15 | | improperly situated on parcels or
located
on parcels of |
16 | | inadequate size and shape in relation to present-day |
17 | | standards of
development for health and safety and (ii) |
18 | | the presence of multiple buildings
on a
single parcel. |
19 | | For there to be a finding of excessive land coverage,
|
20 | | these parcels must exhibit one or more of the following |
21 | | conditions:
insufficient provision for
light and air |
22 | | within or around buildings, increased threat of spread |
23 | | of fire
due to the close proximity of buildings, lack |
24 | | of adequate or proper access to a
public right-of-way, |
25 | | lack of reasonably required off-street parking, or
|
26 | | inadequate provision for loading and service.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 51 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (J) Deleterious land use or layout. The existence |
2 | | of incompatible
land-use
relationships, buildings |
3 | | occupied by inappropriate mixed-uses, or uses
|
4 | | considered to be noxious, offensive, or unsuitable for |
5 | | the
surrounding area.
|
6 | | (K) Environmental clean-up. The proposed |
7 | | redevelopment project area
has incurred Illinois |
8 | | Environmental Protection Agency or United States
|
9 | | Environmental Protection Agency remediation costs for, |
10 | | or a study conducted by
an independent consultant |
11 | | recognized as having expertise in environmental
|
12 | | remediation has determined a need for, the
clean-up of |
13 | | hazardous
waste, hazardous substances, or underground |
14 | | storage tanks required by State or
federal law, |
15 | | provided that the remediation costs constitute a |
16 | | material
impediment to the development or |
17 | | redevelopment of the redevelopment project
area.
|
18 | | (L) Lack of community planning. The proposed |
19 | | redevelopment project area
was
developed prior to or |
20 | | without the benefit or guidance of a community plan.
|
21 | | This means that the development occurred prior to the |
22 | | adoption by the
municipality of a comprehensive or |
23 | | other community plan or that the plan was
not followed |
24 | | at the time of the area's development. This factor must |
25 | | be
documented by evidence of adverse or incompatible |
26 | | land-use relationships,
inadequate street layout, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 52 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | improper subdivision, parcels of inadequate shape and
|
2 | | size to meet contemporary development standards, or |
3 | | other evidence
demonstrating
an absence of effective |
4 | | community planning.
|
5 | | (M) The total equalized assessed value of the |
6 | | proposed redevelopment
project area has declined for 3 |
7 | | of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the year in which |
8 | | the redevelopment project area is designated
or is |
9 | | increasing at an
annual rate that is less
than the |
10 | | balance of the municipality for 3 of the last 5 |
11 | | calendar years
for which
information is available or is |
12 | | increasing at an annual rate that is less than
the |
13 | | Consumer Price Index
for All Urban Consumers published |
14 | | by the United States Department of Labor or
successor |
15 | | agency for 3 of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the |
16 | | year in which the redevelopment project area is |
17 | | designated.
|
18 | | (2) If vacant, the sound growth of the redevelopment |
19 | | project area
is impaired by a
combination of 2 or more of |
20 | | the following factors, each of which
is (i) present, with |
21 | | that presence documented, to a meaningful extent so
that
a |
22 | | municipality may reasonably find that the factor is clearly |
23 | | present
within the intent of the Act and (ii) reasonably |
24 | | distributed throughout the
vacant part of the
|
25 | | redevelopment project area to which it pertains:
|
26 | | (A) Obsolete platting of vacant land that results |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 53 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | in parcels of
limited or
narrow size or configurations |
2 | | of parcels of irregular size or shape that would
be |
3 | | difficult to develop on
a planned basis and in a manner |
4 | | compatible with contemporary standards and
|
5 | | requirements, or platting that failed to create |
6 | | rights-of-ways for streets or
alleys or that created |
7 | | inadequate right-of-way widths for streets, alleys, or
|
8 | | other public rights-of-way or that omitted easements |
9 | | for public utilities.
|
10 | | (B) Diversity of ownership of parcels of vacant |
11 | | land sufficient in
number to
retard or impede the |
12 | | ability to assemble the land for development.
|
13 | | (C) Tax and special assessment delinquencies exist |
14 | | or the property has
been the subject of tax sales under |
15 | | the Property Tax Code within the last 5
years.
|
16 | | (D) Deterioration of structures or site |
17 | | improvements in neighboring
areas adjacent to the |
18 | | vacant land.
|
19 | | (E) The area has incurred Illinois Environmental |
20 | | Protection Agency or
United States Environmental |
21 | | Protection Agency remediation costs for, or a study
|
22 | | conducted by an independent consultant recognized as |
23 | | having expertise in
environmental remediation has |
24 | | determined a need for, the
clean-up of hazardous
waste, |
25 | | hazardous substances, or underground storage tanks |
26 | | required by State or
federal law, provided that the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 54 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | remediation costs
constitute a material impediment to |
2 | | the development or redevelopment of
the
redevelopment |
3 | | project area.
|
4 | | (F) The total equalized assessed value of the |
5 | | proposed redevelopment
project area has declined for 3 |
6 | | of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the year in which |
7 | | the redevelopment project area is designated
or is |
8 | | increasing at an
annual rate that is less
than the |
9 | | balance of the municipality for 3 of the last 5 |
10 | | calendar years for
which information is available or is |
11 | | increasing at an annual rate that is less
than
the |
12 | | Consumer Price Index
for All Urban Consumers published |
13 | | by the United States Department of Labor or
successor |
14 | | agency for 3 of the last 5 calendar years
prior to the |
15 | | year in which the redevelopment project area is |
16 | | designated.
|
17 | | (3) If vacant, the sound growth of the redevelopment |
18 | | project area is
impaired by one of the
following factors |
19 | | that (i) is present, with that presence documented, to a
|
20 | | meaningful extent so that a municipality may reasonably |
21 | | find that the factor is
clearly
present within the intent |
22 | | of the Act and (ii) is reasonably distributed
throughout |
23 | | the vacant part of the
redevelopment project area to which |
24 | | it pertains:
|
25 | | (A) The area consists of one or more unused |
26 | | quarries, mines, or strip
mine ponds.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 55 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (B) The area consists of unused rail yards, rail |
2 | | tracks, or railroad
rights-of-way.
|
3 | | (C) The area, prior to its designation, is subject |
4 | | to (i) chronic
flooding
that adversely impacts on real |
5 | | property in the area as certified by a
registered
|
6 | | professional engineer or appropriate regulatory agency |
7 | | or (ii) surface water
that
discharges from all or a |
8 | | part of the area and contributes to flooding within
the
|
9 | | same watershed, but only if the redevelopment project |
10 | | provides for facilities
or
improvements to contribute |
11 | | to the alleviation of all or part of the
flooding.
|
12 | | (D) The area consists of an unused or illegal |
13 | | disposal site containing
earth,
stone, building |
14 | | debris, or similar materials that were removed from
|
15 | | construction, demolition, excavation, or dredge sites.
|
16 | | (E) Prior to November 1, 1999, the area
is not less |
17 | | than 50 nor more than 100 acres and 75%
of which is |
18 | | vacant (notwithstanding that the area has been used
for |
19 | | commercial agricultural purposes within 5 years prior |
20 | | to the designation
of the redevelopment project area), |
21 | | and the area meets at least one of
the factors itemized |
22 | | in paragraph (1) of this subsection, the area
has been |
23 | | designated as a town or village center by ordinance or |
24 | | comprehensive
plan adopted prior to January 1, 1982, |
25 | | and the area has not been developed
for that designated |
26 | | purpose.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 56 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (F) The area qualified as a blighted improved area |
2 | | immediately prior to
becoming vacant, unless there has |
3 | | been substantial private investment in the
immediately |
4 | | surrounding area.
|
5 | | (b) For any redevelopment project area that has been |
6 | | designated pursuant
to this
Section by an ordinance adopted |
7 | | prior to November 1, 1999 (the effective
date of Public Act
|
8 | | 91-478), "conservation area" shall have the meaning
set forth |
9 | | in this
Section prior to that date.
|
10 | | On and after November 1, 1999,
"conservation area" means |
11 | | any improved area within the boundaries
of a redevelopment |
12 | | project area located within the territorial limits of
the |
13 | | municipality in which 50% or more of the structures in the area |
14 | | have
an age of 35 years or more.
Such an area is not yet a |
15 | | blighted area but
because of a combination of 3 or more of the |
16 | | following factors is detrimental
to the public safety, health, |
17 | | morals
or welfare and such an area may become a blighted area:
|
18 | | (1) Dilapidation. An advanced state of disrepair or |
19 | | neglect of
necessary
repairs to the primary structural |
20 | | components of buildings or improvements in
such a |
21 | | combination that a documented building condition analysis |
22 | | determines
that major repair is required or the defects are |
23 | | so serious and so extensive
that the buildings must be |
24 | | removed.
|
25 | | (2) Obsolescence. The condition or process of falling |
26 | | into disuse.
Structures have become ill-suited for the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 57 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | original use.
|
2 | | (3) Deterioration. With respect to buildings, defects
|
3 | | including, but not limited to, major defects in
the |
4 | | secondary building components such as doors, windows, |
5 | | porches, gutters and
downspouts, and fascia. With respect |
6 | | to surface improvements, that the
condition of roadways, |
7 | | alleys, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, off-street parking,
and |
8 | | surface storage areas evidence deterioration, including, |
9 | | but not limited
to, surface cracking, crumbling, potholes, |
10 | | depressions, loose paving material,
and weeds protruding |
11 | | through paved surfaces.
|
12 | | (4) Presence of structures below minimum code |
13 | | standards. All structures
that do not meet the standards of |
14 | | zoning, subdivision, building, fire, and
other |
15 | | governmental codes applicable to property, but not |
16 | | including housing and
property maintenance codes.
|
17 | | (5) Illegal use of individual structures. The use of |
18 | | structures in
violation of applicable federal, State, or |
19 | | local laws, exclusive of those
applicable to the presence |
20 | | of structures below minimum code standards.
|
21 | | (6) Excessive vacancies. The presence of
buildings |
22 | | that are unoccupied or under-utilized and that represent an |
23 | | adverse
influence on the area because of the frequency, |
24 | | extent, or duration of the
vacancies.
|
25 | | (7) Lack of ventilation, light, or sanitary |
26 | | facilities. The absence of
adequate ventilation for light |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 58 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | or air circulation in spaces or rooms without
windows, or |
2 | | that require the removal of dust, odor, gas, smoke, or |
3 | | other
noxious airborne materials. Inadequate natural light |
4 | | and ventilation means
the absence or inadequacy of |
5 | | skylights or windows for interior spaces or rooms
and |
6 | | improper
window sizes and amounts by room area to window |
7 | | area ratios. Inadequate
sanitary facilities refers to the |
8 | | absence or inadequacy of garbage storage and
enclosure,
|
9 | | bathroom facilities, hot water and kitchens, and |
10 | | structural inadequacies
preventing ingress and egress to |
11 | | and from all rooms and units within a
building.
|
12 | | (8) Inadequate utilities. Underground and overhead |
13 | | utilities
such as storm sewers and storm drainage, sanitary |
14 | | sewers, water lines, and gas,
telephone, and
electrical |
15 | | services that are shown to be inadequate. Inadequate |
16 | | utilities are
those that are: (i) of insufficient capacity |
17 | | to serve the uses in the
redevelopment project area, (ii) |
18 | | deteriorated,
antiquated, obsolete, or in disrepair, or |
19 | | (iii) lacking within the
redevelopment project area.
|
20 | | (9) Excessive land coverage and overcrowding of |
21 | | structures and community
facilities. The over-intensive |
22 | | use of property and the crowding of buildings
and accessory |
23 | | facilities onto a site. Examples of problem conditions
|
24 | | warranting the designation of an area as one exhibiting |
25 | | excessive land coverage
are: the presence of buildings |
26 | | either improperly situated on parcels or located
on parcels |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 59 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of inadequate size and shape in relation to present-day |
2 | | standards of
development for health and safety and the |
3 | | presence of multiple buildings on a
single parcel. For |
4 | | there to be a finding of excessive land coverage,
these |
5 | | parcels must exhibit one or more of the following |
6 | | conditions:
insufficient provision for
light and air |
7 | | within or around buildings, increased threat of spread of |
8 | | fire
due to the close proximity of buildings, lack of |
9 | | adequate or proper access to a
public right-of-way, lack of |
10 | | reasonably required off-street parking, or
inadequate |
11 | | provision for loading and service.
|
12 | | (10) Deleterious land use or layout. The existence of |
13 | | incompatible
land-use
relationships, buildings occupied by |
14 | | inappropriate mixed-uses, or uses
considered to be |
15 | | noxious, offensive, or unsuitable for the
surrounding |
16 | | area.
|
17 | | (11) Lack of community planning. The proposed |
18 | | redevelopment project area
was
developed prior to or |
19 | | without the benefit or guidance of a community plan.
This |
20 | | means that the development occurred prior to the adoption |
21 | | by the
municipality of a comprehensive or other community |
22 | | plan or that the plan was
not followed at the time of the |
23 | | area's development. This factor must be
documented by |
24 | | evidence of adverse or incompatible land-use |
25 | | relationships,
inadequate street layout, improper |
26 | | subdivision, parcels of inadequate shape and
size to meet |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 60 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | contemporary development standards, or other evidence
|
2 | | demonstrating
an absence of effective community planning.
|
3 | | (12) The area has incurred Illinois Environmental |
4 | | Protection Agency or
United
States Environmental |
5 | | Protection Agency remediation costs for, or a study
|
6 | | conducted by an independent consultant recognized as |
7 | | having expertise in
environmental remediation has |
8 | | determined a need for, the clean-up of hazardous
waste, |
9 | | hazardous substances, or underground storage tanks |
10 | | required by State
or federal law, provided that the |
11 | | remediation costs constitute a material
impediment to the |
12 | | development or redevelopment of the redevelopment project
|
13 | | area.
|
14 | | (13) The total equalized assessed value of the proposed |
15 | | redevelopment
project area has declined for 3 of the last 5 |
16 | | calendar years
for which information is
available or is |
17 | | increasing at an annual rate that is less than the balance |
18 | | of
the municipality for 3 of the last 5 calendar years for |
19 | | which information is
available or is increasing at an |
20 | | annual rate that is less
than the Consumer Price Index for |
21 | | All Urban Consumers published by the United
States |
22 | | Department of Labor or successor agency for 3 of the last 5 |
23 | | calendar
years for which information is available.
|
24 | | (c) "Industrial park" means an area in a blighted or |
25 | | conservation
area suitable for use by any manufacturing, |
26 | | industrial, research or
transportation enterprise, of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 61 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | facilities to include but not be limited to
factories, mills, |
2 | | processing plants, assembly plants, packing plants,
|
3 | | fabricating plants, industrial distribution centers, |
4 | | warehouses, repair
overhaul or service facilities, freight |
5 | | terminals, research facilities,
test facilities or railroad |
6 | | facilities.
|
7 | | (d) "Industrial park conservation area" means an area |
8 | | within the
boundaries of a redevelopment project area located |
9 | | within the territorial
limits of a municipality that is a labor |
10 | | surplus municipality or within 1
1/2 miles of the territorial |
11 | | limits of a municipality that is a labor
surplus municipality |
12 | | if the area is annexed to the municipality; which
area is zoned |
13 | | as industrial no later than at the time the municipality by
|
14 | | ordinance designates the redevelopment project area, and which |
15 | | area
includes both vacant land suitable for use as an |
16 | | industrial park and a
blighted area or conservation area |
17 | | contiguous to such vacant land.
|
18 | | (e) "Labor surplus municipality" means a municipality in |
19 | | which, at any
time during the 6 months before the municipality |
20 | | by ordinance designates
an industrial park conservation area, |
21 | | the unemployment rate was over 6% and was
also 100% or more of |
22 | | the national average unemployment rate for that same
time as |
23 | | published in the United States Department of Labor Bureau of |
24 | | Labor
Statistics publication entitled "The Employment |
25 | | Situation" or its successor
publication. For the purpose of |
26 | | this subsection, if unemployment rate
statistics for the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 62 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | municipality are not available, the unemployment rate in
the |
2 | | municipality shall be deemed to be the same as the unemployment |
3 | | rate in
the principal county in which the municipality is |
4 | | located.
|
5 | | (f) "Municipality" shall mean a city, village, |
6 | | incorporated town, or a township that is located in the |
7 | | unincorporated portion of a county with 3 million or more |
8 | | inhabitants, if the county adopted an ordinance that approved |
9 | | the township's redevelopment plan.
|
10 | | (g) "Initial Sales Tax Amounts" means the amount of taxes |
11 | | paid under
the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, Use Tax Act, |
12 | | Service Use Tax Act, the
Service Occupation Tax Act, the |
13 | | Municipal Retailers' Occupation Tax Act,
and the Municipal |
14 | | Service Occupation Tax Act by
retailers and servicemen on |
15 | | transactions at places located in a
State Sales Tax Boundary |
16 | | during the calendar year 1985.
|
17 | | (g-1) "Revised Initial Sales Tax Amounts" means the amount |
18 | | of taxes paid
under the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, Use Tax |
19 | | Act, Service Use Tax Act, the
Service Occupation Tax Act, the |
20 | | Municipal Retailers' Occupation Tax Act,
and the Municipal |
21 | | Service Occupation Tax Act by retailers and servicemen on
|
22 | | transactions at places located within the State Sales Tax |
23 | | Boundary
revised pursuant to Section 11-74.4-8a(9) of this Act.
|
24 | | (h) "Municipal Sales Tax Increment" means an amount equal |
25 | | to the
increase in the aggregate amount of taxes paid to a |
26 | | municipality from the
Local Government Tax Fund arising from |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 63 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | sales by retailers and servicemen
within the redevelopment |
2 | | project area or State Sales Tax Boundary, as
the case may be, |
3 | | for as long as the redevelopment project area or State
Sales |
4 | | Tax Boundary, as the case may be, exist over and above the |
5 | | aggregate
amount of taxes as certified by the Illinois |
6 | | Department of Revenue and paid
under the Municipal Retailers' |
7 | | Occupation Tax Act and the Municipal Service
Occupation Tax Act |
8 | | by retailers and servicemen, on transactions at places
of |
9 | | business located in the redevelopment project area or State |
10 | | Sales Tax
Boundary, as the case may be, during the
base year |
11 | | which shall be the calendar year immediately prior to the year |
12 | | in
which the municipality adopted tax increment allocation |
13 | | financing. For
purposes of computing the aggregate amount of |
14 | | such taxes for base years
occurring prior to 1985, the |
15 | | Department of Revenue shall determine the
Initial Sales Tax |
16 | | Amounts for such taxes and deduct therefrom an amount
equal to |
17 | | 4% of the aggregate amount of taxes per year for each year the
|
18 | | base year is prior to 1985, but not to exceed a total deduction |
19 | | of 12%.
The amount so determined shall be known as the |
20 | | "Adjusted Initial Sales Tax
Amounts". For purposes of |
21 | | determining the Municipal Sales Tax Increment,
the Department |
22 | | of Revenue shall for each period subtract from the amount
paid |
23 | | to the municipality from the Local Government Tax Fund arising |
24 | | from
sales by retailers and servicemen on transactions
located |
25 | | in the redevelopment project area or the State Sales Tax |
26 | | Boundary,
as the case may be, the certified Initial Sales Tax
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 64 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Amounts, the Adjusted Initial Sales Tax Amounts or the Revised |
2 | | Initial
Sales Tax Amounts for the Municipal Retailers'
|
3 | | Occupation Tax Act and the Municipal Service
Occupation Tax |
4 | | Act. For the State Fiscal Year 1989, this calculation shall
be |
5 | | made by utilizing the calendar year 1987 to determine the tax |
6 | | amounts
received. For the State Fiscal Year 1990, this |
7 | | calculation shall be made
by utilizing the period from January |
8 | | 1, 1988, until September 30, 1988, to
determine the tax amounts |
9 | | received from retailers and servicemen pursuant
to the |
10 | | Municipal Retailers' Occupation Tax and the Municipal Service
|
11 | | Occupation Tax Act, which shall have deducted therefrom
|
12 | | nine-twelfths of the certified Initial Sales Tax Amounts, the |
13 | | Adjusted Initial
Sales Tax Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales |
14 | | Tax Amounts as appropriate.
For the State Fiscal Year 1991, |
15 | | this calculation shall be made by utilizing
the period from |
16 | | October 1, 1988, to June 30, 1989, to determine the tax
amounts |
17 | | received from retailers and servicemen pursuant to the |
18 | | Municipal
Retailers' Occupation Tax and the Municipal Service |
19 | | Occupation Tax Act
which shall have deducted therefrom |
20 | | nine-twelfths of the
certified Initial Sales Tax Amounts, |
21 | | Adjusted Initial Sales Tax
Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales |
22 | | Tax Amounts as appropriate. For every
State Fiscal Year |
23 | | thereafter, the applicable period shall be the 12 months
|
24 | | beginning July 1 and ending June 30 to determine the tax |
25 | | amounts received
which shall have deducted therefrom the |
26 | | certified Initial Sales Tax
Amounts, the Adjusted Initial Sales |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 65 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Tax Amounts or the Revised Initial
Sales Tax Amounts, as the |
2 | | case may be.
|
3 | | (i) "Net State Sales Tax Increment" means the sum of the |
4 | | following: (a)
80% of the first $100,000 of State Sales Tax |
5 | | Increment annually generated
within a State Sales Tax Boundary; |
6 | | (b) 60% of the amount in excess of
$100,000 but not exceeding |
7 | | $500,000 of State Sales Tax Increment annually
generated within |
8 | | a State Sales Tax Boundary; and (c) 40% of all amounts in
|
9 | | excess of $500,000 of State Sales Tax Increment annually |
10 | | generated within a
State Sales Tax Boundary. If, however, a |
11 | | municipality established a tax
increment financing district in |
12 | | a county with a population in excess of
3,000,000 before |
13 | | January 1, 1986, and the municipality entered into a
contract |
14 | | or issued bonds after January 1, 1986, but before December 31, |
15 | | 1986,
to finance redevelopment project costs within a State |
16 | | Sales Tax
Boundary, then the Net State Sales Tax Increment |
17 | | means, for the fiscal years
beginning July 1, 1990, and July 1, |
18 | | 1991, 100% of the State Sales Tax
Increment annually generated |
19 | | within a State Sales Tax Boundary; and
notwithstanding any |
20 | | other provision of this Act, for those fiscal years the
|
21 | | Department of Revenue shall distribute to those municipalities |
22 | | 100% of
their Net State Sales Tax Increment before any |
23 | | distribution to any other
municipality and regardless of |
24 | | whether or not those other municipalities
will receive 100% of |
25 | | their Net State Sales Tax Increment. For Fiscal Year
1999, and |
26 | | every year thereafter until the year 2007, for any municipality
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 66 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | that has not entered into a contract or has not issued bonds |
2 | | prior to June
1, 1988 to finance redevelopment project costs |
3 | | within a State Sales Tax
Boundary, the Net State Sales Tax |
4 | | Increment shall be calculated as follows:
By multiplying the |
5 | | Net State Sales Tax Increment by 90% in the State Fiscal
Year |
6 | | 1999; 80% in the State Fiscal Year 2000; 70% in the State |
7 | | Fiscal Year
2001; 60% in the State Fiscal Year 2002; 50% in the |
8 | | State Fiscal Year 2003; 40%
in the State Fiscal Year 2004; 30% |
9 | | in the State Fiscal Year 2005; 20% in
the State Fiscal Year |
10 | | 2006; and 10% in the State Fiscal Year 2007. No
payment shall |
11 | | be made for State Fiscal Year 2008 and thereafter.
|
12 | | Municipalities that issued bonds in connection with a |
13 | | redevelopment project
in a redevelopment project area within |
14 | | the State Sales Tax Boundary prior to
July 29, 1991,
or that |
15 | | entered into contracts in connection with a redevelopment |
16 | | project in
a redevelopment project area before June 1, 1988,
|
17 | | shall continue to receive their proportional share of the
|
18 | | Illinois Tax Increment Fund distribution until the date on |
19 | | which the
redevelopment project is completed or terminated.
If, |
20 | | however, a municipality that issued bonds in connection with a
|
21 | | redevelopment project in a redevelopment project area within |
22 | | the State Sales
Tax Boundary prior to July 29, 1991 retires the |
23 | | bonds prior to June 30, 2007 or
a municipality that entered |
24 | | into contracts in connection with a redevelopment
project in a |
25 | | redevelopment project area before June 1, 1988 completes the
|
26 | | contracts prior to June 30, 2007, then so long as the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 67 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | redevelopment project is
not
completed or is not terminated, |
2 | | the Net State Sales Tax Increment shall be
calculated, |
3 | | beginning on the date on which the bonds are retired or the
|
4 | | contracts are completed, as follows: By multiplying the Net |
5 | | State Sales Tax
Increment by 60% in the State Fiscal Year
2002; |
6 | | 50% in the State Fiscal Year 2003; 40% in the State Fiscal Year |
7 | | 2004; 30%
in the State Fiscal Year 2005; 20% in the State |
8 | | Fiscal Year 2006; and 10% in
the State Fiscal Year 2007. No |
9 | | payment shall be made for State Fiscal Year
2008 and |
10 | | thereafter.
Refunding of any bonds issued
prior to July 29, |
11 | | 1991, shall not alter the Net State Sales Tax Increment.
|
12 | | (j) "State Utility Tax Increment Amount" means an amount |
13 | | equal to the
aggregate increase in State electric and gas tax |
14 | | charges imposed on owners
and tenants, other than residential |
15 | | customers, of properties located within
the redevelopment |
16 | | project area under Section 9-222 of the Public Utilities
Act, |
17 | | over and above the aggregate of such charges as certified by |
18 | | the
Department of Revenue and paid by owners and tenants, other |
19 | | than
residential customers, of properties within the |
20 | | redevelopment project area
during the base year, which shall be |
21 | | the calendar year immediately prior to
the year of the adoption |
22 | | of the ordinance authorizing tax increment allocation
|
23 | | financing.
|
24 | | (k) "Net State Utility Tax Increment" means the sum of the |
25 | | following:
(a) 80% of the first $100,000 of State Utility Tax |
26 | | Increment annually
generated by a redevelopment project area; |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 68 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (b) 60% of the amount in excess
of $100,000 but not exceeding |
2 | | $500,000 of the State Utility Tax Increment
annually generated |
3 | | by a redevelopment project area; and (c) 40% of all
amounts in |
4 | | excess of $500,000 of State Utility Tax Increment annually
|
5 | | generated by a redevelopment project area. For the State Fiscal |
6 | | Year 1999,
and every year thereafter until the year 2007, for |
7 | | any municipality that
has not entered into a contract or has |
8 | | not issued bonds prior to June 1,
1988 to finance redevelopment |
9 | | project costs within a redevelopment project
area, the Net |
10 | | State Utility Tax Increment shall be calculated as follows:
By |
11 | | multiplying the Net State Utility Tax Increment by 90% in the |
12 | | State
Fiscal Year 1999; 80% in the State Fiscal Year 2000; 70% |
13 | | in the State
Fiscal Year 2001; 60% in the State Fiscal Year |
14 | | 2002; 50% in the State
Fiscal Year 2003; 40% in the State |
15 | | Fiscal Year 2004; 30% in the State
Fiscal Year 2005; 20% in the |
16 | | State Fiscal Year 2006; and 10% in the State
Fiscal Year 2007. |
17 | | No payment shall be made for the State Fiscal Year 2008
and |
18 | | thereafter.
|
19 | | Municipalities that issue bonds in connection with the |
20 | | redevelopment project
during the period from June 1, 1988 until |
21 | | 3 years after the effective date
of this Amendatory Act of 1988 |
22 | | shall receive the Net State Utility Tax
Increment, subject to |
23 | | appropriation, for 15 State Fiscal Years after the
issuance of |
24 | | such bonds. For the 16th through the 20th State Fiscal Years
|
25 | | after issuance of the bonds, the Net State Utility Tax |
26 | | Increment shall be
calculated as follows: By multiplying the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 69 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Net State Utility Tax Increment
by 90% in year 16; 80% in year |
2 | | 17; 70% in year 18; 60% in year 19; and 50%
in year 20. |
3 | | Refunding of any bonds issued prior to June 1, 1988, shall not
|
4 | | alter the revised Net State Utility Tax Increment payments set |
5 | | forth above.
|
6 | | (l) "Obligations" mean bonds, loans, debentures, notes, |
7 | | special certificates
or other evidence of indebtedness issued |
8 | | by the municipality to carry out
a redevelopment project or to |
9 | | refund outstanding obligations.
|
10 | | (m) "Payment in lieu of taxes" means those estimated tax |
11 | | revenues from
real property in a redevelopment project area |
12 | | derived from real property that
has been acquired by a |
13 | | municipality
which according to the redevelopment project or |
14 | | plan is to be used for a
private use which taxing districts |
15 | | would have received had a municipality
not acquired the real |
16 | | property and adopted tax increment allocation
financing and |
17 | | which would result from
levies made after the time of the |
18 | | adoption of tax increment allocation
financing to the time the |
19 | | current equalized value of real property in the
redevelopment |
20 | | project area exceeds the total initial equalized value of
real |
21 | | property in said area.
|
22 | | (n) "Redevelopment plan" means the comprehensive program |
23 | | of
the municipality for development or redevelopment intended |
24 | | by the payment of
redevelopment project costs to reduce or |
25 | | eliminate those conditions the
existence of which qualified the |
26 | | redevelopment project area as
a "blighted
area" or |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 70 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | "conservation area" or combination thereof or "industrial park
|
2 | | conservation area," and thereby to enhance the tax bases of the |
3 | | taxing
districts which extend into the redevelopment project |
4 | | area, provided that, with respect to redevelopment project |
5 | | areas described in subsections (p-1) and (p-2), "redevelopment |
6 | | plan" means the comprehensive program of the affected |
7 | | municipality for the development of qualifying transit |
8 | | facilities.
On and after November 1, 1999 (the effective date |
9 | | of
Public Act 91-478), no
redevelopment plan may be approved or |
10 | | amended that includes the development of
vacant land (i) with a |
11 | | golf course and related clubhouse and other facilities
or (ii) |
12 | | designated by federal, State, county, or municipal government |
13 | | as public
land for outdoor recreational activities or for |
14 | | nature preserves and used for
that purpose within 5
years prior |
15 | | to the adoption of the redevelopment plan. For the purpose of
|
16 | | this subsection, "recreational activities" is limited to mean |
17 | | camping and
hunting.
Each
redevelopment plan shall set forth in |
18 | | writing the program to be undertaken
to accomplish the |
19 | | objectives and shall include but not be limited to:
|
20 | | (A) an itemized list of estimated redevelopment |
21 | | project costs;
|
22 | | (B) evidence indicating that the redevelopment project |
23 | | area on the whole
has not been subject to growth and |
24 | | development through investment by private
enterprise, |
25 | | provided that such evidence shall not be required for any |
26 | | redevelopment project area located within a transit |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 71 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | facility improvement area established pursuant to Section |
2 | | 11-74.4-3.3;
|
3 | | (C) an assessment of any financial impact of the |
4 | | redevelopment project
area on or any increased demand for |
5 | | services from any taxing district affected
by the plan and |
6 | | any program to address such financial impact or increased
|
7 | | demand;
|
8 | | (D) the sources of funds to pay costs;
|
9 | | (E) the nature and term of the obligations to be |
10 | | issued;
|
11 | | (F) the most recent equalized assessed valuation of the |
12 | | redevelopment
project area;
|
13 | | (G) an estimate as to the equalized assessed valuation |
14 | | after redevelopment
and the general land uses to apply in |
15 | | the redevelopment project area;
|
16 | | (H) a commitment to fair employment practices and an |
17 | | affirmative action
plan;
|
18 | | (I) if it concerns an industrial park
conservation |
19 | | area, the plan shall
also include a general description
of |
20 | | any proposed developer, user and tenant of any property, a |
21 | | description
of the type, structure and general character of |
22 | | the facilities to be
developed, a description of the type, |
23 | | class and number of new employees to
be employed in the |
24 | | operation of the facilities to be developed; and
|
25 | | (J) if property is to be annexed to the municipality, |
26 | | the plan shall
include the terms of the annexation |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 72 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | agreement.
|
2 | | The provisions of items (B) and (C) of this subsection (n) |
3 | | shall not apply to
a municipality that before March 14, 1994 |
4 | | (the effective date of Public Act
88-537) had fixed, either by |
5 | | its
corporate authorities or by a commission designated under |
6 | | subsection (k) of
Section 11-74.4-4, a time and place for a |
7 | | public hearing as required by
subsection (a) of Section |
8 | | 11-74.4-5.
No redevelopment plan shall be adopted unless a
|
9 | | municipality complies with all of the following requirements:
|
10 | | (1) The municipality finds that the redevelopment |
11 | | project area on
the whole has not been subject to growth |
12 | | and development through investment
by private enterprise |
13 | | and would not reasonably be anticipated to be
developed |
14 | | without the adoption of the redevelopment plan, provided, |
15 | | however, that such a finding shall not be required with |
16 | | respect to any redevelopment project area located within a |
17 | | transit facility improvement area established pursuant to |
18 | | Section 11-74.4-3.3.
|
19 | | (2) The municipality finds that the redevelopment plan |
20 | | and project conform
to the comprehensive plan for the |
21 | | development of the municipality as a whole,
or, for |
22 | | municipalities with a population of 100,000 or more, |
23 | | regardless of when
the redevelopment plan and project was |
24 | | adopted, the redevelopment plan and
project either: (i) |
25 | | conforms to the strategic economic development or
|
26 | | redevelopment plan issued by the designated planning |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 73 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | authority of the
municipality, or (ii) includes land uses |
2 | | that have been approved by the
planning commission of the |
3 | | municipality.
|
4 | | (3) The redevelopment plan establishes the estimated |
5 | | dates of completion
of the redevelopment project and |
6 | | retirement of obligations issued to finance
redevelopment |
7 | | project costs. Those dates may not be later than the dates |
8 | | set forth under Section 11-74.4-3.5.
|
9 | | A municipality may by municipal ordinance amend an |
10 | | existing redevelopment
plan to conform to this paragraph |
11 | | (3) as amended by Public Act 91-478, which
municipal |
12 | | ordinance may be adopted without
further hearing or
notice |
13 | | and without complying with the procedures provided in this |
14 | | Act
pertaining to an amendment to or the initial approval |
15 | | of a redevelopment plan
and project and
designation of a |
16 | | redevelopment project area.
|
17 | | (3.5) The municipality finds, in the case of an |
18 | | industrial
park
conservation area, also that the |
19 | | municipality is a labor surplus municipality
and that the |
20 | | implementation of the redevelopment plan will reduce |
21 | | unemployment,
create new jobs and by the provision of new |
22 | | facilities enhance the tax base of
the taxing districts |
23 | | that extend into the redevelopment project area.
|
24 | | (4) If any incremental revenues are being utilized |
25 | | under
Section 8(a)(1)
or 8(a)(2) of this Act in |
26 | | redevelopment project areas approved by ordinance
after |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 74 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | January 1, 1986, the municipality finds: (a) that the |
2 | | redevelopment
project area would not reasonably be |
3 | | developed without the use of such
incremental revenues, and |
4 | | (b) that such incremental revenues will be
exclusively |
5 | | utilized for the development of the redevelopment project |
6 | | area.
|
7 | | (5) If: (a)
the redevelopment plan will not result in
|
8 | | displacement of
residents from 10 or more inhabited |
9 | | residential units, and the
municipality certifies in the |
10 | | plan that
such displacement will not result from the plan; |
11 | | or (b) the redevelopment plan is for a redevelopment |
12 | | project area located within a transit facility improvement |
13 | | area established pursuant to Section 11-74.4-3.3, and the |
14 | | applicable project is subject to the process for evaluation |
15 | | of environmental effects under the National Environmental |
16 | | Policy Act of 1969, 42 U.S.C. § 4321 et seq., then a |
17 | | housing impact study
need not be performed.
If, however, |
18 | | the redevelopment plan would result in the displacement
of
|
19 | | residents from 10 or more inhabited
residential units,
or |
20 | | if the redevelopment project area contains 75 or more |
21 | | inhabited residential
units and no
certification is made,
|
22 | | then the municipality shall prepare, as part of the |
23 | | separate
feasibility report required by subsection (a) of |
24 | | Section 11-74.4-5, a housing
impact study.
|
25 | | Part I of the housing impact study shall include (i) |
26 | | data as to whether
the residential units are single family |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 75 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | or multi-family units,
(ii) the number and type of rooms |
2 | | within the units, if that information is
available, (iii) |
3 | | whether
the
units are inhabited or uninhabited, as |
4 | | determined not less than 45
days before the date that the |
5 | | ordinance or resolution required
by subsection (a) of |
6 | | Section 11-74.4-5 is passed, and (iv) data as to the
racial |
7 | | and ethnic composition of the residents in the inhabited |
8 | | residential
units. The data requirement as to the racial |
9 | | and ethnic composition of the
residents in the inhabited |
10 | | residential units shall be deemed to be fully
satisfied by |
11 | | data from the most recent federal census.
|
12 | | Part II of the housing impact study shall identify the |
13 | | inhabited
residential units in the proposed redevelopment |
14 | | project area that are to be or
may be removed. If inhabited |
15 | | residential units are to be removed, then the
housing |
16 | | impact study shall identify (i) the number and location of |
17 | | those units
that will or may be removed, (ii) the |
18 | | municipality's plans for relocation
assistance for those |
19 | | residents in the proposed redevelopment project area
whose |
20 | | residences are to be removed, (iii) the availability of |
21 | | replacement
housing for those residents whose residences |
22 | | are to be removed, and shall
identify the type, location, |
23 | | and cost of the housing, and (iv) the type and
extent
of |
24 | | relocation assistance to be provided.
|
25 | | (6) On and after November 1, 1999, the
housing impact |
26 | | study required by paragraph (5) shall be
incorporated in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 76 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the redevelopment plan for the
redevelopment project area.
|
2 | | (7) On and after November 1, 1999, no
redevelopment |
3 | | plan shall be adopted, nor an
existing plan amended, nor |
4 | | shall residential housing that is
occupied by households of |
5 | | low-income and very low-income
persons in currently |
6 | | existing redevelopment project
areas be removed after |
7 | | November 1, 1999 unless the redevelopment plan provides, |
8 | | with
respect to inhabited housing units that are to be |
9 | | removed for
households of low-income and very low-income |
10 | | persons, affordable
housing and relocation assistance not |
11 | | less than that which would
be provided under the federal |
12 | | Uniform Relocation Assistance and
Real Property |
13 | | Acquisition Policies Act of 1970 and the regulations
under |
14 | | that Act, including the eligibility criteria.
Affordable |
15 | | housing may be either existing or newly constructed
|
16 | | housing. For purposes of this paragraph (7), "low-income
|
17 | | households", "very low-income households", and "affordable
|
18 | | housing" have the meanings set forth in the Illinois |
19 | | Affordable
Housing Act.
The municipality shall make a good |
20 | | faith effort to ensure that this affordable
housing is |
21 | | located in or near the redevelopment project area within |
22 | | the
municipality.
|
23 | | (8) On and after November 1, 1999, if,
after the |
24 | | adoption of the redevelopment plan for the
redevelopment |
25 | | project area, any municipality desires to amend its
|
26 | | redevelopment plan
to remove more inhabited residential |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 77 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | units than
specified in its original redevelopment plan, |
2 | | that change shall be made in
accordance with the procedures |
3 | | in subsection (c) of Section 11-74.4-5.
|
4 | | (9) For redevelopment project areas designated prior |
5 | | to November 1,
1999, the redevelopment plan may be amended |
6 | | without further joint review board
meeting or hearing, |
7 | | provided that the municipality shall give notice of any
|
8 | | such changes by mail to each affected taxing district and |
9 | | registrant on the
interested party registry, to authorize |
10 | | the municipality to expend tax
increment revenues for |
11 | | redevelopment project costs defined by paragraphs (5)
and |
12 | | (7.5), subparagraphs (E) and (F) of paragraph (11), and |
13 | | paragraph (11.5) of
subsection (q) of Section 11-74.4-3, so |
14 | | long as the changes do not increase the
total estimated |
15 | | redevelopment project costs set out in the redevelopment |
16 | | plan
by more than 5% after adjustment for inflation from |
17 | | the date the plan was
adopted.
|
18 | | (o) "Redevelopment project" means any public and private |
19 | | development project
in furtherance of the objectives of a |
20 | | redevelopment plan.
On and after November 1, 1999 (the |
21 | | effective date of Public Act 91-478), no
redevelopment plan may |
22 | | be approved or amended that includes the development
of vacant |
23 | | land (i) with a golf course and related clubhouse and other
|
24 | | facilities
or (ii) designated by federal, State, county, or |
25 | | municipal government as public
land for outdoor recreational |
26 | | activities or for nature preserves and used for
that purpose |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 78 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | within 5
years prior to the adoption of the redevelopment plan. |
2 | | For the purpose of
this subsection, "recreational activities" |
3 | | is limited to mean camping and
hunting.
|
4 | | (p) "Redevelopment project area" means an area designated |
5 | | by
the
municipality, which is not less in the aggregate than 1 |
6 | | 1/2 acres and in
respect to which the municipality has made a |
7 | | finding that there exist
conditions which cause the area to be |
8 | | classified as an industrial park
conservation area or a |
9 | | blighted area or a conservation area, or a
combination of both |
10 | | blighted areas and conservation areas.
|
11 | | (p-1) Notwithstanding any provision of this Act to the |
12 | | contrary, on and after August 25, 2009 (the effective date of |
13 | | Public Act 96-680), a redevelopment project area may include |
14 | | areas within a one-half mile radius of an existing or proposed |
15 | | Regional Transportation Authority Suburban Transit Access |
16 | | Route (STAR Line) station without a finding that the area is |
17 | | classified as an industrial park conservation area, a blighted |
18 | | area, a conservation area, or a combination thereof, but only |
19 | | if the municipality receives unanimous consent from the joint |
20 | | review board created to review the proposed redevelopment |
21 | | project area. |
22 | | (p-2) Notwithstanding any provision of this Act to the |
23 | | contrary, on and after the effective date of this amendatory |
24 | | Act of the 99th General Assembly, a redevelopment project area |
25 | | may include areas within a transit facility improvement area |
26 | | that has been established pursuant to Section 11-74.4-3.3 |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 79 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | without a finding that the area is classified as an industrial |
2 | | park conservation area, a blighted area, a conservation area, |
3 | | or any combination thereof. |
4 | | (q) "Redevelopment project costs", except for |
5 | | redevelopment project areas created pursuant to subsection |
6 | | subsections (p-1) or (p-2), means and includes the sum total of |
7 | | all
reasonable or necessary costs incurred or estimated to be |
8 | | incurred, and
any such costs incidental to a redevelopment plan |
9 | | and a redevelopment
project. Such costs include, without |
10 | | limitation, the following:
|
11 | | (1) Costs of studies, surveys, development of plans, |
12 | | and
specifications, implementation and administration of |
13 | | the redevelopment
plan including but not limited to staff |
14 | | and professional service costs for
architectural, |
15 | | engineering, legal, financial, planning or other
services, |
16 | | provided however that no charges for professional services |
17 | | may be
based on a percentage of the tax increment |
18 | | collected; except that on and
after November 1, 1999 (the |
19 | | effective date of Public Act 91-478), no
contracts for
|
20 | | professional services, excluding architectural and |
21 | | engineering services, may be
entered into if the terms of |
22 | | the contract extend
beyond a period of 3 years. In |
23 | | addition, "redevelopment project costs" shall
not include |
24 | | lobbying expenses.
After consultation with the |
25 | | municipality, each tax
increment consultant or advisor to a |
26 | | municipality that plans to designate or
has designated a |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 80 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | redevelopment project area shall inform the municipality |
2 | | in
writing of any contracts that the consultant or advisor |
3 | | has entered into with
entities or individuals that have |
4 | | received, or are receiving, payments financed
by tax
|
5 | | increment revenues produced by the redevelopment project |
6 | | area with respect to
which the consultant or advisor has |
7 | | performed, or will be performing, service
for the
|
8 | | municipality. This requirement shall be satisfied by the |
9 | | consultant or advisor
before the commencement of services |
10 | | for the municipality and thereafter
whenever any other |
11 | | contracts with those individuals or entities are executed |
12 | | by
the consultant or advisor;
|
13 | | (1.5) After July 1, 1999, annual administrative costs |
14 | | shall
not include general overhead or
administrative costs |
15 | | of the municipality
that would still have been incurred by |
16 | | the municipality if the municipality had
not
designated a |
17 | | redevelopment project area or approved a redevelopment |
18 | | plan;
|
19 | | (1.6) The cost of
marketing sites within the |
20 | | redevelopment project area to prospective
businesses, |
21 | | developers, and investors;
|
22 | | (2) Property assembly costs, including but not limited |
23 | | to acquisition
of land and other property, real or |
24 | | personal, or rights or interests therein,
demolition of |
25 | | buildings, site preparation, site improvements that serve |
26 | | as an
engineered barrier addressing ground level or below |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 81 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | ground environmental
contamination, including, but not |
2 | | limited to parking lots and other concrete
or asphalt |
3 | | barriers, and the clearing and grading of
land;
|
4 | | (3) Costs of rehabilitation, reconstruction or repair |
5 | | or remodeling of
existing public or private buildings, |
6 | | fixtures, and leasehold
improvements; and the cost of |
7 | | replacing
an existing public building if pursuant to the |
8 | | implementation of a
redevelopment project the existing |
9 | | public building is to be demolished to use
the site for |
10 | | private investment or
devoted to a different use requiring |
11 | | private investment; including any direct or indirect costs |
12 | | relating to Green Globes or LEED certified construction |
13 | | elements or construction elements with an equivalent |
14 | | certification;
|
15 | | (4) Costs of the construction of public works or |
16 | | improvements, including any direct or indirect costs |
17 | | relating to Green Globes or LEED certified construction |
18 | | elements or construction elements with an equivalent |
19 | | certification, except
that on and after November 1, 1999,
|
20 | | redevelopment
project costs shall not include the cost of |
21 | | constructing a
new municipal public building principally |
22 | | used to provide
offices, storage space, or conference |
23 | | facilities or vehicle storage,
maintenance, or repair for |
24 | | administrative,
public safety, or public works personnel
|
25 | | and that is not intended to replace an existing
public |
26 | | building as provided under paragraph (3) of subsection (q) |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 82 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of Section
11-74.4-3
unless either (i) the construction of |
2 | | the new municipal building
implements a redevelopment |
3 | | project that was included in a redevelopment plan
that was |
4 | | adopted by the municipality prior to November 1, 1999, (ii) |
5 | | the
municipality makes a reasonable
determination in the |
6 | | redevelopment plan, supported by information that provides
|
7 | | the basis for that determination, that the new municipal |
8 | | building is required
to meet an increase in the need for |
9 | | public safety purposes anticipated to
result from the |
10 | | implementation of the redevelopment plan, or (iii) the new |
11 | | municipal public building is for the storage, maintenance, |
12 | | or repair of transit vehicles and is located in a transit |
13 | | facility improvement area that has been established |
14 | | pursuant to Section 11-74.4-3.3;
|
15 | | (5) Costs of job training and retraining projects, |
16 | | including the cost of
"welfare to work" programs |
17 | | implemented by businesses located within the
redevelopment |
18 | | project area;
|
19 | | (6) Financing costs, including but not limited to all |
20 | | necessary and
incidental expenses related to the issuance |
21 | | of obligations and which may
include payment of interest on |
22 | | any obligations issued hereunder including
interest |
23 | | accruing
during the estimated period of construction of any |
24 | | redevelopment project
for which such obligations are |
25 | | issued and for not exceeding 36 months
thereafter and |
26 | | including reasonable reserves related thereto;
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 83 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (7) To the extent the municipality by written agreement |
2 | | accepts and
approves
the same, all or a portion of a taxing |
3 | | district's capital costs resulting
from the redevelopment |
4 | | project necessarily incurred or to be incurred within a
|
5 | | taxing district in
furtherance of the objectives of the |
6 | | redevelopment plan and project ; .
|
7 | | (7.5) For redevelopment project areas designated (or |
8 | | redevelopment
project areas amended to add or increase the |
9 | | number of
tax-increment-financing assisted housing units) |
10 | | on or after November 1,
1999,
an elementary, secondary,
or |
11 | | unit school
district's increased costs attributable to |
12 | | assisted housing units located
within the
redevelopment |
13 | | project area for which the developer or redeveloper |
14 | | receives
financial assistance through an agreement with |
15 | | the municipality or because the
municipality incurs the |
16 | | cost of necessary infrastructure improvements within
the |
17 | | boundaries of the assisted housing sites necessary for the |
18 | | completion of
that housing
as authorized by this Act, and |
19 | | which costs shall be paid by the municipality
from the |
20 | | Special Tax Allocation Fund when the tax increment revenue |
21 | | is received
as a result of the assisted housing units and |
22 | | shall be calculated annually as
follows:
|
23 | | (A) for foundation districts, excluding any school |
24 | | district in a
municipality with a population in excess |
25 | | of 1,000,000, by multiplying the
district's increase |
26 | | in attendance resulting from the net increase in new
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 84 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | students enrolled in that school district who reside in |
2 | | housing units within
the redevelopment project area |
3 | | that have received financial assistance through
an |
4 | | agreement with the municipality or because the |
5 | | municipality incurs the cost
of necessary |
6 | | infrastructure improvements within the boundaries of |
7 | | the housing
sites necessary for the completion of that |
8 | | housing as authorized by this Act
since the designation |
9 | | of the redevelopment project area by the most recently
|
10 | | available per capita tuition cost as defined in Section |
11 | | 10-20.12a of the School
Code less any increase in |
12 | | general State aid as defined in Section 18-8.05 of
the |
13 | | School Code or evidence-based funding as defined in |
14 | | Section 18-8.15 of the School Code attributable to |
15 | | these added new students subject to the
following |
16 | | annual limitations:
|
17 | | (i) for unit school districts with a district |
18 | | average 1995-96 Per
Capita
Tuition Charge of less |
19 | | than $5,900, no more than 25% of the total amount |
20 | | of
property tax increment revenue produced by |
21 | | those housing units that have
received tax |
22 | | increment finance assistance under this Act;
|
23 | | (ii) for elementary school districts with a |
24 | | district average 1995-96
Per
Capita Tuition Charge |
25 | | of less than $5,900, no more than 17% of the total |
26 | | amount
of property tax increment revenue produced |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 85 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | by those housing units that have
received tax |
2 | | increment finance assistance under this Act; and
|
3 | | (iii) for secondary school districts with a |
4 | | district average 1995-96
Per
Capita Tuition Charge |
5 | | of less than $5,900, no more than 8% of the total |
6 | | amount
of property tax increment revenue produced |
7 | | by those housing units that have
received tax |
8 | | increment finance assistance under this Act.
|
9 | | (B) For alternate method districts, flat grant |
10 | | districts, and foundation
districts with a district |
11 | | average 1995-96 Per Capita Tuition Charge equal to or
|
12 | | more than $5,900, excluding any school district with a |
13 | | population in excess of
1,000,000, by multiplying the |
14 | | district's increase in attendance
resulting
from the |
15 | | net increase in new students enrolled in that school |
16 | | district who
reside in
housing units within the |
17 | | redevelopment project area that have received
|
18 | | financial assistance through an agreement with the |
19 | | municipality or because the
municipality incurs the |
20 | | cost of necessary infrastructure improvements within
|
21 | | the boundaries of the housing sites necessary for the |
22 | | completion of that
housing as authorized by this Act |
23 | | since the designation of the redevelopment
project |
24 | | area by the most recently available per capita tuition |
25 | | cost as defined
in Section 10-20.12a of the School Code |
26 | | less any increase in general state aid
as defined in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 86 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 18-8.05 of the School Code or evidence-based |
2 | | funding as defined in Section 18-8.15 of the School |
3 | | Code attributable to these added
new students subject |
4 | | to the following annual limitations:
|
5 | | (i) for unit school districts, no more than 40% |
6 | | of the total amount of
property tax increment |
7 | | revenue produced by those housing units that have
|
8 | | received tax increment finance assistance under |
9 | | this Act;
|
10 | | (ii) for elementary school districts, no more |
11 | | than 27% of the total
amount
of property tax |
12 | | increment revenue produced by those housing units |
13 | | that have
received tax increment finance |
14 | | assistance under this Act; and
|
15 | | (iii) for secondary school districts, no more |
16 | | than 13% of the total
amount
of property tax |
17 | | increment revenue produced by those housing units |
18 | | that have
received tax increment finance |
19 | | assistance under this Act.
|
20 | | (C) For any school district in a municipality with |
21 | | a population in
excess of
1,000,000, the following |
22 | | restrictions shall apply to the
reimbursement of |
23 | | increased costs under this paragraph (7.5):
|
24 | | (i) no increased costs shall be reimbursed |
25 | | unless the school district
certifies that each of |
26 | | the schools affected by the assisted housing |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 87 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | project
is at or over its student capacity;
|
2 | | (ii) the amount reimbursable shall be reduced |
3 | | by the value of any
land
donated to the school |
4 | | district by the municipality or developer, and by |
5 | | the
value of any physical improvements made to the |
6 | | schools by the
municipality or developer; and
|
7 | | (iii) the amount reimbursed may not affect |
8 | | amounts otherwise obligated
by
the terms of any |
9 | | bonds, notes, or other funding instruments, or the |
10 | | terms of
any redevelopment agreement.
|
11 | | Any school district seeking payment under this |
12 | | paragraph (7.5) shall,
after July 1 and before |
13 | | September 30 of each year,
provide the municipality |
14 | | with reasonable evidence to support its claim for
|
15 | | reimbursement before the municipality shall be |
16 | | required to approve or make
the payment to the school |
17 | | district. If the school district fails to provide
the |
18 | | information during this period in any year, it shall |
19 | | forfeit any claim to
reimbursement for that year. |
20 | | School districts may adopt a resolution
waiving the |
21 | | right to all or a portion of the reimbursement |
22 | | otherwise required
by this paragraph
(7.5). By |
23 | | acceptance of this reimbursement the school
district |
24 | | waives the right to directly or indirectly set aside, |
25 | | modify, or
contest in any manner the establishment of |
26 | | the redevelopment project area or
projects;
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 88 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (7.7) For redevelopment project areas designated (or |
2 | | redevelopment
project areas amended to add or increase the |
3 | | number of
tax-increment-financing assisted housing units) |
4 | | on or after
January 1, 2005 (the effective date of Public |
5 | | Act 93-961),
a public library
district's increased costs |
6 | | attributable to assisted housing units located
within the
|
7 | | redevelopment project area for which the developer or |
8 | | redeveloper receives
financial assistance through an |
9 | | agreement with the municipality or because the
|
10 | | municipality incurs the cost of necessary infrastructure |
11 | | improvements within
the boundaries of the assisted housing |
12 | | sites necessary for the completion of
that housing
as |
13 | | authorized by this Act shall be paid to the library |
14 | | district by the
municipality
from the Special Tax |
15 | | Allocation Fund when the tax increment revenue is received
|
16 | | as a result of the assisted housing units. This paragraph |
17 | | (7.7) applies only if (i) the library district is located |
18 | | in a county that is subject to the Property Tax Extension |
19 | | Limitation Law or (ii) the library district is not located |
20 | | in a county that is subject to the Property Tax Extension |
21 | | Limitation Law but the district is prohibited by any other |
22 | | law from increasing its tax levy rate without a prior voter |
23 | | referendum.
|
24 | | The amount paid to a library district under this |
25 | | paragraph (7.7) shall be
calculated
by multiplying (i) the |
26 | | net increase in the number of persons eligible to obtain
a
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 89 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | library card
in that district who reside in housing units |
2 | | within
the redevelopment project area that have received |
3 | | financial assistance through
an agreement with the |
4 | | municipality or because the municipality incurs the cost
of |
5 | | necessary infrastructure improvements within the |
6 | | boundaries of the housing
sites necessary for the |
7 | | completion of that housing as authorized by this Act
since |
8 | | the designation of the redevelopment project area by (ii)
|
9 | | the per-patron cost of providing library services so long |
10 | | as it does not exceed $120.
The per-patron cost shall be |
11 | | the Total Operating Expenditures Per Capita for the library |
12 | | in the previous fiscal year.
The municipality may deduct |
13 | | from the amount that it must pay to a library district |
14 | | under this paragraph any amount that it has voluntarily |
15 | | paid to the library district from the tax increment |
16 | | revenue. The amount paid to a library district under this |
17 | | paragraph (7.7) shall be no
more
than 2% of the amount |
18 | | produced by the assisted housing units and deposited into |
19 | | the Special Tax Allocation Fund.
|
20 | | A library district is not eligible for any payment |
21 | | under this paragraph
(7.7)
unless the library district has |
22 | | experienced an increase in the
number of patrons from the |
23 | | municipality that created the tax-increment-financing |
24 | | district since the designation of the redevelopment |
25 | | project area.
|
26 | | Any library district seeking payment under this |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 90 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | paragraph (7.7) shall,
after July 1 and before September 30 |
2 | | of each year,
provide the municipality with convincing |
3 | | evidence to support its claim for
reimbursement before the |
4 | | municipality shall be required to approve or make
the |
5 | | payment to the library district. If the library district |
6 | | fails to provide
the information during this period in any |
7 | | year, it shall forfeit any claim to
reimbursement for that |
8 | | year. Library districts may adopt a resolution
waiving the |
9 | | right to all or a portion of the reimbursement otherwise |
10 | | required by this paragraph (7.7). By acceptance of such |
11 | | reimbursement, the library district shall forfeit any |
12 | | right to directly or indirectly set aside, modify, or |
13 | | contest in any manner whatsoever the establishment of the |
14 | | redevelopment project area or
projects; |
15 | | (8) Relocation costs to the extent that a municipality |
16 | | determines that
relocation costs shall be paid or is |
17 | | required to make payment of relocation
costs by federal or |
18 | | State law or in order to satisfy subparagraph (7) of
|
19 | | subsection (n);
|
20 | | (9) Payment in lieu of taxes;
|
21 | | (10) Costs of job training, retraining, advanced |
22 | | vocational education
or career
education, including but |
23 | | not limited to courses in occupational,
semi-technical or |
24 | | technical fields leading directly to employment, incurred
|
25 | | by one or more taxing districts, provided that such costs |
26 | | (i) are related
to the establishment and maintenance of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 91 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | additional job training, advanced
vocational education or |
2 | | career education programs for persons employed or
to be |
3 | | employed by employers located in a redevelopment project |
4 | | area; and
(ii) when incurred by a taxing district or taxing |
5 | | districts other than the
municipality, are set forth in a |
6 | | written agreement by or among the
municipality and the |
7 | | taxing district or taxing districts, which agreement
|
8 | | describes the program to be undertaken, including but not |
9 | | limited to the
number of employees to be trained, a |
10 | | description of the training and
services to be provided, |
11 | | the number and type of positions available or to
be |
12 | | available, itemized costs of the program and sources of |
13 | | funds to pay for the
same, and the term of the agreement. |
14 | | Such costs include, specifically, the
payment by community |
15 | | college districts of costs pursuant to Sections 3-37,
3-38, |
16 | | 3-40 and 3-40.1 of the Public Community College Act and by |
17 | | school
districts of costs pursuant to Sections 10-22.20a |
18 | | and 10-23.3a of the The School
Code;
|
19 | | (11) Interest cost incurred by a redeveloper related to |
20 | | the
construction, renovation or rehabilitation of a |
21 | | redevelopment project
provided that:
|
22 | | (A) such costs are to be paid directly from the |
23 | | special tax
allocation fund established pursuant to |
24 | | this Act;
|
25 | | (B) such payments in any one year may not exceed |
26 | | 30% of the annual
interest costs incurred by the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 92 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | redeveloper with regard to the redevelopment
project |
2 | | during that year;
|
3 | | (C) if there are not sufficient funds available in |
4 | | the special tax
allocation fund to make the payment |
5 | | pursuant to this paragraph (11) then
the amounts so due |
6 | | shall accrue and be payable when sufficient funds are
|
7 | | available in the special tax allocation fund;
|
8 | | (D) the total of such interest payments paid |
9 | | pursuant to this Act
may not exceed 30% of the total |
10 | | (i) cost paid or incurred by the
redeveloper for the |
11 | | redevelopment project plus (ii) redevelopment project
|
12 | | costs excluding any property assembly costs and any |
13 | | relocation costs
incurred by a municipality pursuant |
14 | | to this Act; and
|
15 | | (E) the cost limits set forth in subparagraphs (B) |
16 | | and (D) of
paragraph (11) shall be modified for the |
17 | | financing of rehabilitated or
new housing units for |
18 | | low-income households and very low-income households, |
19 | | as
defined in
Section 3 of the Illinois Affordable |
20 | | Housing Act. The percentage of
75% shall be substituted |
21 | | for 30% in subparagraphs (B) and (D) of
paragraph (11) ; |
22 | | and .
|
23 | | (F) instead Instead of the eligible costs provided |
24 | | by subparagraphs (B) and (D)
of
paragraph (11), as |
25 | | modified by this subparagraph, and notwithstanding
any |
26 | | other provisions of this Act to the contrary, the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 93 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | municipality may
pay from tax increment revenues up to |
2 | | 50% of the cost of construction
of new housing units to |
3 | | be occupied by low-income households and very
|
4 | | low-income
households as defined in Section 3 of the |
5 | | Illinois Affordable Housing
Act. The cost of |
6 | | construction of those units may be derived from the
|
7 | | proceeds of bonds issued by the municipality under this |
8 | | Act or
other constitutional or statutory authority or |
9 | | from other sources of
municipal revenue that may be |
10 | | reimbursed from tax increment
revenues or the proceeds |
11 | | of bonds issued to finance the construction
of that |
12 | | housing.
|
13 | | The eligible costs provided under this |
14 | | subparagraph (F) of paragraph (11)
shall
be
an eligible |
15 | | cost for the construction, renovation, and |
16 | | rehabilitation of all
low and very low-income housing |
17 | | units, as defined in Section 3 of the Illinois
|
18 | | Affordable Housing Act, within the redevelopment |
19 | | project area. If the low and
very
low-income units are |
20 | | part of a residential redevelopment project that |
21 | | includes
units not affordable to low and very |
22 | | low-income households, only the low and
very |
23 | | low-income units shall be eligible for benefits under |
24 | | this subparagraph (F) of
paragraph (11).
The standards |
25 | | for maintaining the occupancy
by low-income households |
26 | | and very low-income households,
as
defined in Section 3 |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 94 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the Illinois Affordable Housing Act,
of those units |
2 | | constructed with eligible costs made available under |
3 | | the
provisions of
this subparagraph (F) of paragraph |
4 | | (11)
shall be
established by guidelines adopted by the |
5 | | municipality. The
responsibility for annually |
6 | | documenting the initial occupancy of
the units by |
7 | | low-income households and very low-income households, |
8 | | as defined
in
Section 3
of the Illinois Affordable |
9 | | Housing Act, shall be that of the then current
owner of |
10 | | the property.
For ownership units, the guidelines will |
11 | | provide, at a minimum, for a
reasonable recapture of |
12 | | funds, or other appropriate methods designed to
|
13 | | preserve the original affordability of the ownership |
14 | | units. For rental units,
the guidelines will provide, |
15 | | at a minimum, for the affordability of rent to low
and |
16 | | very low-income households. As units become available, |
17 | | they shall be
rented to income-eligible tenants.
The |
18 | | municipality may modify these
guidelines from time to |
19 | | time; the guidelines, however, shall be in effect
for |
20 | | as long as tax increment revenue is being used to pay |
21 | | for costs
associated with the units or for the |
22 | | retirement of bonds issued to finance
the units or for |
23 | | the life of the redevelopment project area, whichever |
24 | | is
later ; .
|
25 | | (11.5) If the redevelopment project area is located |
26 | | within a municipality
with a population of more than |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 95 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 100,000, the cost of day care services for
children of |
2 | | employees from
low-income
families working for businesses |
3 | | located within the redevelopment project area
and all or a
|
4 | | portion of the cost of operation of day care centers |
5 | | established by
redevelopment project
area businesses to |
6 | | serve employees from low-income families working in
|
7 | | businesses
located in the redevelopment project area. For |
8 | | the purposes of this paragraph,
"low-income families" |
9 | | means families whose annual income does not exceed 80% of
|
10 | | the
municipal, county, or regional median income, adjusted |
11 | | for family size, as the
annual
income and municipal, |
12 | | county, or regional median income are determined from
time |
13 | | to
time by the United States Department of Housing and |
14 | | Urban Development.
|
15 | | (12) Unless explicitly stated herein the cost of |
16 | | construction of new
privately-owned buildings shall not be an |
17 | | eligible redevelopment project cost.
|
18 | | (13) After November 1, 1999 (the effective date of Public |
19 | | Act
91-478), none of
the
redevelopment project costs enumerated |
20 | | in this subsection shall be eligible
redevelopment project |
21 | | costs if those costs would provide direct financial
support to |
22 | | a
retail entity initiating operations in the
redevelopment |
23 | | project area while
terminating operations at another Illinois |
24 | | location within 10 miles of the
redevelopment project area but |
25 | | outside the boundaries of the redevelopment
project area |
26 | | municipality. For
purposes of this paragraph, termination |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 96 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | means a
closing of a retail operation that is directly related |
2 | | to the opening of the
same operation or like retail entity |
3 | | owned or operated by more than 50% of the
original ownership in |
4 | | a redevelopment project area, but
it does not mean
closing an |
5 | | operation for reasons beyond the control of the
retail entity, |
6 | | as
documented by the retail entity, subject to a reasonable |
7 | | finding by the
municipality that the current location contained |
8 | | inadequate space, had become
economically obsolete, or was no |
9 | | longer a viable location for the retailer or
serviceman.
|
10 | | (14) No cost shall be a redevelopment project cost in a |
11 | | redevelopment project area if used to demolish, remove, or |
12 | | substantially modify a historic resource, after August 26, 2008 |
13 | | (the effective date of Public Act 95-934), unless no prudent |
14 | | and feasible alternative exists. "Historic resource" for the |
15 | | purpose of this paragraph item (14) means (i) a place or |
16 | | structure that is included or eligible for inclusion on the |
17 | | National Register of Historic Places or (ii) a contributing |
18 | | structure in a district on the National Register of Historic |
19 | | Places. This paragraph item (14) does not apply to a place or |
20 | | structure for which demolition, removal, or modification is |
21 | | subject to review by the preservation agency of a Certified |
22 | | Local Government designated as such by the National Park |
23 | | Service of the United States Department of the Interior. |
24 | | If a special service area has been established pursuant to
|
25 | | the Special Service Area Tax Act or Special Service Area Tax |
26 | | Law, then any
tax increment revenues derived
from the tax |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 97 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | imposed pursuant to the Special Service Area Tax Act or Special
|
2 | | Service Area Tax Law may
be used within the redevelopment |
3 | | project area for the purposes permitted by
that Act or Law as |
4 | | well as the purposes permitted by this Act.
|
5 | | (q-1) For redevelopment project areas created pursuant to |
6 | | subsection (p-1), redevelopment project costs are limited to |
7 | | those costs in paragraph (q) that are related to the existing |
8 | | or proposed Regional Transportation Authority Suburban Transit |
9 | | Access Route (STAR Line) station. |
10 | | (q-2) For a redevelopment project area located within a |
11 | | transit facility improvement area established pursuant to |
12 | | Section 11-74.4-3.3, redevelopment project costs means those |
13 | | costs described in subsection (q) that are related to the |
14 | | construction, reconstruction, rehabilitation, remodeling, or |
15 | | repair of any existing or proposed transit facility. |
16 | | (r) "State Sales Tax Boundary" means the redevelopment |
17 | | project area or
the amended redevelopment project area |
18 | | boundaries which are determined
pursuant to subsection (9) of |
19 | | Section 11-74.4-8a of this
Act. The Department of Revenue shall |
20 | | certify pursuant to subsection (9) of
Section 11-74.4-8a the |
21 | | appropriate boundaries eligible for the
determination of State |
22 | | Sales Tax Increment.
|
23 | | (s) "State Sales Tax Increment" means an amount equal to |
24 | | the increase
in the aggregate amount of taxes paid by retailers |
25 | | and servicemen, other
than retailers and servicemen subject to |
26 | | the Public Utilities Act,
on transactions at places of business |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 98 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | located within a State Sales Tax
Boundary pursuant to the |
2 | | Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, the Use Tax Act,
the Service Use |
3 | | Tax Act, and the Service Occupation Tax Act, except such
|
4 | | portion of such increase that is paid into the State and Local |
5 | | Sales Tax
Reform Fund, the Local Government Distributive Fund, |
6 | | the Local
Government Tax Fund and the County and Mass Transit |
7 | | District Fund, for as
long as State participation exists, over |
8 | | and above the Initial Sales Tax
Amounts, Adjusted Initial Sales |
9 | | Tax Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales
Tax Amounts for such |
10 | | taxes as certified by the Department of Revenue and
paid under |
11 | | those Acts by retailers and servicemen on transactions at |
12 | | places
of business located within the State Sales Tax Boundary |
13 | | during the base
year which shall be the calendar year |
14 | | immediately prior to the year in
which the municipality adopted |
15 | | tax increment allocation financing, less
3.0% of such amounts |
16 | | generated under the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, Use
Tax Act |
17 | | and Service Use Tax Act and the Service Occupation Tax Act, |
18 | | which
sum shall be appropriated to the Department of Revenue to |
19 | | cover its costs
of administering and enforcing this Section. |
20 | | For purposes of computing the
aggregate amount of such taxes |
21 | | for base years occurring prior to 1985, the
Department of |
22 | | Revenue shall compute the Initial Sales Tax Amount for such
|
23 | | taxes and deduct therefrom an amount equal to 4% of the |
24 | | aggregate amount of
taxes per year for each year the base year |
25 | | is prior to 1985, but not to
exceed a total deduction of 12%. |
26 | | The amount so determined shall be known
as the "Adjusted |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 99 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Initial Sales Tax Amount". For purposes of determining the
|
2 | | State Sales Tax Increment the Department of Revenue shall for |
3 | | each period
subtract from the tax amounts received from |
4 | | retailers and servicemen on
transactions located in the State |
5 | | Sales Tax Boundary, the certified Initial
Sales Tax Amounts, |
6 | | Adjusted Initial Sales Tax Amounts or Revised Initial
Sales Tax |
7 | | Amounts for the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act, the Use Tax Act,
|
8 | | the Service Use Tax Act and the Service Occupation Tax Act. For |
9 | | the State
Fiscal Year 1989 this calculation shall be made by |
10 | | utilizing the calendar
year 1987 to determine the tax amounts |
11 | | received. For the State Fiscal Year
1990, this calculation |
12 | | shall be made by utilizing the period from January
1, 1988, |
13 | | until September 30, 1988, to determine the tax amounts received
|
14 | | from retailers and servicemen, which shall have deducted |
15 | | therefrom
nine-twelfths of the certified Initial Sales Tax |
16 | | Amounts, Adjusted Initial
Sales Tax Amounts or the Revised |
17 | | Initial Sales Tax Amounts as appropriate.
For the State Fiscal |
18 | | Year 1991, this calculation shall be made by utilizing
the |
19 | | period from October 1, 1988, until June 30, 1989, to determine |
20 | | the tax
amounts received from retailers and servicemen, which |
21 | | shall have
deducted therefrom nine-twelfths of the certified |
22 | | Initial State Sales Tax
Amounts, Adjusted Initial Sales Tax |
23 | | Amounts or the Revised Initial Sales
Tax Amounts as |
24 | | appropriate. For every State Fiscal Year thereafter, the
|
25 | | applicable period shall be the 12 months beginning July 1 and |
26 | | ending on
June 30, to determine the tax amounts received which |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 100 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | shall have deducted
therefrom the certified Initial Sales Tax |
2 | | Amounts, Adjusted Initial Sales
Tax Amounts or the Revised |
3 | | Initial Sales Tax Amounts. Municipalities
intending to receive |
4 | | a distribution of State Sales Tax Increment must
report a list |
5 | | of retailers to the Department of Revenue by October 31, 1988
|
6 | | and by July 31, of each year thereafter.
|
7 | | (t) "Taxing districts" means counties, townships, cities |
8 | | and incorporated
towns and villages, school, road, park, |
9 | | sanitary, mosquito abatement, forest
preserve, public health, |
10 | | fire protection, river conservancy, tuberculosis
sanitarium |
11 | | and any other municipal corporations or districts with the |
12 | | power
to levy taxes.
|
13 | | (u) "Taxing districts' capital costs" means those costs of |
14 | | taxing districts
for capital improvements that are found by the |
15 | | municipal corporate authorities
to be necessary and directly |
16 | | result from the redevelopment project.
|
17 | | (v) As used in subsection (a) of Section 11-74.4-3 of this
|
18 | | Act, "vacant
land" means any parcel or combination of parcels |
19 | | of real property without
industrial, commercial, and |
20 | | residential buildings which has not been used
for commercial |
21 | | agricultural purposes within 5 years prior to the
designation |
22 | | of the redevelopment project area, unless the parcel
is |
23 | | included in an industrial park conservation area or the parcel |
24 | | has
been subdivided; provided that if the parcel was part of a |
25 | | larger tract that
has been divided into 3 or more smaller |
26 | | tracts that were accepted for
recording during the period from |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 101 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 1950 to 1990, then the parcel shall be deemed
to have been |
2 | | subdivided, and all proceedings and actions of the municipality
|
3 | | taken in that connection with respect to any previously |
4 | | approved or designated
redevelopment project area or amended |
5 | | redevelopment project area are hereby
validated and hereby |
6 | | declared to be legally sufficient for all purposes of this
Act.
|
7 | | For purposes of this Section and only for land subject to
the |
8 | | subdivision requirements of the Plat Act, land is subdivided |
9 | | when the
original plat of
the proposed Redevelopment Project |
10 | | Area or relevant portion thereof has
been
properly certified, |
11 | | acknowledged, approved, and recorded or filed in accordance
|
12 | | with the Plat Act and a preliminary plat, if any, for any |
13 | | subsequent phases of
the
proposed Redevelopment Project Area or |
14 | | relevant portion thereof has been
properly approved and filed |
15 | | in accordance with the applicable ordinance of the
|
16 | | municipality.
|
17 | | (w) "Annual Total Increment" means the sum of each |
18 | | municipality's
annual Net Sales Tax Increment and each |
19 | | municipality's annual Net Utility
Tax Increment. The ratio of |
20 | | the Annual Total Increment of each
municipality to the Annual |
21 | | Total Increment for all municipalities, as most
recently |
22 | | calculated by the Department, shall determine the proportional
|
23 | | shares of the Illinois Tax Increment Fund to be distributed to |
24 | | each
municipality.
|
25 | | (x) "LEED certified" means any certification level of |
26 | | construction elements by a qualified Leadership in Energy and |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 102 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Environmental Design Accredited Professional as determined by |
2 | | the U.S. Green Building Council. |
3 | | (y) "Green Globes certified" means any certification level |
4 | | of construction elements by a qualified Green Globes |
5 | | Professional as determined by the Green Building Initiative. |
6 | | (Source: P.A. 99-792, eff. 8-12-16; revised 10-31-16.)
|
7 | | (65 ILCS 5/11-74.4-8)
(from Ch. 24, par. 11-74.4-8)
|
8 | | Sec. 11-74.4-8. Tax increment allocation financing. A |
9 | | municipality may
not adopt tax increment financing in a
|
10 | | redevelopment
project area after the effective date of this |
11 | | amendatory Act of 1997 that will
encompass an area that is |
12 | | currently included in an enterprise zone created
under the |
13 | | Illinois Enterprise Zone Act unless that municipality, |
14 | | pursuant to
Section 5.4 of the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act, |
15 | | amends the enterprise zone
designating ordinance to limit the |
16 | | eligibility for tax abatements as provided
in Section 5.4.1 of |
17 | | the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act.
A municipality, at the time a |
18 | | redevelopment project area
is designated, may adopt tax |
19 | | increment allocation financing by passing an
ordinance |
20 | | providing that the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from the
|
21 | | levies upon taxable real property in such redevelopment project
|
22 | | area by taxing districts and tax rates determined in the manner |
23 | | provided
in paragraph (c) of Section 11-74.4-9 each year after |
24 | | the effective
date of the ordinance until redevelopment project |
25 | | costs and all municipal
obligations financing redevelopment |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 103 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | project costs incurred under this Division
have been paid shall |
2 | | be divided as follows, provided, however, that with respect to |
3 | | any redevelopment project area located within a transit |
4 | | facility improvement area established pursuant to Section |
5 | | 11-74.4-3.3 in a municipality with a population of 1,000,000 or |
6 | | more, ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from the levies upon |
7 | | taxable real property in such redevelopment project area shall |
8 | | be allocated as specifically provided in this Section:
|
9 | | (a) That portion of taxes levied upon each taxable lot, |
10 | | block, tract or
parcel of real property which is |
11 | | attributable to the lower of the current
equalized assessed |
12 | | value or the initial equalized assessed
value of each such |
13 | | taxable lot, block, tract or parcel of real property
in the |
14 | | redevelopment project area shall be allocated to and when |
15 | | collected
shall be paid by the county collector to the |
16 | | respective affected taxing
districts in the manner |
17 | | required by law in the absence of the adoption of
tax |
18 | | increment allocation financing.
|
19 | | (b) Except from a tax levied by a township to retire |
20 | | bonds issued to satisfy
court-ordered damages, that |
21 | | portion, if any, of such taxes which is
attributable to the
|
22 | | increase in the current equalized assessed valuation of |
23 | | each taxable lot,
block, tract or parcel of real property |
24 | | in the redevelopment project area
over and above the |
25 | | initial equalized assessed value of each property in the
|
26 | | project area shall be allocated to and when collected shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 104 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be paid to the
municipal treasurer who shall deposit said |
2 | | taxes into a special fund called
the special tax allocation |
3 | | fund of the municipality for the purpose of
paying |
4 | | redevelopment project costs and obligations incurred in |
5 | | the payment
thereof. In any county with a population of |
6 | | 3,000,000 or more that has adopted
a procedure for |
7 | | collecting taxes that provides for one or more of the
|
8 | | installments of the taxes to be billed and collected on an |
9 | | estimated basis,
the municipal treasurer shall be paid for |
10 | | deposit in the special tax
allocation fund of the |
11 | | municipality, from the taxes collected from
estimated |
12 | | bills issued for property in the redevelopment project |
13 | | area, the
difference between the amount actually collected |
14 | | from each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of real |
15 | | property within the redevelopment project
area and an |
16 | | amount determined by multiplying the rate at which taxes |
17 | | were
last extended against the taxable lot, block, track, |
18 | | or parcel of real
property in the manner provided in |
19 | | subsection (c) of Section 11-74.4-9 by
the initial |
20 | | equalized assessed value of the property divided by the |
21 | | number
of installments in which real estate taxes are |
22 | | billed and collected within
the county; provided that the |
23 | | payments on or before December 31,
1999 to a municipal |
24 | | treasurer shall be made only if each of the following
|
25 | | conditions are met:
|
26 | | (1) The total equalized assessed value of the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 105 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | redevelopment project
area as last determined was not |
2 | | less than 175% of the total initial
equalized assessed |
3 | | value.
|
4 | | (2) Not more than 50% of the total equalized assessed |
5 | | value of the
redevelopment project area as last |
6 | | determined is attributable to a piece of
property |
7 | | assigned a single real estate index number.
|
8 | | (3) The municipal clerk has certified to the county |
9 | | clerk that the
municipality has issued its obligations |
10 | | to which there has been pledged
the incremental |
11 | | property taxes of the redevelopment project area or |
12 | | taxes
levied and collected on any or all property in |
13 | | the municipality or
the full faith and credit of the |
14 | | municipality to pay or secure payment for
all or a |
15 | | portion of the redevelopment project costs. The |
16 | | certification
shall be filed annually no later than |
17 | | September 1 for the estimated taxes
to be distributed |
18 | | in the following year; however, for the year 1992 the
|
19 | | certification shall be made at any time on or before |
20 | | March 31, 1992.
|
21 | | (4) The municipality has not requested that the total |
22 | | initial
equalized assessed value of real property be |
23 | | adjusted as provided in
subsection (b) of Section |
24 | | 11-74.4-9.
|
25 | | The conditions of paragraphs (1) through (4) do not |
26 | | apply after December
31, 1999 to payments to a municipal |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 106 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | treasurer
made by a county with 3,000,000 or more |
2 | | inhabitants that has adopted an
estimated billing |
3 | | procedure for collecting taxes.
If a county that has |
4 | | adopted the estimated billing
procedure makes an erroneous |
5 | | overpayment of tax revenue to the municipal
treasurer, then |
6 | | the county may seek a refund of that overpayment.
The |
7 | | county shall send the municipal treasurer a notice of |
8 | | liability for the
overpayment on or before the mailing date |
9 | | of the next real estate tax bill
within the county. The |
10 | | refund shall be limited to the amount of the
overpayment.
|
11 | | It is the intent of this Division that after the |
12 | | effective date of this
amendatory Act of 1988 a |
13 | | municipality's own ad valorem
tax arising from levies on |
14 | | taxable real property be included in the
determination of |
15 | | incremental revenue in the manner provided in paragraph
(c) |
16 | | of Section 11-74.4-9. If the municipality does not extend |
17 | | such a tax,
it shall annually deposit in the municipality's |
18 | | Special Tax Increment Fund
an amount equal to 10% of the |
19 | | total contributions to the fund from all
other taxing |
20 | | districts in that year. The annual 10% deposit required by
|
21 | | this paragraph shall be limited to the actual amount of |
22 | | municipally
produced incremental tax revenues available to |
23 | | the municipality from
taxpayers located in the |
24 | | redevelopment project area in that year if:
(a) the plan |
25 | | for the area restricts the use of the property primarily to
|
26 | | industrial purposes, (b) the municipality establishing the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 107 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | redevelopment
project area is a home-rule community with a |
2 | | 1990 population of between
25,000 and 50,000, (c) the |
3 | | municipality is wholly located within a county
with a 1990 |
4 | | population of over 750,000 and (d) the redevelopment |
5 | | project
area was established by the municipality prior to |
6 | | June 1, 1990. This
payment shall be in lieu of a |
7 | | contribution of ad valorem taxes on real
property. If no |
8 | | such payment is made, any redevelopment project area of the
|
9 | | municipality shall be dissolved.
|
10 | | If a municipality has adopted tax increment allocation |
11 | | financing by ordinance
and the County Clerk thereafter |
12 | | certifies the "total initial equalized assessed
value as |
13 | | adjusted" of the taxable real property within such |
14 | | redevelopment
project area in the manner provided in |
15 | | paragraph (b) of Section 11-74.4-9,
each year after the |
16 | | date of the certification of the total initial equalized
|
17 | | assessed value as adjusted until redevelopment project |
18 | | costs and all
municipal obligations financing |
19 | | redevelopment project costs have been paid
the ad valorem |
20 | | taxes, if any, arising from the levies upon the taxable |
21 | | real
property in such redevelopment project area by taxing |
22 | | districts and tax
rates determined in the manner provided |
23 | | in paragraph (c) of Section
11-74.4-9 shall be divided as |
24 | | follows, provided, however, that with respect to any |
25 | | redevelopment project area located within a transit |
26 | | facility improvement area established pursuant to Section |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 108 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 11-74.4-3.3 in a municipality with a population of |
2 | | 1,000,000 or more, ad valorem taxes, if any, arising from |
3 | | the levies upon the taxable real property in such |
4 | | redevelopment project area shall be allocated as |
5 | | specifically provided in this Section:
|
6 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable |
7 | | lot, block, tract
or parcel of real property which is |
8 | | attributable to the lower of the
current equalized |
9 | | assessed value or "current equalized assessed value as
|
10 | | adjusted" or the initial equalized assessed value of |
11 | | each such taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of real |
12 | | property existing at the time tax increment
financing |
13 | | was adopted, minus the total current homestead |
14 | | exemptions under Article 15 of the Property
Tax Code in |
15 | | the
redevelopment project area shall be allocated to |
16 | | and when collected shall be
paid by the county |
17 | | collector to the respective affected taxing districts |
18 | | in the
manner required by law in the absence of the |
19 | | adoption of tax increment
allocation financing.
|
20 | | (2) That portion, if any, of such taxes which is |
21 | | attributable to the
increase in the current equalized |
22 | | assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, |
23 | | or parcel of real property in the redevelopment project |
24 | | area,
over and above the initial equalized assessed |
25 | | value of each property
existing at the time tax |
26 | | increment financing was adopted, minus the total
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 109 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | current homestead exemptions pertaining to each piece |
2 | | of property provided
by Article 15 of the Property Tax |
3 | | Code
in the redevelopment
project area, shall be |
4 | | allocated to and when collected shall be paid to the
|
5 | | municipal Treasurer, who shall deposit said taxes into |
6 | | a special fund called
the special tax allocation fund |
7 | | of the municipality for the purpose of paying
|
8 | | redevelopment project costs and obligations incurred |
9 | | in the payment thereof.
|
10 | | The municipality may pledge in the ordinance the funds |
11 | | in and to be
deposited in the special tax allocation fund |
12 | | for the payment of such costs
and obligations. No part of |
13 | | the current equalized assessed valuation of
each property |
14 | | in the redevelopment project area attributable to any
|
15 | | increase above the total initial equalized assessed value, |
16 | | or the total
initial equalized assessed value as adjusted, |
17 | | of such properties shall be
used in calculating the general |
18 | | State school aid formula, provided for in
Section 18-8 of |
19 | | the School Code, or the evidence-based funding formula, |
20 | | provided for in Section 18-8.15 of the School Code, until |
21 | | such time as all redevelopment
project costs have been paid |
22 | | as provided for in this Section.
|
23 | | Whenever a municipality issues bonds for the purpose of |
24 | | financing
redevelopment project costs, such municipality |
25 | | may provide by ordinance for the
appointment of a trustee, |
26 | | which may be any trust company within the State,
and for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 110 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the establishment of such funds or accounts to be |
2 | | maintained by
such trustee as the municipality shall deem |
3 | | necessary to provide for the
security and payment of the |
4 | | bonds. If such municipality provides for
the appointment of |
5 | | a trustee, such trustee shall be considered the assignee
of |
6 | | any payments assigned by the municipality pursuant to such |
7 | | ordinance
and this Section. Any amounts paid to such |
8 | | trustee as assignee shall be
deposited in the funds or |
9 | | accounts established pursuant to such trust
agreement, and |
10 | | shall be held by such trustee in trust for the benefit of |
11 | | the
holders of the bonds, and such holders shall have a |
12 | | lien on and a security
interest in such funds or accounts |
13 | | so long as the bonds remain outstanding and
unpaid. Upon |
14 | | retirement of the bonds, the trustee shall pay over any |
15 | | excess
amounts held to the municipality for deposit in the |
16 | | special tax allocation
fund.
|
17 | | When such redevelopment projects costs, including |
18 | | without limitation all
municipal obligations financing |
19 | | redevelopment project costs incurred under
this Division, |
20 | | have been paid, all surplus funds then remaining in the
|
21 | | special tax allocation fund shall be distributed
by being |
22 | | paid by the
municipal treasurer to the Department of |
23 | | Revenue, the municipality and the
county collector; first |
24 | | to the Department of Revenue and the municipality
in direct |
25 | | proportion to the tax incremental revenue received from the |
26 | | State
and the municipality, but not to exceed the total |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 111 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | incremental revenue received
from the State or the |
2 | | municipality less any annual surplus distribution
of |
3 | | incremental revenue previously made; with any remaining |
4 | | funds to be paid
to the County Collector who shall |
5 | | immediately thereafter pay said funds to
the taxing |
6 | | districts in the redevelopment project area in the same |
7 | | manner
and proportion as the most recent distribution by |
8 | | the county collector to
the affected districts of real |
9 | | property taxes from real property in the
redevelopment |
10 | | project area.
|
11 | | Upon the payment of all redevelopment project costs, |
12 | | the retirement of
obligations, the distribution of any |
13 | | excess monies pursuant to this
Section, and final closing |
14 | | of the books and records of the redevelopment
project
area, |
15 | | the municipality shall adopt an ordinance dissolving the |
16 | | special
tax allocation fund for the redevelopment project |
17 | | area and terminating the
designation of the redevelopment |
18 | | project area as a redevelopment project
area.
Title to real |
19 | | or personal property and public improvements
acquired
by or |
20 | | for
the
municipality as a result of the redevelopment |
21 | | project and plan shall vest in
the
municipality when |
22 | | acquired and shall continue to be held by the municipality
|
23 | | after the redevelopment project area has been terminated.
|
24 | | Municipalities shall notify affected taxing districts |
25 | | prior to
November 1 if the redevelopment project area is to |
26 | | be terminated by December 31
of
that same year. If a |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 112 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | municipality extends estimated dates of completion of a
|
2 | | redevelopment project and retirement of obligations to |
3 | | finance a
redevelopment project, as allowed by this |
4 | | amendatory Act of 1993, that
extension shall not extend the |
5 | | property tax increment allocation financing
authorized by |
6 | | this Section. Thereafter the rates of the taxing districts
|
7 | | shall be extended and taxes levied, collected and |
8 | | distributed in the manner
applicable in the absence of the |
9 | | adoption of tax increment allocation
financing.
|
10 | | If a municipality with a population of 1,000,000 or |
11 | | more has adopted by ordinance tax increment allocation |
12 | | financing for a redevelopment project area located in a |
13 | | transit facility improvement area established pursuant to |
14 | | Section 11-74.4-3.3, for each year after the effective date |
15 | | of the ordinance until redevelopment project costs and all |
16 | | municipal obligations financing redevelopment project |
17 | | costs have been paid, the ad valorem taxes, if any, arising |
18 | | from the levies upon the taxable real property in that |
19 | | redevelopment project area by taxing districts and tax |
20 | | rates determined in the manner provided in paragraph (c) of |
21 | | Section 11-74.4-9 shall be divided as follows: |
22 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each |
23 | | taxable lot, block, tract or parcel of real property |
24 | | which is attributable to the lower of (i) the current |
25 | | equalized assessed value or "current equalized |
26 | | assessed value as adjusted" or (ii) the initial |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 113 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | equalized assessed value of each such taxable lot, |
2 | | block, tract, or parcel of real property existing at |
3 | | the time tax increment financing was adopted, minus the |
4 | | total current homestead exemptions under Article 15 of |
5 | | the Property Tax Code in the redevelopment project area |
6 | | shall be allocated to and when collected shall be paid |
7 | | by the county collector to the respective affected |
8 | | taxing districts in the manner required by law in the |
9 | | absence of the adoption of tax increment allocation |
10 | | financing. |
11 | | (2) That portion, if any, of such taxes which is |
12 | | attributable to the increase in the current equalized |
13 | | assessed valuation of each taxable lot, block, tract, |
14 | | or parcel of real property in the redevelopment project |
15 | | area, over and above the initial equalized assessed |
16 | | value of each property existing at the time tax |
17 | | increment financing was adopted, minus the total |
18 | | current homestead exemptions pertaining to each piece |
19 | | of property provided by Article 15 of the Property Tax |
20 | | Code in the redevelopment project area, shall be |
21 | | allocated to and when collected shall be paid by the |
22 | | county collector as follows: |
23 | | (A) First, that portion which would be payable |
24 | | to a school district whose boundaries are |
25 | | coterminous with such municipality in the absence |
26 | | of the adoption of tax increment allocation |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 114 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | financing, shall be paid to such school district in |
2 | | the manner required by law in the absence of the |
3 | | adoption of tax increment allocation financing; |
4 | | then |
5 | | (B) 80% of the remaining portion shall be paid |
6 | | to the municipal Treasurer, who shall deposit said |
7 | | taxes into a special fund called the special tax |
8 | | allocation fund of the municipality for the |
9 | | purpose of paying redevelopment project costs and |
10 | | obligations incurred in the payment thereof; and |
11 | | then |
12 | | (C) 20% of the remaining portion shall be paid |
13 | | to the respective affected taxing districts, other |
14 | | than the school district described in clause (a) |
15 | | above, in the manner required by law in the absence |
16 | | of the adoption of tax increment allocation |
17 | | financing. |
18 | | Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving |
19 | | property in such
redevelopment project areas from being |
20 | | assessed as provided in the Property
Tax Code or as relieving |
21 | | owners of such property from paying a uniform rate of
taxes, as |
22 | | required by Section 4 of Article IX of the Illinois |
23 | | Constitution.
|
24 | | (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 99-792, eff. 8-12-16.)
|
25 | | (65 ILCS 5/11-74.6-35)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 115 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 11-74.6-35. Ordinance for tax increment allocation |
2 | | financing.
|
3 | | (a) A municipality, at the time a redevelopment project |
4 | | area
is designated, may adopt tax increment allocation |
5 | | financing by passing an
ordinance providing that the ad valorem |
6 | | taxes, if any, arising from the
levies upon taxable real |
7 | | property within the redevelopment project
area by taxing |
8 | | districts and tax rates determined in the manner provided
in |
9 | | subsection (b) of Section 11-74.6-40 each year after the |
10 | | effective
date of the ordinance until redevelopment project |
11 | | costs and all municipal
obligations financing redevelopment |
12 | | project costs incurred under this Act
have been paid shall be |
13 | | divided as follows:
|
14 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable |
15 | | lot, block,
tract or parcel of real property that is |
16 | | attributable to the lower of the
current equalized assessed |
17 | | value or the initial equalized assessed value or the
|
18 | | updated initial equalized assessed value of
each taxable |
19 | | lot, block, tract or parcel of real property in the
|
20 | | redevelopment project area shall be allocated to and when |
21 | | collected shall
be paid by the county collector to the |
22 | | respective affected taxing districts
in the manner |
23 | | required by law without regard to the adoption of tax
|
24 | | increment allocation financing.
|
25 | | (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes that is |
26 | | attributable to the
increase in the current equalized |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 116 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | assessed value of each taxable lot,
block, tract or parcel |
2 | | of real property in the redevelopment project area,
over |
3 | | and above the initial equalized assessed value or the |
4 | | updated initial
equalized assessed value of each property |
5 | | in the
project area, shall be allocated to and when |
6 | | collected shall be paid by the
county collector to the |
7 | | municipal treasurer who shall deposit that portion
of those |
8 | | taxes into a special fund called the special tax allocation |
9 | | fund
of the municipality for the purpose of paying |
10 | | redevelopment project costs
and obligations incurred in |
11 | | the payment of those costs and obligations.
In any county |
12 | | with a population of 3,000,000 or more that has adopted
a |
13 | | procedure for collecting taxes that provides for one or |
14 | | more of the
installments of the taxes to be billed and |
15 | | collected on an estimated basis,
the municipal treasurer |
16 | | shall be paid for deposit in the special tax
allocation |
17 | | fund of the municipality, from the taxes collected from
|
18 | | estimated bills issued for property in the redevelopment |
19 | | project area, the
difference between the amount actually |
20 | | collected from each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel of |
21 | | real property within the redevelopment project
area and an |
22 | | amount determined by multiplying the rate at which taxes |
23 | | were
last extended against the taxable lot, block, track, |
24 | | or parcel of real
property in the manner provided in |
25 | | subsection (b) of Section 11-74.6-40 by
the initial |
26 | | equalized assessed value or the updated initial equalized |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 117 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | assessed
value of the property divided by the number
of |
2 | | installments in which real estate taxes are billed and |
3 | | collected within
the county, provided that the payments on |
4 | | or before December 31, 1999 to a
municipal treasurer shall |
5 | | be made only if each of the following conditions
are met:
|
6 | | (A) The total equalized assessed value of the |
7 | | redevelopment project
area as last determined was not |
8 | | less than 175% of the total initial
equalized assessed |
9 | | value.
|
10 | | (B) Not more than 50% of the total equalized |
11 | | assessed value of the
redevelopment project area as |
12 | | last determined is attributable to a piece of
property |
13 | | assigned a single real estate index number.
|
14 | | (C) The municipal clerk has certified to the county |
15 | | clerk that the
municipality has issued its obligations |
16 | | to which there has been pledged
the incremental |
17 | | property taxes of the redevelopment project area or |
18 | | taxes
levied and collected on any or all property in |
19 | | the municipality or
the full faith and credit of the |
20 | | municipality to pay or secure payment for
all or a |
21 | | portion of the redevelopment project costs. The |
22 | | certification
shall be filed annually no later than |
23 | | September 1 for the estimated taxes
to be distributed |
24 | | in the following year.
|
25 | | The conditions of paragraphs (A) through (C) do not apply |
26 | | after December
31, 1999 to payments to a municipal treasurer
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 118 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | made by a county with 3,000,000 or more inhabitants that has |
2 | | adopted an
estimated billing procedure for collecting taxes.
If |
3 | | a county that has adopted the estimated billing
procedure makes |
4 | | an erroneous overpayment of tax revenue to the municipal
|
5 | | treasurer, then the county may seek a refund of that |
6 | | overpayment.
The county shall send the municipal treasurer a |
7 | | notice of liability for the
overpayment on or before the |
8 | | mailing date of the next real estate tax bill
within the |
9 | | county. The refund shall be limited to the amount of the
|
10 | | overpayment.
|
11 | | (b) It is the intent of this Act that a municipality's own |
12 | | ad valorem
tax arising from levies on taxable real property be |
13 | | included in the
determination of incremental revenue in the |
14 | | manner provided in paragraph
(b) of Section 11-74.6-40.
|
15 | | (c) If a municipality has adopted tax increment allocation |
16 | | financing for a
redevelopment project area by
ordinance and the |
17 | | county clerk thereafter certifies the total initial
equalized |
18 | | assessed value or the total updated initial equalized
assessed |
19 | | value of the taxable real property within such redevelopment
|
20 | | project area in the manner provided in paragraph (a) or (b) of |
21 | | Section
11-74.6-40, each year after the date of the |
22 | | certification of the total
initial equalized assessed value or |
23 | | the total updated initial
equalized assessed value until |
24 | | redevelopment project costs and all
municipal obligations |
25 | | financing redevelopment project costs have been paid,
the ad |
26 | | valorem taxes, if any, arising from the levies upon the taxable |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 119 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | real
property in the redevelopment project area by taxing |
2 | | districts and tax
rates determined in the manner provided in |
3 | | paragraph (b) of Section
11-74.6-40 shall be divided as |
4 | | follows:
|
5 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable |
6 | | lot, block, tract
or parcel of real property that is |
7 | | attributable to the lower of the
current equalized assessed |
8 | | value or the initial equalized assessed value, or
the |
9 | | updated initial equalized assessed value of each parcel if |
10 | | the updated
initial equalized assessed value of that parcel |
11 | | has been certified in
accordance with Section 11-74.6-40, |
12 | | whichever has been most
recently certified, of each taxable |
13 | | lot, block, tract, or parcel of real
property existing at |
14 | | the time tax increment allocation financing was
adopted in |
15 | | the redevelopment project area, shall be allocated to and |
16 | | when
collected shall be paid by the county collector to the |
17 | | respective affected
taxing districts in the manner |
18 | | required by law without regard to the adoption
of tax |
19 | | increment allocation financing.
|
20 | | (2) That portion, if any, of those taxes that is |
21 | | attributable to the
increase in the current equalized |
22 | | assessed value of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or parcel |
23 | | of real property in the redevelopment project area,
over |
24 | | and above the initial equalized assessed value of each |
25 | | property
existing at the time tax increment allocation |
26 | | financing was adopted
in the redevelopment project area, or
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 120 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the updated initial equalized assessed value of each parcel |
2 | | if the updated
initial equalized assessed value of that |
3 | | parcel has been certified in
accordance with Section |
4 | | 11-74.6-40, shall be allocated to and when collected
shall |
5 | | be paid to the municipal treasurer, who shall deposit those |
6 | | taxes
into a special fund called the special tax allocation |
7 | | fund of the
municipality for the purpose of paying |
8 | | redevelopment project costs and
obligations incurred in |
9 | | the payment thereof.
|
10 | | (d) The municipality may pledge in the ordinance the funds |
11 | | in and to be
deposited in the special tax allocation fund for |
12 | | the payment of
redevelopment project costs and obligations. No |
13 | | part of the current
equalized assessed value of each property |
14 | | in the redevelopment project
area attributable to any increase |
15 | | above the total initial equalized
assessed value
or the total |
16 | | initial updated equalized assessed value of the property,
shall |
17 | | be used in calculating the general General State aid formula |
18 | | School Aid Formula , provided
for in Section 18-8 of the School |
19 | | Code, or the evidence-based funding formula, provided for in |
20 | | Section 18-8.15 of the School Code, until all redevelopment |
21 | | project
costs have been paid as provided for in this Section.
|
22 | | Whenever a municipality issues bonds for the purpose of |
23 | | financing
redevelopment project costs, that municipality may |
24 | | provide by ordinance for the
appointment of a trustee, which |
25 | | may be any trust company within the State,
and for the |
26 | | establishment of any funds or accounts to be maintained by
that |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 121 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | trustee, as the municipality deems necessary to provide for the
|
2 | | security and payment of the bonds. If the municipality provides |
3 | | for
the appointment of a trustee, the trustee shall be |
4 | | considered the assignee
of any payments assigned by the |
5 | | municipality under that ordinance
and this Section. Any amounts |
6 | | paid to the trustee as
assignee shall be deposited into the |
7 | | funds or accounts established
under the trust agreement, and |
8 | | shall be held by the trustee in trust for the
benefit of the |
9 | | holders of the bonds. The holders of those bonds shall have a
|
10 | | lien on and a security interest in those funds or accounts |
11 | | while the
bonds remain outstanding and unpaid. Upon retirement |
12 | | of the bonds,
the trustee shall pay over any excess amounts |
13 | | held to the municipality for
deposit in the special tax |
14 | | allocation fund.
|
15 | | When the redevelopment projects costs, including without |
16 | | limitation all
municipal obligations financing redevelopment |
17 | | project costs incurred under
this Law, have been paid, all |
18 | | surplus funds then remaining in the
special tax allocation fund |
19 | | shall be distributed by being paid by the
municipal treasurer |
20 | | to the municipality and the county collector; first to
the |
21 | | municipality in direct proportion to the tax incremental |
22 | | revenue
received from the municipality, but not to exceed the |
23 | | total incremental
revenue received from the municipality, |
24 | | minus any annual surplus
distribution of incremental revenue |
25 | | previously made. Any remaining funds
shall be paid to the |
26 | | county collector who shall immediately distribute that
payment |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 122 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to the taxing districts in the redevelopment project area in |
2 | | the
same manner and proportion as the most recent distribution |
3 | | by the county
collector to the affected districts of real |
4 | | property taxes from real
property situated in the redevelopment |
5 | | project area.
|
6 | | Upon the payment of all redevelopment project costs, |
7 | | retirement of
obligations and the distribution of any excess |
8 | | moneys under this
Section, the municipality shall adopt an |
9 | | ordinance dissolving the special
tax allocation fund for the |
10 | | redevelopment project area and terminating the
designation of |
11 | | the redevelopment project area as a redevelopment project
area. |
12 | | Thereafter the tax levies of taxing districts shall be |
13 | | extended,
collected and distributed in the same manner |
14 | | applicable
before the adoption of tax increment allocation |
15 | | financing.
Municipality shall notify affected taxing districts |
16 | | prior to November if the
redevelopment project area is to be |
17 | | terminated by December 31 of that same
year.
|
18 | | Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving |
19 | | property in a
redevelopment project area from being assessed as |
20 | | provided in the Property
Tax Code or as relieving owners of |
21 | | that property
from paying a uniform rate of taxes, as required |
22 | | by Section 4 of Article IX
of the Illinois Constitution.
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 91-474, eff. 11-1-99.)
|
24 | | Section 40. The Economic Development Project Area Tax |
25 | | Increment Allocation Act of
1995 is amended by changing Section |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 123 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 50 as follows:
|
2 | | (65 ILCS 110/50)
|
3 | | Sec. 50. Special tax allocation fund.
|
4 | | (a) If a county clerk has certified the "total initial |
5 | | equalized assessed
value" of the taxable real property within |
6 | | an economic development project area
in the manner provided in |
7 | | Section 45, each year after the date of the
certification by |
8 | | the county clerk of the "total initial equalized assessed
|
9 | | value", until economic development project costs and all |
10 | | municipal obligations
financing economic development project |
11 | | costs have been paid, the ad valorem
taxes, if any, arising |
12 | | from the levies upon the taxable real property in the
economic |
13 | | development project area by taxing districts and tax rates |
14 | | determined
in the manner provided in subsection (b) of Section |
15 | | 45 shall be divided as
follows:
|
16 | | (1) That portion of the taxes levied upon each taxable
|
17 | | lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property that is |
18 | | attributable to the lower
of the current equalized assessed |
19 | | value or the initial equalized assessed value
of each |
20 | | taxable lot, block, tract, or parcel of real property |
21 | | existing
at the time tax increment financing was adopted |
22 | | shall be allocated to (and when
collected shall be paid by |
23 | | the county collector to) the respective affected
taxing |
24 | | districts in the manner required by law in the absence of |
25 | | the adoption
of tax increment allocation financing.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 124 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) That portion, if any, of the taxes that is |
2 | | attributable to the
increase in the current equalized |
3 | | assessed valuation of each taxable lot,
block, tract, or
|
4 | | parcel of real property in the economic development project |
5 | | area, over and
above the initial equalized assessed value |
6 | | of each property existing at the
time tax increment |
7 | | financing was adopted, shall be allocated to (and when
|
8 | | collected shall be paid to) the municipal treasurer, who |
9 | | shall deposit the
taxes into a special fund (called the |
10 | | special tax allocation fund of the
municipality) for the |
11 | | purpose of paying economic development project costs and
|
12 | | obligations incurred in the payment of those costs.
|
13 | | (b) The municipality, by an ordinance adopting tax |
14 | | increment allocation
financing, may pledge the monies in and to |
15 | | be deposited into the special tax
allocation fund for the |
16 | | payment of obligations issued under this Act and for
the |
17 | | payment of economic development project costs. No part of the |
18 | | current
equalized assessed valuation of each property in the |
19 | | economic development
project area attributable to any increase |
20 | | above the total initial equalized
assessed value of those |
21 | | properties shall be used in calculating the general
State |
22 | | school aid formula under
Section 18-8 of the School Code or the |
23 | | evidence-based funding formula under Section 18-8.15 of the |
24 | | School Code, until all economic development projects costs
have |
25 | | been paid as provided for in this Section.
|
26 | | (c) When the economic development projects costs, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 125 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | including without
limitation all municipal obligations |
2 | | financing economic development project
costs incurred under |
3 | | this Act, have been paid, all surplus monies then
remaining in |
4 | | the special tax allocation fund shall be distributed by being |
5 | | paid
by the municipal treasurer to the county collector, who |
6 | | shall immediately pay
the monies to the taxing districts having |
7 | | taxable property in the economic
development project area in |
8 | | the same manner and proportion as the most recent
distribution |
9 | | by the county collector to those taxing districts of real |
10 | | property
taxes from real property in the economic development |
11 | | project area.
|
12 | | (d) Upon the payment of all economic development project |
13 | | costs, retirement
of obligations, and distribution of any |
14 | | excess monies under this Section and
not later than 23 years |
15 | | from the date of the adoption of the ordinance
establishing the |
16 | | economic development project area, the municipality shall
|
17 | | adopt an ordinance dissolving the special tax allocation fund |
18 | | for the economic
development project area and terminating the |
19 | | designation of the economic
development project area as an |
20 | | economic development project area.
Thereafter, the rates of the |
21 | | taxing districts shall be extended and taxes shall
be levied, |
22 | | collected, and distributed in the manner applicable in the |
23 | | absence
of the adoption of tax increment allocation financing.
|
24 | | (e) Nothing in this Section shall be construed as relieving |
25 | | property in the
economic development project areas from being |
26 | | assessed as provided in the
Property Tax Code or as relieving |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 126 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | owners or lessees of that property from
paying a uniform rate |
2 | | of taxes as required by Section 4 of Article IX of the
Illinois |
3 | | Constitution.
|
4 | | (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13.)
|
5 | | Section 45. The School Code is amended by changing Sections |
6 | | 1A-8, 1B-5, 1B-6, 1B-7, 1B-8, 1C-1, 1C-2, 1D-1, 1E-20, 1F-20, |
7 | | 1F-62, 1H-20, 1H-70, 2-3.33, 2-3.51.5, 2-3.62, 2-3.66, |
8 | | 2-3.66b, 2-3.80, 2-3.84, 2-3.109a, 3-14.21, 7-14A, 10-17a, |
9 | | 10-19, 10-22.5a, 10-22.20, 10-29, 11E-135, 13A-8, 13B-20.20, |
10 | | 13B-45, 13B-50, 13B-50.10, 13B-50.15, 14-7.02, 14-7.02b, |
11 | | 14-7.03, 14-13.01, 14C-1, 14C-12, 17-1, 17-1.2, 17-1.5, |
12 | | 17-2.11, 17-2A, 18-4.3, 18-8.05, 18-8.10, 18-9, 18-12, 26-16, |
13 | | 27-8.1, 27A-9, 27A-11, 29-5, 34-2.3, 34-18, 34-18.30, and |
14 | | 34-43.1 and by adding Sections 17-3.6 and 18-8.15 as follows:
|
15 | | (105 ILCS 5/1A-8) (from Ch. 122, par. 1A-8)
|
16 | | Sec. 1A-8. Powers of the Board in Assisting Districts |
17 | | Deemed in Financial
Difficulties. To promote the financial |
18 | | integrity of school districts, the
State Board of Education |
19 | | shall be provided the necessary powers to promote
sound |
20 | | financial management and continue operation of the public |
21 | | schools.
|
22 | | (a) The State Superintendent of Education may require a |
23 | | school district, including any district subject to Article 34A |
24 | | of this Code, to share financial information relevant to a |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 127 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | proper investigation of the district's financial condition and |
2 | | the delivery of appropriate State financial, technical, and |
3 | | consulting services to the district if the district (i) has |
4 | | been designated, through the State Board of Education's School |
5 | | District Financial Profile System, as on financial warning or |
6 | | financial watch status, (ii) has failed to file an annual |
7 | | financial report, annual budget, deficit reduction plan, or |
8 | | other financial information as required by law, (iii) has been |
9 | | identified, through the district's annual audit or other |
10 | | financial and management information, as in serious financial |
11 | | difficulty in the current or next school year, or (iv) is |
12 | | determined to be likely to fail to fully meet any regularly |
13 | | scheduled, payroll-period obligations when due or any debt |
14 | | service payments when due or both. In addition to financial, |
15 | | technical, and consulting services provided by the State Board |
16 | | of Education, at the request of a school district, the State |
17 | | Superintendent may provide for an independent financial |
18 | | consultant to assist the district review its financial |
19 | | condition and options.
|
20 | | (b) The State Board of Education, after proper |
21 | | investigation of a district's
financial condition, may certify |
22 | | that a district, including any district
subject to Article 34A, |
23 | | is in financial difficulty
when any of the following conditions |
24 | | occur:
|
25 | | (1) The district has issued school or teacher orders |
26 | | for wages as permitted in Sections
8-16, 32-7.2 and 34-76 |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 128 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of this Code.
|
2 | | (2) The district has issued tax anticipation warrants |
3 | | or tax
anticipation notes in anticipation of a second |
4 | | year's taxes when warrants or
notes in anticipation of |
5 | | current year taxes are still outstanding, as
authorized by |
6 | | Sections 17-16, 34-23, 34-59 and 34-63 of this Code, or has |
7 | | issued short-term debt against 2 future revenue sources, |
8 | | such as, but not limited to, tax anticipation warrants and |
9 | | general State aid or evidence-based funding Aid |
10 | | certificates or tax anticipation warrants and revenue |
11 | | anticipation notes.
|
12 | | (3) The district has for 2 consecutive years shown an |
13 | | excess
of expenditures and other financing uses over |
14 | | revenues and other financing
sources and beginning fund |
15 | | balances on its annual financial report for the
aggregate |
16 | | totals of the Educational, Operations and Maintenance,
|
17 | | Transportation, and Working Cash Funds.
|
18 | | (4) The district refuses to provide financial |
19 | | information or cooperate with the State Superintendent in |
20 | | an investigation of the district's financial condition. |
21 | | (5) The district is likely to fail to fully meet any |
22 | | regularly scheduled, payroll-period obligations when due |
23 | | or any debt service payments when due or both.
|
24 | | No school district shall be certified by the State Board of |
25 | | Education to be in financial difficulty solely by
reason of any |
26 | | of the above circumstances arising as a result of (i) the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 129 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | failure
of the county to make any distribution of property tax |
2 | | money due the district
at the time such distribution is due or |
3 | | (ii) the failure of this State to make timely payments of |
4 | | general State aid , evidence-based funding, or any of the |
5 | | mandated categoricals; or if the district clearly demonstrates
|
6 | | to the satisfaction of the State Board of Education at the time |
7 | | of its
determination that such condition no longer exists. If |
8 | | the State Board of
Education certifies that a district in a |
9 | | city with 500,000 inhabitants or
more is in financial |
10 | | difficulty, the State Board shall so notify the
Governor and |
11 | | the Mayor of the city in which the district is located. The
|
12 | | State Board of Education may require school districts certified |
13 | | in
financial difficulty, except those districts subject to |
14 | | Article 34A, to
develop, adopt and submit a financial plan |
15 | | within 45 days after
certification of financial difficulty. The |
16 | | financial plan shall be
developed according to guidelines |
17 | | presented to the district by the State
Board of Education |
18 | | within 14 days of certification. Such guidelines shall
address |
19 | | the specific nature of each district's financial difficulties. |
20 | | Any
proposed budget of the district shall be consistent with |
21 | | the financial plan
submitted to and
approved by the State Board |
22 | | of Education.
|
23 | | A district certified to be in financial difficulty, other |
24 | | than a district
subject to Article 34A, shall report to the |
25 | | State Board of Education at
such times and in such manner as |
26 | | the State Board may direct, concerning the
district's |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 130 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | compliance with each financial plan. The State Board may review
|
2 | | the district's operations, obtain budgetary data and financial |
3 | | statements,
require the district to produce reports, and have |
4 | | access to any other
information in the possession of the |
5 | | district that it deems relevant. The
State Board may issue |
6 | | recommendations or directives within its powers to
the district |
7 | | to assist in compliance with the financial plan. The district
|
8 | | shall produce such budgetary data, financial statements, |
9 | | reports and other
information and comply with such directives. |
10 | | If the State Board of Education
determines that a district has |
11 | | failed to comply with its financial plan, the
State Board of |
12 | | Education may rescind approval of the plan and appoint a
|
13 | | Financial Oversight Panel for the district as provided in |
14 | | Section 1B-4. This
action shall be taken only after the |
15 | | district has been given notice and an
opportunity to appear |
16 | | before the State Board of Education to discuss its
failure to |
17 | | comply with its financial plan.
|
18 | | No bonds, notes, teachers orders, tax anticipation |
19 | | warrants or other
evidences of indebtedness shall be issued or |
20 | | sold by a school district or
be legally binding upon or |
21 | | enforceable against a local board of education
of a district |
22 | | certified to be in financial difficulty unless and until the
|
23 | | financial plan required under this Section has been approved by |
24 | | the State
Board of Education.
|
25 | | Any financial profile compiled and distributed by the State |
26 | | Board of Education in Fiscal Year 2009 or any fiscal year |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 131 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | thereafter
shall incorporate such adjustments as may be needed |
2 | | in the profile scores to reflect the financial effects of the
|
3 | | inability or refusal of the State of Illinois to make timely
|
4 | | disbursements of any general State aid , evidence-based |
5 | | funding, or mandated categorical aid payments due school |
6 | | districts or to fully reimburse
school districts for mandated |
7 | | categorical programs pursuant to
reimbursement formulas |
8 | | provided in this School Code.
|
9 | | (Source: P.A. 96-668, eff. 8-25-09; 96-1423, eff. 8-3-10; |
10 | | 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
|
11 | | (105 ILCS 5/1B-5) (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-5)
|
12 | | Sec. 1B-5.
When a petition for emergency financial
|
13 | | assistance for a school district is allowed by the State
Board |
14 | | under Section 1B-4, the State Superintendent
shall within 10 |
15 | | days thereafter appoint 3 members
to serve at the State |
16 | | Superintendent's pleasure on a
Financial Oversight Panel for |
17 | | the district. The State
Superintendent shall designate one of |
18 | | the members of the
Panel to serve as its Chairman. In the event |
19 | | of vacancy or
resignation the State Superintendent shall |
20 | | appoint a
successor within 10 days of receiving notice thereof.
|
21 | | Members of the Panel shall be selected primarily on the
|
22 | | basis of their experience and education in financial
|
23 | | management, with consideration given to persons
knowledgeable |
24 | | in education finance. A member of the Panel
may not be a board |
25 | | member or employee of the district for
which the Panel is |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 132 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | constituted, nor may a member have a
direct financial interest |
2 | | in that district.
|
3 | | Panel members shall serve without compensation, but may
be |
4 | | reimbursed for travel and other necessary expenses
incurred in |
5 | | the performance of their official duties by the
State Board. |
6 | | The amount reimbursed Panel
members for their expenses shall be |
7 | | charged to the school
district as part of any emergency |
8 | | financial assistance and
incorporated as a part of the terms |
9 | | and conditions for
repayment of such assistance or shall be |
10 | | deducted from the district's general
State aid or |
11 | | evidence-based funding as provided in Section 1B-8.
|
12 | | The first meeting of the Panel shall be held at the
call of |
13 | | the Chairman. The Panel may elect such other
officers as it |
14 | | deems appropriate. The Panel shall prescribe
the times and |
15 | | places for its meetings and the manner in
which regular and |
16 | | special meetings may be called, and shall
comply with the Open |
17 | | Meetings Act.
|
18 | | Two members of the Panel shall constitute a quorum, and
the |
19 | | affirmative vote of 2 members shall be necessary for any
|
20 | | decision or action to be taken by the Panel.
|
21 | | The Panel and the State Superintendent
shall cooperate with |
22 | | each other in the exercise of their
respective powers. The |
23 | | Panel shall report not later than
September 1 annually to the |
24 | | State Board and the State
Superintendent with respect to its |
25 | | activities and the
condition of the school district for the |
26 | | previous fiscal
year.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 133 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Any Financial Oversight Panel established under this
|
2 | | Article shall remain in existence for not less than 3 years
nor |
3 | | more than 10 years from the date the State Board grants
the |
4 | | petition under Section 1B-4. If after 3 years the
school |
5 | | district has repaid all of its obligations resulting
from |
6 | | emergency State financial assistance provided under
this |
7 | | Article and has improved its financial situation, the board of
|
8 | | education may, not more
frequently than once in any 12 month |
9 | | period, petition the
State Board to dissolve the Financial |
10 | | Oversight Panel,
terminate the oversight responsibility, and |
11 | | remove the
district's certification under Section 1A-8 as a |
12 | | district in
financial difficulty. In acting on such a petition |
13 | | the
State Board shall give additional weight to the
|
14 | | recommendations of the State Superintendent and the
Financial |
15 | | Oversight Panel.
|
16 | | (Source: P.A. 88-618, eff. 9-9-94.)
|
17 | | (105 ILCS 5/1B-6) (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-6)
|
18 | | Sec. 1B-6. General powers. The purpose of the Financial |
19 | | Oversight Panel
shall be to exercise financial control over the |
20 | | board of education, and, when
approved by the State Board and |
21 | | the State Superintendent of Education, to
furnish financial |
22 | | assistance so that the board can provide public education
|
23 | | within the board's jurisdiction while permitting the board to |
24 | | meet its
obligations to its creditors and the holders of its |
25 | | notes and bonds.
Except as expressly limited by this Article, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 134 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the Panel shall have all
powers necessary to meet its |
2 | | responsibilities and to carry out its purposes
and the purposes |
3 | | of this Article, including, but not limited to, the following
|
4 | | powers:
|
5 | | (a) to sue and be sued;
|
6 | | (b) to provide for its organization and internal
|
7 | | management;
|
8 | | (c) to appoint a Financial Administrator to serve as
the |
9 | | chief executive officer of the Panel. The Financial
|
10 | | Administrator may be an individual, partnership,
corporation, |
11 | | including an accounting firm, or other entity
determined by the |
12 | | Panel to be qualified to serve; and to
appoint other officers, |
13 | | agents, and employees of the Panel,
define their duties and |
14 | | qualifications and fix their
compensation and employee |
15 | | benefits;
|
16 | | (d) to approve the local board of education appointments to |
17 | | the
positions of treasurer in a Class I county school unit and |
18 | | in each school
district which forms a part of a Class II county |
19 | | school unit but which no
longer is subject to the jurisdiction |
20 | | and authority of a township treasurer
or trustees of schools of |
21 | | a township because the district has withdrawn
from the |
22 | | jurisdiction and authority of the township treasurer and the
|
23 | | trustees of schools of the township or because those offices |
24 | | have been
abolished as provided in subsection (b) or (c) of |
25 | | Section 5-1,
and chief school business official, if such |
26 | | official is not the
superintendent of the district. Either the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 135 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | board or the Panel may remove
such treasurer or chief school |
2 | | business official;
|
3 | | (e) to approve any and all bonds, notes, teachers
orders, |
4 | | tax anticipation warrants, and other evidences of
indebtedness |
5 | | prior to issuance or sale by the school
district; and |
6 | | notwithstanding any other provision of The School Code, as
now |
7 | | or hereafter amended, no bonds, notes, teachers orders, tax
|
8 | | anticipation warrants or other evidences of indebtedness shall |
9 | | be issued or
sold by the school district or be legally binding |
10 | | upon or enforceable
against the local board of education unless |
11 | | and until the approval of the
Panel has been received;
|
12 | | (f) to approve all property tax levies of the school
|
13 | | district and require adjustments thereto as the Panel deems
|
14 | | necessary or advisable;
|
15 | | (g) to require and approve a school district financial |
16 | | plan;
|
17 | | (h) to approve and require revisions of the school district |
18 | | budget;
|
19 | | (i) to approve all contracts and other obligations as
the |
20 | | Panel deems necessary and appropriate;
|
21 | | (j) to authorize emergency State financial assistance,
|
22 | | including requirements regarding the terms and conditions of
|
23 | | repayment of such assistance, and to require the board of
|
24 | | education to levy a separate local property tax, subject to
the |
25 | | limitations of Section 1B-8, sufficient to repay such
|
26 | | assistance consistent with the terms and conditions of
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 136 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | repayment and the district's approved financial plan and
|
2 | | budget;
|
3 | | (k) to request the regional superintendent to make |
4 | | appointments to
fill all vacancies on the local school board as |
5 | | provided in Section 10-10;
|
6 | | (l) to recommend dissolution or reorganization of the |
7 | | school district
to the General Assembly if in the Panel's |
8 | | judgment the
circumstances so require;
|
9 | | (m) to direct a phased reduction in the oversight |
10 | | responsibilities of
the Financial Administrator and of the |
11 | | Panel as the circumstances permit;
|
12 | | (n) to determine the amount of emergency State
financial |
13 | | assistance to be made available to the school
district, and to |
14 | | establish an operating budget for the Panel
to be supported by |
15 | | funds available from such assistance,
with the assistance and |
16 | | the budget required to be approved
by the State Superintendent;
|
17 | | (o) to procure insurance against any loss in such
amounts |
18 | | and from such insurers as it deems necessary;
|
19 | | (p) to engage the services of consultants for
rendering |
20 | | professional and technical assistance and advice
on matters |
21 | | within the Panel's power;
|
22 | | (q) to contract for and to accept any gifts, grants or
|
23 | | loans of funds or property or financial or other aid in any
|
24 | | form from the federal government, State government, unit of
|
25 | | local government, school district or any agency or
|
26 | | instrumentality thereof, or from any other private or public
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 137 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | source, and to comply with the terms and conditions thereof;
|
2 | | (r) to pay the expenses of its operations based on the
|
3 | | Panel's budget as approved by the State Superintendent from
|
4 | | emergency financial assistance funds available to the
district |
5 | | or from deductions from the district's general State aid or |
6 | | evidence-based funding ;
|
7 | | (s) to do any and all things necessary or convenient
to |
8 | | carry out its purposes and exercise the powers given to
the |
9 | | Panel by this Article; and
|
10 | | (t) to recommend the creation of a school finance authority
|
11 | | pursuant to Article 1F of this Code.
|
12 | | (Source: P.A. 91-357, eff. 7-29-99; 92-855, eff. 12-6-02.)
|
13 | | (105 ILCS 5/1B-7) (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-7)
|
14 | | Sec. 1B-7. Financial Administrator; Powers and
Duties. The |
15 | | Financial Administrator appointed by the
Financial Oversight |
16 | | Panel shall serve as the Panel's chief
executive officer. The |
17 | | Financial Administrator shall
exercise the powers and duties |
18 | | required by the Panel,
including but not limited to the |
19 | | following:
|
20 | | (a) to provide guidance and recommendations to the
local |
21 | | board and officials of the school district in
developing the |
22 | | district's financial plan and budget prior to
board action;
|
23 | | (b) to direct the local board to reorganize its
financial |
24 | | accounts, budgetary systems, and internal
accounting and |
25 | | financial controls, in whatever manner the
Panel deems |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 138 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | appropriate to achieve greater financial
responsibility and to |
2 | | reduce financial inefficiency, and to
provide technical |
3 | | assistance to aid the district in
accomplishing the |
4 | | reorganization;
|
5 | | (c) to make recommendations to the Financial Oversight
|
6 | | Panel concerning the school district's financial plan and
|
7 | | budget, and all other matters within the scope of the
Panel's |
8 | | authority;
|
9 | | (d) to prepare and recommend to the Panel a proposal
for |
10 | | emergency State financial assistance for the district,
|
11 | | including recommended terms and conditions of repayment, and
an |
12 | | operations budget for the Panel to be funded from the
emergency |
13 | | assistance or from deductions from the district's general State
|
14 | | aid or evidence-based funding ;
|
15 | | (e) to require the local board to prepare and submit
|
16 | | preliminary staffing and budgetary analyses annually prior
to |
17 | | February 1 in such manner and form as the Financial
|
18 | | Administrator shall prescribe; and
|
19 | | (f) subject to the direction of the Panel, to do all
other |
20 | | things necessary or convenient to carry out its
purposes and |
21 | | exercise the powers given to the Panel under
this Article.
|
22 | | (Source: P.A. 88-618, eff. 9-9-94.)
|
23 | | (105 ILCS 5/1B-8) (from Ch. 122, par. 1B-8)
|
24 | | Sec. 1B-8. There is created in the State Treasury a
special |
25 | | fund to be known as the School District Emergency
Financial |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 139 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Assistance Fund (the "Fund"). The School District Emergency
|
2 | | Financial Assistance Fund shall consist of appropriations, |
3 | | loan repayments, grants from the
federal government, and |
4 | | donations from any public or private source. Moneys in
the Fund
|
5 | | may be appropriated only to the Illinois Finance Authority and
|
6 | | the State Board for
those purposes authorized under this |
7 | | Article and Articles
1F and 1H of this Code.
The appropriation |
8 | | may be
allocated and expended by the State Board for |
9 | | contractual services to provide technical assistance or |
10 | | consultation to school districts to assess their financial |
11 | | condition and to Financial Oversight Panels that petition for |
12 | | emergency financial assistance grants. The Illinois Finance |
13 | | Authority may provide
loans to school districts which are the |
14 | | subject of an
approved petition for emergency financial |
15 | | assistance under
Section 1B-4,
1F-62, or 1H-65 of this Code. |
16 | | Neither the State Board of Education nor the Illinois Finance |
17 | | Authority may collect any fees for providing these services. |
18 | | From the amount allocated to each such school
district |
19 | | under this Article the State Board shall identify a sum |
20 | | sufficient to
cover all approved costs of the Financial |
21 | | Oversight Panel
established for the respective school |
22 | | district. If the State Board and State
Superintendent of |
23 | | Education have not approved emergency financial assistance in
|
24 | | conjunction with the appointment of a Financial Oversight |
25 | | Panel, the Panel's
approved costs shall be paid from deductions |
26 | | from the district's general State
aid or evidence-based |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 140 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | funding .
|
2 | | The Financial Oversight Panel may prepare and file
with the |
3 | | State Superintendent a proposal for emergency
financial |
4 | | assistance for the school district and for its
operations |
5 | | budget. No expenditures from the Fund shall be
authorized by |
6 | | the State Superintendent until he or she has approved
the |
7 | | request of the Panel, either as submitted or in such
lesser |
8 | | amount determined by the State Superintendent.
|
9 | | The maximum amount of an emergency financial assistance |
10 | | loan
which may be allocated to any school district under this
|
11 | | Article, including moneys necessary for the operations of
the |
12 | | Panel, shall not exceed $4,000 times the number of pupils
|
13 | | enrolled in the school district during the school year
ending |
14 | | June 30 prior to the date of approval by the State
Board of the |
15 | | petition for emergency financial assistance, as
certified to |
16 | | the local board and the Panel by the State
Superintendent.
An |
17 | | emergency financial assistance grant shall not exceed $1,000 |
18 | | times the
number of such pupils. A district may receive both a |
19 | | loan and a grant.
|
20 | | The payment of an emergency State financial assistance |
21 | | grant or loan
shall be subject to appropriation by the General |
22 | | Assembly. Payment of the emergency State financial assistance |
23 | | loan is subject to the applicable provisions of the Illinois |
24 | | Finance Authority Act.
Emergency State financial assistance |
25 | | allocated and paid to a school
district under this Article may |
26 | | be applied to any fund or funds from which
the local board of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 141 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | education of that district is authorized to make
expenditures |
2 | | by law.
|
3 | | Any emergency financial assistance grant proposed by the
|
4 | | Financial Oversight Panel and approved by the State
|
5 | | Superintendent may be paid in its entirety during the
initial |
6 | | year of the Panel's existence or spread in equal or
declining |
7 | | amounts over a period of years not to exceed the
period of the |
8 | | Panel's existence. An emergency financial assistance loan |
9 | | proposed by the Financial Oversight Panel and approved by the |
10 | | Illinois Finance Authority may be paid in its entirety during |
11 | | the initial year of the Panel's existence or spread in equal or |
12 | | declining amounts over a period of years not to exceed the |
13 | | period of the Panel's existence. All
loans made by the Illinois |
14 | | Finance Authority for a
school district shall be required to be |
15 | | repaid, with simple interest over
the term of the loan at a |
16 | | rate equal to 50% of the one-year Constant Maturity
Treasury |
17 | | (CMT) yield as last published by the Board of Governors of the |
18 | | Federal
Reserve System before the date on which the district's |
19 | | loan is
approved
by the Illinois Finance Authority, not later |
20 | | than the
date the
Financial Oversight Panel ceases to exist. |
21 | | The Panel shall
establish and the Illinois Finance Authority |
22 | | shall
approve the terms and conditions, including the schedule, |
23 | | of
repayments. The schedule shall provide for repayments
|
24 | | commencing July 1 of each year or upon each fiscal year's |
25 | | receipt of moneys from a tax levy for emergency financial |
26 | | assistance. Repayment shall be incorporated into the
annual |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 142 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | budget of the school district and may be made from any fund or |
2 | | funds
of the district in which there are moneys available. An |
3 | | emergency financial assistance loan to the Panel or district |
4 | | shall not be considered part of the calculation of a district's |
5 | | debt for purposes of the limitation specified in Section 19-1 |
6 | | of this Code. Default on repayment is subject to the Illinois |
7 | | Grant Funds Recovery Act. When moneys are repaid
as provided |
8 | | herein they shall not be made available to the local board for
|
9 | | further use as emergency financial assistance under this |
10 | | Article at any
time thereafter. All repayments required to be |
11 | | made by a school district
shall be received by the State Board |
12 | | and deposited in the School District
Emergency Financial |
13 | | Assistance Fund.
|
14 | | In establishing the terms and conditions for the
repayment |
15 | | obligation of the school district the Panel shall
annually |
16 | | determine whether a separate local property tax levy is
|
17 | | required. The board of any school district with a tax rate
for |
18 | | educational purposes for the prior year of less than
120% of |
19 | | the maximum rate for educational purposes authorized
by Section |
20 | | 17-2 shall provide for a separate
tax levy for emergency |
21 | | financial assistance repayment
purposes. Such tax levy shall |
22 | | not be subject to referendum approval. The
amount of the levy |
23 | | shall be equal to the
amount necessary to meet the annual |
24 | | repayment obligations of
the district as established by the |
25 | | Panel, or 20% of the
amount levied for educational purposes for |
26 | | the prior year,
whichever is less. However, no district shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 143 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be
required to levy the tax if the district's operating tax
|
2 | | rate as determined under Section
18-8 , or 18-8.05 , or 18-8.15 |
3 | | exceeds 200% of the district's tax rate for educational
|
4 | | purposes for the prior year.
|
5 | | (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
|
6 | | (105 ILCS 5/1C-1)
|
7 | | Sec. 1C-1. Purpose. The purpose of this Article is to |
8 | | permit greater
flexibility and efficiency in the distribution |
9 | | and use of certain State funds
available to
local education |
10 | | agencies for the improvement of the quality of educational
|
11 | | services pursuant to locally established priorities.
|
12 | | Through fiscal year 2017, this This Article does not apply |
13 | | to school districts having a population in excess
of 500,000 |
14 | | inhabitants.
|
15 | | (Source: P.A. 88-555, eff. 7-27-94; 89-15, eff. 5-30-95; |
16 | | 89-397, eff.
8-20-95; 89-626, eff. 8-9-96.)
|
17 | | (105 ILCS 5/1C-2)
|
18 | | Sec. 1C-2. Block grants.
|
19 | | (a) For fiscal year 1999, and each fiscal year thereafter, |
20 | | the State Board
of Education shall award to school districts |
21 | | block grants as described in subsection
(c). The State Board of |
22 | | Education may adopt
rules and regulations necessary to |
23 | | implement this Section. In accordance with
Section 2-3.32, all |
24 | | state block grants are subject to an audit. Therefore,
block |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 144 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | grant receipts and block grant expenditures shall be recorded |
2 | | to the
appropriate fund code.
|
3 | | (b) (Blank).
|
4 | | (c) An Early Childhood Education Block Grant shall be |
5 | | created by combining
the following programs: Preschool |
6 | | Education, Parental Training and Prevention
Initiative. These |
7 | | funds shall be distributed to school districts and other
|
8 | | entities on a competitive basis , except that the State Board of |
9 | | Education shall award to a school district having a population |
10 | | exceeding 500,000 inhabitants 37% of the funds in each fiscal |
11 | | year . Not less than 14% of the Early Childhood Education Block |
12 | | Grant allocation of funds
shall be used to
fund programs for |
13 | | children ages 0-3. Beginning in Fiscal Year 2016, at least 25% |
14 | | of any additional Early Childhood Education Block Grant funding |
15 | | over and above the previous fiscal year's allocation shall be |
16 | | used to fund programs for children ages 0-3. Once the |
17 | | percentage of Early Childhood Education Block Grant funding |
18 | | allocated to programs for children ages 0-3 reaches 20% of the |
19 | | overall Early Childhood Education Block Grant allocation for a |
20 | | full fiscal year, thereafter in subsequent fiscal years the |
21 | | percentage of Early Childhood Education Block Grant funding |
22 | | allocated to programs for children ages 0-3 each fiscal year |
23 | | shall remain at least 20% of the overall Early Childhood |
24 | | Education Block Grant allocation. However, if, in a given |
25 | | fiscal year, the amount appropriated for the Early Childhood |
26 | | Education Block Grant is insufficient to increase the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 145 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | percentage of the grant to fund programs for children ages 0-3 |
2 | | without reducing the amount of the grant for existing providers |
3 | | of preschool education programs, then the percentage of the |
4 | | grant to fund programs for children ages 0-3 may be held steady |
5 | | instead of increased.
|
6 | | (Source: P.A. 98-645, eff. 7-1-14; 99-589, eff. 7-21-16.)
|
7 | | (105 ILCS 5/1D-1)
|
8 | | Sec. 1D-1. Block grant funding.
|
9 | | (a) For fiscal year 1996 through fiscal year 2017 and each |
10 | | fiscal year thereafter , the State Board
of Education shall |
11 | | award to a school district having a population exceeding
|
12 | | 500,000 inhabitants a general education block grant and an |
13 | | educational services
block grant, determined as provided in |
14 | | this Section, in lieu of distributing to
the district separate |
15 | | State funding for the programs described in subsections
(b) and |
16 | | (c). The provisions of this Section, however, do not apply to |
17 | | any
federal funds that the district is entitled to receive. In |
18 | | accordance with
Section 2-3.32, all block grants are subject to |
19 | | an audit. Therefore, block
grant receipts and block grant |
20 | | expenditures shall be recorded to the
appropriate fund code for |
21 | | the designated block grant.
|
22 | | (b) The general education block grant shall include the |
23 | | following
programs: REI Initiative, Summer Bridges, Preschool |
24 | | At Risk, K-6
Comprehensive Arts, School Improvement Support, |
25 | | Urban Education, Scientific
Literacy, Substance Abuse |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 146 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Prevention, Second Language Planning, Staff
Development, |
2 | | Outcomes and Assessment, K-6 Reading Improvement, 7-12 |
3 | | Continued
Reading Improvement, Truants'
Optional Education, |
4 | | Hispanic Programs, Agriculture Education,
Parental Education, |
5 | | Prevention Initiative, Report Cards, and Criminal
Background |
6 | | Investigations. Notwithstanding any other provision of law, |
7 | | all
amounts paid under the general education block grant from |
8 | | State appropriations
to a school district in a city having a |
9 | | population exceeding 500,000
inhabitants shall be appropriated |
10 | | and expended by the board of that district
for any of the |
11 | | programs included in the block grant or any of the board's
|
12 | | lawful purposes.
|
13 | | (c) The educational services block grant shall include the |
14 | | following
programs: Regular and Vocational Transportation, |
15 | | State Lunch and
Free Breakfast Program, Special Education |
16 | | (Personnel,
Transportation, Orphanage, Private Tuition), |
17 | | funding
for children requiring special education services, |
18 | | Summer School,
Educational Service Centers, and |
19 | | Administrator's Academy. This subsection (c)
does not relieve |
20 | | the district of its obligation to provide the services
required |
21 | | under a program that is included within the educational |
22 | | services block
grant. It is the intention of the General |
23 | | Assembly in enacting the provisions
of this subsection (c) to |
24 | | relieve the district of the administrative burdens
that impede |
25 | | efficiency and accompany single-program funding. The General
|
26 | | Assembly encourages the board to pursue mandate waivers |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 147 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | pursuant to Section
2-3.25g. |
2 | | The funding program included in the educational services |
3 | | block grant
for funding for children requiring special |
4 | | education services in each fiscal
year shall be treated in that |
5 | | fiscal year as a payment to the school district
in respect of |
6 | | services provided or costs incurred in the prior fiscal year,
|
7 | | calculated in each case as provided in this Section. Nothing in |
8 | | this Section
shall change the nature of payments for any |
9 | | program that, apart from this
Section, would be or, prior to |
10 | | adoption or amendment of this Section, was on
the basis of a |
11 | | payment in a fiscal year in respect of services provided or
|
12 | | costs incurred in the prior fiscal year, calculated in each |
13 | | case as provided
in this Section.
|
14 | | (d) For fiscal year 1996 through fiscal year 2017 and each |
15 | | fiscal year thereafter , the amount
of the district's block |
16 | | grants shall be determined as follows:
(i) with respect to each |
17 | | program that is included within each block grant, the
district |
18 | | shall receive an amount equal to the same percentage of the |
19 | | current
fiscal year appropriation made for that program as the |
20 | | percentage of the
appropriation received by the district from |
21 | | the 1995 fiscal year appropriation
made for that program, and
|
22 | | (ii) the total amount that is due the district under the block |
23 | | grant shall be
the aggregate of the amounts that the district |
24 | | is entitled to receive for the
fiscal year with respect to each |
25 | | program that is included within the block
grant that the State |
26 | | Board of Education shall award the district under this
Section |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 148 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | for that fiscal year. In the case of the Summer Bridges |
2 | | program,
the amount of the district's block grant shall be |
3 | | equal to 44% of the amount
of the current fiscal year |
4 | | appropriation made for that program.
|
5 | | (e) The district is not required to file any application or |
6 | | other claim in
order to receive the block grants to which it is |
7 | | entitled under this Section.
The State Board of Education shall |
8 | | make payments to the district of amounts due
under the |
9 | | district's block grants on a schedule determined by the State |
10 | | Board
of Education.
|
11 | | (f) A school district to which this Section applies shall |
12 | | report to the
State Board of Education on its use of the block |
13 | | grants in such form and detail
as the State Board of Education |
14 | | may specify. In addition, the report must include the following |
15 | | description for the district, which must also be reported to |
16 | | the General Assembly: block grant allocation and expenditures |
17 | | by program; population and service levels by program; and |
18 | | administrative expenditures by program. The State Board of |
19 | | Education shall ensure that the reporting requirements for the |
20 | | district are the same as for all other school districts in this |
21 | | State.
|
22 | | (g) Through fiscal year 2017, this This paragraph provides |
23 | | for the treatment of block grants under Article
1C for purposes |
24 | | of calculating the amount of block grants for a district under
|
25 | | this Section. Those block grants under Article 1C are, for this
|
26 | | purpose, treated as included in the amount of appropriation for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 149 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the various
programs set forth in paragraph (b) above. The |
2 | | appropriation in each current
fiscal year for each block grant |
3 | | under Article 1C shall be treated for these
purposes as |
4 | | appropriations for the individual program included in that |
5 | | block
grant. The proportion of each block grant so allocated to |
6 | | each such program
included in it shall be the proportion which |
7 | | the appropriation for that program
was of all appropriations |
8 | | for such purposes now in that block grant, in fiscal
1995.
|
9 | | Payments to the school district under this Section with |
10 | | respect to each
program for which payments to school districts |
11 | | generally, as of the date of
this
amendatory Act of the 92nd |
12 | | General Assembly, are on a reimbursement basis
shall continue |
13 | | to be made to the district on a reimbursement basis, pursuant
|
14 | | to the provisions of this Code governing those programs.
|
15 | | (h) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school |
16 | | district
receiving a block grant under this Section may |
17 | | classify all or a portion of
the funds that it receives in a |
18 | | particular fiscal year from any block grant
authorized under |
19 | | this Code or from general State aid pursuant to Section
18-8.05 |
20 | | of this Code (other than supplemental general State aid) as
|
21 | | funds received in connection with any funding program for which |
22 | | it is
entitled to receive funds from the State in that fiscal |
23 | | year (including,
without limitation, any funding program |
24 | | referred to in subsection (c) of
this Section), regardless of |
25 | | the source or timing of the receipt. The
district may not |
26 | | classify more funds as funds received in connection
with the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 150 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | funding program than the district is entitled to receive in |
2 | | that
fiscal year for that program. Any classification by a |
3 | | district must be made by
a resolution
of its board of |
4 | | education. The resolution must identify the amount of any
block |
5 | | grant or general State aid to be classified under this |
6 | | subsection (h)
and must specify the funding program to which |
7 | | the funds are to be
treated as received in connection |
8 | | therewith. This resolution is
controlling as to the |
9 | | classification of funds referenced therein. A certified
copy of |
10 | | the resolution must be sent to the State Superintendent of
|
11 | | Education.
The resolution shall still take effect even though a |
12 | | copy of the resolution
has not been sent to the State
|
13 | | Superintendent of Education in a timely manner.
No |
14 | | classification under this subsection (h) by a district shall
|
15 | | affect the total amount or timing of money the district is |
16 | | entitled to receive
under this Code.
No classification under |
17 | | this subsection (h) by a district
shall in any way relieve the |
18 | | district from or affect any
requirements that otherwise would |
19 | | apply with respect to the
block grant as provided in this |
20 | | Section, including any
accounting of funds by source, reporting |
21 | | expenditures by
original source and purpose,
reporting |
22 | | requirements, or requirements of provision of
services.
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 97-238, eff. 8-2-11; 97-324, eff. 8-12-11; |
24 | | 97-813, eff. 7-13-12.)
|
25 | | (105 ILCS 5/1E-20)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 151 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (This Section scheduled to be repealed in accordance with |
2 | | 105 ILCS 5/1E-165) |
3 | | Sec. 1E-20. Members of Authority; meetings.
|
4 | | (a) When a petition for a School Finance Authority is |
5 | | allowed by the State
Board under Section 1E-15 of this Code, |
6 | | the State Superintendent shall within
10 days thereafter |
7 | | appoint 5 members to serve on a School Finance Authority for
|
8 | | the district. Of the initial members, 2 shall be appointed to |
9 | | serve a
term of 2 years and 3 shall be appointed to serve a term |
10 | | of 3 years.
Thereafter, each member shall serve for a term of 3 |
11 | | years and until his or her
successor has been appointed. The |
12 | | State Superintendent shall designate one of
the members of the |
13 | | Authority to serve as its Chairperson. In the event
of vacancy |
14 | | or resignation, the State Superintendent shall, within 10
days |
15 | | after receiving notice, appoint a successor to serve out that
|
16 | | member's term. The State Superintendent may remove a member for
|
17 | | incompetence, malfeasance, neglect of duty, or other just |
18 | | cause.
|
19 | | Members of the Authority shall be selected primarily on the |
20 | | basis
of their experience and education in financial |
21 | | management,
with consideration given to persons knowledgeable |
22 | | in education finance.
Two members of the Authority shall be |
23 | | residents of the school district that the
Authority serves. A |
24 | | member of the Authority may not be a member of the
district's |
25 | | school board or an
employee of the district
nor may
a
member |
26 | | have a direct financial interest in the district.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 152 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Authority members shall serve without compensation, but |
2 | | may
be reimbursed by the State Board for travel and other |
3 | | necessary
expenses incurred in the performance of their |
4 | | official duties.
Unless paid from bonds issued under Section |
5 | | 1E-65 of this Code, the amount
reimbursed members for their |
6 | | expenses shall be charged
to the school district as part of any |
7 | | emergency financial
assistance and incorporated as a part of |
8 | | the terms and conditions
for repayment of the assistance or |
9 | | shall be deducted from the
district's general State aid or |
10 | | evidence-based funding as provided in Section 1B-8 of this |
11 | | Code.
|
12 | | The Authority may elect such officers as it deems |
13 | | appropriate.
|
14 | | (b) The first meeting of the Authority shall be held at the |
15 | | call of the
Chairperson.
The
Authority shall prescribe the |
16 | | times and places for its meetings and the manner
in which |
17 | | regular and special meetings may be called and shall comply |
18 | | with the
Open Meetings Act.
|
19 | | Three members of the Authority shall constitute a quorum.
|
20 | | When a vote is taken upon any measure before the Authority, a |
21 | | quorum
being present, a majority of the votes of the members |
22 | | voting on the
measure shall determine the outcome.
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 92-547, eff. 6-13-02 .)
|
24 | | (105 ILCS 5/1F-20)
|
25 | | (This Section scheduled to be repealed in accordance with 105 |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 153 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | ILCS 5/1F-165) |
2 | | Sec. 1F-20. Members of Authority; meetings.
|
3 | | (a) Upon establishment of a School Finance Authority
under |
4 | | Section 1F-15 of this Code, the State Superintendent shall |
5 | | within
15 days thereafter appoint 5 members to serve on a |
6 | | School Finance Authority for
the district. Of the initial |
7 | | members, 2 shall be appointed to serve a
term of 2 years and 3 |
8 | | shall be appointed to serve a term of 3 years.
Thereafter, each |
9 | | member shall serve for a term of 3 years and until his or her
|
10 | | successor has been appointed. The State Superintendent shall |
11 | | designate one of
the members of the Authority to serve as its |
12 | | Chairperson. In the event
of vacancy or resignation, the State |
13 | | Superintendent shall, within 10
days after receiving notice, |
14 | | appoint a successor to serve out that
member's term. The State |
15 | | Superintendent may remove a member for
incompetence, |
16 | | malfeasance, neglect of duty, or other just cause.
|
17 | | Members of the Authority shall be selected primarily on the |
18 | | basis
of their experience and education in financial |
19 | | management,
with consideration given to persons knowledgeable |
20 | | in education finance.
Two members of the Authority shall be |
21 | | residents of the school district that the
Authority serves. A |
22 | | member of the Authority may not be a member of the
district's |
23 | | school board or an
employee of the district
nor may
a
member |
24 | | have a direct financial interest in the district.
|
25 | | Authority members shall be paid a stipend approved by the |
26 | | State Superintendent of not more than $100 per meeting and may
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 154 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be reimbursed by the State Board for travel and other necessary
|
2 | | expenses incurred in the performance of their official duties.
|
3 | | Unless paid from bonds issued under Section 1F-65 of this Code, |
4 | | the amount
reimbursed members for their expenses shall be |
5 | | charged
to the school district as part of any emergency |
6 | | financial
assistance and incorporated as a part of the terms |
7 | | and conditions
for repayment of the assistance or shall be |
8 | | deducted from the
district's general State aid or |
9 | | evidence-based funding as provided in Section 1B-8 of this |
10 | | Code.
|
11 | | The Authority may elect such officers as it deems |
12 | | appropriate.
|
13 | | (b) The first meeting of the Authority shall be held at the |
14 | | call of the
Chairperson.
The
Authority shall prescribe the |
15 | | times and places for its meetings and the manner
in which |
16 | | regular and special meetings may be called and shall comply |
17 | | with the
Open Meetings Act.
|
18 | | Three members of the Authority shall constitute a quorum.
|
19 | | When a vote is taken upon any measure before the Authority, a |
20 | | quorum
being present, a majority of the votes of the members |
21 | | voting on the
measure shall determine the outcome.
|
22 | | (Source: P.A. 94-234, eff. 7-1-06 .)
|
23 | | (105 ILCS 5/1F-62)
|
24 | | (This Section scheduled to be repealed in accordance with 105 |
25 | | ILCS 5/1F-165) |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 155 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 1F-62. School District Emergency Financial Assistance |
2 | | Fund;
grants and loans. |
3 | | (a) Moneys in the School District Emergency Financial |
4 | | Assistance Fund
established under Section 1B-8 of this Code may |
5 | | be allocated and
expended by the State Board as grants to |
6 | | provide technical and consulting services to school districts |
7 | | to assess their financial condition and by the Illinois Finance |
8 | | Authority for emergency financial assistance loans to a School |
9 | | Finance
Authority that petitions for
emergency financial
|
10 | | assistance.
An emergency financial assistance loan to a School |
11 | | Finance Authority or borrowing from
sources other than the |
12 | | State shall not be
considered as part of the calculation of a |
13 | | district's debt for purposes of
the limitation specified in |
14 | | Section 19-1 of this Code. From the amount allocated to each |
15 | | School Finance Authority, the State Board shall identify a sum |
16 | | sufficient to cover all approved costs of the School Finance |
17 | | Authority. If the State Board and State Superintendent have not |
18 | | approved emergency financial assistance in conjunction with |
19 | | the appointment of a School Finance Authority, the Authority's |
20 | | approved costs shall be paid from deductions from the |
21 | | district's general State aid or evidence-based funding . |
22 | | The School Finance Authority may prepare and file with the |
23 | | State
Superintendent a proposal for emergency financial |
24 | | assistance for the school district and for its operations |
25 | | budget. No expenditures shall be
authorized by the State |
26 | | Superintendent until he or she has approved
the proposal of the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 156 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | School Finance Authority, either as submitted or in such lesser |
2 | | amount determined by the State Superintendent.
|
3 | | (b) The amount of an emergency financial assistance
loan |
4 | | that may be allocated to a School Finance Authority under this |
5 | | Article,
including moneys necessary for the operations of the |
6 | | School Finance Authority, and borrowing
from sources other than |
7 | | the State shall not
exceed, in the aggregate, $4,000 times the |
8 | | number of pupils enrolled in the
district
during the school |
9 | | year ending June 30 prior to the date of approval by
the State |
10 | | Board of the petition for emergency financial assistance, as
|
11 | | certified to the school board and the School Finance Authority |
12 | | by the State
Superintendent.
However, this limitation does not |
13 | | apply to borrowing by the district secured
by
amounts levied by |
14 | | the district prior to establishment of the School Finance
|
15 | | Authority. An emergency financial assistance grant shall not |
16 | | exceed $1,000 times the number of such pupils. A district may |
17 | | receive both a loan and a grant.
|
18 | | (c) The payment of a State emergency financial assistance |
19 | | grant or loan
shall be subject to appropriation by the General |
20 | | Assembly. State
emergency financial assistance allocated and |
21 | | paid to a School Finance Authority
under this Article may be |
22 | | applied to any fund or funds from which the
School Finance
|
23 | | Authority is authorized to make expenditures by
law.
|
24 | | (d) Any State emergency financial assistance proposed by |
25 | | the
School Finance Authority and approved by the State |
26 | | Superintendent may be paid in its
entirety during the initial |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 157 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | year of the School Finance Authority's existence or spread in
|
2 | | equal or declining amounts over a period of years not to exceed |
3 | | the
period of the School Finance Authority's existence. The |
4 | | State Superintendent shall not
approve any loan to the School |
5 | | Finance Authority unless the School Finance Authority has been
|
6 | | unable to borrow sufficient funds to operate the district.
|
7 | | All loan payments made from the School District Emergency
|
8 | | Financial Assistance Fund to a School Finance Authority shall |
9 | | be required to be
repaid not later than the date the School |
10 | | Finance Authority ceases to exist, with simple
interest over |
11 | | the term of the loan at a rate equal to
50% of the one-year |
12 | | Constant Maturity Treasury (CMT) yield as last published
by the |
13 | | Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
before the
|
14 | | date on which the School Finance Authority's loan is approved |
15 | | by the State
Board.
|
16 | | The School Finance Authority shall establish and the |
17 | | Illinois Finance Authority shall
approve the terms and |
18 | | conditions of the loan, including the schedule of
repayments.
|
19 | | The schedule shall provide for repayments commencing July 1 of |
20 | | each
year or upon each fiscal year's receipt of moneys from a |
21 | | tax levy for emergency financial assistance. Repayment shall be |
22 | | incorporated into the annual budget of the
district and may be |
23 | | made from any fund or funds of the district in
which there are |
24 | | moneys available. Default on repayment is subject to the |
25 | | Illinois Grant Funds Recovery Act.
When moneys are repaid as |
26 | | provided
in this Section, they shall not be made available to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 158 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the School Finance Authority for
further use as emergency |
2 | | financial assistance under this Article at any
time thereafter. |
3 | | All repayments required to be made by a School Finance |
4 | | Authority
shall be received by the State Board and deposited in |
5 | | the School District
Emergency Financial Assistance Fund.
|
6 | | In establishing the terms and conditions for the repayment
|
7 | | obligation of the School Finance Authority, the School Finance
|
8 | | Authority shall annually determine
whether a separate local |
9 | | property tax levy is required to meet that obligation.
The |
10 | | School Finance Authority
shall provide for a separate tax
levy |
11 | | for emergency financial assistance repayment purposes. This |
12 | | tax
levy shall not be subject to referendum approval. The |
13 | | amount of the levy
shall not exceed the amount necessary to |
14 | | meet the annual
emergency financial repayment
obligations of |
15 | | the district, including principal and interest, as established
|
16 | | by the School Finance Authority.
|
17 | | (Source: P.A. 94-234, eff. 7-1-06 .)
|
18 | | (105 ILCS 5/1H-20) |
19 | | Sec. 1H-20. Members of Panel; meetings. |
20 | | (a) Upon establishment of a Financial Oversight Panel under |
21 | | Section 1H-15 of this Code, the State Superintendent shall |
22 | | within 15 working days thereafter appoint 5 members to serve on |
23 | | a Financial Oversight Panel for the district. Members appointed |
24 | | to the Panel shall serve at the pleasure of the State |
25 | | Superintendent. The State Superintendent shall designate one |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 159 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the members of the Panel to serve as its Chairperson. In the |
2 | | event of vacancy or resignation, the State Superintendent |
3 | | shall, within 10 days after receiving notice, appoint a |
4 | | successor to serve out that member's term. |
5 | | (b) Members of the Panel shall be selected primarily on the |
6 | | basis of their experience and education in financial |
7 | | management, with consideration given to persons knowledgeable |
8 | | in education finance. Two members of the Panel shall be |
9 | | residents of the school district that the Panel serves. A |
10 | | member of the Panel may not be a member of the district's |
11 | | school board or an employee of the district nor may a member |
12 | | have a direct financial interest in the district. |
13 | | (c) Panel members may be reimbursed by the State Board for |
14 | | travel and other necessary expenses incurred in the performance |
15 | | of their official duties. The amount reimbursed members for |
16 | | their expenses shall be charged to the school district as part |
17 | | of any emergency financial assistance and incorporated as a |
18 | | part of the terms and conditions for repayment of the |
19 | | assistance or shall be deducted from the district's general |
20 | | State aid or evidence-based funding as provided in Section |
21 | | 1H-65 of this Code. |
22 | | (d) With the exception of the chairperson, who shall be |
23 | | designated as provided in subsection (a) of this Section, the |
24 | | Panel may elect such officers as it deems appropriate. |
25 | | (e) The first meeting of the Panel shall be held at the |
26 | | call of the Chairperson. The Panel shall prescribe the times |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 160 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | and places for its meetings and the manner in which regular and |
2 | | special meetings may be called and shall comply with the Open |
3 | | Meetings Act. The Panel shall also comply with the Freedom of |
4 | | Information Act. |
5 | | (f) Three members of the Panel shall constitute a quorum. A |
6 | | majority of members present is required to pass a measure.
|
7 | | (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.) |
8 | | (105 ILCS 5/1H-70) |
9 | | Sec. 1H-70. Tax anticipation warrants, tax anticipation |
10 | | notes, revenue anticipation certificates or notes, general |
11 | | State aid or evidence-based funding anticipation certificates, |
12 | | and lines of credit. With the approval of the State |
13 | | Superintendent and provided that the district is unable to |
14 | | secure short-term financing after 3 attempts, a Panel shall |
15 | | have the same power as a district to do the following: |
16 | | (1) issue tax anticipation warrants under the |
17 | | provisions of Section 17-16 of this Code against taxes |
18 | | levied by either the school board or the Panel pursuant to |
19 | | Section 1H-25 of this Code; |
20 | | (2) issue tax anticipation notes under the provisions |
21 | | of the Tax Anticipation Note Act against taxes levied by |
22 | | either the school board or the Panel pursuant to Section |
23 | | 1H-25 of this Code; |
24 | | (3) issue revenue anticipation certificates or notes |
25 | | under the provisions of the Revenue Anticipation Act; |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 161 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) issue general State aid or evidence-based funding |
2 | | anticipation certificates under the provisions of Section |
3 | | 18-18 of this Code; and |
4 | | (5) establish and utilize lines of credit under the |
5 | | provisions of Section 17-17 of this Code. |
6 | | Tax anticipation warrants, tax anticipation notes, revenue |
7 | | anticipation certificates or notes, general State aid or |
8 | | evidence-based funding anticipation certificates, and lines of |
9 | | credit are considered borrowing from sources other than the |
10 | | State and are subject to Section 1H-65 of this Code.
|
11 | | (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.) |
12 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.33) (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.33)
|
13 | | Sec. 2-3.33. Recomputation of claims. To recompute within |
14 | | 3 years from the
final date for filing of a claim any claim for |
15 | | general State aid reimbursement to any school
district and one |
16 | | year from the final date for filing of a claim for |
17 | | evidence-based funding if the claim has been found to be |
18 | | incorrect and to adjust subsequent
claims accordingly, and to |
19 | | recompute and adjust any such claims within 6 years
from the |
20 | | final date for filing when there has been an adverse court or
|
21 | | administrative agency decision on
the merits affecting the tax |
22 | | revenues of the school district. However, no such
adjustment |
23 | | shall be made regarding equalized assessed valuation unless the
|
24 | | district's equalized assessed valuation is changed by greater |
25 | | than $250,000 or
2%. Any adjustments for claims recomputed for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 162 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the 2016-2017 school year and prior school years shall be |
2 | | applied to the apportionment of evidence-based funding in |
3 | | Section 18-8.15 of this Code beginning in the 2017-2018 school |
4 | | year and thereafter. However, the recomputation of a claim for |
5 | | evidence-based funding for a school district shall not require |
6 | | the recomputation of claims for all districts, and the State |
7 | | Board of Education shall only make recomputations of |
8 | | evidence-based funding for those districts where an adjustment |
9 | | is required.
|
10 | | Except in the case of an adverse court or administrative |
11 | | agency decision ,
no recomputation of a
State aid claim shall be |
12 | | made pursuant to this Section as a result of a
reduction in the |
13 | | assessed valuation of a school district from the assessed
|
14 | | valuation of the district reported to the State Board of |
15 | | Education by the
Department of Revenue under Section 18-8.05 or |
16 | | 18-8.15 of this Code unless the
requirements of Section
16-15 |
17 | | of the Property Tax Code and Section 2-3.84 of this Code are
|
18 | | complied with in all respects.
|
19 | | This paragraph applies to all requests for recomputation of |
20 | | a general
State aid or evidence-based funding claim received |
21 | | after June 30, 2003. In recomputing a general
State aid or |
22 | | evidence-based funding claim that was originally calculated |
23 | | using an extension
limitation equalized assessed valuation |
24 | | under paragraph (3) of
subsection (G) of Section 18-8.05 of |
25 | | this Code or Section 18-8.15 of this Code , a qualifying |
26 | | reduction in
equalized assessed valuation shall be deducted |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 163 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | from the extension
limitation equalized assessed valuation |
2 | | that was used in calculating the
original claim.
|
3 | | From the total amount of general State aid or |
4 | | evidence-based funding to be provided to
districts, |
5 | | adjustments as a result of recomputation under this Section
|
6 | | together with adjustments under Section 2-3.84 must not exceed |
7 | | $25
million, in the aggregate for all districts under both |
8 | | Sections combined,
of the general State aid or evidence-based |
9 | | funding appropriation in any fiscal year; if necessary,
amounts |
10 | | shall be prorated among districts. If it is necessary to |
11 | | prorate
claims under this paragraph, then that portion of each |
12 | | prorated claim that is
approved but not paid in the current |
13 | | fiscal year may be resubmitted as a
valid claim in the |
14 | | following fiscal year.
|
15 | | (Source: P.A. 93-845, eff. 7-30-04.)
|
16 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.51.5) |
17 | | Sec. 2-3.51.5. School Safety and Educational Improvement |
18 | | Block Grant
Program. To improve the level of education and |
19 | | safety of students from
kindergarten through grade 12 in school |
20 | | districts and State-recognized, non-public schools. The State |
21 | | Board of
Education is authorized to fund a School Safety and |
22 | | Educational Improvement
Block Grant Program. |
23 | | (1) For school districts, the program shall provide funding |
24 | | for school safety, textbooks and
software, electronic |
25 | | textbooks and the technological equipment necessary to gain |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 164 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | access to and use electronic textbooks, teacher training and |
2 | | curriculum development, school improvements, school
report |
3 | | cards under Section 10-17a, and criminal history records checks
|
4 | | under Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5. For State-recognized, |
5 | | non-public schools, the program shall provide funding for |
6 | | secular textbooks and software, criminal history records |
7 | | checks, and health and safety mandates to the extent that the |
8 | | funds are expended for purely secular purposes. A school |
9 | | district
or laboratory school as defined in Section 18-8 , or |
10 | | 18-8.05 , or 18-8.15 is not required
to file an application in |
11 | | order to receive the categorical funding to which it
is |
12 | | entitled under this Section. Funds for the School Safety and |
13 | | Educational
Improvement Block Grant Program shall be |
14 | | distributed to school districts and
laboratory schools based on |
15 | | the prior year's best 3 months average daily
attendance. Funds |
16 | | for the School Safety and Educational Improvement Block Grant |
17 | | Program shall be distributed to State-recognized, non-public |
18 | | schools based on the average daily attendance figure for the |
19 | | previous school year provided to the State Board of Education. |
20 | | The State Board of Education shall develop an application that |
21 | | requires State-recognized, non-public schools to submit |
22 | | average daily attendance figures. A State-recognized, |
23 | | non-public school must submit the application and average daily |
24 | | attendance figure prior to receiving funds under this Section. |
25 | | The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and
|
26 | | regulations necessary for the implementation of this program. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 165 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) Distribution of moneys to school districts and |
2 | | State-recognized, non-public schools shall be made in 2
|
3 | | semi-annual installments, one payment on or before October 30, |
4 | | and one
payment prior to April 30, of each fiscal year. |
5 | | (3) Grants under the School Safety and Educational |
6 | | Improvement Block Grant
Program shall be awarded provided there |
7 | | is an appropriation for the program,
and funding levels for |
8 | | each district shall be prorated according to the amount
of the |
9 | | appropriation. |
10 | | (4) The provisions of this Section are in the public |
11 | | interest, are for the public benefit, and serve secular public |
12 | | purposes. |
13 | | (Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14.)
|
14 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.62) (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.62)
|
15 | | Sec. 2-3.62. Educational service centers.
|
16 | | (a) A regional network of educational service centers shall |
17 | | be established
by the State Board of Education to coordinate |
18 | | and combine existing services in
a manner which is practical |
19 | | and efficient and to provide new services to
schools as |
20 | | provided in this Section. Services to be made available by such
|
21 | | centers shall include the planning, implementation and |
22 | | evaluation of:
|
23 | | (1) (blank);
|
24 | | (2) computer technology education;
|
25 | | (3) mathematics, science and reading resources for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 166 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | teachers including
continuing education, inservice |
2 | | training and staff development.
|
3 | | The centers may provide training, technical assistance, |
4 | | coordination and
planning in other program areas such as school |
5 | | improvement, school
accountability, financial planning, |
6 | | consultation, and services, career guidance, early childhood |
7 | | education, alcohol/drug
education and prevention, family life - |
8 | | sex education, electronic transmission
of data from school |
9 | | districts to the State, alternative education and regional
|
10 | | special education, and telecommunications systems that provide |
11 | | distance
learning. Such telecommunications systems may be |
12 | | obtained through the
Department of Central Management Services |
13 | | pursuant to Section 405-270 of the
Department of Central |
14 | | Management Services Law (20 ILCS 405/405-270). The programs and |
15 | | services of educational
service centers may be offered to |
16 | | private school teachers and private school
students within each |
17 | | service center area provided public schools have already
been |
18 | | afforded adequate access to such programs and services.
|
19 | | Upon the abolition of the office, removal from office, |
20 | | disqualification for office, resignation from office, or |
21 | | expiration of the current term of office of the regional |
22 | | superintendent of schools, whichever is earlier, the chief |
23 | | administrative officer of the centers serving that portion of a |
24 | | Class II county school unit outside of a city of 500,000 or |
25 | | more inhabitants shall have and exercise, in and with respect |
26 | | to each educational service region having a population of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 167 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 2,000,000 or more inhabitants and in and with respect to each |
2 | | school district located in any such educational service region, |
3 | | all of the rights, powers, duties, and responsibilities |
4 | | theretofore vested by law in and exercised and performed by the |
5 | | regional superintendent of schools for that area under the |
6 | | provisions of this Code or any other laws of this State. |
7 | | The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and |
8 | | regulations necessary
to implement this Section. The rules |
9 | | shall include detailed standards which
delineate the scope and |
10 | | specific content of programs to be provided by each
Educational |
11 | | Service Center, as well as the specific planning, |
12 | | implementation
and evaluation services to be provided by each |
13 | | Center relative to its programs.
The Board shall also provide |
14 | | the standards by which it will evaluate the
programs provided |
15 | | by each Center.
|
16 | | (b) Centers serving Class 1 county school units shall be |
17 | | governed by an
11-member board, 3 members of which shall be |
18 | | public school teachers
nominated by the local bargaining |
19 | | representatives to the appropriate regional
superintendent for |
20 | | appointment and no more than 3 members of which shall be
from |
21 | | each of the following categories, including but not limited to
|
22 | | superintendents, regional superintendents, school board |
23 | | members
and a representative of an institution of higher |
24 | | education. The members of
the board shall be appointed by the |
25 | | regional superintendents whose school
districts are served by |
26 | | the educational service center.
The composition of the board |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 168 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | will reflect the revisions of this
amendatory Act of 1989 as |
2 | | the terms of office of current members expire.
|
3 | | (c) The centers shall be of sufficient size and number to |
4 | | assure delivery
of services to all local school districts in |
5 | | the State.
|
6 | | (d) From monies appropriated for this program the State |
7 | | Board of
Education shall provide grants paid from the Personal |
8 | | Property Tax Replacement Fund to qualifying Educational |
9 | | Service Centers
applying for such grants in accordance with |
10 | | rules and regulations
promulgated by the State Board of |
11 | | Education to implement this Section.
|
12 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
13 | | Section, the State Board of Education shall award to a school |
14 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000 inhabitants |
15 | | 14.9% of the funds appropriated by the General Assembly for any |
16 | | fiscal year for purposes of payment of claims under this |
17 | | Section. |
18 | | (e) The governing authority of each of the 18 regional |
19 | | educational service
centers shall appoint a family life - sex |
20 | | education advisory board
consisting of 2 parents, 2 teachers, 2 |
21 | | school administrators, 2 school
board members, 2 health care |
22 | | professionals, one library system
representative, and the |
23 | | director of the regional educational service center
who shall |
24 | | serve as chairperson of the advisory board so appointed. |
25 | | Members
of the family life - sex education advisory boards |
26 | | shall serve without
compensation. Each of the advisory boards |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 169 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | appointed pursuant to this
subsection shall develop a plan for |
2 | | regional teacher-parent family life - sex
education training |
3 | | sessions and shall file a written report of such plan
with the |
4 | | governing board of their regional educational service center. |
5 | | The
directors of each of the regional educational service
|
6 | | centers shall thereupon meet, review each of the reports |
7 | | submitted by the
advisory boards and combine those reports into |
8 | | a single written report which
they shall file with the Citizens |
9 | | Council on School Problems prior to the
end of the regular |
10 | | school term of the 1987-1988 school year.
|
11 | | (f) The 14 educational service centers serving Class I |
12 | | county school units
shall be disbanded on the first Monday of |
13 | | August, 1995, and their statutory
responsibilities and |
14 | | programs shall be assumed by the regional offices of
education, |
15 | | subject to rules and regulations developed by
the
State Board |
16 | | of Education. The regional superintendents of schools elected |
17 | | by
the voters residing in all Class I counties shall serve as |
18 | | the chief
administrators for these programs and services.
|
19 | | (Source: P.A. 98-24, eff. 6-19-13; 98-647, eff. 6-13-14; 99-30, |
20 | | eff. 7-10-15.)
|
21 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.66) (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.66)
|
22 | | Sec. 2-3.66. Truants' alternative and optional education |
23 | | programs. To
establish projects to offer modified |
24 | | instructional programs or other
services designed to prevent |
25 | | students from dropping out of school,
including programs |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 170 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | pursuant to Section 2-3.41, and to serve as a part time
or full |
2 | | time option in lieu of regular school attendance and to award
|
3 | | grants to local school districts, educational service regions |
4 | | or community
college districts from appropriated funds to |
5 | | assist districts in
establishing such projects. The education |
6 | | agency may operate its own
program or enter into a contract |
7 | | with another not-for-profit entity to
implement the program. |
8 | | The projects shall allow dropouts, up to and
including age 21, |
9 | | potential dropouts, including truants, uninvolved,
unmotivated |
10 | | and disaffected students, as defined by State Board of
|
11 | | Education rules and regulations, to enroll, as an alternative |
12 | | to regular
school attendance, in an optional education program |
13 | | which may be
established by school board policy and is in |
14 | | conformance with rules adopted
by the State Board of Education. |
15 | | Truants' Alternative and Optional
Education programs funded |
16 | | pursuant to this Section shall be
planned by a student, the |
17 | | student's parents or legal guardians, unless the
student is 18 |
18 | | years or older, and school officials and shall culminate in
an |
19 | | individualized optional education plan. Such plan shall focus
|
20 | | on academic or vocational skills, or both, and may include, but |
21 | | not be
limited to, evening school, summer school, community |
22 | | college courses, adult
education, preparation courses for high |
23 | | school equivalency testing, vocational training, work |
24 | | experience, programs to
enhance self concept and parenting |
25 | | courses. School districts which are
awarded grants pursuant to |
26 | | this Section shall be authorized to provide day
care services |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 171 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to children of students who are eligible and desire to enroll
|
2 | | in programs established and funded under this Section, but only |
3 | | if and to
the extent that such day care is necessary to enable |
4 | | those eligible
students to attend and participate in the |
5 | | programs and courses which are
conducted pursuant to this |
6 | | Section.
School districts and regional offices of education may |
7 | | claim general State
aid under Section 18-8.05 or evidence-based |
8 | | funding under Section 18-8.15 for students enrolled in truants' |
9 | | alternative and
optional education programs, provided that |
10 | | such students are receiving services
that are supplemental to a |
11 | | program leading to a high school diploma and are
otherwise |
12 | | eligible to be claimed for general State aid under Section |
13 | | 18-8.05 or evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15, as |
14 | | applicable .
|
15 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
16 | | Section, the State Board of Education shall award to a school |
17 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000 inhabitants |
18 | | 26.8% of the funds appropriated by the General Assembly for any |
19 | | fiscal year for purposes of payment of claims under this |
20 | | Section. |
21 | | (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15 .)
|
22 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.66b) |
23 | | Sec. 2-3.66b. IHOPE Program. |
24 | | (a) There is established the Illinois Hope and Opportunity |
25 | | Pathways through Education (IHOPE) Program. The State Board of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 172 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Education shall implement and administer the IHOPE Program. The |
2 | | goal of the IHOPE Program is to develop a comprehensive system |
3 | | in this State to re-enroll significant numbers of high school |
4 | | dropouts in programs that will enable them to earn their high |
5 | | school diploma. |
6 | | (b) The IHOPE Program shall award grants, subject to |
7 | | appropriation for this purpose, to educational service regions |
8 | | and a school district organized under Article 34 of this Code |
9 | | from appropriated funds to assist in establishing |
10 | | instructional programs and other services designed to |
11 | | re-enroll high school dropouts. From any funds appropriated for |
12 | | the IHOPE Program, the State Board of Education may use up to |
13 | | 5% for administrative costs, including the performance of a |
14 | | program evaluation and the hiring of staff to implement and |
15 | | administer the program. |
16 | | The IHOPE Program shall provide incentive grant funds for |
17 | | regional offices of education and a school district organized |
18 | | under Article 34 of this Code to develop partnerships with |
19 | | school districts, public community colleges, and community |
20 | | groups to build comprehensive plans to re-enroll high school |
21 | | dropouts in their regions or districts. |
22 | | Programs funded through the IHOPE Program shall allow high |
23 | | school dropouts, up to and including age 21 notwithstanding |
24 | | Section 26-2 of this Code, to re-enroll in an educational |
25 | | program in conformance with rules adopted by the State Board of |
26 | | Education. Programs may include without limitation |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 173 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | comprehensive year-round programming, evening school, summer |
2 | | school, community college courses, adult education, vocational |
3 | | training, work experience, programs to enhance self-concept, |
4 | | and parenting courses. Any student in the IHOPE Program who |
5 | | wishes to earn a high school diploma must meet the |
6 | | prerequisites to receiving a high school diploma specified in |
7 | | Section 27-22 of this Code and any other graduation |
8 | | requirements of the student's district of residence. Any |
9 | | student who successfully completes the requirements for his or |
10 | | her graduation shall receive a diploma identifying the student |
11 | | as graduating from his or her district of residence. |
12 | | (c) In order to be eligible for funding under the IHOPE |
13 | | Program, an interested regional office of education or a school |
14 | | district organized under Article 34 of this Code shall develop |
15 | | an IHOPE Plan to be approved by the State Board of Education. |
16 | | The State Board of Education shall develop rules for the IHOPE |
17 | | Program that shall set forth the requirements for the |
18 | | development of the IHOPE Plan. Each Plan shall involve school |
19 | | districts, public community colleges, and key community |
20 | | programs that work with high school dropouts located in an |
21 | | educational service region or the City of Chicago before the |
22 | | Plan is sent to the State Board for approval. No funds may be |
23 | | distributed to a regional office of education or a school |
24 | | district organized under Article 34 of this Code until the |
25 | | State Board has approved the Plan. |
26 | | (d) A regional office of education or a school district |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 174 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | organized under Article 34 of this Code may operate its own |
2 | | program funded by the IHOPE Program or enter into a contract |
3 | | with other not-for-profit entities, including school |
4 | | districts, public community colleges, and not-for-profit |
5 | | community-based organizations, to operate a program. |
6 | | A regional office of education or a school district |
7 | | organized under Article 34 of this Code that receives an IHOPE |
8 | | grant from the State Board of Education may provide funds under |
9 | | a sub-grant, as specified in the IHOPE Plan, to other |
10 | | not-for-profit entities to provide services according to the |
11 | | IHOPE Plan that was developed. These other entities may include |
12 | | school districts, public community colleges, or not-for-profit |
13 | | community-based organizations or a cooperative partnership |
14 | | among these entities. |
15 | | (e) In order to distribute funding based upon the need to |
16 | | ensure delivery of programs that will have the greatest impact, |
17 | | IHOPE Program funding must be distributed based upon the |
18 | | proportion of dropouts in the educational service region or |
19 | | school district, in the case of a school district organized |
20 | | under Article 34 of this Code, to the total number of dropouts |
21 | | in this State. This formula shall employ the dropout data |
22 | | provided by school districts to the State Board of Education. |
23 | | A regional office of education or a school district |
24 | | organized under Article 34 of this Code may claim State aid |
25 | | under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code for students |
26 | | enrolled in a program funded by the IHOPE Program, provided |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 175 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | that the State Board of Education has approved the IHOPE Plan |
2 | | and that these students are receiving services that are meeting |
3 | | the requirements of Section 27-22 of this Code for receipt of a |
4 | | high school diploma and are otherwise eligible to be claimed |
5 | | for general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or |
6 | | evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15 of this Code , |
7 | | including provisions related to the minimum number of days of |
8 | | pupil attendance pursuant to Section 10-19 of this Code and the |
9 | | minimum number of daily hours of school work and any exceptions |
10 | | thereto as defined by the State Board of Education in rules. |
11 | | (f) IHOPE categories of programming may include the |
12 | | following: |
13 | | (1) Full-time programs that are comprehensive, |
14 | | year-round programs. |
15 | | (2) Part-time programs combining work and study |
16 | | scheduled at various times that are flexible to the needs |
17 | | of students. |
18 | | (3) Online programs and courses in which students take |
19 | | courses and complete on-site, supervised tests that |
20 | | measure the student's mastery of a specific course needed |
21 | | for graduation. Students may take courses online and earn |
22 | | credit or students may prepare to take supervised tests for |
23 | | specific courses for credit leading to receipt of a high |
24 | | school diploma. |
25 | | (4) Dual enrollment in which students attend high |
26 | | school classes in combination with community college |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 176 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | classes or students attend community college classes while |
2 | | simultaneously earning high school credit and eventually a |
3 | | high school diploma. |
4 | | (g) In order to have successful comprehensive programs |
5 | | re-enrolling and graduating low-skilled high school dropouts, |
6 | | programs funded through the IHOPE Program shall include all of |
7 | | the following components: |
8 | | (1) Small programs (70 to 100 students) at a separate |
9 | | school site with a distinct identity. Programs may be |
10 | | larger with specific need and justification, keeping in |
11 | | mind that it is crucial to keep programs small to be |
12 | | effective. |
13 | | (2) Specific performance-based goals and outcomes and |
14 | | measures of enrollment, attendance, skills, credits, |
15 | | graduation, and the transition to college, training, and |
16 | | employment. |
17 | | (3) Strong, experienced leadership and teaching staff |
18 | | who are provided with ongoing professional development. |
19 | | (4) Voluntary enrollment. |
20 | | (5) High standards for student learning, integrating |
21 | | work experience, and education, including during the |
22 | | school year and after school, and summer school programs |
23 | | that link internships, work, and learning. |
24 | | (6) Comprehensive programs providing extensive support |
25 | | services. |
26 | | (7) Small teams of students supported by full-time paid |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 177 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | mentors who work to retain and help those students |
2 | | graduate. |
3 | | (8) A comprehensive technology learning center with |
4 | | Internet access and broad-based curriculum focusing on |
5 | | academic and career subject areas. |
6 | | (9) Learning opportunities that incorporate action |
7 | | into study. |
8 | | (h) Programs funded through the IHOPE Program must report |
9 | | data to the State Board of Education as requested. This |
10 | | information shall include, but is not limited to, student |
11 | | enrollment figures, attendance information, course completion |
12 | | data, graduation information, and post-graduation information, |
13 | | as available. |
14 | | (i) Rules must be developed by the State Board of Education |
15 | | to set forth the fund distribution process to regional offices |
16 | | of education and a school district organized under Article 34 |
17 | | of this Code, the planning and the conditions upon which an |
18 | | IHOPE Plan would be approved by State Board, and other rules to |
19 | | develop the IHOPE Program.
|
20 | | (Source: P.A. 96-106, eff. 7-30-09.)
|
21 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.80) (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.80)
|
22 | | Sec. 2-3.80. (a) The General Assembly recognizes that |
23 | | agriculture is
the most basic and singularly important industry |
24 | | in the State, that
agriculture is of central importance to the |
25 | | welfare and economic stability
of the State, and that the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 178 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | maintenance of this vital industry requires a
continued source |
2 | | of trained and qualified individuals for employment in
|
3 | | agriculture and agribusiness. The General Assembly hereby |
4 | | declares that it
is in the best interests of the people of the |
5 | | State of Illinois that a
comprehensive education program in |
6 | | agriculture be created and maintained by
the State's public |
7 | | school system in order to ensure an adequate supply of
trained |
8 | | and skilled individuals and to ensure appropriate |
9 | | representation of
racial and ethnic groups in all phases of the |
10 | | industry. It is the intent
of the General Assembly that a State |
11 | | program for agricultural education
shall be a part of the |
12 | | curriculum of the public school system K through
adult, and |
13 | | made readily available to all school districts which may, at
|
14 | | their option, include programs in education in agriculture as a |
15 | | part of the
curriculum of that district.
|
16 | | (b) The State Board of Education shall adopt such rules and |
17 | | regulations
as are necessary to implement the provisions of |
18 | | this Section. The rules
and regulations shall not create any |
19 | | new State mandates on school districts
as a condition of |
20 | | receiving federal, State, and local funds by those
entities. It |
21 | | is in the intent of the General Assembly that, although this
|
22 | | Section does not create any new mandates, school districts are |
23 | | strongly
advised to follow the guidelines set forth in this |
24 | | Section.
|
25 | | (c) The State Superintendent of Education shall assume |
26 | | responsibility
for the administration of the State program |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 179 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | adopted under this Section
throughout the public school system |
2 | | as well as the articulation of the
State program to the |
3 | | requirements and mandates of federally assisted
education. |
4 | | There is currently within the State Board of Education an
|
5 | | agricultural education unit to assist school districts in the |
6 | | establishment
and maintenance of educational programs pursuant |
7 | | to the provisions of this
Section. The staffing of the unit |
8 | | shall at all times be comprised of an
appropriate number of |
9 | | full-time employees who shall serve as program
consultants in |
10 | | agricultural education and shall be available to provide
|
11 | | assistance to school districts. At least one consultant shall |
12 | | be
responsible for the coordination of the State program, as |
13 | | Head Consultant.
At least one consultant shall be responsible |
14 | | for the coordination of the
activities of student and |
15 | | agricultural organizations and associations.
|
16 | | (d) A committee of 13 agriculturalists representative of |
17 | | the various and
diverse areas of the agricultural industry in |
18 | | Illinois shall be established
to at least develop a curriculum |
19 | | and overview the implementation of the
Build Illinois through |
20 | | Quality Agricultural Education plans of the Illinois
|
21 | | Leadership Council for Agricultural Education and to advise
the |
22 | | State Board of Education on vocational agricultural education. |
23 | | The
Committee shall be composed of the following: (6) |
24 | | agriculturalists
representing the Illinois Leadership Council |
25 | | for Agricultural Education;
(2) Secondary Agriculture |
26 | | Teachers; (1) "Ag In The Classroom" Teacher; (1)
Community |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 180 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | College Agriculture Teacher; (1) Adult Agriculture Education
|
2 | | Teacher; (1) University Agriculture Teacher Educator; and (1) |
3 | | FFA
Representative. All members of the Committee shall be |
4 | | appointed by the
Governor by and with the advice and consent of |
5 | | the Senate. The terms of
all members so appointed shall be for |
6 | | 3 years, except that of the members
initially appointed, 5 |
7 | | shall be appointed to serve for terms of 1 year, 4
shall be |
8 | | appointed to serve for terms of 2 years and 4 shall be |
9 | | appointed
to serve for terms of 3 years. All members of the |
10 | | Committee shall serve
until their successors are appointed and |
11 | | qualified. Vacancies in terms
shall be filled by appointment of |
12 | | the Governor with the advice and consent
of the Senate for the |
13 | | extent of the unexpired term. The State Board of
Education |
14 | | shall implement a Build Illinois through Quality Agricultural
|
15 | | Education plan following receipt of these recommendations |
16 | | which
shall be made available on or before March 31, 1987.
|
17 | | Recommendations shall include, but not be limited to, the |
18 | | development of a
curriculum and a strategy for the purpose of |
19 | | establishing a source of
trained and qualified individuals in |
20 | | agriculture, a strategy for
articulating the State program in |
21 | | agricultural education throughout the
public school system, |
22 | | and a consumer education outreach strategy regarding
the |
23 | | importance of agriculture in Illinois. The committee of |
24 | | agriculturalists
shall serve without compensation.
|
25 | | (e) A school district that offers a secondary agricultural |
26 | | education program that is approved for State and federal |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 181 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | funding must ensure that, at a minimum, all of the following |
2 | | are available to its secondary agricultural education |
3 | | students: |
4 | | (1) An instructional sequence of courses approved by |
5 | | the State Board of Education. |
6 | | (2) A State and nationally affiliated FFA (Future |
7 | | Farmers of America) chapter that is integral to instruction |
8 | | and is not treated solely as an extracurricular activity. |
9 | | (3) A mechanism for ensuring the involvement of all |
10 | | secondary agricultural education students in formal, |
11 | | supervised, agricultural-experience activities and |
12 | | programs.
|
13 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
14 | | Section, the State Board of Education shall award to a school |
15 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000 inhabitants |
16 | | 1.1% of the funds appropriated by the General Assembly for any |
17 | | fiscal year for purposes of payment of claims under this |
18 | | Section. |
19 | | (f) Nothing in this Section may prevent those secondary |
20 | | agricultural education programs that are in operation before |
21 | | the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 94th General |
22 | | Assembly and that do not have an active State and nationally |
23 | | affiliated FFA chapter from continuing to operate or from |
24 | | continuing to receive funding from the State Board of |
25 | | Education.
|
26 | | (Source: P.A. 94-855, eff. 1-1-07.)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 182 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.84) (from Ch. 122, par. 2-3.84)
|
2 | | Sec. 2-3.84. In calculating the amount of State aid to be |
3 | | apportioned
to the various school districts in this State, the |
4 | | State Board of Education
shall incorporate and deduct the total |
5 | | aggregate adjustments to assessments
made by
the State Property |
6 | | Tax Appeal Board or Cook County Board of Appeals, as
reported |
7 | | pursuant to Section 16-15 of the Property Tax Code or Section
|
8 | | 129.1 of the Revenue Act of 1939 by the Department of Revenue, |
9 | | from the
equalized assessed valuation that is otherwise to be |
10 | | utilized in
the initial calculation.
|
11 | | From the total amount of general State aid or |
12 | | evidence-based funding to be provided to
districts, |
13 | | adjustments under this Section together with adjustments as a
|
14 | | result of recomputation under Section 2-3.33 must not exceed |
15 | | $25
million, in the aggregate for all districts under both |
16 | | Sections combined,
of the general State aid or evidence-based |
17 | | funding appropriation in any fiscal year; if necessary,
amounts |
18 | | shall be prorated among districts. If it is necessary to |
19 | | prorate
claims under this paragraph, then that portion of each |
20 | | prorated claim that is
approved but not paid in the current |
21 | | fiscal year may be resubmitted as a
valid claim in the |
22 | | following fiscal year.
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 93-845, eff. 7-30-04.)
|
24 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.109a)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 183 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 2-3.109a. Laboratory schools grant eligibility. A |
2 | | laboratory school
as defined in Section 18-8 or 18-8.15 may |
3 | | apply for and be eligible to receive, subject to
the same |
4 | | restrictions applicable to school districts, any grant |
5 | | administered by
the State Board of Education that is available |
6 | | for school districts.
|
7 | | (Source: P.A. 90-566, eff. 1-2-98.)
|
8 | | (105 ILCS 5/3-14.21) (from Ch. 122, par. 3-14.21)
|
9 | | Sec. 3-14.21. Inspection of schools.
|
10 | | (a) The regional superintendent shall inspect and survey |
11 | | all
public
schools under his or her supervision and notify the |
12 | | board of education, or the
trustees of schools in a district |
13 | | with trustees, in writing before July 30,
whether or not the |
14 | | several schools in their district have been kept as required
by |
15 | | law, using forms provided by the State Board of Education which |
16 | | are based on
the Health/Life Safety Code for Public Schools |
17 | | adopted under Section 2-3.12. The regional
superintendent |
18 | | shall report his or her findings to the State Board of
|
19 | | Education on
forms provided by the State Board of Education.
|
20 | | (b) If the regional superintendent determines that a school |
21 | | board has
failed in a timely manner to correct urgent items |
22 | | identified in a previous
life-safety report completed under |
23 | | Section 2-3.12 or as otherwise previously
ordered by the |
24 | | regional superintendent, the regional superintendent shall |
25 | | order
the school board to adopt and submit to the regional |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 184 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | superintendent a plan for
the immediate correction of the |
2 | | building violations. This plan shall be
adopted following a |
3 | | public hearing that is conducted by the school board on the
|
4 | | violations and the plan and that is preceded by at least 7 |
5 | | days' prior notice
of the hearing published in
a newspaper of |
6 | | general circulation within the school district. If the regional
|
7 | | superintendent determines in the next annual inspection that |
8 | | the plan has not
been completed and that the violations have |
9 | | not been corrected, the regional
superintendent shall submit a |
10 | | report to the State Board of Education with a
recommendation |
11 | | that the State Board withhold from payments of general State |
12 | | aid or evidence-based funding
due to the district an amount |
13 | | necessary to correct the outstanding violations.
The State |
14 | | Board, upon notice to the school board
and to the regional |
15 | | superintendent, shall consider the report at a meeting of
the |
16 | | State Board, and may order that a sufficient amount of general |
17 | | State aid or evidence-based funding be
withheld from payments |
18 | | due to the district to correct the violations. This
amount |
19 | | shall be paid to the regional superintendent who shall contract |
20 | | on
behalf of the school board for the correction of the |
21 | | outstanding violations.
|
22 | | (c) The Office of the State Fire Marshal or a qualified |
23 | | fire official, as defined in Section 2-3.12 of this Code, to |
24 | | whom the State Fire Marshal has delegated his or her authority |
25 | | shall conduct an annual fire safety inspection of each school |
26 | | building in this State. The State Fire Marshal or the fire |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 185 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | official shall coordinate its inspections with the regional |
2 | | superintendent. The inspection shall be based on the fire |
3 | | safety code authorized in Section 2-3.12 of this Code. Any |
4 | | violations shall be reported in writing to the regional |
5 | | superintendent and shall reference the specific code sections |
6 | | where a discrepancy has been identified within 15 days after |
7 | | the inspection has been conducted. The regional superintendent |
8 | | shall address those violations that are not corrected in a |
9 | | timely manner pursuant to subsection (b) of this Section. The |
10 | | inspection must be at no cost to the school district.
|
11 | | (d) If a municipality or, in the case of an unincorporated |
12 | | area, a county or, if applicable, a fire protection district |
13 | | wishes to perform new construction inspections under the |
14 | | jurisdiction of a regional superintendent, then the entity must |
15 | | register this wish with the regional superintendent. These |
16 | | inspections must be based on the building code authorized in |
17 | | Section 2-3.12 of this Code. The inspections must be at no cost |
18 | | to the school district.
|
19 | | (Source: P.A. 96-734, eff. 8-25-09.)
|
20 | | (105 ILCS 5/7-14A) (from Ch. 122, par. 7-14A)
|
21 | | Sec. 7-14A. Annexation compensation. There shall be no |
22 | | accounting
made after a mere change in boundaries when no new |
23 | | district is created, except that those districts whose |
24 | | enrollment increases by 90% or more as a result of annexing |
25 | | territory detached from another district pursuant to this |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 186 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Article are eligible for supplementary State aid payments in |
2 | | accordance with Section 11E-135 of this Code. Eligible annexing |
3 | | districts shall apply to the State Board of Education for |
4 | | supplementary State aid payments by submitting enrollment |
5 | | figures for the year immediately preceding and the year |
6 | | immediately following the effective date of the boundary change |
7 | | for both the district gaining territory and the district losing |
8 | | territory. Copies of any intergovernmental agreements between |
9 | | the district gaining territory and the district losing |
10 | | territory detailing any transfer of fund balances and staff |
11 | | must also be submitted. In all instances of changes in |
12 | | boundaries,
the district losing territory shall
not count the |
13 | | average daily attendance of pupils living in the territory
|
14 | | during the year preceding the effective date of the boundary |
15 | | change in its
claim for reimbursement under Section 18-8.05 or |
16 | | 18-8.15 of this Code for the school year following
the |
17 | | effective date of the change in boundaries and the district |
18 | | receiving
the territory shall count the average daily |
19 | | attendance of pupils living in
the territory during the year |
20 | | preceding the effective date of the boundary
change in its |
21 | | claim for reimbursement under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of |
22 | | this Code for the school
year following the effective date of |
23 | | the change in boundaries. The changes to this Section made by |
24 | | this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are intended |
25 | | to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation taking |
26 | | effect on or after July 1, 2004.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 187 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (Source: P.A. 99-657, eff. 7-28-16.)
|
2 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-17a) (from Ch. 122, par. 10-17a)
|
3 | | Sec. 10-17a. State, school district, and school report |
4 | | cards.
|
5 | | (1) By October 31, 2013 and October 31 of each subsequent |
6 | | school year, the State Board of Education, through the State |
7 | | Superintendent of Education, shall prepare a State report card, |
8 | | school district report cards, and school report cards, and |
9 | | shall by the most economic means provide to each school
|
10 | | district in this State, including special charter districts and |
11 | | districts
subject to the provisions of Article 34, the report |
12 | | cards for the school district and each of its schools. |
13 | | (2) In addition to any information required by federal law, |
14 | | the State Superintendent shall determine the indicators and |
15 | | presentation of the school report card, which must include, at |
16 | | a minimum, the most current data possessed by the State Board |
17 | | of Education related to the following: |
18 | | (A) school characteristics and student demographics, |
19 | | including average class size, average teaching experience, |
20 | | student racial/ethnic breakdown, and the percentage of |
21 | | students classified as low-income; the percentage of |
22 | | students classified as English learners; the percentage of |
23 | | students who have individualized education plans or 504 |
24 | | plans that provide for special education services; the |
25 | | percentage of students who annually transferred in or out |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 188 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the school district; the per-pupil operating |
2 | | expenditure of the school district; and the per-pupil State |
3 | | average operating expenditure for the district type |
4 | | (elementary, high school, or unit); |
5 | | (B) curriculum information, including, where |
6 | | applicable, Advanced Placement, International |
7 | | Baccalaureate or equivalent courses, dual enrollment |
8 | | courses, foreign language classes, school personnel |
9 | | resources (including Career Technical Education teachers), |
10 | | before and after school programs, extracurricular |
11 | | activities, subjects in which elective classes are |
12 | | offered, health and wellness initiatives (including the |
13 | | average number of days of Physical Education per week per |
14 | | student), approved programs of study, awards received, |
15 | | community partnerships, and special programs such as |
16 | | programming for the gifted and talented, students with |
17 | | disabilities, and work-study students; |
18 | | (C) student outcomes, including, where applicable, the |
19 | | percentage of students deemed proficient on assessments of |
20 | | State standards, the percentage of students in the eighth |
21 | | grade who pass Algebra, the percentage of students enrolled |
22 | | in post-secondary institutions (including colleges, |
23 | | universities, community colleges, trade/vocational |
24 | | schools, and training programs leading to career |
25 | | certification within 2 semesters of high school |
26 | | graduation), the percentage of students graduating from |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 189 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | high school who are college and career ready, and the |
2 | | percentage of graduates enrolled in community colleges, |
3 | | colleges, and universities who are in one or more courses |
4 | | that the community college, college, or university |
5 | | identifies as a developmental course; |
6 | | (D) student progress, including, where applicable, the |
7 | | percentage of students in the ninth grade who have earned 5 |
8 | | credits or more without failing more than one core class, a |
9 | | measure of students entering kindergarten ready to learn, a |
10 | | measure of growth, and the percentage of students who enter |
11 | | high school on track for college and career readiness; |
12 | | (E) the school environment, including, where |
13 | | applicable, the percentage of students with less than 10 |
14 | | absences in a school year, the percentage of teachers with |
15 | | less than 10 absences in a school year for reasons other |
16 | | than professional development, leaves taken pursuant to |
17 | | the federal Family Medical Leave Act of 1993, long-term |
18 | | disability, or parental leaves, the 3-year average of the |
19 | | percentage of teachers returning to the school from the |
20 | | previous year, the number of different principals at the |
21 | | school in the last 6 years, 2 or more indicators from any |
22 | | school climate survey selected or approved by the State and |
23 | | administered pursuant to Section 2-3.153 of this Code, with |
24 | | the same or similar indicators included on school report |
25 | | cards for all surveys selected or approved by the State |
26 | | pursuant to Section 2-3.153 of this Code, and the combined |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 190 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | percentage of teachers rated as proficient or excellent in |
2 | | their most recent evaluation; and |
3 | | (F) a school district's and its individual schools' |
4 | | balanced accountability measure, in accordance with |
5 | | Section 2-3.25a of this Code ; . |
6 | | (G) a school district's Final Percent of Adequacy, as |
7 | | defined in paragraph (4) of subsection (f) of Section |
8 | | 18-8.15 of this Code; |
9 | | (H) a school district's Local Capacity Target, as |
10 | | defined in paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of Section |
11 | | 18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount; and |
12 | | (I) a school district's Real Receipts, as defined in |
13 | | paragraph (1) of subsection (d) of Section 18-8.15 of this |
14 | | Code, divided by a school district's Adequacy Target, as |
15 | | defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (b) of Section |
16 | | 18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount. |
17 | | The school report card shall also provide
information that |
18 | | allows for comparing the current outcome, progress, and |
19 | | environment data to the State average, to the school data from |
20 | | the past 5 years, and to the outcomes, progress, and |
21 | | environment of similar schools based on the type of school and |
22 | | enrollment of low-income students, special education students, |
23 | | and English learners.
|
24 | | (3) At the discretion of the State Superintendent, the |
25 | | school district report card shall include a subset of the |
26 | | information identified in paragraphs (A) through (E) of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 191 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | subsection (2) of this Section, as well as information relating |
2 | | to the operating expense per pupil and other finances of the |
3 | | school district, and the State report card shall include a |
4 | | subset of the information identified in paragraphs (A) through |
5 | | (E) of subsection (2) of this Section. |
6 | | (4) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this |
7 | | Section, in consultation with key education stakeholders, the |
8 | | State Superintendent shall at any time have the discretion to |
9 | | amend or update any and all metrics on the school, district, or |
10 | | State report card. |
11 | | (5) Annually, no more than 30 calendar days after receipt |
12 | | of the school district and school report cards from the State |
13 | | Superintendent of Education, each school district, including |
14 | | special charter districts and districts subject to the |
15 | | provisions of Article 34, shall present such report
cards at a |
16 | | regular school board meeting subject to
applicable notice |
17 | | requirements, post the report cards
on the
school district's |
18 | | Internet web site, if the district maintains an Internet web
|
19 | | site, make the report cards
available
to a newspaper of general |
20 | | circulation serving the district, and, upon
request, send the |
21 | | report cards
home to a parent (unless the district does not |
22 | | maintain an Internet web site,
in which case
the report card |
23 | | shall be sent home to parents without request). If the
district |
24 | | posts the report card on its Internet web
site, the district
|
25 | | shall send a
written notice home to parents stating (i) that |
26 | | the report card is available on
the web site,
(ii) the address |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 192 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the web site, (iii) that a printed copy of the report card
|
2 | | will be sent to
parents upon request, and (iv) the telephone |
3 | | number that parents may
call to
request a printed copy of the |
4 | | report card.
|
5 | | (6) Nothing contained in this amendatory Act of the 98th |
6 | | General Assembly repeals, supersedes, invalidates, or |
7 | | nullifies final decisions in lawsuits pending on the effective |
8 | | date of this amendatory Act of the 98th General Assembly in |
9 | | Illinois courts involving the interpretation of Public Act |
10 | | 97-8. |
11 | | (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 98-648, eff. 7-1-14; 99-30, |
12 | | eff. 7-10-15; 99-193, eff. 7-30-15; 99-642, eff. 7-28-16.)
|
13 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-19) (from Ch. 122, par. 10-19)
|
14 | | Sec. 10-19. Length of school term - experimental programs. |
15 | | Each school
board shall annually prepare a calendar for the |
16 | | school term, specifying
the opening and closing dates and |
17 | | providing a minimum term of at least 185
days to insure 176 |
18 | | days of actual pupil attendance, computable under Section
|
19 | | 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 , except that for the 1980-1981 school year |
20 | | only 175 days
of actual
pupil attendance shall be required |
21 | | because of the closing of schools pursuant
to Section 24-2 on |
22 | | January 29, 1981 upon the appointment by the President
of that |
23 | | day as a day of thanksgiving for the freedom of the Americans |
24 | | who
had been held hostage in Iran. Any days allowed by law for |
25 | | teachers' institutes
but not used as such or used as parental |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 193 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | institutes as provided
in Section 10-22.18d shall increase the |
2 | | minimum term by the school days not
so used. Except as provided |
3 | | in Section 10-19.1, the board may not extend
the school term |
4 | | beyond such closing date unless that extension of term is
|
5 | | necessary to provide the minimum number of computable days. In |
6 | | case of
such necessary extension school employees
shall be paid |
7 | | for such additional time on the basis of their regular
|
8 | | contracts. A school board may specify a closing date earlier |
9 | | than that
set on the annual calendar when the schools of the |
10 | | district have
provided the minimum number of computable days |
11 | | under this Section.
Nothing in this Section prevents the board |
12 | | from employing
superintendents of schools, principals and |
13 | | other nonteaching personnel
for a period of 12 months, or in |
14 | | the case of superintendents for a
period in accordance with |
15 | | Section 10-23.8, or prevents the board from
employing other |
16 | | personnel before or after the regular school term with
payment |
17 | | of salary proportionate to that received for comparable work
|
18 | | during the school term.
|
19 | | A school board may make such changes in its calendar for |
20 | | the school term
as may be required by any changes in the legal |
21 | | school holidays prescribed
in Section 24-2. A school board may |
22 | | make changes in its calendar for the
school term as may be |
23 | | necessary to reflect the utilization of teachers'
institute |
24 | | days as parental institute days as provided in Section |
25 | | 10-22.18d.
|
26 | | The calendar for the school term and any changes must be |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 194 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | submitted to and approved by the regional superintendent of |
2 | | schools before the calendar or changes may take effect.
|
3 | | With the prior approval of the State Board of Education and |
4 | | subject
to review by the State Board of Education every 3 |
5 | | years, any school
board may, by resolution of its board and in |
6 | | agreement with affected
exclusive collective bargaining |
7 | | agents, establish experimental
educational programs, including |
8 | | but not limited to programs for e-learning days as authorized |
9 | | under Section 10-20.56 of this Code,
self-directed learning, or |
10 | | outside of formal class periods, which programs
when so |
11 | | approved shall be considered to comply with the requirements of
|
12 | | this Section as respects numbers of days of actual pupil |
13 | | attendance and
with the other requirements of this Act as |
14 | | respects courses of instruction.
|
15 | | (Source: P.A. 98-756, eff. 7-16-14; 99-194, eff. 7-30-15.)
|
16 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-22.5a) (from Ch. 122, par. 10-22.5a)
|
17 | | Sec. 10-22.5a. Attendance by dependents of United States |
18 | | military personnel, foreign exchange students, and certain
|
19 | | nonresident pupils. |
20 | | (a) To enter into written agreements with cultural exchange |
21 | | organizations,
or with nationally recognized eleemosynary |
22 | | institutions that promote excellence
in the arts, mathematics, |
23 | | or science. The written agreements may provide
for tuition free |
24 | | attendance at the local district school by foreign exchange
|
25 | | students, or by nonresident pupils of eleemosynary |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 195 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | institutions. The local
board of education, as part of the |
2 | | agreement, may require that the cultural
exchange program or |
3 | | the eleemosynary institutions provide services to the
district |
4 | | in exchange for the waiver of nonresident tuition.
|
5 | | To enter into written agreements with adjacent school |
6 | | districts to provide
for tuition free attendance by a student |
7 | | of the adjacent district when
requested for the student's |
8 | | health and safety by the student or parent and both
districts |
9 | | determine that the student's health or safety will be served by |
10 | | such
attendance. Districts shall not be required to enter into |
11 | | such agreements nor
be
required to alter existing |
12 | | transportation services due to the attendance of
such |
13 | | non-resident pupils.
|
14 | | (a-5) If, at the time of enrollment, a dependent of United |
15 | | States military personnel is housed in temporary housing |
16 | | located outside of a school district, but will be living within |
17 | | the district within 60 days after the time of initial |
18 | | enrollment, the dependent must be allowed to enroll, subject to |
19 | | the requirements of this subsection (a-5), and must not be |
20 | | charged tuition. Any United States military personnel |
21 | | attempting to enroll a dependent under this subsection (a-5) |
22 | | shall provide proof that the dependent will be living within |
23 | | the district within 60 days after the time of initial |
24 | | enrollment. Proof of residency may include, but is not limited |
25 | | to, postmarked mail addressed to the military personnel and |
26 | | sent to an address located within the district, a lease |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 196 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | agreement for occupancy of a residence located within the |
2 | | district, or proof of ownership of a residence located within |
3 | | the district.
|
4 | | (b) Nonresident pupils and foreign exchange students |
5 | | attending school on a
tuition free basis under such agreements |
6 | | and nonresident dependents of United States military personnel |
7 | | attending school on a tuition free basis may be counted for the |
8 | | purposes
of determining the apportionment of State aid provided |
9 | | under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15
of this Code. No organization
|
10 | | or institution participating in agreements authorized under |
11 | | this Section
may exclude any individual for participation in |
12 | | its program on account
of the person's race, color, sex, |
13 | | religion or nationality.
|
14 | | (Source: P.A. 98-739, eff. 7-16-14.)
|
15 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-22.20) (from Ch. 122, par. 10-22.20)
|
16 | | Sec. 10-22.20. Classes for adults and youths whose |
17 | | schooling has
been interrupted; conditions for State |
18 | | reimbursement; use of child
care facilities. |
19 | | (a) To establish special classes for the instruction (1)
of |
20 | | persons of age 21 years or over and (2) of persons less than |
21 | | age 21
and not otherwise in attendance in public school, for |
22 | | the purpose of
providing adults in the community and youths |
23 | | whose schooling has been
interrupted with such additional basic |
24 | | education, vocational skill
training, and other instruction as |
25 | | may be necessary to increase their
qualifications for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 197 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | employment or other means of self-support and their
ability to |
2 | | meet their responsibilities as citizens, including courses of
|
3 | | instruction regularly accepted for graduation from elementary |
4 | | or high
schools and for Americanization and high school |
5 | | equivalency testing review classes.
|
6 | | The board shall pay the necessary expenses of such classes |
7 | | out of
school funds of the district, including costs of student |
8 | | transportation
and such facilities or provision for child-care |
9 | | as may be necessary in
the judgment of the board to permit |
10 | | maximum utilization of the courses
by students with children, |
11 | | and other special needs of the students
directly related to |
12 | | such instruction. The expenses thus incurred shall
be subject |
13 | | to State reimbursement, as provided in this Section. The
board |
14 | | may make a tuition charge for persons taking instruction who |
15 | | are
not subject to State reimbursement, such tuition charge not |
16 | | to exceed
the per capita cost of such classes.
|
17 | | The cost of such instruction, including the additional |
18 | | expenses herein
authorized, incurred for recipients of |
19 | | financial aid under the Illinois
Public Aid Code, or for |
20 | | persons for whom education and training aid has been
authorized |
21 | | under Section 9-8 of that Code, shall be assumed in its |
22 | | entirety
from funds appropriated by the State to the Illinois |
23 | | Community College
Board.
|
24 | | (b) The
Illinois Community College Board shall establish
|
25 | | the standards for the
courses of instruction reimbursed
under |
26 | | this Section. The Illinois Community College Board shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 198 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | supervise the
administration of the programs. The Illinois |
2 | | Community College Board shall
determine the cost
of instruction |
3 | | in accordance with standards established by the Illinois
|
4 | | Community College Board, including therein
other incidental |
5 | | costs as herein authorized, which shall serve as the basis of
|
6 | | State reimbursement in accordance with the provisions of this |
7 | | Section. In the
approval of programs and the determination of |
8 | | the cost of instruction, the
Illinois Community College Board |
9 | | shall provide
for the maximum utilization of federal
funds for |
10 | | such programs.
The Illinois Community College Board shall also |
11 | | provide for:
|
12 | | (1) the development of an index of need for program |
13 | | planning and for area
funding allocations, as defined by |
14 | | the Illinois Community College Board;
|
15 | | (2) the method for calculating hours of instruction, as |
16 | | defined by the
Illinois Community College Board, claimable
|
17 | | for reimbursement and a method to phase in
the calculation |
18 | | and for adjusting the calculations in cases where the |
19 | | services
of a program are interrupted due to circumstances |
20 | | beyond the control of the
program provider;
|
21 | | (3) a plan for the reallocation of funds to increase |
22 | | the amount allocated
for grants based upon program |
23 | | performance as set forth in subsection (d) below;
and
|
24 | | (4) the development of standards for determining |
25 | | grants based upon
performance as set forth in subsection |
26 | | (d) below and a plan for the phased-in
implementation of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 199 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | those standards.
|
2 | | For instruction provided by school districts and community |
3 | | college
districts beginning July 1, 1996 and thereafter, |
4 | | reimbursement
provided by
the Illinois Community College Board |
5 | | for
classes authorized by this Section
shall be provided from
|
6 | | funds appropriated for the reimbursement criteria set forth in |
7 | | subsection (c)
below.
|
8 | | (c) Upon the annual approval of the Illinois Community |
9 | | College Board, reimbursement
shall be first provided for |
10 | | transportation, child care services, and other
special needs of |
11 | | the students directly related to instruction and then from the
|
12 | | funds remaining
an amount equal to the product of the total |
13 | | credit hours or units
of instruction approved by the Illinois |
14 | | Community College Board, multiplied by the
following:
|
15 | | (1) For adult basic education, the maximum |
16 | | reimbursement per
credit hour
or per unit of instruction |
17 | | shall be equal to (i) through fiscal year 2017, the general |
18 | | state aid per pupil
foundation level established in |
19 | | subsection (B) of Section 18-8.05, divided by
60 , or (ii) |
20 | | in fiscal year 2018 and thereafter, the prior fiscal year |
21 | | reimbursement level multiplied by the Consumer Price Index |
22 | | for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the |
23 | | United States Department of Labor ;
|
24 | | (2) The maximum reimbursement per credit hour or per |
25 | | unit of
instruction
in subparagraph (1) above shall be |
26 | | weighted for students enrolled in classes
defined as |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 200 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | vocational skills and
approved
by the Illinois Community |
2 | | College Board by
1.25;
|
3 | | (3) The maximum reimbursement per credit hour or per |
4 | | unit of
instruction
in subparagraph (1) above shall be |
5 | | multiplied by .90 for students enrolled in
classes defined |
6 | | as adult
secondary
education programs and approved by the |
7 | | Illinois Community College Board;
|
8 | | (4) (Blank); and
|
9 | | (5) Funding
for program years after 1999-2000 shall be |
10 | | determined by the Illinois
Community College Board.
|
11 | | (d) Upon its annual approval, the Illinois Community |
12 | | College Board
shall provide grants to eligible programs for |
13 | | supplemental
activities to improve or expand services under the |
14 | | Adult Education Act.
Eligible programs shall be determined |
15 | | based upon performance outcomes of
students in the programs as |
16 | | set by the Illinois Community College Board.
|
17 | | (e) Reimbursement under this Section shall not exceed
the |
18 | | actual costs of the approved program.
|
19 | | If the amount appropriated to the Illinois Community |
20 | | College Board for
reimbursement under this Section is less than |
21 | | the amount required under
this Act, the apportionment shall
be |
22 | | proportionately reduced.
|
23 | | School districts and community college districts may |
24 | | assess students up
to $3.00 per credit hour, for classes other |
25 | | than Adult Basic Education level
programs, if needed to meet |
26 | | program costs.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 201 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (f) An education plan shall be established for each adult |
2 | | or youth
whose
schooling has been interrupted and who is |
3 | | participating in the
instructional programs provided under |
4 | | this Section.
|
5 | | Each school board and community college shall keep an |
6 | | accurate and
detailed account of the
students assigned to and |
7 | | receiving instruction under this Section who
are subject to |
8 | | State reimbursement and shall submit reports of services
|
9 | | provided commencing with fiscal year 1997 as required by the |
10 | | Illinois
Community College Board.
|
11 | | For classes authorized under this Section, a credit hour or |
12 | | unit of
instruction is equal to 15 hours of direct instruction |
13 | | for students
enrolled in approved adult education programs at |
14 | | midterm and making
satisfactory progress, in accordance with |
15 | | standards established by the Illinois Community College Board.
|
16 | | (g) Upon proof submitted to the Illinois
Department of |
17 | | Human Services of the payment of all claims submitted under
|
18 | | this Section, that Department shall apply for federal funds |
19 | | made
available therefor and any federal funds so received shall
|
20 | | be paid into the General Revenue Fund in the State Treasury.
|
21 | | School districts or community colleges providing classes |
22 | | under this Section
shall submit applications to the Illinois |
23 | | Community College Board for
preapproval in accordance with the |
24 | | standards established by the Illinois
Community College Board. |
25 | | Payments shall be made by the Illinois Community
College Board |
26 | | based upon approved programs. Interim expenditure reports may
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 202 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be required by the Illinois Community College Board. Final
|
2 | | claims for the school year shall be submitted to the regional |
3 | | superintendents
for transmittal to the Illinois Community |
4 | | College Board. Final adjusted
payments shall be made by |
5 | | September
30.
|
6 | | If a school district or community college district fails to |
7 | | provide, or
is providing unsatisfactory or insufficient |
8 | | classes under this Section,
the Illinois Community College |
9 | | Board may enter
into agreements with public or
private |
10 | | educational or other agencies other than the public schools for
|
11 | | the establishment of such classes.
|
12 | | (h) If a school district or community college district |
13 | | establishes
child-care
facilities for the children of |
14 | | participants in classes established under
this Section, it may |
15 | | extend the use of these facilities to students who
have |
16 | | obtained employment and to other persons in the community whose
|
17 | | children require care and supervision while the parent or other |
18 | | person in
charge of the children is employed or otherwise |
19 | | absent from the home during
all or part of the day. It may make |
20 | | the facilities available before and
after as well as during |
21 | | regular school hours to school age and preschool
age children |
22 | | who may benefit thereby, including children who require care
|
23 | | and supervision pending the return of their parent or other |
24 | | person in
charge of their care from employment or other |
25 | | activity requiring absence
from the home.
|
26 | | The Illinois Community College Board shall
pay to the board |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 203 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the cost of care
in the facilities for any child who is a |
2 | | recipient of financial aid
under the Illinois Public Aid Code.
|
3 | | The board may charge for care of children for whom it |
4 | | cannot make
claim under the provisions of this Section. The |
5 | | charge shall not exceed
per capita cost, and to the extent |
6 | | feasible, shall be fixed at a level
which will permit |
7 | | utilization by employed parents of low or moderate
income. It |
8 | | may also permit any other State or local governmental agency
or |
9 | | private agency providing care for children to purchase care.
|
10 | | After July 1, 1970 when the provisions of Section 10-20.20 |
11 | | become
operative in the district, children in a child-care |
12 | | facility shall be
transferred to the kindergarten established |
13 | | under that Section for such
portion of the day as may be |
14 | | required for the kindergarten program, and
only the prorated |
15 | | costs of care and training provided in the Center for
the |
16 | | remaining period shall be charged to the Illinois Department of
|
17 | | Human Services or other persons or agencies paying for such |
18 | | care.
|
19 | | (i) The provisions of this Section shall also apply to |
20 | | school
districts having a population exceeding 500,000.
|
21 | | (j) In addition to claiming reimbursement under this |
22 | | Section, a school
district may claim general State aid under |
23 | | Section 18-8.05 or evidence-based funding under Section |
24 | | 18-8.15 for any student
under age 21 who is enrolled in courses |
25 | | accepted for graduation from elementary
or high school and who |
26 | | otherwise meets the requirements of Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 204 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | as applicable .
|
2 | | (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15 .)
|
3 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-29) |
4 | | Sec. 10-29. Remote educational programs. |
5 | | (a) For purposes of this Section, "remote educational |
6 | | program" means an educational program delivered to students in |
7 | | the home or other location outside of a school building that |
8 | | meets all of the following criteria: |
9 | | (1) A student may participate in the program only after |
10 | | the school district, pursuant to adopted school board |
11 | | policy, and a person authorized to enroll the student under |
12 | | Section 10-20.12b of this Code determine that a remote |
13 | | educational program will best serve the student's |
14 | | individual learning needs. The adopted school board policy |
15 | | shall include, but not be limited to, all of the following: |
16 | | (A) Criteria for determining that a remote |
17 | | educational program will best serve a student's |
18 | | individual learning needs. The criteria must include |
19 | | consideration of, at a minimum, a student's prior |
20 | | attendance, disciplinary record, and academic history. |
21 | | (B) Any limitations on the number of students or |
22 | | grade levels that may participate in a remote |
23 | | educational program. |
24 | | (C) A description of the process that the school |
25 | | district will use to approve participation in the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 205 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | remote educational program. The process must include |
2 | | without limitation a requirement that, for any student |
3 | | who qualifies to receive services pursuant to the |
4 | | federal Individuals with Disabilities Education |
5 | | Improvement Act of 2004, the student's participation |
6 | | in a remote educational program receive prior approval |
7 | | from the student's individualized education program |
8 | | team. |
9 | | (D) A description of the process the school |
10 | | district will use to develop and approve a written |
11 | | remote educational plan that meets the requirements of |
12 | | subdivision (5) of this subsection (a). |
13 | | (E) A description of the system the school district |
14 | | will establish to calculate the number of clock hours a |
15 | | student is participating in instruction in accordance |
16 | | with the remote educational program. |
17 | | (F) A description of the process for renewing a |
18 | | remote educational program at the expiration of its |
19 | | term. |
20 | | (G) Such other terms and provisions as the school |
21 | | district deems necessary to provide for the |
22 | | establishment and delivery of a remote educational |
23 | | program. |
24 | | (2) The school district has determined that the remote |
25 | | educational program's curriculum is aligned to State |
26 | | learning standards and that the program offers instruction |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 206 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | and educational experiences consistent with those given to |
2 | | students at the same grade level in the district. |
3 | | (3) The remote educational program is delivered by |
4 | | instructors that meet the following qualifications: |
5 | | (A) they are certificated under Article 21 of this |
6 | | Code; |
7 | | (B) they meet applicable highly qualified criteria |
8 | | under the federal No Child Left Behind Act of 2001; and |
9 | | (C) they have responsibility for all of the |
10 | | following elements of the program: planning |
11 | | instruction, diagnosing learning needs, prescribing |
12 | | content delivery through class activities, assessing |
13 | | learning, reporting outcomes to administrators and |
14 | | parents and guardians, and evaluating the effects of |
15 | | instruction. |
16 | | (4) During the period of time from and including the |
17 | | opening date to the
closing date of the regular school term |
18 | | of the school district established pursuant to Section |
19 | | 10-19 of this Code, participation in a remote educational |
20 | | program may be claimed for general State aid purposes under |
21 | | Section 18-8.05 of this Code or evidence-based funding |
22 | | purposes under Section 18-8.15 of this Code on any calendar |
23 | | day, notwithstanding whether the day is a day of pupil |
24 | | attendance or institute day on the school district's |
25 | | calendar or any other provision of law restricting |
26 | | instruction on that day. If the district holds year-round |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 207 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | classes in some buildings, the district
shall classify each |
2 | | student's participation in a remote educational program as |
3 | | either on a year-round or a non-year-round schedule for |
4 | | purposes of claiming general State aid or evidence-based |
5 | | funding . Outside of the regular school term of the |
6 | | district, the remote educational program may be offered as |
7 | | part of any summer school program authorized by this Code. |
8 | | (5) Each student participating in a remote educational |
9 | | program must have a written remote educational plan that |
10 | | has been approved by the school district and a person |
11 | | authorized to enroll the student under Section 10-20.12b of |
12 | | this Code. The school district and a person authorized to |
13 | | enroll the student under Section 10-20.12b of this Code |
14 | | must approve any amendment to a remote educational plan. |
15 | | The remote educational plan must include, but is not |
16 | | limited to, all of the following: |
17 | | (A) Specific achievement goals for the student |
18 | | aligned to State learning standards. |
19 | | (B) A description of all assessments that will be |
20 | | used to measure student progress, which description |
21 | | shall indicate the assessments that will be |
22 | | administered at an attendance center within the school |
23 | | district. |
24 | | (C) A description of the progress reports that will |
25 | | be provided to the school district and the person or |
26 | | persons authorized to enroll the student under Section |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 208 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 10-20.12b of this Code. |
2 | | (D) Expectations, processes, and schedules for |
3 | | interaction between a teacher and student. |
4 | | (E) A description of the specific responsibilities |
5 | | of the student's family and the school district with |
6 | | respect to equipment, materials, phone and Internet |
7 | | service, and any other requirements applicable to the |
8 | | home or other location outside of a school building |
9 | | necessary for the delivery of the remote educational |
10 | | program. |
11 | | (F) If applicable, a description of how the remote |
12 | | educational program will be delivered in a manner |
13 | | consistent with the student's individualized education |
14 | | program required by Section 614(d) of the federal |
15 | | Individuals with Disabilities Education Improvement |
16 | | Act of 2004 or plan to ensure compliance with Section |
17 | | 504 of the federal Rehabilitation Act of 1973. |
18 | | (G) A description of the procedures and |
19 | | opportunities for participation in academic and |
20 | | extra-curricular activities and programs within the |
21 | | school district. |
22 | | (H) The identification of a parent, guardian, or |
23 | | other responsible adult who will provide direct |
24 | | supervision of the program. The plan must include an |
25 | | acknowledgment by the parent, guardian, or other |
26 | | responsible adult that he or she may engage only in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 209 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | non-teaching duties not requiring instructional |
2 | | judgment or the evaluation of a student. The plan shall |
3 | | designate the parent, guardian, or other responsible |
4 | | adult as non-teaching personnel or volunteer personnel |
5 | | under subsection (a) of Section 10-22.34 of this Code. |
6 | | (I) The identification of a school district |
7 | | administrator who will oversee the remote educational |
8 | | program on behalf of the school district and who may be |
9 | | contacted by the student's parents with respect to any |
10 | | issues or concerns with the program. |
11 | | (J) The term of the student's participation in the |
12 | | remote educational program, which may not extend for |
13 | | longer than 12 months, unless the term is renewed by |
14 | | the district in accordance with subdivision (7) of this |
15 | | subsection (a). |
16 | | (K) A description of the specific location or |
17 | | locations in which the program will be delivered. If |
18 | | the remote educational program is to be delivered to a |
19 | | student in any location other than the student's home, |
20 | | the plan must include a written determination by the |
21 | | school district that the location will provide a |
22 | | learning environment appropriate for the delivery of |
23 | | the program. The location or locations in which the |
24 | | program will be delivered shall be deemed a long |
25 | | distance teaching reception area under subsection (a) |
26 | | of Section 10-22.34 of this Code. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 210 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (L) Certification by the school district that the |
2 | | plan meets all other requirements of this Section. |
3 | | (6) Students participating in a remote educational |
4 | | program must be enrolled in a school district attendance |
5 | | center pursuant to the school district's enrollment policy |
6 | | or policies. A student participating in a remote |
7 | | educational program must be tested as part of all |
8 | | assessments administered by the school district pursuant |
9 | | to Section 2-3.64a-5 of this Code at the attendance center |
10 | | in which the student is enrolled and in accordance with the |
11 | | attendance center's assessment policies and schedule. The |
12 | | student must be included within all accountability |
13 | | determinations for the school district and attendance |
14 | | center under State and federal law. |
15 | | (7) The term of a student's participation in a remote |
16 | | educational program may not extend for longer than 12 |
17 | | months, unless the term is renewed by the school district. |
18 | | The district may only renew a student's participation in a |
19 | | remote educational program following an evaluation of the |
20 | | student's progress in the program, a determination that the |
21 | | student's continuation in the program will best serve the |
22 | | student's individual learning needs, and an amendment to |
23 | | the student's written remote educational plan addressing |
24 | | any changes for the upcoming term of the program. |
25 | | For purposes of this Section, a remote educational program |
26 | | does not include instruction delivered to students through an |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 211 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | e-learning program approved under Section 10-20.56 of this |
2 | | Code. |
3 | | (b) A school district may, by resolution of its school |
4 | | board, establish a remote educational program. |
5 | | (c) Clock hours of instruction by students in a remote |
6 | | educational program meeting the requirements of this Section |
7 | | may be claimed by the school district and shall be counted as |
8 | | school work for general State aid purposes in accordance with |
9 | | and subject to the limitations of Section 18-8.05 of this Code |
10 | | or evidence-based funding purposes in accordance with and |
11 | | subject to the limitations of Section 18-8.15 of this Code . |
12 | | (d) The impact of remote educational programs on wages, |
13 | | hours, and terms and conditions of employment of educational |
14 | | employees within the school district shall be subject to local |
15 | | collective bargaining agreements. |
16 | | (e) The use of a home or other location outside of a school |
17 | | building for a remote educational program shall not cause the |
18 | | home or other location to be deemed a public school facility. |
19 | | (f) A remote educational program may be used, but is not |
20 | | required, for instruction delivered to a student in the home or |
21 | | other location outside of a school building that is not claimed |
22 | | for general State aid purposes under Section 18-8.05 of this |
23 | | Code or evidence-based funding purposes under Section 18-8.15 |
24 | | of this Code . |
25 | | (g) School districts that, pursuant to this Section, adopt |
26 | | a policy for a remote educational program must submit to the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 212 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | State Board of Education a copy of the policy and any |
2 | | amendments thereto, as well as data on student participation in |
3 | | a format specified by the State Board of Education. The State |
4 | | Board of Education may perform or contract with an outside |
5 | | entity to perform an evaluation of remote educational programs |
6 | | in this State. |
7 | | (h) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules |
8 | | necessary to ensure compliance by remote educational programs |
9 | | with the requirements of this Section and other applicable |
10 | | legal requirements.
|
11 | | (Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14; 99-193, eff. 7-30-15; |
12 | | 99-194, eff. 7-30-15; 99-642, eff. 7-28-16.) |
13 | | (105 ILCS 5/11E-135) |
14 | | Sec. 11E-135. Incentives. For districts reorganizing under |
15 | | this Article and for a district or districts that annex all of |
16 | | the territory of one or more entire other school districts in |
17 | | accordance with Article 7 of this Code, the following payments |
18 | | shall be made from appropriations made for these purposes: |
19 | | (a)(1) For a combined school district, as defined in |
20 | | Section 11E-20 of this Code, or for a unit district, as defined |
21 | | in Section 11E-25 of this Code, for its first year of |
22 | | existence, the general State aid and supplemental general State |
23 | | aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or the |
24 | | evidence-based funding calculated under Section 18-8.15 of |
25 | | this Code, as applicable, shall be computed for the new |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 213 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | district and for the previously existing districts for which |
2 | | property is totally included within the new district. If the |
3 | | computation on the basis of the previously existing districts |
4 | | is greater, a supplementary payment equal to the difference |
5 | | shall be made for the first 4 years of existence of the new |
6 | | district. |
7 | | (2) For a school district that annexes all of the territory |
8 | | of one or more entire other school districts as defined in |
9 | | Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during which the |
10 | | change of boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes |
11 | | effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9 of |
12 | | this Code, the general State aid and supplemental general State |
13 | | aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or the |
14 | | evidence-based funding calculated under Section 18-8.15 of |
15 | | this Code, as applicable, shall be computed for the annexing |
16 | | district as constituted after the annexation and for the |
17 | | annexing and each annexed district as constituted prior to the |
18 | | annexation; and if the computation on the basis of the annexing |
19 | | and annexed districts as constituted prior to the annexation is |
20 | | greater, then a supplementary payment equal to the difference |
21 | | shall be made for the first 4 years of existence of the |
22 | | annexing school district as constituted upon the annexation. |
23 | | (3) For 2 or more school districts that annex all of the |
24 | | territory of one or more entire other school districts, as |
25 | | defined in Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during |
26 | | which the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 214 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | becomes effective for all purposes, as determined under Section |
2 | | 7-9 of this Code, the general State aid and supplemental |
3 | | general State aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code |
4 | | or the evidence-based funding calculated under Section 18-8.15 |
5 | | of this Code, as applicable, shall be computed for each |
6 | | annexing district as constituted after the annexation and for |
7 | | each annexing and annexed district as constituted prior to the |
8 | | annexation; and if the aggregate of the general State aid and |
9 | | supplemental general State aid or evidence-based funding, as |
10 | | applicable, as so computed for the annexing districts as |
11 | | constituted after the annexation is less than the aggregate of |
12 | | the general State aid and supplemental general State aid or |
13 | | evidence-based funding, as applicable, as so computed for the |
14 | | annexing and annexed districts, as constituted prior to the |
15 | | annexation, then a supplementary payment equal to the |
16 | | difference shall be made and allocated between or among the |
17 | | annexing districts, as constituted upon the annexation, for the |
18 | | first 4 years of their existence. The total difference payment |
19 | | shall be allocated between or among the annexing districts in |
20 | | the same ratio as the pupil enrollment from that portion of the |
21 | | annexed district or districts that is annexed to each annexing |
22 | | district bears to the total pupil enrollment from the entire |
23 | | annexed district or districts, as such pupil enrollment is |
24 | | determined for the school year last ending prior to the date |
25 | | when the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation |
26 | | becomes effective for all purposes. The amount of the total |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 215 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | difference payment and the amount thereof to be allocated to |
2 | | the annexing districts shall be computed by the State Board of |
3 | | Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other data that |
4 | | shall be certified to the State Board of Education, on forms |
5 | | that it shall provide for that purpose, by the regional |
6 | | superintendent of schools for each educational service region |
7 | | in which the annexing and annexed districts are located. |
8 | | (4) For a school district conversion, as defined in Section |
9 | | 11E-15 of this Code, or a multi-unit conversion, as defined in |
10 | | subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if in their |
11 | | first year of existence the newly created elementary districts |
12 | | and the newly created high school district, from a school |
13 | | district conversion, or the newly created elementary district |
14 | | or districts and newly created combined high school - unit |
15 | | district, from a multi-unit conversion, qualify for less |
16 | | general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or |
17 | | evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15 of this Code than |
18 | | would have been payable under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15, as |
19 | | applicable, for that same year to the previously existing |
20 | | districts, then a supplementary payment equal to that |
21 | | difference shall be made for the first 4 years of existence of |
22 | | the newly created districts. The aggregate amount of each |
23 | | supplementary payment shall be allocated among the newly |
24 | | created districts in the proportion that the deemed pupil |
25 | | enrollment in each district during its first year of existence |
26 | | bears to the actual aggregate pupil enrollment in all of the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 216 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | districts during their first year of existence. For purposes of |
2 | | each allocation: |
3 | | (A) the deemed pupil enrollment of the newly created |
4 | | high school district from a school district conversion |
5 | | shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for |
6 | | its first year of existence multiplied by 1.25; |
7 | | (B) the deemed pupil enrollment of each newly created |
8 | | elementary district from a school district conversion |
9 | | shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for |
10 | | its first year of existence reduced by an amount equal to |
11 | | the product obtained when the amount by which the newly |
12 | | created high school district's deemed pupil enrollment |
13 | | exceeds its actual pupil enrollment for its first year of |
14 | | existence is multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of |
15 | | which is the actual pupil enrollment of the newly created |
16 | | elementary district for its first year of existence and the |
17 | | denominator of which is the actual aggregate pupil |
18 | | enrollment of all of the newly created elementary districts |
19 | | for their first year of existence; |
20 | | (C) the deemed high school pupil enrollment of the |
21 | | newly created combined high school - unit district from a |
22 | | multi-unit conversion shall be an amount equal to its |
23 | | actual grades 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for its first |
24 | | year of existence multiplied by 1.25; and |
25 | | (D) the deemed elementary pupil enrollment of each |
26 | | newly created district from a multi-unit conversion shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 217 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be an amount equal to each district's actual grade K |
2 | | through 8 pupil enrollment for its first year of existence, |
3 | | reduced by an amount equal to the product obtained when the |
4 | | amount by which the newly created combined high school - |
5 | | unit district's deemed high school pupil enrollment |
6 | | exceeds its actual grade 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for |
7 | | its first year of existence is multiplied by a fraction, |
8 | | the numerator of which is the actual grade K through 8 |
9 | | pupil enrollment of each newly created district for its |
10 | | first year of existence and the denominator of which is the |
11 | | actual aggregate grade K through 8 pupil enrollment of all |
12 | | such newly created districts for their first year of |
13 | | existence. |
14 | |
The aggregate amount of each supplementary payment under |
15 | | this subdivision (4) and the amount thereof to be allocated to |
16 | | the newly created districts shall be computed by the State |
17 | | Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other |
18 | | data, which shall be certified to the State Board of Education, |
19 | | on forms that it shall provide for that purpose, by the |
20 | | regional superintendent of schools for each educational |
21 | | service region in which the newly created districts are |
22 | | located.
|
23 | | (5) For a partial elementary unit district, as defined in |
24 | | subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if, in |
25 | | the first year of existence, the newly created partial |
26 | | elementary unit district qualifies for less general State aid |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 218 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | and supplemental general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of |
2 | | this Code or less evidence-based funding under Section 18-8.15 |
3 | | of this Code, as applicable, than would have been payable under |
4 | | those Sections that Section for that same year to the |
5 | | previously existing districts that formed the partial |
6 | | elementary unit district, then a supplementary payment equal to |
7 | | that difference shall be made to the partial elementary unit |
8 | | district for the first 4 years of existence of that newly |
9 | | created district. |
10 | | (6) For an elementary opt-in, as described in subsection |
11 | | (d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the general State aid or |
12 | | evidence-based funding difference shall be computed in |
13 | | accordance with paragraph (5) of this subsection (a) as if the |
14 | | elementary opt-in was included in an optional elementary unit |
15 | | district at the optional elementary unit district's original |
16 | | effective date. If the calculation in this paragraph (6) is |
17 | | less than that calculated in paragraph (5) of this subsection |
18 | | (a) at the optional elementary unit district's original |
19 | | effective date, then no adjustments may be made. If the |
20 | | calculation in this paragraph (6) is more than that calculated |
21 | | in paragraph (5) of this subsection (a) at the optional |
22 | | elementary unit district's original effective date, then the |
23 | | excess must be paid as follows: |
24 | | (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
25 | | one year after the effective date for the optional |
26 | | elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 219 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
2 | | each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
3 | | elementary opt-in. |
4 | | (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
5 | | 2 years after the effective date for the optional |
6 | | elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess |
7 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
8 | | each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
9 | | elementary opt-in. |
10 | | (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
11 | | 3 years after the effective date for the optional |
12 | | elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess |
13 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
14 | | each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
15 | | elementary opt-in. |
16 | | (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
17 | | 4 years after the effective date for the optional |
18 | | elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess |
19 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
20 | | each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
21 | | elementary opt-in. |
22 | | (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
23 | | 5 years after the effective date for the optional |
24 | | elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
25 | | district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
26 | | to the elementary opt-in. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 220 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (6.5) For a school district that annexes territory detached |
2 | | from another school district whereby the enrollment of the |
3 | | annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of the |
4 | | annexation, for the first year during which the change of |
5 | | boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes effective |
6 | | for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of this Code, |
7 | | the general State aid and supplemental general State aid or |
8 | | evidence-based funding, as applicable, calculated under this |
9 | | Section shall be computed for the district gaining territory |
10 | | and the district losing territory as constituted after the |
11 | | annexation and for the same districts as constituted prior to |
12 | | the annexation; and if the aggregate of the general State aid |
13 | | and supplemental general State aid or evidence-based funding, |
14 | | as applicable, as so computed for the district gaining |
15 | | territory and the district losing territory as constituted |
16 | | after the annexation is less than the aggregate of the general |
17 | | State aid and supplemental general State aid or evidence-based |
18 | | funding, as applicable, as so computed for the district gaining |
19 | | territory and the district losing territory as constituted |
20 | | prior to the annexation, then a supplementary payment shall be |
21 | | made to the annexing district for the first 4 years of |
22 | | existence after the annexation, equal to the difference |
23 | | multiplied by the ratio of student enrollment in the territory |
24 | | detached to the total student enrollment in the district losing |
25 | | territory for the year prior to the effective date of the |
26 | | annexation. The amount of the total difference and the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 221 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | proportion paid to the annexing district shall be computed by |
2 | | the State Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment |
3 | | and other data that must be submitted to the State Board of |
4 | | Education in accordance with Section 7-14A of this Code. The |
5 | | changes to this Section made by Public Act 95-707
are intended |
6 | | to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation taking |
7 | | effect on or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that are |
8 | | eligible for payments under this paragraph (6.5) and that are |
9 | | effective on or after July 1, 2004, but before January 11, 2008 |
10 | | (the effective date of Public Act 95-707), the first required |
11 | | yearly payment under this paragraph (6.5) shall be paid in the |
12 | | fiscal year of January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public |
13 | | Act 95-707). Subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid |
14 | | in subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under |
15 | | this paragraph (6.5) is complete. |
16 | | (7) Claims for financial assistance under this subsection |
17 | | (a) may not be recomputed except as expressly provided under |
18 | | Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code. |
19 | | (8) Any supplementary payment made under this subsection |
20 | | (a) must be treated as separate from all other payments made |
21 | | pursuant to Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code. |
22 | | (b)(1) After the formation of a combined school district, |
23 | | as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, or a unit district, |
24 | | as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a computation shall |
25 | | be made to determine the difference between the salaries |
26 | | effective in each of the previously existing districts on June |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 222 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 30, prior to the creation of the new district. For the first 4 |
2 | | years after the formation of the new district, a supplementary |
3 | | State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the new district equal |
4 | | to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by |
5 | | each of the certificated members of the new district, while |
6 | | employed in one of the previously existing districts during the |
7 | | year immediately preceding the formation of the new district, |
8 | | and the sum of the salaries those certificated members would |
9 | | have been paid during the year immediately prior to the |
10 | | formation of the new district if placed on the salary schedule |
11 | | of the previously existing district with the highest salary |
12 | | schedule. |
13 | | (2) After the territory of one or more school districts is |
14 | | annexed by one or more other school districts as defined in |
15 | | Article 7 of this Code, a computation shall be made to |
16 | | determine the difference between the salaries effective in each |
17 | | annexed district and in the annexing district or districts as |
18 | | they were each constituted on June 30 preceding the date when |
19 | | the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became |
20 | | effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9 of |
21 | | this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a |
22 | | supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to each |
23 | | annexing district as constituted after the annexation equal to |
24 | | the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by each |
25 | | of the certificated members of the annexing district as |
26 | | constituted after the annexation, while employed in an annexed |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 223 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | or annexing district during the year immediately preceding the |
2 | | annexation, and the sum of the salaries those certificated |
3 | | members would have been paid during the immediately preceding |
4 | | year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the |
5 | | annexing or annexed districts had the highest salary schedule |
6 | | during the immediately preceding year. |
7 | | (3) For each new high school district formed under a school |
8 | | district conversion, as defined in Section 11E-15 of this Code, |
9 | | the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4 years equal |
10 | | to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by |
11 | | each certified member of the new high school district, while |
12 | | employed in one of the previously existing districts, and the |
13 | | sum of the salaries those certified members would have been |
14 | | paid if placed on the salary schedule of the previously |
15 | | existing district with the highest salary schedule. |
16 | | (4) For each newly created partial elementary unit |
17 | | district, the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4 |
18 | | years equal to the difference between the sum of the salaries |
19 | | earned by each certified member of the newly created partial |
20 | | elementary unit district, while employed in one of the |
21 | | previously existing districts that formed the partial |
22 | | elementary unit district, and the sum of the salaries those |
23 | | certified members would have been paid if placed on the salary |
24 | | schedule of the previously existing district with the highest |
25 | | salary schedule. The salary schedules used in the calculation |
26 | | shall be those in effect in the previously existing districts |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 224 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | for the school year prior to the creation of the new partial |
2 | | elementary unit district. |
3 | | (5) For an elementary district opt-in, as described in |
4 | | subsection (d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the salary |
5 | | difference incentive shall be computed in accordance with |
6 | | paragraph (4) of this subsection (b) as if the opted-in |
7 | | elementary district was included in the optional elementary |
8 | | unit district at the optional elementary unit district's |
9 | | original effective date. If the calculation in this paragraph |
10 | | (5) is less than that calculated in paragraph (4) of this |
11 | | subsection (b) at the optional elementary unit district's |
12 | | original effective date, then no adjustments may be made. If |
13 | | the calculation in this paragraph (5) is more than that |
14 | | calculated in paragraph (4) of this subsection (b) at the |
15 | | optional elementary unit district's original effective date, |
16 | | then the excess must be paid as follows: |
17 | | (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
18 | | one year after the effective date for the optional |
19 | | elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess |
20 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
21 | | each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
22 | | elementary opt-in. |
23 | | (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
24 | | 2 years after the effective date for the optional |
25 | | elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess |
26 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 225 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
2 | | elementary opt-in. |
3 | | (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
4 | | 3 years after the effective date for the optional |
5 | | elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess |
6 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
7 | | each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
8 | | elementary opt-in. |
9 | | (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
10 | | 4 years after the effective date for the partial elementary |
11 | | unit district, 25% of the calculated excess shall be paid |
12 | | to the optional elementary unit district in each of the |
13 | | first 4 years after the effective date of the elementary |
14 | | opt-in. |
15 | | (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
16 | | 5 years after the effective date for the optional |
17 | | elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
18 | | district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
19 | | to the elementary opt-in. |
20 | | (5.5) After the formation of a cooperative high school by 2 |
21 | | or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of this Code, |
22 | | a computation shall be made to determine the difference between |
23 | | the salaries effective in each of the previously existing high |
24 | | schools on June 30 prior to the formation of the cooperative |
25 | | high school. For the first 4 years after the formation of the |
26 | | cooperative high school, a supplementary State aid |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 226 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | reimbursement shall be paid to the cooperative high school |
2 | | equal to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned |
3 | | by each of the certificated members of the cooperative high |
4 | | school while employed in one of the previously existing high |
5 | | schools during the year immediately preceding the formation of |
6 | | the cooperative high school and the sum of the salaries those |
7 | | certificated members would have been paid during the year |
8 | | immediately prior to the formation of the cooperative high |
9 | | school if placed on the salary schedule of the previously |
10 | | existing high school with the highest salary schedule. |
11 | | (5.10) After the annexation of territory detached from
|
12 | | another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
|
13 | | district increases by 90% or more as a result of the
|
14 | | annexation, a computation shall be made to determine the
|
15 | | difference between the salaries effective in the district
|
16 | | gaining territory and the district losing territory as they
|
17 | | each were constituted on June 30 preceding the date when the
|
18 | | change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became
|
19 | | effective for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of
|
20 | | this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a
|
21 | | supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
|
22 | | annexing district equal to the difference between the sum of
|
23 | | the salaries earned by each of the certificated members of the
|
24 | | annexing district as constituted after the annexation while
|
25 | | employed in the district gaining territory or the district
|
26 | | losing territory during the year immediately preceding the
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 227 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | annexation and the sum of the salaries those certificated
|
2 | | members would have been paid during such immediately preceding
|
3 | | year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the
|
4 | | district gaining territory or district losing territory had the
|
5 | | highest salary schedule during the immediately preceding year.
|
6 | | To be eligible for supplementary State aid reimbursement under
|
7 | | this Section, the intergovernmental agreement to be submitted
|
8 | | pursuant to Section 7-14A of this Code must show that staff
|
9 | | members were transferred from the control of the district
|
10 | | losing territory to the control of the district gaining
|
11 | | territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
|
12 | | by Public Act 95-707
are
intended to be retroactive and |
13 | | applicable to any annexation
taking effect on or after July 1, |
14 | | 2004. For annexations that are eligible for payments under this |
15 | | paragraph (5.10) and that are effective on or after July 1, |
16 | | 2004, but before January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public |
17 | | Act 95-707), the first required yearly payment under this |
18 | | paragraph (5.10) shall be paid in the fiscal year of January |
19 | | 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707). Subsequent |
20 | | required yearly payments shall be paid in subsequent fiscal |
21 | | years until the payment obligation under this paragraph (5.10) |
22 | | is complete.
|
23 | | (5.15)
After the deactivation of a school facility in |
24 | | accordance with Section 10-22.22b of this Code, a computation |
25 | | shall be made to determine the difference between the salaries |
26 | | effective in the sending school district and each receiving |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 228 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | school district on June 30 prior to the deactivation of the |
2 | | school facility. For the lesser of the first 4 years after the |
3 | | deactivation of the school facility or the length of the |
4 | | deactivation agreement, including any renewals of the original |
5 | | deactivation agreement, a supplementary State aid |
6 | | reimbursement shall be paid to each receiving district equal to |
7 | | the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by each |
8 | | of the certificated members transferred to that receiving |
9 | | district as a result of the deactivation while employed in the |
10 | | sending district during the year immediately preceding the |
11 | | deactivation and the sum of the salaries those certificated |
12 | | members would have been paid during the year immediately |
13 | | preceding the deactivation if placed on the salary schedule of |
14 | | the sending or receiving district with the highest salary |
15 | | schedule. |
16 | | (6) The supplementary State aid reimbursement under this |
17 | | subsection (b) shall be treated as separate from all other |
18 | | payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. In the |
19 | | case of the formation of a new district or cooperative high |
20 | | school or a deactivation, reimbursement shall begin during the |
21 | | first year of operation of the new district or cooperative high |
22 | | school or the first year of the deactivation, and in the case |
23 | | of an annexation of the territory of one or more school |
24 | | districts by one or more other school districts or the |
25 | | annexation of territory detached from a school district whereby
|
26 | | the enrollment of the annexing district increases by 90% or
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 229 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | more as a result of the annexation, reimbursement shall begin |
2 | | during the first year when the change in boundaries |
3 | | attributable to the annexation becomes effective for all |
4 | | purposes as determined pursuant to Section 7-9 of this Code, |
5 | | except that for an annexation of territory detached from a |
6 | | school district that is effective on or after July 1, 2004, but |
7 | | before January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act |
8 | | 95-707), whereby the enrollment of the annexing district |
9 | | increases by 90% or more as a result of the annexation, |
10 | | reimbursement shall begin during the fiscal year of January 11, |
11 | | 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707). Each year that |
12 | | the new, annexing, or receiving district or cooperative high |
13 | | school, as the case may be, is entitled to receive |
14 | | reimbursement, the number of eligible certified members who are |
15 | | employed on October 1 in the district or cooperative high |
16 | | school shall be certified to the State Board of Education on |
17 | | prescribed forms by October 15 and payment shall be made on or |
18 | | before November 15 of that year. |
19 | | (c)(1) For the first year after the formation of a combined |
20 | | school district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code or a |
21 | | unit district, as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a |
22 | | computation shall be made totaling each previously existing |
23 | | district's audited fund balances in the educational fund, |
24 | | working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and |
25 | | transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the |
26 | | referendum for the creation of the new district. The new |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 230 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | district shall be paid supplementary State aid equal to the sum |
2 | | of the differences between the deficit of the previously |
3 | | existing district with the smallest deficit and the deficits of |
4 | | each of the other previously existing districts. |
5 | | (2) For the first year after the annexation of all of the |
6 | | territory of one or more entire school districts by another |
7 | | school district, as defined in Article 7 of this Code, |
8 | | computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior |
9 | | to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the |
10 | | annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision issued by the |
11 | | regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this |
12 | | Code, notwithstanding any effort to seek administrative review |
13 | | of the decision, totaling the annexing district's and totaling |
14 | | each annexed district's audited fund balances in their |
15 | | respective educational, working cash, operations and |
16 | | maintenance, and transportation funds. The annexing district |
17 | | as constituted after the annexation shall be paid supplementary |
18 | | State aid equal to the sum of the differences between the |
19 | | deficit of whichever of the annexing or annexed districts as |
20 | | constituted prior to the annexation had the smallest deficit |
21 | | and the deficits of each of the other districts as constituted |
22 | | prior to the annexation. |
23 | | (3) For the first year after the annexation of all of the |
24 | | territory of one or more entire school districts by 2 or more |
25 | | other school districts, as defined by Article 7 of this Code, |
26 | | computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 231 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the |
2 | | annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision of the |
3 | | regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this |
4 | | Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative review of |
5 | | the decision, totaling each annexing and annexed district's |
6 | | audited fund balances in their respective educational, working |
7 | | cash, operations and maintenance, and transportation funds. |
8 | | The annexing districts as constituted after the annexation |
9 | | shall be paid supplementary State aid, allocated as provided in |
10 | | this paragraph (3), in an aggregate amount equal to the sum of |
11 | | the differences between the deficit of whichever of the |
12 | | annexing or annexed districts as constituted prior to the |
13 | | annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficits of each of |
14 | | the other districts as constituted prior to the annexation. The |
15 | | aggregate amount of the supplementary State aid payable under |
16 | | this paragraph (3) shall be allocated between or among the |
17 | | annexing districts as follows: |
18 | | (A) the regional superintendent of schools for each |
19 | | educational service region in which an annexed district is |
20 | | located prior to the annexation shall certify to the State |
21 | | Board of Education, on forms that it shall provide for that |
22 | | purpose, the value of all taxable property in each annexed |
23 | | district, as last equalized or assessed by the Department |
24 | | of Revenue prior to the annexation, and the equalized |
25 | | assessed value of each part of the annexed district that |
26 | | was annexed to or included as a part of an annexing |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 232 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | district; |
2 | | (B) using equalized assessed values as certified by the |
3 | | regional superintendent of schools under clause (A) of this |
4 | | paragraph (3), the combined audited fund balance deficit of |
5 | | each annexed district as determined under this Section |
6 | | shall be apportioned between or among the annexing |
7 | | districts in the same ratio as the equalized assessed value |
8 | | of that part of the annexed district that was annexed to or |
9 | | included as a part of an annexing district bears to the |
10 | | total equalized assessed value of the annexed district; and |
11 | | (C) the aggregate supplementary State aid payment |
12 | | under this paragraph (3) shall be allocated between or |
13 | | among, and shall be paid to, the annexing districts in the |
14 | | same ratio as the sum of the combined audited fund balance |
15 | | deficit of each annexing district as constituted prior to |
16 | | the annexation, plus all combined audited fund balance |
17 | | deficit amounts apportioned to that annexing district |
18 | | under clause (B) of this subsection, bears to the aggregate |
19 | | of the combined audited fund balance deficits of all of the |
20 | | annexing and annexed districts as constituted prior to the |
21 | | annexation. |
22 | | (4) For the new elementary districts and new high school |
23 | | district formed through a school district conversion, as |
24 | | defined in Section 11E-15 of this Code or the new elementary |
25 | | district or districts and new combined high school - unit |
26 | | district formed through a multi-unit conversion, as defined in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 233 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, a computation |
2 | | shall be made totaling each previously existing district's |
3 | | audited fund balances in the educational fund, working cash |
4 | | fund, operations and maintenance fund, and transportation fund |
5 | | for the year ending June 30 prior to the referendum |
6 | | establishing the new districts. In the first year of the new |
7 | | districts, the State shall make a one-time supplementary |
8 | | payment equal to the sum of the differences between the deficit |
9 | | of the previously existing district with the smallest deficit |
10 | | and the deficits of each of the other previously existing |
11 | | districts. A district with a combined balance among the 4 funds |
12 | | that is positive shall be considered to have a deficit of zero. |
13 | | The supplementary payment shall be allocated among the newly |
14 | | formed high school and elementary districts in the manner |
15 | | provided by the petition for the formation of the districts, in |
16 | | the form in which the petition is approved by the regional |
17 | | superintendent of schools or State Superintendent of Education |
18 | | under Section 11E-50 of this Code. |
19 | | (5) For each newly created partial elementary unit |
20 | | district, as defined in subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30 |
21 | | of this Code, a computation shall be made totaling the audited |
22 | | fund balances of each previously existing district that formed |
23 | | the new partial elementary unit district in the educational |
24 | | fund, working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and |
25 | | transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the |
26 | | referendum for the formation of the partial elementary unit |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 234 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | district. In the first year of the new partial elementary unit |
2 | | district, the State shall make a one-time supplementary payment |
3 | | to the new district equal to the sum of the differences between |
4 | | the deficit of the previously existing district with the |
5 | | smallest deficit and the deficits of each of the other |
6 | | previously existing districts. A district with a combined |
7 | | balance among the 4 funds that is positive shall be considered |
8 | | to have a deficit of zero. |
9 | | (6) For an elementary opt-in as defined in subsection (d) |
10 | | of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the deficit fund balance |
11 | | incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (5) of |
12 | | this subsection (c) as if the opted-in elementary was included |
13 | | in the optional elementary unit district at the optional |
14 | | elementary unit district's original effective date. If the |
15 | | calculation in this paragraph (6) is less than that calculated |
16 | | in paragraph (5) of this subsection (c) at the optional |
17 | | elementary unit district's original effective date, then no |
18 | | adjustments may be made. If the calculation in this paragraph |
19 | | (6) is more than that calculated in paragraph (5) of this |
20 | | subsection (c) at the optional elementary unit district's |
21 | | original effective date, then the excess must be paid as |
22 | | follows: |
23 | | (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
24 | | one year after the effective date for the optional |
25 | | elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess |
26 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 235 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
2 | | opt-in. |
3 | | (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
4 | | 2 years after the effective date for the optional |
5 | | elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess |
6 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
7 | | the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
8 | | opt-in. |
9 | | (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
10 | | 3 years after the effective date for the optional |
11 | | elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess |
12 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
13 | | the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
14 | | opt-in. |
15 | | (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
16 | | 4 years after the effective date for the optional |
17 | | elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess |
18 | | shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
19 | | the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
20 | | opt-in. |
21 | | (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
22 | | 5 years after the effective date for the optional |
23 | | elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
24 | | district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
25 | | to the elementary opt-in. |
26 | | (6.5) For the first year after the annexation of territory
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 236 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | detached from another school district whereby the enrollment of
|
2 | | the annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of
|
3 | | the annexation, a computation shall be made totaling the
|
4 | | audited fund balances of the district gaining territory and the
|
5 | | audited fund balances of the district losing territory in the
|
6 | | educational fund, working cash fund, operations and
|
7 | | maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the year ending
|
8 | | June 30 prior to the date that the change of boundaries
|
9 | | attributable to the annexation is allowed by the affirmative
|
10 | | decision of the regional board of school trustees under Section
|
11 | | 7-6 of this Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative
|
12 | | review of the decision. The annexing district as constituted
|
13 | | after the annexation shall be paid supplementary State aid
|
14 | | equal to the difference between the deficit of whichever
|
15 | | district included in this calculation as constituted prior to
|
16 | | the annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficit of each
|
17 | | other district included in this calculation as constituted
|
18 | | prior to the annexation, multiplied by the ratio of equalized
|
19 | | assessed value of the territory detached to the total equalized
|
20 | | assessed value of the district losing territory. The regional
|
21 | | superintendent of schools for the educational service region in
|
22 | | which a district losing territory is located prior to the
|
23 | | annexation shall certify to the State Board of Education the
|
24 | | value of all taxable property in the district losing territory
|
25 | | and the value of all taxable property in the territory being
|
26 | | detached, as last equalized or assessed by the Department of
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 237 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Revenue prior to the annexation. To be eligible for
|
2 | | supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
|
3 | | intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
|
4 | | Section 7-14A of this Code must show that fund balances were
|
5 | | transferred from the district losing territory to the district
|
6 | | gaining territory in the annexation. The changes to this
|
7 | | Section made by Public Act 95-707
are intended to be |
8 | | retroactive and applicable to any
annexation taking effect on |
9 | | or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that are eligible for |
10 | | payments under this paragraph (6.5) and that are effective on |
11 | | or after July 1, 2004, but before January 11, 2008 (the |
12 | | effective date of Public Act 95-707), the required payment |
13 | | under this paragraph (6.5) shall be paid in the fiscal year of |
14 | | January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707).
|
15 | | (7) For purposes of any calculation required under |
16 | | paragraph (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), or (6.5) of this |
17 | | subsection (c), a district with a combined fund balance that is |
18 | | positive shall be considered to have a deficit of zero. For |
19 | | purposes of determining each district's audited fund balances |
20 | | in its educational fund, working cash fund, operations and |
21 | | maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the specified |
22 | | year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3), |
23 | | (4), (5), (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c), the balance of |
24 | | each fund shall be deemed decreased by an amount equal to the |
25 | | amount of the annual property tax theretofore levied in the |
26 | | fund by the district for collection and payment to the district |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 238 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | during the calendar year in which the June 30 fell, but only to |
2 | | the extent that the tax so levied in the fund actually was |
3 | | received by the district on or before or comprised a part of |
4 | | the fund on such June 30. For purposes of determining each |
5 | | district's audited fund balances, a calculation shall be made |
6 | | for each fund to determine the average for the 3 years prior to |
7 | | the specified year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs |
8 | | (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c), |
9 | | of the district's expenditures in the categories "purchased |
10 | | services", "supplies and materials", and "capital outlay", as |
11 | | those categories are defined in rules of the State Board of |
12 | | Education. If this 3-year average is less than the district's |
13 | | expenditures in these categories for the specified year ending |
14 | | June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), |
15 | | (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c), then the 3-year average |
16 | | shall be used in calculating the amounts payable under this |
17 | | Section in place of the amounts shown in these categories for |
18 | | the specified year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs |
19 | | (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c). |
20 | | Any deficit because of State aid not yet received may not be |
21 | | considered in determining the June 30 deficits. The same basis |
22 | | of accounting shall be used by all previously existing |
23 | | districts and by all annexing or annexed districts, as |
24 | | constituted prior to the annexation, in making any computation |
25 | | required under paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (6), and |
26 | | (6.5) of this subsection (c). |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 239 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (8) The supplementary State aid payments under this |
2 | | subsection (c) shall be treated as separate from all other |
3 | | payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. |
4 | | (d)(1) Following the formation of a combined school |
5 | | district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, a new unit |
6 | | district, as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a new |
7 | | elementary district or districts and a new high school district |
8 | | formed through a school district conversion, as defined in |
9 | | Section 11E-15 of this Code, a new partial elementary unit |
10 | | district, as defined in Section 11E-30 of this Code, or a new |
11 | | elementary district or districts formed through a multi-unit |
12 | | conversion, as defined in subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of |
13 | | this Code, or the annexation of all of the territory of one or |
14 | | more entire school districts by one or more other school |
15 | | districts, as defined in Article 7 of this Code, a |
16 | | supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid for the |
17 | | number of school years determined under the following table to |
18 | | each new or annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for |
19 | | each certified employee who is employed by the district on a |
20 | | full-time basis for the regular term of the school year: |
|
21 | | Reorganized District's Rank |
Reorganized District's Rank |
|
22 | | by type of district (unit, |
in Average Daily Attendance |
|
23 | | high school, elementary) |
By Quintile |
|
24 | | in Equalized Assessed Value |
|
|
|
|
25 | | Per Pupil by Quintile |
|
|
|
|
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 240 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | |
|
|
3rd, 4th, |
|
2 | | |
1st |
2nd |
or 5th |
|
3 | | |
Quintile |
Quintile |
Quintile |
|
4 | | 1st Quintile |
1 year |
1 year |
1 year |
|
5 | | 2nd Quintile |
1 year |
2 years |
2 years |
|
6 | | 3rd Quintile |
2 years |
3 years |
3 years |
|
7 | | 4th Quintile |
2 years |
3 years |
3 years |
|
8 | | 5th Quintile |
2 years |
3 years |
3 years |
|
9 | | The State Board of Education shall make a one-time calculation |
10 | | of a reorganized district's quintile ranks. The average daily |
11 | | attendance used in this calculation shall be the best 3 months' |
12 | | average daily attendance for the district's first year. The |
13 | | equalized assessed value per pupil shall be the district's real |
14 | | property equalized assessed value used in calculating the |
15 | | district's first-year general State aid claim, under Section |
16 | | 18-8.05 of this Code, or first-year evidence-based funding |
17 | | claim, under Section 18-8.15 of this Code, as applicable, |
18 | | divided by the best 3 months' average daily attendance. |
19 | | No annexing or resulting school district shall be entitled |
20 | | to supplementary State aid under this subsection (d) unless the |
21 | | district acquires at least 30% of the average daily attendance |
22 | | of the district from which the territory is being detached or |
23 | | divided. |
24 | | If a district results from multiple reorganizations that |
25 | | would otherwise qualify the district for multiple payments |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 241 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | under this subsection (d) in any year, then the district shall |
2 | | receive a single payment only for that year based solely on the |
3 | | most recent reorganization. |
4 | | (2) For an elementary opt-in, as defined in subsection (d) |
5 | | of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the full-time certified staff |
6 | | incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (1) of |
7 | | this subsection (d), equal to the sum of $4,000 for each |
8 | | certified employee of the elementary district that opts-in who |
9 | | is employed by the optional elementary unit district on a |
10 | | full-time basis for the regular term of the school year. The |
11 | | calculation from this paragraph (2) must be paid as follows: |
12 | | (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
13 | | one year after the effective date for the optional |
14 | | elementary unit district, 100% of the amount calculated in |
15 | | this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
16 | | unit district for the number of years calculated in |
17 | | paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
18 | | elementary unit district's original effective date, |
19 | | starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
20 | | elementary opt-in. |
21 | | (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
22 | | 2 years after the effective date for the optional |
23 | | elementary unit district, 75% of the amount calculated in |
24 | | this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
25 | | unit district for the number of years calculated in |
26 | | paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 242 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | elementary unit district's original effective date, |
2 | | starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
3 | | elementary opt-in. |
4 | | (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
5 | | 3 years after the effective date for the optional |
6 | | elementary unit district, 50% of the amount calculated in |
7 | | this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
8 | | unit district for the number of years calculated in |
9 | | paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
10 | | elementary unit district's original effective date, |
11 | | starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
12 | | elementary opt-in. |
13 | | (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
14 | | 4 years after the effective date for the optional |
15 | | elementary unit district, 25% of the amount calculated in |
16 | | this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
17 | | unit district for the number of years calculated in |
18 | | paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
19 | | elementary unit district's original effective date, |
20 | | starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
21 | | elementary opt-in. |
22 | | (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
23 | | 5 years after the effective date for the optional |
24 | | elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
25 | | district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
26 | | to the elementary opt-in. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 243 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (2.5) Following the formation of a cooperative high school |
2 | | by 2 or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of this |
3 | | Code, a supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid for |
4 | | 3 school years to the cooperative high school equal to the sum |
5 | | of $4,000 for each certified employee who is employed by the |
6 | | cooperative high school on a full-time basis for the regular |
7 | | term of any such school year. If a cooperative high school |
8 | | results from multiple agreements that would otherwise qualify |
9 | | the cooperative high school for multiple payments under this |
10 | | Section in any year, the cooperative high school shall receive |
11 | | a single payment for that year based solely on the most recent |
12 | | agreement. |
13 | | (2.10) Following the annexation of territory detached from
|
14 | | another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
|
15 | | district increases 90% or more as a result of the annexation, a
|
16 | | supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
|
17 | | annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for each certified
|
18 | | employee who is employed by the annexing district on a
|
19 | | full-time basis and shall be calculated in accordance with
|
20 | | subsection (a) of this Section. To be eligible for
|
21 | | supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
|
22 | | intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
|
23 | | Section 7-14A of this Code must show that certified staff
|
24 | | members were transferred from the control of the district
|
25 | | losing territory to the control of the district gaining
|
26 | | territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 244 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | by Public Act 95-707
are
intended to be retroactive and |
2 | | applicable to any annexation
taking effect on or after July 1, |
3 | | 2004. For annexations that are eligible for payments under this |
4 | | paragraph (2.10) and that are effective on or after July 1, |
5 | | 2004, but before January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public |
6 | | Act 95-707), the first required yearly payment under this |
7 | | paragraph (2.10) shall be paid in the second fiscal year after |
8 | | January 11, 2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-707). Any |
9 | | subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid in subsequent |
10 | | fiscal years until the payment obligation under this paragraph |
11 | | (2.10) is complete.
|
12 | | (2.15)
Following the deactivation of a school facility in |
13 | | accordance with Section 10-22.22b of this Code, a supplementary |
14 | | State aid reimbursement shall be paid for the lesser of 3 |
15 | | school years or the length of the deactivation agreement, |
16 | | including any renewals of the original deactivation agreement, |
17 | | to each receiving school district equal to the sum of $4,000 |
18 | | for each certified employee who is employed by that receiving |
19 | | district on a full-time basis for the regular term of any such |
20 | | school year who was originally transferred to the control of |
21 | | that receiving district as a result of the deactivation. |
22 | | Receiving districts are eligible for payments under this |
23 | | paragraph (2.15)
based on the certified employees transferred |
24 | | to that receiving district as a result of the deactivation and |
25 | | are not required to receive at least 30% of the deactivating |
26 | | district's average daily attendance as required under |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 245 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) to be eligible for |
2 | | payments. |
3 | | (3) The supplementary State aid reimbursement payable |
4 | | under this subsection (d) shall be separate from and in |
5 | | addition to all other payments made to the district pursuant to |
6 | | any other Section of this Article. |
7 | | (4) During May of each school year for which a |
8 | | supplementary State aid reimbursement is to be paid to a new, |
9 | | annexing, or receiving school district or cooperative high |
10 | | school pursuant to this subsection (d), the school board or |
11 | | governing board shall certify to the State Board of Education, |
12 | | on forms furnished to the school board or governing board by |
13 | | the State Board of Education for purposes of this subsection |
14 | | (d), the number of certified employees for which the district |
15 | | or cooperative high school is entitled to reimbursement under |
16 | | this Section, together with the names, certificate numbers, and |
17 | | positions held by the certified employees. |
18 | | (5) Upon certification by the State Board of Education to |
19 | | the State Comptroller of the amount of the supplementary State |
20 | | aid reimbursement to which a school district or cooperative |
21 | | high school is entitled under this subsection (d), the State |
22 | | Comptroller shall draw his or her warrant upon the State |
23 | | Treasurer for the payment thereof to the school district or |
24 | | cooperative high school and shall promptly transmit the payment |
25 | | to the school district or cooperative high school through the |
26 | | appropriate school treasurer.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 246 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (Source: P.A. 95-331, eff. 8-21-07; 95-707, eff. 1-11-08; |
2 | | 95-903, eff. 8-25-08; 96-328, eff. 8-11-09.)
|
3 | | (105 ILCS 5/13A-8)
|
4 | | Sec. 13A-8. Funding.
|
5 | | (a) The State of Illinois shall provide funding for
the
|
6 | | alternative school programs within each educational service |
7 | | region and within
the Chicago public school system by line item |
8 | | appropriation made to the State
Board of Education for that |
9 | | purpose. This money, when appropriated, shall be
provided to |
10 | | the regional superintendent and to the Chicago Board of |
11 | | Education,
who shall establish a budget, including salaries, |
12 | | for their
alternative school programs.
Each program shall |
13 | | receive funding in the amount of $30,000 plus an amount
based |
14 | | on the ratio of the region's or Chicago's best 3 months' |
15 | | average daily
attendance in grades pre-kindergarten through 12 |
16 | | to the statewide totals of
these amounts. For purposes of this |
17 | | calculation, the best 3 months' average
daily attendance for |
18 | | each region or Chicago shall be calculated by adding to
the |
19 | | best 3 months' average
daily
attendance the number of |
20 | | low-income students identified in the most
recently available |
21 | | federal census multiplied by one-half times the percentage
of |
22 | | the
region's or Chicago's low-income students
to the State's |
23 | | total low-income students.
The State Board of Education shall |
24 | | retain
up to 1.1% of the appropriation to be used to provide |
25 | | technical assistance,
professional development, and |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 247 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | evaluations for the programs.
|
2 | | (a-5) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this |
3 | | Section, for the
1998-1999
fiscal year, the total amount |
4 | | distributed
under subsection (a) for an alternative school |
5 | | program shall be not less than
the total amount that was |
6 | | distributed under that subsection for that
alternative school |
7 | | program for the 1997-1998 fiscal year. If an alternative
school |
8 | | program is to receive a total distribution under subsection (a) |
9 | | for the
1998-1999 fiscal year that is less than the total
|
10 | | distribution that the program received under that subsection |
11 | | for the 1997-1998
fiscal year, that alternative school program |
12 | | shall also receive, from a
separate appropriation made for |
13 | | purposes of this subsection (a-5), a
supplementary
payment |
14 | | equal to the amount by which its total distribution under
|
15 | | subsection (a) for the 1997-1998 fiscal year exceeds the amount |
16 | | of the total
distribution that the alternative school program |
17 | | receives under that
subsection for the 1998-1999 fiscal year.
|
18 | | If the amount appropriated
for supplementary payments to |
19 | | alternative school programs under this subsection
(a-5)
is |
20 | | insufficient for that purpose, those supplementary payments |
21 | | shall be
prorated among the alternative school programs |
22 | | entitled to receive those
supplementary payments according to |
23 | | the aggregate amount of the appropriation
made for purposes of |
24 | | this subsection (a-5).
|
25 | | (b) An alternative school program shall be entitled to |
26 | | receive general
State aid as calculated in subsection (K) of
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 248 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 18-8.05 or evidence-based funding as calculated in |
2 | | subsection (g) of Section 18-8.15 upon filing a claim as
|
3 | | provided therein. Any time that a student who is enrolled in an |
4 | | alternative
school program spends in work-based learning, |
5 | | community service, or a similar
alternative educational |
6 | | setting shall be included in determining the student's
minimum |
7 | | number of clock hours of daily school work that constitute a |
8 | | day of
attendance for purposes of calculating general State aid |
9 | | or evidence-based funding .
|
10 | | (c) An alternative school program may receive additional |
11 | | funding from its
school districts in such amount as may be |
12 | | agreed upon by the parties and
necessary
to support the |
13 | | program. In addition, an alternative school program is
|
14 | | authorized to accept and expend gifts, legacies, and grants, |
15 | | including but not
limited to federal grants, from any source |
16 | | for purposes directly related to the
conduct and operation of |
17 | | the program.
|
18 | | (Source: P.A. 89-383, eff. 8-18-95; 89-629, eff. 8-9-96; |
19 | | 89-636, eff. 8-9-96;
90-14, eff. 7-1-97; 90-283, eff. 7-31-97; |
20 | | 90-802, eff. 12-15-98.)
|
21 | | (105 ILCS 5/13B-20.20)
|
22 | | Sec. 13B-20.20. Enrollment in other programs. High school |
23 | | equivalency testing
preparation programs are not eligible for |
24 | | funding under this Article. A
student
may enroll in a program |
25 | | approved under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code, as
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 249 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | appropriate, or
attend both the alternative learning |
2 | | opportunities program and the regular
school program to enhance |
3 | | student performance and facilitate on-time
graduation.
|
4 | | (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15 .)
|
5 | | (105 ILCS 5/13B-45)
|
6 | | Sec. 13B-45. Days and hours of attendance. An alternative |
7 | | learning
opportunities program
shall provide students with at |
8 | | least the minimum number of days of pupil
attendance required |
9 | | under Section 10-19 of this Code and the minimum number of
|
10 | | daily hours of school work required under Section 18-8.05 or |
11 | | 18-8.15 of this Code,
provided that the State Board may approve |
12 | | exceptions to these
requirements if the program meets all of |
13 | | the following conditions:
|
14 | | (1) The district plan submitted under Section |
15 | | 13B-25.15 of this Code
establishes that a program providing |
16 | | the required minimum number of days of
attendance or daily |
17 | | hours of school work would not serve the needs of the
|
18 | | program's students.
|
19 | | (2) Each day of attendance shall provide no fewer than |
20 | | 3 clock hours of
school work, as defined under paragraph |
21 | | (1) of subsection (F) of Section
18-8.05 of this Code.
|
22 | | (3) Each day of attendance that provides fewer than 5 |
23 | | clock hours of
school
work shall also provide supplementary |
24 | | services, including without limitation
work-based |
25 | | learning, student assistance programs, counseling, case |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 250 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | management,
health and fitness programs, or life-skills or |
2 | | conflict resolution training,
in order to provide a total |
3 | | daily program to the student of 5 clock hours. A
program |
4 | | may claim general State aid or evidence-based funding for |
5 | | up to 2 hours of the time each day that
a student is |
6 | | receiving
supplementary services.
|
7 | | (4) Each program shall provide no fewer than 174 days |
8 | | of actual pupil
attendance during the school term; however, |
9 | | approved evening programs that meet
the requirements of |
10 | | Section 13B-45 of this Code may offer less than 174 days
of |
11 | | actual pupil attendance during the school term.
|
12 | | (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
|
13 | | (105 ILCS 5/13B-50)
|
14 | | Sec. 13B-50. Eligibility to receive general State aid or |
15 | | evidence-based funding . In order to
receive general State aid |
16 | | or evidence-based funding ,
alternative learning opportunities |
17 | | programs must meet the requirements for
claiming general State
|
18 | | aid as specified in Section 18-8.05 of this Code or |
19 | | evidence-based funding as specified in Section 18-8.15 of this |
20 | | Code, as applicable , with the exception of the
length of the |
21 | | instructional
day, which may be less than 5 hours of school |
22 | | work if the program meets the
criteria set forth under
Sections |
23 | | 13B-50.5 and 13B-50.10 of this Code and if the program is |
24 | | approved by
the State Board.
|
25 | | (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 251 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (105 ILCS 5/13B-50.10)
|
2 | | Sec. 13B-50.10. Additional criteria for general State aid |
3 | | or evidence-based funding . In order to
claim general State aid |
4 | | or evidence-based funding ,
an alternative learning |
5 | | opportunities program must meet the following
criteria:
|
6 | | (1) Teacher professional development plans should include |
7 | | education in the
instruction
of at-risk students.
|
8 | | (2) Facilities must meet the health, life, and safety |
9 | | requirements in this
Code.
|
10 | | (3) The program must comply with all other State and |
11 | | federal laws
applicable to
education providers.
|
12 | | (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
|
13 | | (105 ILCS 5/13B-50.15)
|
14 | | Sec. 13B-50.15. Level of funding. Approved alternative |
15 | | learning
opportunities programs are
entitled to claim general |
16 | | State aid or evidence-based funding , subject to Sections |
17 | | 13B-50, 13B-50.5, and
13B-50.10 of this
Code. Approved programs |
18 | | operated by regional offices of education are entitled
to |
19 | | receive general
State aid at the foundation level of support. A |
20 | | school district or consortium
must ensure that an
approved |
21 | | program receives supplemental general State aid, |
22 | | transportation
reimbursements, and
special education |
23 | | resources, if appropriate, for students enrolled in the
|
24 | | program.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 252 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (Source: P.A. 92-42, eff. 1-1-02.)
|
2 | | (105 ILCS 5/14-7.02) (from Ch. 122, par. 14-7.02)
|
3 | | Sec. 14-7.02. Children attending private schools, public
|
4 | | out-of-state schools, public school residential facilities or |
5 | | private
special education facilities. The General Assembly |
6 | | recognizes that non-public
schools or special education |
7 | | facilities provide an important service in the
educational |
8 | | system in Illinois.
|
9 | | If because of his or her disability the special education
|
10 | | program of a district is unable to meet the needs of a child |
11 | | and the
child attends a non-public school or special education |
12 | | facility, a
public out-of-state school or a special education |
13 | | facility owned and
operated by a county government unit that |
14 | | provides special educational
services required by the child and |
15 | | is in compliance with the appropriate
rules and regulations of |
16 | | the State Superintendent of Education, the
school district in |
17 | | which the child is a resident shall pay the actual
cost of |
18 | | tuition for special education and related services provided
|
19 | | during the regular school term and during the summer school |
20 | | term if the
child's educational needs so require, excluding |
21 | | room, board and
transportation costs charged the child by that |
22 | | non-public school or
special education facility, public |
23 | | out-of-state school or county special
education facility, or |
24 | | $4,500 per year, whichever is less, and shall
provide him any |
25 | | necessary transportation. "Nonpublic special
education |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 253 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | facility" shall include a residential facility,
within or |
2 | | without the State of Illinois, which provides
special education |
3 | | and related services to meet the needs of the child by
|
4 | | utilizing private schools or public schools, whether located on |
5 | | the site
or off the site of the residential facility.
|
6 | | The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and |
7 | | regulations
for determining when placement in a private special |
8 | | education facility
is appropriate. Such rules and regulations |
9 | | shall take into account
the various types of services needed by |
10 | | a child and the availability
of such services to the particular |
11 | | child in the public school.
In developing these rules and |
12 | | regulations the State Board of
Education shall consult with the |
13 | | Advisory Council on
Education of Children with Disabilities and |
14 | | hold public
hearings to secure recommendations from parents, |
15 | | school personnel,
and others concerned about this matter.
|
16 | | The State Board of Education shall also promulgate rules |
17 | | and
regulations for transportation to and from a residential |
18 | | school.
Transportation to and from home to a residential school |
19 | | more than once
each school term shall be subject to prior |
20 | | approval by the State
Superintendent in accordance with the |
21 | | rules and regulations of the State
Board.
|
22 | | A school district making tuition payments pursuant to this
|
23 | | Section is eligible for reimbursement from the State for the |
24 | | amount of
such payments actually made in excess of the district |
25 | | per capita tuition
charge for students not receiving special |
26 | | education services.
Such reimbursement shall be approved in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 254 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | accordance with Section 14-12.01
and each district shall file |
2 | | its claims, computed in accordance with rules
prescribed by the |
3 | | State Board of Education, on forms prescribed by the
State |
4 | | Superintendent of Education. Data used as a basis of |
5 | | reimbursement
claims shall be for the preceding regular school |
6 | | term and summer school
term. Each school district shall |
7 | | transmit its claims to the State Board of Education
on or |
8 | | before
August 15. The State Board of Education, before |
9 | | approving any such claims,
shall determine their accuracy and |
10 | | whether they are based upon services
and facilities provided |
11 | | under approved programs. Upon approval the State
Board shall |
12 | | cause vouchers to be prepared showing the amount due
for |
13 | | payment of reimbursement claims to school
districts, for |
14 | | transmittal to the State Comptroller on
the 30th day of |
15 | | September, December, and March, respectively, and the final
|
16 | | voucher, no later than June 20. If the
money appropriated by |
17 | | the General Assembly for such purpose for any year
is |
18 | | insufficient, it shall be apportioned on the basis of the |
19 | | claims approved.
|
20 | | No child shall be placed in a special education program |
21 | | pursuant to
this Section if the tuition cost for special |
22 | | education and related
services increases more than 10 percent |
23 | | over the tuition cost for the
previous school year or exceeds |
24 | | $4,500 per year unless such costs have
been approved by the |
25 | | Illinois Purchased Care Review Board. The
Illinois Purchased |
26 | | Care Review Board shall consist of the following
persons, or |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 255 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | their designees: the Directors of Children and Family
Services, |
2 | | Public Health,
Public Aid, and the
Governor's Office of |
3 | | Management and Budget; the
Secretary of Human Services; the |
4 | | State Superintendent of Education; and such
other persons as |
5 | | the
Governor may designate. The Review Board shall also consist |
6 | | of one non-voting member who is an administrator of a
private, |
7 | | nonpublic, special education school. The Review Board shall |
8 | | establish rules and
regulations for its determination of |
9 | | allowable costs and payments made by
local school districts for |
10 | | special education, room and board, and other related
services |
11 | | provided by non-public schools or special education facilities |
12 | | and
shall establish uniform standards and criteria which it |
13 | | shall follow. The Review Board shall approve the usual and |
14 | | customary rate or rates of a special education program that (i) |
15 | | is offered by an out-of-state, non-public provider of |
16 | | integrated autism specific educational and autism specific |
17 | | residential services, (ii) offers 2 or more levels of |
18 | | residential care, including at least one locked facility, and |
19 | | (iii) serves 12 or fewer Illinois students.
|
20 | | The Review Board shall establish uniform definitions and |
21 | | criteria for
accounting separately by special education, room |
22 | | and board and other
related services costs. The Board shall |
23 | | also establish guidelines for
the coordination of services and |
24 | | financial assistance provided by all
State agencies to assure |
25 | | that no otherwise qualified child with a disability
receiving |
26 | | services under Article 14 shall be excluded from participation
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 256 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | in, be denied the benefits of or be subjected to discrimination |
2 | | under
any program or activity provided by any State agency.
|
3 | | The Review Board shall review the costs for special |
4 | | education and
related services provided by non-public schools |
5 | | or special education
facilities and shall approve or disapprove |
6 | | such facilities in accordance
with the rules and regulations |
7 | | established by it with respect to
allowable costs.
|
8 | | The State Board of Education shall provide administrative |
9 | | and staff support
for the Review Board as deemed reasonable by |
10 | | the State Superintendent of
Education. This support shall not |
11 | | include travel expenses or other
compensation for any Review |
12 | | Board member other than the State Superintendent of
Education.
|
13 | | The Review Board shall seek the advice of the Advisory |
14 | | Council on
Education of Children with Disabilities on the rules |
15 | | and
regulations to be
promulgated by it relative to providing |
16 | | special education services.
|
17 | | If a child has been placed in a program in which the actual |
18 | | per pupil costs
of tuition for special education and related |
19 | | services based on program
enrollment, excluding room, board and |
20 | | transportation costs, exceed $4,500 and
such costs have been |
21 | | approved by the Review Board, the district shall pay such
total |
22 | | costs which exceed $4,500. A district making such tuition |
23 | | payments in
excess of $4,500 pursuant to this Section shall be |
24 | | responsible for an amount in
excess of $4,500 equal to the |
25 | | district per capita
tuition charge and shall be eligible for |
26 | | reimbursement from the State for
the amount of such payments |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 257 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | actually made in excess of the districts per capita
tuition |
2 | | charge for students not receiving special education services.
|
3 | | If a child has been placed in an approved individual |
4 | | program and the
tuition costs including room and board costs |
5 | | have been approved by the
Review Board, then such room and |
6 | | board costs shall be paid by the
appropriate State agency |
7 | | subject to the provisions of Section 14-8.01 of
this Act. Room |
8 | | and board costs not provided by a State agency other
than the |
9 | | State Board of Education shall be provided by the State Board
|
10 | | of Education on a current basis. In no event, however, shall |
11 | | the
State's liability for funding of these tuition costs begin |
12 | | until after
the legal obligations of third party payors have |
13 | | been subtracted from
such costs. If the money appropriated by |
14 | | the General Assembly for such
purpose for any year is |
15 | | insufficient, it shall be apportioned on the
basis of the |
16 | | claims approved. Each district shall submit estimated claims to |
17 | | the State
Superintendent of Education. Upon approval of such |
18 | | claims, the State
Superintendent of Education shall direct the |
19 | | State Comptroller to make payments
on a monthly basis. The |
20 | | frequency for submitting estimated
claims and the method of |
21 | | determining payment shall be prescribed in rules
and |
22 | | regulations adopted by the State Board of Education. Such |
23 | | current state
reimbursement shall be reduced by an amount equal |
24 | | to the proceeds which
the child or child's parents are eligible |
25 | | to receive under any public or
private insurance or assistance |
26 | | program. Nothing in this Section shall
be construed as |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 258 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | relieving an insurer or similar third party from an
otherwise |
2 | | valid obligation to provide or to pay for services provided to
|
3 | | a child with a disability.
|
4 | | If it otherwise qualifies, a school district is eligible |
5 | | for the
transportation reimbursement under Section 14-13.01 |
6 | | and for the
reimbursement of tuition payments under this |
7 | | Section whether the
non-public school or special education |
8 | | facility, public out-of-state
school or county special |
9 | | education facility, attended by a child who
resides in that |
10 | | district and requires special educational services, is
within |
11 | | or outside of the State of Illinois. However, a district is not
|
12 | | eligible to claim transportation reimbursement under this |
13 | | Section unless
the district certifies to the State |
14 | | Superintendent of Education that the
district is unable to |
15 | | provide special educational services required by
the child for |
16 | | the current school year.
|
17 | | Nothing in this Section authorizes the reimbursement of a |
18 | | school
district for the amount paid for tuition of a child |
19 | | attending a
non-public school or special education facility, |
20 | | public out-of-state
school or county special education |
21 | | facility unless the school district
certifies to the State |
22 | | Superintendent of Education that the special
education program |
23 | | of that district is unable to meet the needs of that child
|
24 | | because of his disability and the State Superintendent of |
25 | | Education finds
that the school district is in substantial |
26 | | compliance with Section 14-4.01. However, if a child is |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 259 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | unilaterally placed by a State agency or any court in a |
2 | | non-public school or special education facility, public |
3 | | out-of-state school, or county special education facility, a |
4 | | school district shall not be required to certify to the State |
5 | | Superintendent of Education, for the purpose of tuition |
6 | | reimbursement, that the special education program of that |
7 | | district is unable to meet the needs of a child because of his |
8 | | or her disability.
|
9 | | Any educational or related services provided, pursuant to |
10 | | this
Section in a non-public school or special education |
11 | | facility or a
special education facility owned and operated by |
12 | | a county government
unit shall be at no cost to the parent or |
13 | | guardian of the child.
However, current law and practices |
14 | | relative to contributions by parents
or guardians for costs |
15 | | other than educational or related services are
not affected by |
16 | | this amendatory Act of 1978.
|
17 | | Reimbursement for children attending public school |
18 | | residential facilities
shall be made in accordance with the |
19 | | provisions of this Section.
|
20 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school |
21 | | district
receiving a payment under this Section or under |
22 | | Section 14-7.02b, 14-13.01, or
29-5 of this Code may classify |
23 | | all or a portion of the funds that
it receives in a particular |
24 | | fiscal year or from general State aid pursuant
to Section |
25 | | 18-8.05 of this Code
as funds received in connection with any |
26 | | funding program for which
it is entitled to receive funds from |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 260 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the State in that fiscal year (including,
without limitation, |
2 | | any funding program referenced in this Section),
regardless of |
3 | | the source or timing of the receipt. The district may not
|
4 | | classify more funds as funds received in connection with the |
5 | | funding
program than the district is entitled to receive in |
6 | | that fiscal year for that
program. Any
classification by a |
7 | | district must be made by a resolution of its board of
|
8 | | education. The resolution must identify the amount of any |
9 | | payments or
general State aid to be classified under this |
10 | | paragraph and must specify
the funding program to which the |
11 | | funds are to be treated as received in
connection therewith. |
12 | | This resolution is controlling as to the
classification of |
13 | | funds referenced therein. A certified copy of the
resolution |
14 | | must be sent to the State Superintendent of Education.
The |
15 | | resolution shall still take effect even though a copy of the |
16 | | resolution has
not been sent to the State
Superintendent of |
17 | | Education in a timely manner.
No
classification under this |
18 | | paragraph by a district shall affect the total amount
or timing |
19 | | of money the district is entitled to receive under this Code.
|
20 | | No classification under this paragraph by a district shall
in |
21 | | any way relieve the district from or affect any
requirements |
22 | | that otherwise would apply with respect to
that funding |
23 | | program, including any
accounting of funds by source, reporting |
24 | | expenditures by
original source and purpose,
reporting |
25 | | requirements,
or requirements of providing services.
|
26 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 261 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Section, the State Board of Education shall award to a school |
2 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000 inhabitants |
3 | | 48.4% of the funds appropriated by the General Assembly for any |
4 | | fiscal year for purposes of payments to school districts under |
5 | | this Section. |
6 | | (Source: P.A. 98-636, eff. 6-6-14; 98-1008, eff. 1-1-15; 99-78, |
7 | | eff. 7-20-15; 99-143, eff. 7-27-15.)
|
8 | | (105 ILCS 5/14-7.02b)
|
9 | | Sec. 14-7.02b. Funding for children requiring special |
10 | | education services.
Payments to school districts for children |
11 | | requiring
special education services documented in their |
12 | | individualized education
program regardless of the program |
13 | | from which these services are received,
excluding children |
14 | | claimed under Sections 14-7.02 and 14-7.03 of this Code,
shall
|
15 | | be made in accordance with this Section. Funds received under |
16 | | this Section
may be used only for the provision of special |
17 | | educational facilities and
services as defined in Section |
18 | | 14-1.08 of this Code.
|
19 | | The appropriation for fiscal year 2005 through fiscal year |
20 | | 2017 and thereafter shall be based upon
the IDEA child count of |
21 | | all students in the State, excluding students
claimed under |
22 | | Sections 14-7.02 and 14-7.03 of this Code, on December 1 of the
|
23 | | fiscal year 2
years
preceding, multiplied by 17.5% of the |
24 | | general State aid
foundation level of support established for |
25 | | that fiscal year under Section
18-8.05 of
this Code.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 262 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Beginning with fiscal year 2005 and through fiscal year |
2 | | 2007, individual school districts
shall not receive payments |
3 | | under this Section totaling less than they received
under the
|
4 | | funding authorized under Section 14-7.02a of this Code
during |
5 | | fiscal year 2004, pursuant to the provisions of Section |
6 | | 14-7.02a as they
were in effect before the effective date of |
7 | | this amendatory Act of the 93rd
General Assembly. This base |
8 | | level funding shall be computed first.
|
9 | | Beginning with fiscal year 2008 through fiscal year 2017 |
10 | | and each fiscal year thereafter , individual school districts |
11 | | must not receive payments under this Section totaling less than |
12 | | they received in fiscal year 2007. This funding shall be |
13 | | computed last and shall be a separate calculation from any |
14 | | other calculation set forth in this Section. This amount is |
15 | | exempt from the requirements of Section 1D-1 of this Code.
|
16 | | Through fiscal year 2017, an An amount equal to 85% of the |
17 | | funds remaining in the appropriation shall be allocated to |
18 | | school districts based upon the
district's average daily |
19 | | attendance reported for purposes of Section
18-8.05 of this |
20 | | Code for the preceding school year. Fifteen percent of the
|
21 | | funds
remaining in the appropriation
shall be allocated to |
22 | | school districts based upon the district's low income
eligible |
23 | | pupil count used in the calculation of general State aid under |
24 | | Section
18-8.05 of this Code for the same fiscal year. One |
25 | | hundred percent of the
funds
computed and allocated to |
26 | | districts under this Section shall be distributed and
paid to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 263 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | school districts.
|
2 | | For individual
students with disabilities whose program |
3 | | costs exceed 4 times the
district's per capita tuition rate
as |
4 | | calculated under Section 10-20.12a of this Code, the costs in |
5 | | excess
of 4 times the district's per capita tuition rate shall |
6 | | be paid by the State
Board of Education from unexpended IDEA |
7 | | discretionary funds originally
designated for room and board |
8 | | reimbursement pursuant to Section
14-8.01 of this Code. The |
9 | | amount of tuition for these children shall be
determined by the |
10 | | actual cost of maintaining classes for these children,
using |
11 | | the per
capita cost formula set forth in Section 14-7.01 of |
12 | | this Code, with the
program and cost being pre-approved by the |
13 | | State Superintendent of
Education. Reimbursement for |
14 | | individual students with disabilities whose program costs |
15 | | exceed 4 times the district's per capita tuition rate shall be |
16 | | claimed beginning with costs encumbered for the 2004-2005 |
17 | | school year and thereafter.
|
18 | | The State Board of Education shall prepare vouchers equal |
19 | | to one-fourth the
amount allocated to districts, for |
20 | | transmittal
to the State Comptroller on the 30th day of |
21 | | September, December, and March,
respectively, and the final |
22 | | voucher, no later than June 20. The Comptroller
shall make |
23 | | payments pursuant to this Section to school districts as soon |
24 | | as possible after receipt of vouchers. If the money
|
25 | | appropriated from the General Assembly for such purposes for |
26 | | any year is
insufficient, it shall be apportioned on the basis |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 264 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the payments due to
school districts.
|
2 | | Nothing in this Section shall be construed to decrease or |
3 | | increase the
percentage of all special education funds that are |
4 | | allocated annually
under Article 1D of this Code
or to alter |
5 | | the requirement that a
school district provide special |
6 | | education services.
|
7 | | Nothing in this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly |
8 | | shall
eliminate any reimbursement obligation owed as of the |
9 | | effective date of this
amendatory Act of the 93rd General |
10 | | Assembly to a school district with in excess
of 500,000 |
11 | | inhabitants.
|
12 | | Except for reimbursement for individual students with |
13 | | disabilities whose program costs exceed 4 times the district's |
14 | | per capita tuition rate, no funding shall be provided to school |
15 | | districts under this Section after fiscal year 2017. |
16 | | (Source: P.A. 93-1022, eff. 8-24-08; 95-705, eff. 1-8-08.) |
17 | | (105 ILCS 5/14-7.03) (from Ch. 122, par. 14-7.03)
|
18 | | Sec. 14-7.03. Special Education Classes for Children from |
19 | | Orphanages,
Foster Family Homes, Children's Homes, or in State |
20 | | Housing Units. If a
school district maintains special education |
21 | | classes on the site of
orphanages and children's homes, or if |
22 | | children from the orphanages,
children's homes, foster family |
23 | | homes, other State agencies, or State
residential units for |
24 | | children attend classes for children with disabilities
in which |
25 | | the school district is a participating member of a joint
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 265 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | agreement, or if the children from the orphanages, children's |
2 | | homes,
foster family homes, other State agencies, or State |
3 | | residential units
attend classes for the children with |
4 | | disabilities maintained by the school
district, then |
5 | | reimbursement shall be paid to eligible districts in
accordance |
6 | | with the provisions of this Section by the Comptroller as |
7 | | directed
by the State Superintendent of Education.
|
8 | | The amount of tuition for such children shall be determined |
9 | | by the
actual cost of maintaining such classes, using the per |
10 | | capita cost formula
set forth in Section 14-7.01, such program |
11 | | and cost to be pre-approved by
the State Superintendent of |
12 | | Education.
|
13 | | If a school district makes a claim for reimbursement under |
14 | | Section
18-3 or 18-4 of this Act it shall not include in any |
15 | | claim filed under
this Section a claim for such children. |
16 | | Payments authorized by law,
including State or federal grants |
17 | | for education of children included in
this Section, shall be |
18 | | deducted in determining the tuition amount.
|
19 | | Nothing in this Act shall be construed so as to prohibit
|
20 | | reimbursement for the tuition of children placed in for profit |
21 | | facilities.
Private facilities shall provide adequate space at |
22 | | the
facility for special education classes provided by a school |
23 | | district or
joint agreement for children with disabilities who |
24 | | are
residents of the
facility at no cost to the school district |
25 | | or joint agreement upon
request of the school district or joint |
26 | | agreement. If such a private
facility provides space at no cost |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 266 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to the district or joint agreement
for special education |
2 | | classes provided to children with
disabilities who are
|
3 | | residents of the facility, the district or joint agreement |
4 | | shall not
include any costs for the use of those facilities in |
5 | | its claim for
reimbursement.
|
6 | | Reimbursement for tuition may include the cost of providing |
7 | | summer
school programs for children with severe and profound |
8 | | disabilities served
under this Section. Claims for that |
9 | | reimbursement shall be filed by
November 1 and shall be paid on |
10 | | or before December 15 from
appropriations made for the purposes |
11 | | of this Section.
|
12 | | The State Board of Education shall establish such rules and
|
13 | | regulations as may be necessary to implement the provisions of |
14 | | this
Section.
|
15 | | Claims filed on behalf of programs operated under this |
16 | | Section housed in a
jail, detention center, or county-owned |
17 | | shelter care facility
shall be on an individual student basis |
18 | | only for
eligible students with disabilities. These claims |
19 | | shall be in accordance with
applicable rules.
|
20 | | Each district claiming reimbursement for a program |
21 | | operated as a group
program shall have an approved budget on |
22 | | file with the State Board of
Education prior to the initiation |
23 | | of the program's operation. On September
30, December 31, and |
24 | | March 31, the State Board of Education shall voucher
payments |
25 | | to group programs based upon the approved budget during the |
26 | | year
of operation. Final claims for group payments shall be |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 267 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | filed on or before
July 15. Final claims for group programs |
2 | | received at the State
Board of
Education on or before June 15 |
3 | | shall be vouchered by June 30. Final claims
received at the |
4 | | State Board of Education between June 16 and July 15
shall be |
5 | | vouchered by August 30. Claims for group programs
received
|
6 | | after July 15 shall not be honored.
|
7 | | Each district claiming reimbursement for individual |
8 | | students shall have the
eligibility of those students verified |
9 | | by the State Board of Education. On
September 30, December 31, |
10 | | and March 31, the State Board of Education shall
voucher |
11 | | payments for individual students based upon an estimated cost
|
12 | | calculated from the prior year's claim. Final claims for |
13 | | individual students
for the regular school term must be |
14 | | received at the State Board of Education by
July 15. Claims for |
15 | | individual students received after July 15 shall not
be |
16 | | honored. Final claims for individual students shall be |
17 | | vouchered by
August 30.
|
18 | | Reimbursement shall be made based upon approved group |
19 | | programs or
individual students. The State Superintendent of |
20 | | Education shall direct the
Comptroller to pay a specified |
21 | | amount to the district by the 30th day of
September, December, |
22 | | March, June, or August, respectively. However,
notwithstanding |
23 | | any other provisions of this Section or the School Code,
|
24 | | beginning with fiscal year 1994 and each fiscal year |
25 | | thereafter, if the amount appropriated for any fiscal year
is |
26 | | less than the amount required for purposes of this Section, the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 268 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | amount
required to eliminate any insufficient reimbursement |
2 | | for each district claim
under this Section shall be reimbursed |
3 | | on August 30 of the next fiscal
year. Payments required to |
4 | | eliminate any insufficiency for prior
fiscal year claims shall |
5 | | be made before any claims are paid for the current
fiscal year.
|
6 | | The claim of a school district otherwise eligible to be |
7 | | reimbursed in
accordance with Section 14-12.01 for the 1976-77 |
8 | | school year but for
this amendatory Act of 1977 shall not be |
9 | | paid unless the district ceases
to maintain such classes for |
10 | | one entire school year.
|
11 | | If a school district's current reimbursement payment for |
12 | | the 1977-78
school year only is less than the prior year's |
13 | | reimbursement payment
owed, the district shall be paid the |
14 | | amount of the difference between
the payments in addition to |
15 | | the current reimbursement payment, and the
amount so paid shall |
16 | | be subtracted from the amount of prior year's
reimbursement |
17 | | payment owed to the district.
|
18 | | Regional superintendents may operate special education |
19 | | classes for
children from orphanages, foster family homes, |
20 | | children's homes or State
housing units located within the |
21 | | educational services region upon consent
of the school board |
22 | | otherwise so obligated. In electing to assume the
powers and |
23 | | duties of a school district in providing and maintaining such a
|
24 | | special education program, the regional superintendent may |
25 | | enter into joint
agreements with other districts and may |
26 | | contract with public or private
schools or the orphanage, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 269 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | foster family home, children's home or State
housing unit for |
2 | | provision of the special education program. The regional
|
3 | | superintendent exercising the powers granted under this |
4 | | Section shall claim
the reimbursement authorized by this |
5 | | Section directly from the State Board
of Education.
|
6 | | Any child who is not a resident of Illinois who is placed |
7 | | in a child
welfare institution, private facility, foster family |
8 | | home, State operated
program, orphanage or children's home |
9 | | shall have the payment for his
educational tuition and any |
10 | | related services assured by the placing agent.
|
11 | | For each student with a disability who is placed in a |
12 | | residential facility by an Illinois public
agency or by any |
13 | | court in this State, the costs for educating the student
are |
14 | | eligible for reimbursement under this Section.
|
15 | | The district of residence of the student with a disability |
16 | | as
defined in Section 14-1.11a is responsible for the actual |
17 | | costs of
the student's special education program and is |
18 | | eligible for reimbursement under
this Section when placement is |
19 | | made by a State agency or the courts.
|
20 | | When a dispute arises over the determination of the |
21 | | district of
residence under this Section, the district or |
22 | | districts may appeal the decision in writing to
the State |
23 | | Superintendent of Education, who, upon review of materials |
24 | | submitted and any other items or information he or she may |
25 | | request for submission, shall issue a written decision on the |
26 | | matter. The decision of the State
Superintendent of Education |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 270 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | shall be final.
|
2 | | In the event a district does not make a tuition
payment to |
3 | | another district that is providing the special education
|
4 | | program and services, the State Board of Education shall |
5 | | immediately
withhold 125% of
the then remaining annual tuition |
6 | | cost from the State aid or categorical
aid payment due to the
|
7 | | school district that is determined to be the resident school |
8 | | district. All
funds withheld by the State Board of Education |
9 | | shall immediately be
forwarded to the
school district where the |
10 | | student is being served.
|
11 | | When a child eligible for services under this Section |
12 | | 14-7.03 must be
placed in a nonpublic facility, that facility |
13 | | shall meet the programmatic
requirements of Section 14-7.02 and |
14 | | its regulations, and the educational
services shall be funded |
15 | | only in accordance with this Section 14-7.03.
|
16 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
17 | | Section, the State Board of Education shall award to a school |
18 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000 inhabitants |
19 | | 35.8% of the funds appropriated by the General Assembly for any |
20 | | fiscal year for purposes of payment of claims of special |
21 | | education orphanage tuition under this Section.
|
22 | | (Source: P.A. 98-739, eff. 7-16-14; 99-143, eff. 7-27-15.)
|
23 | | (105 ILCS 5/14-13.01) (from Ch. 122, par. 14-13.01)
|
24 | | Sec. 14-13.01. Reimbursement payable by State; amounts for |
25 | | personnel and transportation. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 271 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (a) Through fiscal year 2017, for For staff working on |
2 | | behalf of children who have not been identified as eligible for |
3 | | special
education and for eligible children with physical
|
4 | | disabilities, including all
eligible children whose placement |
5 | | has been determined under Section 14-8.02 in
hospital or home |
6 | | instruction, 1/2 of the teacher's salary but not more than
|
7 | | $1,000 annually per child or $9,000 per teacher, whichever is |
8 | | less. |
9 | | (a-5) A child qualifies for home or hospital instruction if |
10 | | it is anticipated that, due to a medical condition, the child |
11 | | will be unable to attend school, and instead must be instructed |
12 | | at home or in the hospital, for a period of 2 or more |
13 | | consecutive weeks or on an ongoing intermittent basis. For |
14 | | purposes of this Section, "ongoing intermittent basis" means |
15 | | that the child's medical condition is of such a nature or |
16 | | severity that it is anticipated that the child will be absent |
17 | | from school due to the medical condition for periods of at |
18 | | least 2 days at a time multiple times during the school year |
19 | | totaling at least 10 days or more of absences. There shall be |
20 | | no requirement that a child be absent from school a minimum |
21 | | number of days before the child qualifies for home or hospital |
22 | | instruction. In order to establish eligibility for home or |
23 | | hospital services, a student's parent or guardian must submit |
24 | | to the child's school district of residence a written statement |
25 | | from a physician licensed to practice medicine in all of its |
26 | | branches stating the existence of such medical condition, the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 272 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | impact on the child's ability to participate in education, and |
2 | | the anticipated duration or nature of the child's absence from |
3 | | school. Home or hospital instruction may commence upon receipt |
4 | | of a written physician's statement in accordance with this |
5 | | Section, but instruction shall commence not later than 5 school |
6 | | days after the school district receives the physician's |
7 | | statement. Special education and related services required by |
8 | | the child's IEP or services and accommodations required by the |
9 | | child's federal Section 504 plan must be implemented as part of |
10 | | the child's home or hospital instruction, unless the IEP team |
11 | | or federal Section 504 plan team determines that modifications |
12 | | are necessary during the home or hospital instruction due to |
13 | | the child's condition. |
14 | | (a-10) Through fiscal year 2017, eligible Eligible |
15 | | children
to be included in any reimbursement under this |
16 | | paragraph must regularly
receive a minimum of one hour of |
17 | | instruction each school day, or in lieu
thereof of a minimum of |
18 | | 5 hours of instruction in each school week in
order to qualify |
19 | | for full reimbursement under this Section. If the
attending |
20 | | physician for such a child has certified that the child should
|
21 | | not receive as many as 5 hours of instruction in a school week, |
22 | | however,
reimbursement under this paragraph on account of that |
23 | | child shall be
computed proportionate to the actual hours of |
24 | | instruction per week for
that child divided by 5. |
25 | | (a-15) The State Board of Education shall establish rules |
26 | | governing the required qualifications of staff providing home |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 273 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | or hospital instruction.
|
2 | | (b) For children described in Section 14-1.02, 80% of the |
3 | | cost of
transportation approved as a related service in the |
4 | | Individualized Education Program for each student
in order to |
5 | | take advantage of special educational facilities.
|
6 | | Transportation costs shall be determined in the same fashion as |
7 | | provided
in Section 29-5 of this Code, provided that, |
8 | | notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
9 | | subsection (b) or Section 29-5 of this Code, the State Board of |
10 | | Education shall award to a school district having a population |
11 | | exceeding 500,000 inhabitants 30.7% of the funds appropriated |
12 | | by the General Assembly for any fiscal year for purposes of |
13 | | payment of transportation cost claims under this subsection |
14 | | (b) . For purposes of this subsection (b), the dates for
|
15 | | processing claims specified in Section 29-5 shall apply.
|
16 | | (c) Through fiscal year 2017, for For each qualified |
17 | | worker, the annual sum of
$9,000.
|
18 | | (d) Through fiscal year 2017, for For one full time |
19 | | qualified director of the special education
program of each |
20 | | school district which maintains a fully approved program
of |
21 | | special education the annual sum of $9,000. Districts |
22 | | participating in a joint agreement special
education program |
23 | | shall not receive such reimbursement if reimbursement is made
|
24 | | for a director of the joint agreement program.
|
25 | | (e) (Blank).
|
26 | | (f) (Blank).
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 274 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (g) Through fiscal year 2017, for For readers, working with |
2 | | blind or partially seeing children 1/2
of their salary but not |
3 | | more than $400 annually per child. Readers may
be employed to |
4 | | assist such children and shall not be required to be
certified |
5 | | but prior to employment shall meet standards set up by the
|
6 | | State Board of Education.
|
7 | | (h) Through fiscal year 2017, for For non-certified |
8 | | employees, as defined by rules promulgated by the State Board |
9 | | of Education, who deliver services to students with IEPs, 1/2 |
10 | | of the salary paid or
$3,500 per employee, whichever is less.
|
11 | | (i) The State Board of Education shall set standards and |
12 | | prescribe rules
for determining the allocation of |
13 | | reimbursement under this section on
less than a full time basis |
14 | | and for less than a school year.
|
15 | | When any school district eligible for reimbursement under |
16 | | this
Section operates a school or program approved by the State
|
17 | | Superintendent of Education for a number of days in excess of |
18 | | the
adopted school calendar but not to exceed 235 school days, |
19 | | such
reimbursement shall be increased by 1/180 of the amount or |
20 | | rate paid
hereunder for each day such school is operated in |
21 | | excess of 180 days per
calendar year.
|
22 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school |
23 | | district receiving
a payment under this Section or under |
24 | | Section 14-7.02, 14-7.02b, or
29-5 of this Code may classify |
25 | | all or a portion of the funds that it receives
in a particular |
26 | | fiscal year or from evidence-based funding general State aid |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 275 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | pursuant to Section 18-8.15
18-8.05 of this Code as
funds |
2 | | received in connection with any funding program for which it is
|
3 | | entitled to receive funds from the State in that fiscal year |
4 | | (including,
without limitation, any funding program referenced |
5 | | in this Section),
regardless of the source or timing of the |
6 | | receipt. The district may not
classify more funds as funds |
7 | | received in connection with the funding
program than the |
8 | | district is entitled to receive in that fiscal year for that
|
9 | | program. Any
classification by a district must be made by a |
10 | | resolution of its board of
education. The resolution must |
11 | | identify the amount of any payments or evidence-based funding
|
12 | | general State aid to be classified under this paragraph and |
13 | | must specify
the funding program to which the funds are to be |
14 | | treated as received in
connection therewith. This resolution is |
15 | | controlling as to the
classification of funds referenced |
16 | | therein. A certified copy of the
resolution must be sent to the |
17 | | State Superintendent of Education.
The resolution shall still |
18 | | take effect even though a copy of the resolution has
not been |
19 | | sent to the State
Superintendent of Education in a timely |
20 | | manner.
No
classification under this paragraph by a district |
21 | | shall affect the total amount
or timing of money the district |
22 | | is entitled to receive under this Code.
No classification under |
23 | | this paragraph by a district shall
in any way relieve the |
24 | | district from or affect any
requirements that otherwise would |
25 | | apply with respect to
that funding program, including any
|
26 | | accounting of funds by source, reporting expenditures by
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 276 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | original source and purpose,
reporting requirements,
or |
2 | | requirements of providing services.
|
3 | | (Source: P.A. 96-257, eff. 8-11-09; 97-123, eff. 7-14-11.)
|
4 | | (105 ILCS 5/14C-1) (from Ch. 122, par. 14C-1) |
5 | | Sec. 14C-1. The General Assembly finds that there are large |
6 | | numbers of children in
this State who come from environments |
7 | | where the primary language is other
than English. Experience |
8 | | has shown that public school classes in which
instruction is |
9 | | given only in English are often inadequate for the education
of |
10 | | children whose native tongue is another language. The General |
11 | | Assembly
believes that a program of transitional bilingual |
12 | | education can meet the
needs of these children and facilitate |
13 | | their integration into the regular
public school curriculum. |
14 | | Therefore, pursuant to the policy of this State
to ensure equal |
15 | | educational opportunity to every child, and in recognition
of |
16 | | the educational needs of English learners, it is the purpose of |
17 | | this Act to provide for the establishment of
transitional |
18 | | bilingual education programs in the public schools, to
provide |
19 | | supplemental financial assistance through fiscal year 2017 to |
20 | | help local school districts
meet the extra costs of such |
21 | | programs, and to allow this State through the State Board of |
22 | | Education to directly or indirectly provide technical |
23 | | assistance and professional development to support |
24 | | transitional bilingual education or a transitional program of |
25 | | instruction programs statewide through contractual services by |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 277 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | a not-for-profit entity for technical assistance, professional |
2 | | development, and other support to school districts and |
3 | | educators for services for English learner pupils. In no case |
4 | | may aggregate funding for contractual services by a |
5 | | not-for-profit entity for support to school districts and |
6 | | educators for services for English learner pupils be less than |
7 | | the aggregate amount expended for such purposes in Fiscal Year |
8 | | 2017. Not-for-profit entities providing support to school |
9 | | districts and educators for services for English learner pupils |
10 | | must have experience providing those services in a school |
11 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000; one or more |
12 | | school districts in any of the counties of Lake, McHenry, |
13 | | DuPage, Kane, and Will; and one or more school districts |
14 | | elsewhere in this State. Funding for not-for-profit entities |
15 | | providing support to school districts and educators for |
16 | | services for English learner pupils may be increased subject to |
17 | | an agreement with the State Board of Education. Funding for |
18 | | not-for-profit entities providing support to school districts |
19 | | and educators for services for English learner pupils shall |
20 | | come from funds allocated pursuant to Section 18-8.15 of this |
21 | | Code . |
22 | | (Source: P.A. 99-30, eff. 7-10-15.)
|
23 | | (105 ILCS 5/14C-12) (from Ch. 122, par. 14C-12)
|
24 | | Sec. 14C-12. Account of expenditures; Cost report; |
25 | | Reimbursement.
Each
school district with at least one English |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 278 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | learner shall keep an accurate, detailed and separate account |
2 | | of
all monies paid out by it for the programs in transitional |
3 | | bilingual education
required or permitted by this Article, |
4 | | including transportation costs, and
shall annually report |
5 | | thereon for the school year ending June 30 indicating
the |
6 | | average per pupil expenditure. Through fiscal year 2017, each |
7 | | Each school district shall be reimbursed
for the amount by |
8 | | which such costs exceed the average per pupil expenditure
by |
9 | | such school district for the education of children of |
10 | | comparable age
who are not in any special education program. No |
11 | | funding shall be provided to school districts under this |
12 | | Section after fiscal year 2017. In fiscal year 2018 and each |
13 | | fiscal year thereafter, all funding received by a school |
14 | | district from the State pursuant to Section 18-8.15 of this |
15 | | Code that is attributable to instructions, supports, and |
16 | | interventions for English learner pupils must be used for |
17 | | programs and services authorized under this Article. At least |
18 | | 60% of transitional bilingual education funding received from |
19 | | the State must be used for the instructional costs of programs |
20 | | and services authorized under this Article transitional |
21 | | bilingual education .
|
22 | | Applications for preapproval for reimbursement for costs |
23 | | of transitional
bilingual education programs must be submitted |
24 | | to the State Superintendent of
Education at least 60 days |
25 | | before a transitional bilingual education program
is started, |
26 | | unless a justifiable exception is granted by the State
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 279 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Superintendent of Education.
Applications shall set forth a |
2 | | plan for transitional
bilingual education established and |
3 | | maintained in accordance with this Article.
|
4 | | Through fiscal year 2017, reimbursement Reimbursement |
5 | | claims for transitional bilingual education programs shall
be |
6 | | made as follows:
|
7 | | Each school district shall claim reimbursement on a current |
8 | | basis for the
first 3 quarters of the fiscal year and file a |
9 | | final adjusted
claim
for the school year ended June 30 |
10 | | preceding computed in accordance with rules
prescribed by the |
11 | | State Superintendent's Office.
The State Superintendent
of
|
12 | | Education before approving any such claims shall
determine |
13 | | their accuracy and whether
they are based upon services and |
14 | | facilities provided under approved programs.
Upon approval he |
15 | | shall transmit to the Comptroller
the
vouchers showing the |
16 | | amounts due for
school
district reimbursement claims. Upon |
17 | | receipt of the
final adjusted
claims the State Superintendent |
18 | | of Education shall make a final
determination of the
accuracy |
19 | | of such claims. If the money appropriated by the General |
20 | | Assembly
for such purpose for any year is insufficient, it |
21 | | shall be apportioned on
the basis of the claims approved.
|
22 | | Failure on the part of the school district to prepare and |
23 | | certify the final
adjusted claims due under this Section may |
24 | | constitute a forfeiture
by the school district of its right to |
25 | | be reimbursed by the State under this
Section.
|
26 | | (Source: P.A. 96-1170, eff. 1-1-11.)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 280 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (105 ILCS 5/17-1) (from Ch. 122, par. 17-1)
|
2 | | Sec. 17-1. Annual Budget. The board of education of each |
3 | | school
district under 500,000 inhabitants shall, within or |
4 | | before the first
quarter of each fiscal year, adopt and file |
5 | | with the State Board of Education an annual balanced budget |
6 | | which it deems
necessary to defray all necessary expenses and |
7 | | liabilities of the
district, and in such annual budget shall |
8 | | specify the objects and
purposes of each item and amount needed |
9 | | for each object or purpose.
|
10 | | The budget shall be entered upon a School District Budget |
11 | | form prepared
and provided by the State Board of Education and |
12 | | therein shall contain
a statement of the cash on hand at the
|
13 | | beginning of the fiscal year, an estimate of the cash expected |
14 | | to be
received during such fiscal year from all sources, an |
15 | | estimate of the
expenditures contemplated for such fiscal year, |
16 | | and a statement of the
estimated cash expected to be on hand at |
17 | | the end of such year. The
estimate of taxes to be received may |
18 | | be based upon the amount of actual
cash receipts that may |
19 | | reasonably be expected by the district during
such fiscal year, |
20 | | estimated from the experience of the district in prior
years |
21 | | and with due regard for other circumstances that may |
22 | | substantially
affect such receipts. Nothing in this Section |
23 | | shall be construed as
requiring any district to change or |
24 | | preventing any district from
changing from a cash basis of |
25 | | financing to a surplus or deficit basis of
financing; or as |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 281 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | requiring any district to change or preventing any
district |
2 | | from changing its system of accounting. The budget shall |
3 | | conform to the requirements adopted by the State Board of |
4 | | Education pursuant to Section 2-3.28 of this Code.
|
5 | | To the extent that a school district's budget is not |
6 | | balanced, the district shall also adopt and file with the State |
7 | | Board of Education a deficit reduction plan to balance the |
8 | | district's budget within 3 years. The deficit reduction plan |
9 | | must be filed at the same time as the budget, but the State |
10 | | Superintendent of Education may extend this deadline if the |
11 | | situation warrants.
|
12 | | If, as the result of an audit performed in compliance with |
13 | | Section 3-7 of this Code, the resulting Annual Financial Report |
14 | | required to be submitted pursuant to Section 3-15.1 of this |
15 | | Code reflects a deficit as defined for purposes of the |
16 | | preceding paragraph, then the district shall, within 30 days |
17 | | after acceptance of such audit report, submit a deficit |
18 | | reduction plan. |
19 | | The board of education of each district shall fix a fiscal |
20 | | year
therefor. If the beginning of the fiscal year of a |
21 | | district is
subsequent to the time that the tax levy due to be |
22 | | made in such
fiscal year shall be
made, then such annual budget |
23 | | shall be adopted prior to the time such
tax levy shall be made.
|
24 | | The failure by a board of education of any district to adopt an |
25 | | annual
budget, or to comply in any respect with the provisions |
26 | | of this Section, shall
not affect the validity of any tax levy |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 282 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the district otherwise in
conformity with the law. With |
2 | | respect to taxes levied either before, on, or
after the |
3 | | effective date of this amendatory Act of the 91st General |
4 | | Assembly,
(i) a tax levy is made
for the fiscal year in which |
5 | | the levy is due to be made regardless of which
fiscal year the |
6 | | proceeds of the levy are expended or are intended to be
|
7 | | expended, and (ii) except as otherwise provided by law, a board |
8 | | of education's
adoption of
an annual budget in conformity with |
9 | | this Section is not a prerequisite to the
adoption of a valid |
10 | | tax levy and is not a limit on the amount of the levy.
|
11 | | Such budget shall be prepared in tentative form by some |
12 | | person or
persons designated by the board, and in such |
13 | | tentative form shall be
made conveniently available to public |
14 | | inspection for at least 30 days
prior to final action thereon. |
15 | | At least 1 public hearing shall be held
as to such budget prior |
16 | | to final action thereon. Notice of availability
for public |
17 | | inspection and of such public hearing shall be given by
|
18 | | publication in a newspaper published in such district, at least |
19 | | 30 days
prior to the time of such hearing. If there is no |
20 | | newspaper published
in such district, notice of such public |
21 | | hearing shall be given by
posting notices thereof in 5 of the |
22 | | most public places in such district.
It shall be the duty of |
23 | | the secretary of such board to make such
tentative budget |
24 | | available to public inspection, and to arrange for such
public |
25 | | hearing. The board may from time to time make transfers between
|
26 | | the various items in any fund not exceeding in the aggregate |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 283 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 10% of the
total of such fund as set forth in the budget. The |
2 | | board may from time
to time amend such budget by the same |
3 | | procedure as is herein provided
for its original adoption.
|
4 | | Beginning July 1, 1976, the board of education, or regional
|
5 | | superintendent, or governing board responsible for the |
6 | | administration of
a joint agreement shall, by September 1 of |
7 | | each
fiscal year thereafter, adopt an annual budget for the |
8 | | joint agreement
in the same manner and subject to the same |
9 | | requirements as are provided
in this Section.
|
10 | | The State Board of Education shall exercise powers and |
11 | | duties
relating to budgets as provided in Section 2-3.27 of |
12 | | this Code and shall require school districts to submit their |
13 | | annual budgets, deficit reduction plans, and other financial |
14 | | information, including revenue and expenditure reports and |
15 | | borrowing and interfund transfer plans, in such form and within |
16 | | the timelines designated by the State Board of Education.
|
17 | | By fiscal year 1982 all school districts shall use the |
18 | | Program Budget
Accounting System.
|
19 | | In the case of a school district receiving emergency State |
20 | | financial
assistance under Article 1B, the school board shall |
21 | | also be subject to the
requirements
established under Article |
22 | | 1B with respect to the annual budget.
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 97-429, eff. 8-16-11.)
|
24 | | (105 ILCS 5/17-1.2)
|
25 | | Sec. 17-1.2. Post annual budget on web site. If a school |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 284 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | district
has an Internet web site, the school district shall |
2 | | post its current annual
budget,
itemized by receipts and |
3 | | expenditures, on the district's Internet web site. The budget |
4 | | shall include information conforming to the rules adopted by |
5 | | the State Board of Education pursuant to Section 2-3.28 of this |
6 | | Code.
The school district shall notify the parents or guardians |
7 | | of its students
that the budget has been posted on the |
8 | | district's web site and what
the web site's address is.
|
9 | | (Source: P.A. 92-438, eff. 1-1-02.)
|
10 | | (105 ILCS 5/17-1.5)
|
11 | | Sec. 17-1.5. Limitation of administrative costs.
|
12 | | (a) It is the purpose of this Section to establish |
13 | | limitations on the growth
of administrative expenditures in |
14 | | order to maximize the proportion of school
district resources |
15 | | available for the instructional program, building
maintenance, |
16 | | and safety services for the students of each district.
|
17 | | (b) Definitions. For the purposes of this Section:
|
18 | | "Administrative expenditures" mean the annual expenditures |
19 | | of
school districts properly attributable to expenditure |
20 | | functions defined by the
rules of the State Board of Education |
21 | | as: 2320 (Executive Administration Services);
2330 (Special |
22 | | Area Administration Services); 2490 (Other Support Services -
|
23 | | School Administration); 2510 (Direction of Business Support |
24 | | Services); 2570
(Internal Services); and 2610 (Direction of |
25 | | Central
Support Services); provided, however, that |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 285 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | "administrative expenditures" shall
not include early |
2 | | retirement or other pension system obligations required by
|
3 | | State law.
|
4 | | "School district" means all school districts having a |
5 | | population of less than
500,000.
|
6 | | (c) For the 1998-99 school year and each school year |
7 | | thereafter, each school
district shall undertake budgetary and |
8 | | expenditure control actions so that the
increase in |
9 | | administrative expenditures for that school year over the prior
|
10 | | school year does not exceed 5%.
School districts with |
11 | | administrative expenditures per pupil
in the 25th
percentile |
12 | | and below for all districts of the same type,
as defined by the |
13 | | State Board of Education,
may waive the limitation imposed |
14 | | under this Section for any year following a
public hearing and |
15 | | with the
affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the members |
16 | | of the school board of
the
district. Any district waiving the |
17 | | limitation shall notify the State Board
within 45 days of such |
18 | | action.
|
19 | | (d) School districts shall file with the State Board of |
20 | | Education by
November 15, 1998 and
by each November 15th |
21 | | thereafter a one-page report that lists
(i) the actual
|
22 | | administrative expenditures for
the
prior year from the |
23 | | district's audited Annual Financial Report, and (ii) the
|
24 | | projected administrative expenditures for the current year |
25 | | from the budget adopted by the school board
pursuant to Section |
26 | | 17-1 of this Code.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 286 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | If a school district that is ineligible to waive the |
2 | | limitation imposed by
subsection (c) of this Section by board |
3 | | action exceeds the limitation
solely because of circumstances |
4 | | beyond
the control of the district and the district has |
5 | | exhausted all available and
reasonable remedies to comply with |
6 | | the limitation, the district may request a
waiver pursuant to |
7 | | Section 2-3.25g. The waiver application shall specify the
|
8 | | amount,
nature, and reason for the relief requested, as well as |
9 | | all remedies the
district has exhausted to comply with the |
10 | | limitation.
Any emergency relief so requested shall apply only |
11 | | to the specific
school year for which the request is made. The |
12 | | State Board of Education shall
analyze all such waivers |
13 | | submitted and shall recommend that the General
Assembly |
14 | | disapprove any such waiver requested that is not due solely to
|
15 | | circumstances beyond the control of the district and for which |
16 | | the district has
not exhausted all available and reasonable |
17 | | remedies to comply with the
limitation. The State |
18 | | Superintendent shall have
no authority to impose any sanctions |
19 | | pursuant to this Section for any
expenditures for which a |
20 | | waiver has been requested until such waiver has been
reviewed |
21 | | by the General Assembly.
|
22 | | If the report and information required
under this
|
23 | | subsection (d) are not provided by the school district in a |
24 | | timely
manner, or are subsequently determined by
the State |
25 | | Superintendent of Education
to be incomplete or inaccurate, the |
26 | | State Superintendent shall notify the
district in writing of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 287 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | reporting deficiencies. The school district shall,
within 60 |
2 | | days of the notice, address the reporting deficiencies |
3 | | identified.
|
4 | | (e) If the State Superintendent determines that a school |
5 | | district has failed
to comply with the administrative |
6 | | expenditure limitation imposed in subsection
(c) of this |
7 | | Section,
the
State Superintendent shall notify the district of |
8 | | the violation and direct the
district to undertake corrective |
9 | | action to bring the district's budget into
compliance with the |
10 | | administrative expenditure limitation. The district shall,
|
11 | | within 60 days of the notice, provide adequate assurance to the |
12 | | State
Superintendent that appropriate corrective actions have |
13 | | been or will be taken.
If the district fails to provide |
14 | | adequate assurance or fails to undertake the
necessary |
15 | | corrective actions, the State Superintendent may impose |
16 | | progressive
sanctions against the district that may culminate |
17 | | in withholding
all
subsequent payments of general State aid due |
18 | | the district under Section
18-8.05 of
this Code or |
19 | | evidence-based funding due the district under Section 18-8.15 |
20 | | of this Code
until the assurance is provided or the corrective |
21 | | actions taken.
|
22 | | (f) The State Superintendent shall publish a list each year |
23 | | of the school
districts that violate the limitation imposed by |
24 | | subsection (c) of this
Section and a list of the districts that |
25 | | waive the limitation by board
action as provided in subsection |
26 | | (c) of this Section.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 288 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (Source: P.A. 90-548, eff. 1-1-98; 90-653, eff. 7-29-98.)
|
2 | | (105 ILCS 5/17-2.11) (from Ch. 122, par. 17-2.11) |
3 | | Sec. 17-2.11. School board power to levy a tax or to borrow |
4 | | money and
issue bonds for fire prevention, safety, energy |
5 | | conservation,
accessibility, school security, and specified |
6 | | repair purposes. |
7 | | (a) Whenever, as a
result of any lawful order of any |
8 | | agency,
other than a school board, having authority to enforce |
9 | | any school building code
applicable to any facility that houses |
10 | | students, or any law or regulation for
the protection and |
11 | | safety of the environment, pursuant to the Environmental
|
12 | | Protection Act, any school district having a population of less |
13 | | than 500,000
inhabitants is required to alter or reconstruct |
14 | | any school building or
permanent, fixed equipment; the district |
15 | | may, by proper resolution, levy a tax for the purpose of making |
16 | | such alteration or reconstruction, based on a survey report by |
17 | | an architect or engineer licensed in this State, upon all of |
18 | | the taxable property of the district at the value as assessed |
19 | | by the Department of Revenue and at a rate not to exceed 0.05% |
20 | | per year for a period sufficient to finance such alteration or |
21 | | reconstruction, upon the following conditions: |
22 | | (1) When there are not sufficient funds available in |
23 | | the operations and maintenance fund of the school district, |
24 | | the school facility occupation tax fund of the district, or |
25 | | the fire prevention and safety fund of the district, as |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 289 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | determined by the district on the basis of rules adopted by |
2 | | the State Board of Education, to make such alteration or |
3 | | reconstruction or to purchase and install such permanent, |
4 | | fixed equipment so ordered or determined as necessary. |
5 | | Appropriate school district records must be made available |
6 | | to the State Superintendent of Education, upon request, to |
7 | | confirm this insufficiency. |
8 | | (2) When a certified estimate of an architect or |
9 | | engineer licensed in this State stating the estimated |
10 | | amount necessary to make the alteration or reconstruction |
11 | | or to purchase and install the equipment so ordered has |
12 | | been secured by the school district, and the estimate has |
13 | | been approved by the regional superintendent of schools |
14 | | having jurisdiction over the district and the State |
15 | | Superintendent of Education. Approval must not be granted |
16 | | for any work that has already started without the prior |
17 | | express authorization of the State Superintendent of |
18 | | Education. If the estimate is not approved or is denied |
19 | | approval by the regional superintendent of schools within 3 |
20 | | months after the date on which it is submitted to him or |
21 | | her, the school board of the district may submit the |
22 | | estimate directly to the State Superintendent of Education |
23 | | for approval or denial. |
24 | | In the case of an emergency situation, where the estimated |
25 | | cost to effectuate emergency repairs is less than the amount |
26 | | specified in Section 10-20.21 of this Code, the school district |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 290 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | may proceed with such repairs prior to approval by the State |
2 | | Superintendent of Education, but shall comply with the |
3 | | provisions of subdivision (2) of this subsection (a) as soon |
4 | | thereafter as may be as well as Section 10-20.21 of this Code. |
5 | | If the estimated cost to effectuate emergency repairs is |
6 | | greater than the amount specified in Section 10-20.21 of this |
7 | | Code, then the school district shall proceed in conformity with |
8 | | Section 10-20.21 of this Code and with rules established by the |
9 | | State Board of Education to address such situations. The rules |
10 | | adopted by the State Board of Education to deal with these |
11 | | situations shall stipulate that emergency situations must be |
12 | | expedited and given priority consideration. For purposes of |
13 | | this paragraph, an emergency is a situation that presents an |
14 | | imminent and continuing threat to the health and safety of |
15 | | students or other occupants of a facility, requires complete or |
16 | | partial evacuation of a building or part of a building, or |
17 | | consumes one or more of the 5 emergency days built into the |
18 | | adopted calendar of the school or schools or would otherwise be |
19 | | expected to cause such school or schools to fall short of the |
20 | | minimum school calendar requirements. |
21 | | (b) Whenever any such district determines that
it is |
22 | | necessary for energy conservation purposes that any school |
23 | | building
or permanent, fixed equipment should be altered or |
24 | | reconstructed and
that such alterations or reconstruction will |
25 | | be made with funds not necessary
for the completion of approved |
26 | | and recommended projects contained in any safety
survey report |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 291 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | or amendments thereto authorized by Section 2-3.12 of this Act; |
2 | | the district may levy a tax or issue bonds as provided in |
3 | | subsection (a) of this Section. |
4 | | (c) Whenever
any such district determines that it is |
5 | | necessary for accessibility purposes and to comply with the |
6 | | school building
code that any
school building or equipment |
7 | | should be altered or reconstructed and that such
alterations or |
8 | | reconstruction will be made with
funds not necessary for the |
9 | | completion of approved and recommended projects
contained in |
10 | | any safety survey report or amendments thereto authorized under
|
11 | | Section 2-3.12 of this Act, the district may levy a tax or |
12 | | issue bonds as provided in subsection (a) of this Section. |
13 | | (d) Whenever any such district determines that it is
|
14 | | necessary for school
security purposes and the related |
15 | | protection and safety of pupils and school
personnel that any |
16 | | school building or property should be altered or
reconstructed |
17 | | or that security systems and equipment (including but not |
18 | | limited
to intercom, early detection and warning, access |
19 | | control and television
monitoring systems) should be purchased |
20 | | and installed, and that such
alterations, reconstruction or |
21 | | purchase and installation of equipment will be
made with funds |
22 | | not necessary for the completion of approved and recommended
|
23 | | projects contained in any safety survey report or amendment |
24 | | thereto authorized
by Section 2-3.12 of this Act and will deter |
25 | | and prevent unauthorized entry or
activities upon school |
26 | | property by unknown or dangerous persons, assure early
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 292 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | detection and advance warning of any such actual or attempted |
2 | | unauthorized
entry or activities and help assure the continued |
3 | | safety of pupils and school
staff if any such unauthorized |
4 | | entry or activity is attempted or occurs;
the district may levy |
5 | | a tax or issue bonds as provided in subsection (a) of this |
6 | | Section. |
7 | | (e) If a school district does not need funds for other fire |
8 | | prevention and
safety projects, including the completion of |
9 | | approved and recommended projects
contained in any safety |
10 | | survey report or amendments thereto authorized by
Section |
11 | | 2-3.12 of this Act, and it is determined after a public hearing |
12 | | (which
is preceded by at least one published notice (i) |
13 | | occurring at least 7 days
prior to the hearing in a newspaper |
14 | | of general circulation within the school
district and (ii) |
15 | | setting forth the time, date, place, and general subject
matter |
16 | | of the hearing) that there is a
substantial, immediate, and |
17 | | otherwise unavoidable threat to the health, safety,
or welfare |
18 | | of pupils due to disrepair of school sidewalks, playgrounds, |
19 | | parking
lots, or school bus turnarounds and repairs must be |
20 | | made; then the district may levy a tax or issue bonds as |
21 | | provided in subsection (a) of this Section. |
22 | | (f) For purposes of this Section a school district may |
23 | | replace a school
building or build additions to replace |
24 | | portions of a building when it is
determined that the |
25 | | effectuation of the recommendations for the existing
building |
26 | | will cost more than the replacement costs. Such determination |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 293 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | shall
be based on a comparison of estimated costs made by an |
2 | | architect or engineer
licensed in the State of Illinois. The |
3 | | new building or addition shall be
equivalent in area (square |
4 | | feet) and comparable in purpose and grades served
and may be on |
5 | | the same site or another site. Such replacement may only be |
6 | | done
upon order of the regional superintendent of schools and |
7 | | the approval of the
State Superintendent of Education. |
8 | | (g) The filing of a certified copy of the resolution |
9 | | levying the tax when
accompanied by the certificates of the |
10 | | regional superintendent of schools and
State Superintendent of |
11 | | Education shall be the authority of the county clerk to
extend |
12 | | such tax. |
13 | | (h) The county clerk of the county in which any school |
14 | | district levying a
tax under the authority of this Section is |
15 | | located, in reducing raised
levies, shall not consider any such |
16 | | tax as a part of the general levy
for school purposes and shall |
17 | | not include the same in the limitation of
any other tax rate |
18 | | which may be extended. |
19 | | Such tax shall be levied and collected in like manner as |
20 | | all other
taxes of school districts, subject to the provisions |
21 | | contained in this Section. |
22 | | (i) The tax rate limit specified in this Section may be |
23 | | increased to .10%
upon the approval of a proposition to effect |
24 | | such increase by a majority
of the electors voting on that |
25 | | proposition at a regular scheduled election.
Such proposition |
26 | | may be initiated by resolution of the school board and
shall be |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 294 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | certified by the secretary to the proper election authorities |
2 | | for
submission in accordance with the general election law. |
3 | | (j) When taxes are levied by any school district for fire |
4 | | prevention,
safety, energy conservation, and school security |
5 | | purposes as specified in this
Section, and the purposes for |
6 | | which the taxes have been
levied are accomplished and paid in |
7 | | full, and there remain funds on hand in
the Fire Prevention and |
8 | | Safety Fund from the proceeds of the taxes levied,
including |
9 | | interest earnings thereon, the school board by resolution shall |
10 | | use
such excess and other board restricted funds, excluding |
11 | | bond proceeds and
earnings from such proceeds, as follows: |
12 | | (1) for other authorized fire prevention,
safety, |
13 | | energy conservation, required safety inspections, school |
14 | | security purposes, sampling for lead in drinking water in |
15 | | schools, and for repair and mitigation due to lead levels |
16 | | in the drinking water supply;
or |
17 | | (2) for transfer to the Operations and Maintenance Fund
|
18 | | for the purpose of abating an equal amount of operations |
19 | | and maintenance
purposes taxes. |
20 | | Notwithstanding subdivision (2) of this subsection (j) and |
21 | | subsection (k) of this Section, through June 30, 2020 2019 , the |
22 | | school board
may, by proper resolution following a public |
23 | | hearing set by the
school board or the president of the school |
24 | | board (that is
preceded (i) by at least one published notice |
25 | | over the name of
the clerk or secretary of the board, occurring |
26 | | at least 7 days
and not more than 30 days prior to the hearing, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 295 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | in a newspaper
of general circulation within the school |
2 | | district and (ii) by
posted notice over the name of the clerk |
3 | | or secretary of the
board, at least 48 hours before the |
4 | | hearing, at the principal
office of the school board or at the |
5 | | building where the hearing
is to be held if a principal office |
6 | | does not exist, with both
notices setting forth the time, date, |
7 | | place, and subject matter
of the hearing), transfer surplus |
8 | | life safety taxes and interest earnings thereon to the |
9 | | Operations and Maintenance Fund for building repair work. |
10 | | (k) If any transfer is made to the Operation and |
11 | | Maintenance
Fund, the secretary of the school board shall |
12 | | within 30 days notify
the county clerk of the amount of that |
13 | | transfer and direct the clerk to
abate the taxes to be extended |
14 | | for the purposes of operations and
maintenance authorized under |
15 | | Section 17-2 of this Act by an amount equal
to such transfer. |
16 | | (l) If the proceeds from the tax levy authorized by this
|
17 | | Section are insufficient to complete the work approved under |
18 | | this
Section, the school board is authorized to sell bonds |
19 | | without referendum
under the provisions of this Section in an |
20 | | amount that, when added to the
proceeds of the tax levy |
21 | | authorized by this Section, will allow completion
of the |
22 | | approved work. |
23 | | (m) Any bonds issued pursuant to this Section shall bear |
24 | | interest at a rate not to exceed the maximum rate
authorized by |
25 | | law at the time of the making of the contract, shall mature
|
26 | | within 20 years from date, and shall be signed by the president |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 296 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the school
board and the treasurer of the school district. |
2 | | (n) In order to authorize and issue such bonds, the school |
3 | | board shall adopt
a resolution fixing the amount of bonds, the |
4 | | date thereof, the maturities
thereof, rates of interest |
5 | | thereof, place of payment and denomination,
which shall be in |
6 | | denominations of not less than $100 and not more than
$5,000, |
7 | | and provide for the levy and collection of a direct annual tax |
8 | | upon
all the taxable property in the school district sufficient |
9 | | to pay the
principal and interest on such bonds to maturity. |
10 | | Upon the filing in the
office of the county clerk of the county |
11 | | in which the school district is
located of a certified copy of |
12 | | the resolution, it is the duty of the
county clerk to extend |
13 | | the tax therefor in addition to and in excess of all
other |
14 | | taxes heretofore or hereafter authorized to be
levied by such |
15 | | school district. |
16 | | (o) After the time such bonds are issued as provided for by |
17 | | this Section, if
additional alterations or reconstructions are |
18 | | required to be made because
of surveys conducted by an |
19 | | architect or engineer licensed in the State of
Illinois, the |
20 | | district may levy a tax at a rate not to exceed .05% per year
|
21 | | upon all the taxable property of the district or issue |
22 | | additional bonds,
whichever action shall be the most feasible. |
23 | | (p) This Section is cumulative and constitutes complete |
24 | | authority for the
issuance of bonds as provided in this Section |
25 | | notwithstanding any other
statute or law to the contrary. |
26 | | (q) With respect to instruments for the payment of money |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 297 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | issued under this
Section either before, on, or after the |
2 | | effective date of Public Act 86-004
(June 6, 1989), it is, and |
3 | | always has been, the intention of the General
Assembly (i) that |
4 | | the Omnibus Bond Acts are, and always have been,
supplementary |
5 | | grants of power to issue instruments in accordance with the
|
6 | | Omnibus Bond Acts, regardless of any provision of this Act that |
7 | | may appear
to be or to have been more restrictive than those |
8 | | Acts, (ii) that the
provisions of this Section are not a |
9 | | limitation on the supplementary
authority granted by the |
10 | | Omnibus Bond Acts, and (iii) that instruments
issued under this |
11 | | Section within the supplementary authority granted by the
|
12 | | Omnibus Bond Acts are not invalid because of any provision of |
13 | | this Act that
may appear to be or to have been more restrictive |
14 | | than those Acts. |
15 | | (r) When the purposes for which the bonds are issued have |
16 | | been accomplished
and paid for in full and there remain funds |
17 | | on hand from the proceeds of
the bond sale and interest |
18 | | earnings therefrom, the board shall, by
resolution, use such |
19 | | excess funds in accordance with the provisions of
Section |
20 | | 10-22.14 of this Act. |
21 | | (s) Whenever any tax is levied or bonds issued for fire |
22 | | prevention, safety,
energy conservation, and school security |
23 | | purposes, such proceeds shall be
deposited and accounted for |
24 | | separately within the Fire Prevention and Safety
Fund. |
25 | | (Source: P.A. 98-26, eff. 6-21-13; 98-1066, eff. 8-26-14; |
26 | | 99-143, eff. 7-27-15; 99-713, eff. 8-5-16; 99-922, eff. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 298 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 1-17-17.)
|
2 | | (105 ILCS 5/17-2A) (from Ch. 122, par. 17-2A)
|
3 | | Sec. 17-2A. Interfund transfers. |
4 | | (a) The school board of any district having a population of |
5 | | less than
500,000 inhabitants may, by proper resolution |
6 | | following a public hearing
set by the school board or the |
7 | | president of the school board
(that is preceded (i) by at least |
8 | | one published notice over the name of
the clerk
or secretary of |
9 | | the board, occurring at least 7 days and not more than 30
days
|
10 | | prior to the hearing, in a newspaper of general circulation |
11 | | within the
school
district and (ii) by posted notice over the |
12 | | name of the clerk or secretary of
the board, at least 48 hours |
13 | | before the hearing, at the principal office of the
school board |
14 | | or at the building where the hearing is to be held if a |
15 | | principal
office does not exist, with both notices setting |
16 | | forth the time, date, place,
and subject matter of the
|
17 | | hearing), transfer money from (1) the Educational Fund to the |
18 | | Operations
and
Maintenance Fund or the Transportation Fund, (2) |
19 | | the Operations and
Maintenance Fund to the Educational Fund or |
20 | | the Transportation Fund, (3) the
Transportation Fund to the |
21 | | Educational Fund or the Operations and Maintenance
Fund, or (4) |
22 | | the Tort Immunity Fund to the Operations and Maintenance Fund |
23 | | of said
district,
provided that, except during the period from |
24 | | July 1, 2003 through June 30, 2020 2019 , such transfer is made |
25 | | solely for the purpose of meeting one-time,
non-recurring |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 299 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | expenses. Except during the period from July 1, 2003 through
|
2 | | June 30, 2020 2019 and except as otherwise provided in |
3 | | subsection (b) of this Section, any other permanent interfund |
4 | | transfers authorized
by any provision or judicial |
5 | | interpretation of this Code for which the
transferee fund is |
6 | | not precisely and specifically set forth in the provision of
|
7 | | this Code authorizing such transfer shall be made to the fund |
8 | | of the school
district most in need of the funds being |
9 | | transferred, as determined by
resolution of the school board. |
10 | | (b) (Blank).
|
11 | | (c) Notwithstanding subsection (a) of this Section or any |
12 | | other provision of this Code to the contrary, the school board |
13 | | of any school district (i) that is subject to the Property Tax |
14 | | Extension Limitation Law, (ii) that is an elementary district |
15 | | servicing students in grades K through 8, (iii) whose territory |
16 | | is in one county, (iv) that is eligible for Section 7002 |
17 | | Federal Impact Aid, and (v) that has no more than $81,000 in |
18 | | funds remaining from refinancing bonds that were refinanced a |
19 | | minimum of 5 years prior to January 20, 2017 ( the effective |
20 | | date of Public Act 99-926) this amendatory Act of the 99th |
21 | | General Assembly may make a one-time transfer of the funds |
22 | | remaining from the refinancing bonds to the Operations and |
23 | | Maintenance Fund of the district by proper resolution following |
24 | | a public hearing set by the school board or the president of |
25 | | the school board, with notice as provided in subsection (a) of |
26 | | this Section, so long as the district meets the qualifications |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 300 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | set forth in this subsection (c) on January 20, 2017 ( the |
2 | | effective date of Public Act 99-926) this amendatory Act of the |
3 | | 99th General Assembly . |
4 | | (Source: P.A. 98-26, eff. 6-21-13; 98-131, eff. 1-1-14; 99-713, |
5 | | eff. 8-5-16; 99-922, eff. 1-17-17; 99-926, eff. 1-20-17; |
6 | | revised 1-23-17.)
|
7 | | (105 ILCS 5/17-3.6 new) |
8 | | Sec. 17-3.6. Educational purposes tax rate for school |
9 | | districts subject to Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. |
10 | | Notwithstanding the provisions, requirements, or limitations |
11 | | of this Code or any other law, any tax levied for educational |
12 | | purposes by a school district subject to the Property Tax |
13 | | Extension Limitation Law for the 2016 levy year or any |
14 | | subsequent levy year may be extended at a rate exceeding the |
15 | | rate established for educational purposes by referendum or this |
16 | | Code, provided that the rate does not cause the school district |
17 | | to exceed the limiting rate applicable to the school district |
18 | | under the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law for that levy |
19 | | year.
|
20 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-4.3) (from Ch. 122, par. 18-4.3)
|
21 | | Sec. 18-4.3. Summer school grants. Through fiscal year |
22 | | 2017, grants Grants shall be determined for
pupil attendance in |
23 | | summer schools conducted under Sections 10-22.33A
and 34-18 and |
24 | | approved under Section 2-3.25 in the following manner.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 301 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | The amount of grant for each accredited summer school |
2 | | attendance pupil shall
be obtained by dividing the total amount |
3 | | of apportionments determined under Section 18-8.05 by the
|
4 | | actual
number of pupils in average daily attendance used for |
5 | | such
apportionments. The number of credited summer school |
6 | | attendance pupils
shall be determined (a) by counting clock |
7 | | hours of class instruction by
pupils enrolled in grades 1 |
8 | | through 12 in approved courses conducted at
least 60 clock |
9 | | hours in summer sessions; (b) by dividing such total of
clock |
10 | | hours of class instruction by 4 to produce days of credited |
11 | | pupil
attendance; (c) by dividing such days of credited pupil |
12 | | attendance by
the actual number of days in the regular term as |
13 | | used in computation in
the general apportionment in Section |
14 | | 18-8.05; and (d) by
multiplying by
1.25.
|
15 | | The amount of the grant for a summer school program |
16 | | approved by the
State Superintendent of Education for children |
17 | | with
disabilities, as defined
in Sections 14-1.02 through |
18 | | 14-1.07, shall be determined in the manner
contained above |
19 | | except that average daily membership shall be utilized
in lieu |
20 | | of average daily attendance.
|
21 | | In the case of an apportionment based on summer school |
22 | | attendance or
membership pupils, the claim therefor shall be |
23 | | presented as a separate
claim for the particular school year in |
24 | | which such summer school
session ends. On or before November 1 |
25 | | of each year the
superintendent of each eligible school |
26 | | district shall certify to
the State Superintendent of Education |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 302 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the claim
of the district for the summer
session just ended. |
2 | | Failure on the part of the school board to so
certify shall |
3 | | constitute a forfeiture of its right to such payment. The State |
4 | | Superintendent of Education shall transmit to the
Comptroller |
5 | | no later than December 15th of each year
vouchers for payment |
6 | | of amounts due school districts for
summer school. The State |
7 | | Superintendent of Education shall direct the
Comptroller to |
8 | | draw his warrants for payments thereof by the 30th
day of |
9 | | December. If the money appropriated by the
General Assembly for |
10 | | such purpose for any year is insufficient, it shall
be |
11 | | apportioned on the basis of claims approved.
|
12 | | However, notwithstanding the foregoing provisions, for |
13 | | each fiscal year the
money appropriated by the General
Assembly |
14 | | for the purposes of this Section shall only be used for grants
|
15 | | for approved summer school programs for those children with
|
16 | | disabilities served pursuant to Section 14-7.02 or 14-7.02b of |
17 | | this
Code. |
18 | | No funding shall be provided to school districts under this |
19 | | Section after fiscal year 2017.
|
20 | | (Source: P.A. 93-1022, eff. 8-24-04.)
|
21 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-8.05)
|
22 | | Sec. 18-8.05. Basis for apportionment of general State |
23 | | financial aid and
supplemental general State aid to the common |
24 | | schools for the 1998-1999 through the 2016-2017 and
subsequent |
25 | | school years.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 303 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (A) General Provisions. |
2 | | (1) The provisions of this Section relating to the |
3 | | calculation and apportionment of general State financial aid |
4 | | and supplemental general State aid apply to the 1998-1999 |
5 | | through the 2016-2017 and subsequent
school years. The system |
6 | | of general State financial aid provided for in this
Section
is |
7 | | designed to assure that, through a combination of State |
8 | | financial aid and
required local resources, the financial |
9 | | support provided each pupil in Average
Daily Attendance equals |
10 | | or exceeds a
prescribed per pupil Foundation Level. This |
11 | | formula approach imputes a level
of per pupil Available Local |
12 | | Resources and provides for the basis to calculate
a per pupil |
13 | | level of general State financial aid that, when added to |
14 | | Available
Local Resources, equals or exceeds the Foundation |
15 | | Level. The
amount of per pupil general State financial aid for |
16 | | school districts, in
general, varies in inverse
relation to |
17 | | Available Local Resources. Per pupil amounts are based upon
|
18 | | each school district's Average Daily Attendance as that term is |
19 | | defined in this
Section. |
20 | | (2) In addition to general State financial aid, school |
21 | | districts with
specified levels or concentrations of pupils |
22 | | from low income households are
eligible to receive supplemental |
23 | | general State financial aid grants as provided
pursuant to |
24 | | subsection (H).
The supplemental State aid grants provided for |
25 | | school districts under
subsection (H) shall be appropriated for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 304 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | distribution to school districts as
part of the same line item |
2 | | in which the general State financial aid of school
districts is |
3 | | appropriated under this Section. |
4 | | (3) To receive financial assistance under this Section, |
5 | | school districts
are required to file claims with the State |
6 | | Board of Education, subject to the
following requirements: |
7 | | (a) Any school district which fails for any given |
8 | | school year to maintain
school as required by law, or to |
9 | | maintain a recognized school is not
eligible to file for |
10 | | such school year any claim upon the Common School
Fund. In |
11 | | case of nonrecognition of one or more attendance centers in |
12 | | a
school district otherwise operating recognized schools, |
13 | | the claim of the
district shall be reduced in the |
14 | | proportion which the Average Daily
Attendance in the |
15 | | attendance center or centers bear to the Average Daily
|
16 | | Attendance in the school district. A "recognized school" |
17 | | means any
public school which meets the standards as |
18 | | established for recognition
by the State Board of |
19 | | Education. A school district or attendance center
not |
20 | | having recognition status at the end of a school term is |
21 | | entitled to
receive State aid payments due upon a legal |
22 | | claim which was filed while
it was recognized. |
23 | | (b) School district claims filed under this Section are |
24 | | subject to
Sections 18-9 and 18-12, except as otherwise |
25 | | provided in this
Section. |
26 | | (c) If a school district operates a full year school |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 305 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | under Section
10-19.1, the general State aid to the school |
2 | | district shall be determined
by the State Board of |
3 | | Education in accordance with this Section as near as
may be |
4 | | applicable. |
5 | | (d) (Blank). |
6 | | (4) Except as provided in subsections (H) and (L), the |
7 | | board of any district
receiving any of the grants provided for |
8 | | in this Section may apply those funds
to any fund so received |
9 | | for which that board is authorized to make expenditures
by law. |
10 | | School districts are not required to exert a minimum |
11 | | Operating Tax Rate in
order to qualify for assistance under |
12 | | this Section. |
13 | | (5) As used in this Section the following terms, when |
14 | | capitalized, shall
have the meaning ascribed herein: |
15 | | (a) "Average Daily Attendance": A count of pupil |
16 | | attendance in school,
averaged as provided for in |
17 | | subsection (C) and utilized in deriving per pupil
financial |
18 | | support levels. |
19 | | (b) "Available Local Resources": A computation of |
20 | | local financial
support, calculated on the basis of Average |
21 | | Daily Attendance and derived as
provided pursuant to |
22 | | subsection (D). |
23 | | (c) "Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes": |
24 | | Funds paid to local
school districts pursuant to "An Act in |
25 | | relation to the abolition of ad valorem
personal property |
26 | | tax and the replacement of revenues lost thereby, and
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 306 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | amending and repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in |
2 | | connection therewith",
certified August 14, 1979, as |
3 | | amended (Public Act 81-1st S.S.-1). |
4 | | (d) "Foundation Level": A prescribed level of per pupil |
5 | | financial support
as provided for in subsection (B). |
6 | | (e) "Operating Tax Rate": All school district property |
7 | | taxes extended for
all purposes, except Bond and
Interest, |
8 | | Summer School, Rent, Capital Improvement, and Vocational |
9 | | Education
Building purposes.
|
10 | | (B) Foundation Level. |
11 | | (1) The Foundation Level is a figure established by the |
12 | | State representing
the minimum level of per pupil financial |
13 | | support that should be available to
provide for the basic |
14 | | education of each pupil in
Average Daily Attendance. As set |
15 | | forth in this Section, each school district
is assumed to exert
|
16 | | a sufficient local taxing effort such that, in combination with |
17 | | the aggregate
of general State
financial aid provided the |
18 | | district, an aggregate of State and local resources
are |
19 | | available to meet
the basic education needs of pupils in the |
20 | | district. |
21 | | (2) For the 1998-1999 school year, the Foundation Level of |
22 | | support is
$4,225. For the 1999-2000 school year, the |
23 | | Foundation Level of support is
$4,325. For the 2000-2001 school |
24 | | year, the Foundation Level of support is
$4,425. For the |
25 | | 2001-2002 school year and 2002-2003 school year, the
Foundation |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 307 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Level of support is $4,560. For the 2003-2004 school year, the |
2 | | Foundation Level of support is $4,810. For the 2004-2005 school |
3 | | year, the Foundation Level of support is $4,964.
For the |
4 | | 2005-2006 school year,
the Foundation Level of support is |
5 | | $5,164. For the 2006-2007 school year, the Foundation Level of |
6 | | support is $5,334. For the 2007-2008 school year, the |
7 | | Foundation Level of support is $5,734. For the 2008-2009 school |
8 | | year, the Foundation Level of support is $5,959. |
9 | | (3) For the 2009-2010 school year and each school year |
10 | | thereafter,
the Foundation Level of support is $6,119 or such |
11 | | greater amount as
may be established by law by the General |
12 | | Assembly.
|
13 | | (C) Average Daily Attendance. |
14 | | (1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant |
15 | | to subsection
(E), an Average Daily Attendance figure shall be |
16 | | utilized. The Average Daily
Attendance figure for formula
|
17 | | calculation purposes shall be the monthly average of the actual |
18 | | number of
pupils in attendance of
each school district, as |
19 | | further averaged for the best 3 months of pupil
attendance for |
20 | | each
school district. In compiling the figures for the number |
21 | | of pupils in
attendance, school districts
and the State Board |
22 | | of Education shall, for purposes of general State aid
funding, |
23 | | conform
attendance figures to the requirements of subsection |
24 | | (F). |
25 | | (2) The Average Daily Attendance figures utilized in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 308 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | subsection (E) shall be
the requisite attendance data for the |
2 | | school year immediately preceding
the
school year for which |
3 | | general State aid is being calculated
or the average of the |
4 | | attendance data for the 3 preceding school
years, whichever is |
5 | | greater. The Average Daily Attendance figures
utilized in |
6 | | subsection (H) shall be the requisite attendance data for the
|
7 | | school year immediately preceding the school year for which |
8 | | general
State aid is being calculated.
|
9 | | (D) Available Local Resources. |
10 | | (1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant |
11 | | to subsection
(E), a representation of Available Local |
12 | | Resources per pupil, as that term is
defined and determined in |
13 | | this subsection, shall be utilized. Available Local
Resources |
14 | | per pupil shall include a calculated
dollar amount representing |
15 | | local school district revenues from local property
taxes and |
16 | | from
Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes, expressed |
17 | | on the basis of pupils
in Average
Daily Attendance. Calculation |
18 | | of Available Local Resources shall exclude any tax amnesty |
19 | | funds received as a result of Public Act 93-26. |
20 | | (2) In determining a school district's revenue from local |
21 | | property taxes,
the State Board of Education shall utilize the |
22 | | equalized assessed valuation of
all taxable property of each |
23 | | school
district as of September 30 of the previous year. The |
24 | | equalized assessed
valuation utilized shall
be obtained and |
25 | | determined as provided in subsection (G). |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 309 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (3) For school districts maintaining grades kindergarten |
2 | | through 12, local
property tax
revenues per pupil shall be |
3 | | calculated as the product of the applicable
equalized assessed
|
4 | | valuation for the district multiplied by 3.00%, and divided by |
5 | | the district's
Average Daily
Attendance figure. For school |
6 | | districts maintaining grades kindergarten
through 8, local
|
7 | | property tax revenues per pupil shall be calculated as the |
8 | | product of the
applicable equalized
assessed valuation for the |
9 | | district multiplied by 2.30%, and divided by the
district's |
10 | | Average
Daily Attendance figure. For school districts |
11 | | maintaining grades 9 through 12,
local property
tax revenues |
12 | | per pupil shall be the applicable equalized assessed valuation |
13 | | of
the district
multiplied by 1.05%, and divided by the |
14 | | district's Average Daily
Attendance
figure. |
15 | | For partial elementary unit districts created pursuant to |
16 | | Article 11E of this Code, local property tax revenues per pupil |
17 | | shall be calculated as the product of the equalized assessed |
18 | | valuation for property within the partial elementary unit |
19 | | district for elementary purposes, as defined in Article 11E of |
20 | | this Code, multiplied by 2.06% and divided by the district's |
21 | | Average Daily Attendance figure, plus the product of the |
22 | | equalized assessed valuation for property within the partial |
23 | | elementary unit district for high school purposes, as defined |
24 | | in Article 11E of this Code, multiplied by 0.94% and divided by |
25 | | the district's Average Daily Attendance figure.
|
26 | | (4) The Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes paid |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 310 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to each school
district during the calendar year one year |
2 | | before the calendar year in which a
school year begins, divided |
3 | | by the Average Daily Attendance figure for that
district, shall |
4 | | be added to the local property tax revenues per pupil as
|
5 | | derived by the application of the immediately preceding |
6 | | paragraph (3). The sum
of these per pupil figures for each |
7 | | school district shall constitute Available
Local Resources as |
8 | | that term is utilized in subsection (E) in the calculation
of |
9 | | general State aid.
|
10 | | (E) Computation of General State Aid. |
11 | | (1) For each school year, the amount of general State aid |
12 | | allotted to a
school district shall be computed by the State |
13 | | Board of Education as provided
in this subsection. |
14 | | (2) For any school district for which Available Local |
15 | | Resources per pupil
is less than the product of 0.93 times the |
16 | | Foundation Level, general State aid
for that district shall be |
17 | | calculated as an amount equal to the Foundation
Level minus |
18 | | Available Local Resources, multiplied by the Average Daily
|
19 | | Attendance of the school district. |
20 | | (3) For any school district for which Available Local |
21 | | Resources per pupil
is equal to or greater than the product of |
22 | | 0.93 times the Foundation Level and
less than the product of |
23 | | 1.75 times the Foundation Level, the general State aid
per |
24 | | pupil shall be a decimal proportion of the Foundation Level |
25 | | derived using a
linear algorithm. Under this linear algorithm, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 311 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the calculated general State
aid per pupil shall decline in |
2 | | direct linear fashion from 0.07 times the
Foundation Level for |
3 | | a school district with Available Local Resources equal to
the |
4 | | product of 0.93 times the Foundation Level, to 0.05 times the |
5 | | Foundation
Level for a school district with Available Local |
6 | | Resources equal to the product
of 1.75 times the Foundation |
7 | | Level. The allocation of general
State aid for school districts |
8 | | subject to this paragraph 3 shall be the
calculated general |
9 | | State aid
per pupil figure multiplied by the Average Daily |
10 | | Attendance of the school
district. |
11 | | (4) For any school district for which Available Local |
12 | | Resources per pupil
equals or exceeds the product of 1.75 times |
13 | | the Foundation Level, the general
State aid for the school |
14 | | district shall be calculated as the product of $218
multiplied |
15 | | by the Average Daily Attendance of the school
district. |
16 | | (5) The amount of general State aid allocated to a school |
17 | | district for
the 1999-2000 school year meeting the requirements |
18 | | set forth in paragraph (4)
of subsection
(G) shall be increased |
19 | | by an amount equal to the general State aid that
would have |
20 | | been received by the district for the 1998-1999 school year by
|
21 | | utilizing the Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed |
22 | | Valuation as calculated
in paragraph (4) of subsection (G) less |
23 | | the general State aid allotted for the
1998-1999
school year. |
24 | | This amount shall be deemed a one time increase, and shall not
|
25 | | affect any future general State aid allocations.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 312 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (F) Compilation of Average Daily Attendance. |
2 | | (1) Each school district shall, by July 1 of each year, |
3 | | submit to the State
Board of Education, on forms prescribed by |
4 | | the State Board of Education,
attendance figures for the school |
5 | | year that began in the preceding calendar
year. The attendance |
6 | | information so transmitted shall identify the average
daily |
7 | | attendance figures for each month of the school year. Beginning |
8 | | with
the general State aid claim form for the 2002-2003 school
|
9 | | year, districts shall calculate Average Daily Attendance as |
10 | | provided in
subdivisions (a), (b), and (c) of this paragraph |
11 | | (1). |
12 | | (a) In districts that do not hold year-round classes,
|
13 | | days of attendance in August shall be added to the month of |
14 | | September and any
days of attendance in June shall be added |
15 | | to the month of May. |
16 | | (b) In districts in which all buildings hold year-round |
17 | | classes,
days of attendance in July and August shall be |
18 | | added to the month
of September and any days of attendance |
19 | | in June shall be added to
the month of May. |
20 | | (c) In districts in which some buildings, but not all, |
21 | | hold
year-round classes, for the non-year-round buildings, |
22 | | days of
attendance in August shall be added to the month of |
23 | | September
and any days of attendance in June shall be added |
24 | | to the month of
May. The average daily attendance for the |
25 | | year-round buildings
shall be computed as provided in |
26 | | subdivision (b) of this paragraph
(1). To calculate the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 313 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Average Daily Attendance for the district, the
average |
2 | | daily attendance for the year-round buildings shall be
|
3 | | multiplied by the days in session for the non-year-round |
4 | | buildings
for each month and added to the monthly |
5 | | attendance of the
non-year-round buildings. |
6 | | Except as otherwise provided in this Section, days of
|
7 | | attendance by pupils shall be counted only for sessions of not |
8 | | less than
5 clock hours of school work per day under direct |
9 | | supervision of: (i)
teachers, or (ii) non-teaching personnel or |
10 | | volunteer personnel when engaging
in non-teaching duties and |
11 | | supervising in those instances specified in
subsection (a) of |
12 | | Section 10-22.34 and paragraph 10 of Section 34-18, with
pupils |
13 | | of legal school age and in kindergarten and grades 1 through |
14 | | 12. Days of attendance by pupils through verified participation |
15 | | in an e-learning program approved by the State Board of |
16 | | Education under Section 10-20.56 of the Code shall be |
17 | | considered as full days of attendance for purposes of this |
18 | | Section. |
19 | | Days of attendance by tuition pupils shall be accredited |
20 | | only to the
districts that pay the tuition to a recognized |
21 | | school. |
22 | | (2) Days of attendance by pupils of less than 5 clock hours |
23 | | of school
shall be subject to the following provisions in the |
24 | | compilation of Average
Daily Attendance. |
25 | | (a) Pupils regularly enrolled in a public school for |
26 | | only a part of
the school day may be counted on the basis |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 314 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of 1/6 day for every class hour
of instruction of 40 |
2 | | minutes or more attended pursuant to such enrollment,
|
3 | | unless a pupil is
enrolled in a block-schedule format of 80 |
4 | | minutes or more of instruction,
in which case the pupil may |
5 | | be counted on the basis of the proportion of
minutes of |
6 | | school work completed each day to the minimum number of
|
7 | | minutes that school work is required to be held that day. |
8 | | (b) (Blank). |
9 | | (c) A session of 4 or more clock hours may be counted |
10 | | as a day of
attendance upon certification by the regional |
11 | | superintendent, and
approved by the State Superintendent |
12 | | of Education to the extent that the
district has been |
13 | | forced to use daily multiple sessions. |
14 | | (d) A session of 3 or more clock hours may be counted |
15 | | as a day of
attendance (1) when the remainder of the school |
16 | | day or at least
2 hours in the evening of that day is |
17 | | utilized for an
in-service training program for teachers, |
18 | | up to a maximum of 5 days per
school year, provided a |
19 | | district conducts an in-service
training program for |
20 | | teachers in accordance with Section 10-22.39 of this Code; |
21 | | or, in lieu of 4 such days, 2 full days may
be used, in |
22 | | which event each such day
may be counted as a day required |
23 | | for a legal school calendar pursuant to Section 10-19 of |
24 | | this Code; (1.5) when, of the 5 days allowed under item |
25 | | (1), a maximum of 4 days are used for parent-teacher |
26 | | conferences, or, in lieu of 4 such days, 2 full days are |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 315 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | used, in which case each such day may be counted as a |
2 | | calendar day required under Section 10-19 of this Code, |
3 | | provided that the full-day, parent-teacher conference |
4 | | consists of (i) a minimum of 5 clock hours of |
5 | | parent-teacher conferences, (ii) both a minimum of 2 clock |
6 | | hours of parent-teacher conferences held in the evening |
7 | | following a full day of student attendance, as specified in |
8 | | subsection (F)(1)(c), and a minimum of 3 clock hours of |
9 | | parent-teacher conferences held on the day immediately |
10 | | following evening parent-teacher conferences, or (iii) |
11 | | multiple parent-teacher conferences held in the evenings |
12 | | following full days of student attendance, as specified in |
13 | | subsection (F)(1)(c), in which the time used for the |
14 | | parent-teacher conferences is equivalent to a minimum of 5 |
15 | | clock hours; and (2) when days in
addition to
those |
16 | | provided in items (1) and (1.5) are scheduled by a school |
17 | | pursuant to its school
improvement plan adopted under |
18 | | Article 34 or its revised or amended school
improvement |
19 | | plan adopted under Article 2, provided that (i) such |
20 | | sessions of
3 or more clock hours are scheduled to occur at |
21 | | regular intervals, (ii) the
remainder of the school days in |
22 | | which such sessions occur are utilized
for in-service |
23 | | training programs or other staff development activities |
24 | | for
teachers, and (iii) a sufficient number of minutes of |
25 | | school work under the
direct supervision of teachers are |
26 | | added to the school days between such
regularly scheduled |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 316 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | sessions to accumulate not less than the number of minutes
|
2 | | by which such sessions of 3 or more clock hours fall short |
3 | | of 5 clock hours.
Any full days used for the purposes of |
4 | | this paragraph shall not be considered
for
computing |
5 | | average daily attendance. Days scheduled for in-service |
6 | | training
programs, staff development activities, or |
7 | | parent-teacher conferences may be
scheduled separately for |
8 | | different
grade levels and different attendance centers of |
9 | | the district. |
10 | | (e) A session of not less than one clock hour of |
11 | | teaching
hospitalized or homebound pupils on-site or by |
12 | | telephone to the classroom may
be counted as 1/2 day of |
13 | | attendance, however these pupils must receive 4 or
more |
14 | | clock hours of instruction to be counted for a full day of |
15 | | attendance. |
16 | | (f) A session of at least 4 clock hours may be counted |
17 | | as a day of
attendance for first grade pupils, and pupils |
18 | | in full day kindergartens,
and a session of 2 or more hours |
19 | | may be counted as 1/2 day of attendance by
pupils in |
20 | | kindergartens which provide only 1/2 day of attendance. |
21 | | (g) For children with disabilities who are below the |
22 | | age of 6 years and
who
cannot attend 2 or more clock hours |
23 | | because of their disability or
immaturity, a session of not |
24 | | less than one clock hour may be counted as 1/2 day
of |
25 | | attendance; however for such children whose educational |
26 | | needs so require
a session of 4 or more clock hours may be |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 317 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | counted as a full day of attendance. |
2 | | (h) A recognized kindergarten which provides for only |
3 | | 1/2 day of
attendance by each pupil shall not have more |
4 | | than 1/2 day of attendance
counted in any one day. However, |
5 | | kindergartens may count 2 1/2 days
of
attendance in any 5 |
6 | | consecutive school days. When a pupil attends such a
|
7 | | kindergarten for 2 half days on any one school day, the |
8 | | pupil shall have
the following day as a day absent from |
9 | | school, unless the school district
obtains permission in |
10 | | writing from the State Superintendent of Education.
|
11 | | Attendance at kindergartens which provide for a full day of |
12 | | attendance by
each pupil shall be counted the same as |
13 | | attendance by first grade pupils.
Only the first year of |
14 | | attendance in one kindergarten shall be counted,
except in |
15 | | case of children who entered the kindergarten in their |
16 | | fifth year
whose educational development requires a second |
17 | | year of kindergarten as
determined under the rules and |
18 | | regulations of the State Board of Education. |
19 | | (i) On the days when the assessment that includes a |
20 | | college and career ready determination is
administered |
21 | | under subsection (c) of Section 2-3.64a-5 of this Code, the |
22 | | day
of attendance for a pupil whose school
day must be |
23 | | shortened to accommodate required testing procedures may
|
24 | | be less than 5 clock hours and shall be counted towards the |
25 | | 176 days of actual pupil attendance required under Section |
26 | | 10-19 of this Code, provided that a sufficient number of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 318 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | minutes
of school work in excess of 5 clock hours are first |
2 | | completed on other school
days to compensate for the loss |
3 | | of school work on the examination days. |
4 | | (j) Pupils enrolled in a remote educational program |
5 | | established under Section 10-29 of this Code may be counted |
6 | | on the basis of one-fifth day of attendance for every clock |
7 | | hour of instruction attended in the remote educational |
8 | | program, provided that, in any month, the school district |
9 | | may not claim for a student enrolled in a remote |
10 | | educational program more days of attendance than the |
11 | | maximum number of days of attendance the district can claim |
12 | | (i) for students enrolled in a building holding year-round |
13 | | classes if the student is classified as participating in |
14 | | the remote educational program on a year-round schedule or |
15 | | (ii) for students enrolled in a building not holding |
16 | | year-round classes if the student is not classified as |
17 | | participating in the remote educational program on a |
18 | | year-round schedule.
|
19 | | (G) Equalized Assessed Valuation Data. |
20 | | (1) For purposes of the calculation of Available Local |
21 | | Resources required
pursuant to subsection (D), the
State Board |
22 | | of Education shall secure from the Department of
Revenue the |
23 | | value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue of
|
24 | | all taxable property of every school district, together with |
25 | | (i) the applicable
tax rate used in extending taxes for the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 319 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | funds of the district as of
September 30 of the previous year
|
2 | | and (ii) the limiting rate for all school
districts subject to |
3 | | property tax extension limitations as imposed under the
|
4 | | Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
|
5 | | The Department of Revenue shall add to the equalized |
6 | | assessed value of all
taxable
property of each school district |
7 | | situated entirely or partially within a county
that is or was |
8 | | subject to the
provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the |
9 | | Property Tax Code (a)
an amount equal to the total amount by |
10 | | which the
homestead exemption allowed under Section 15-176 or |
11 | | 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for
real
property situated in |
12 | | that school district exceeds the total amount that would
have |
13 | | been
allowed in that school district if the maximum reduction |
14 | | under Section 15-176
was
(i) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500 in |
15 | | all other counties in tax year 2003 or (ii) $5,000 in all |
16 | | counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and (b) an amount |
17 | | equal to the aggregate amount for the taxable year of all |
18 | | additional exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax |
19 | | Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or less. The |
20 | | county clerk of any county that is or was subject to the |
21 | | provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code |
22 | | shall
annually calculate and certify to the Department of |
23 | | Revenue for each school
district all
homestead exemption |
24 | | amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code |
25 | | and all amounts of additional exemptions under Section 15-175 |
26 | | of the Property Tax Code for owners with a household income of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 320 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | $30,000 or less. It is the intent of this paragraph that if the |
2 | | general homestead exemption for a parcel of property is |
3 | | determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax |
4 | | Code rather than Section 15-175, then the calculation of |
5 | | Available Local Resources shall not be affected by the |
6 | | difference, if any, between the amount of the general homestead |
7 | | exemption allowed for that parcel of property under Section |
8 | | 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code and the amount that |
9 | | would have been allowed had the general homestead exemption for |
10 | | that parcel of property been determined under Section 15-175 of |
11 | | the Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this |
12 | | paragraph that if additional exemptions are allowed under |
13 | | Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with a |
14 | | household income of less than $30,000, then the calculation of |
15 | | Available Local Resources shall not be affected by the |
16 | | difference, if any, because of those additional exemptions. |
17 | | This equalized assessed valuation, as adjusted further by |
18 | | the requirements of
this subsection, shall be utilized in the |
19 | | calculation of Available Local
Resources. |
20 | | (2) The equalized assessed valuation in paragraph (1) shall |
21 | | be adjusted, as
applicable, in the following manner: |
22 | | (a) For the purposes of calculating State aid under |
23 | | this Section,
with respect to any part of a school district |
24 | | within a redevelopment
project area in respect to which a |
25 | | municipality has adopted tax
increment allocation |
26 | | financing pursuant to the Tax Increment Allocation
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 321 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Redevelopment Act, Sections 11-74.4-1 through 11-74.4-11 |
2 | | of the Illinois
Municipal Code or the Industrial Jobs |
3 | | Recovery Law, Sections 11-74.6-1 through
11-74.6-50 of the |
4 | | Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current equalized
|
5 | | assessed valuation of real property located in any such |
6 | | project area which is
attributable to an increase above the |
7 | | total initial equalized assessed
valuation of such |
8 | | property shall be used as part of the equalized assessed
|
9 | | valuation of the district, until such time as all
|
10 | | redevelopment project costs have been paid, as provided in |
11 | | Section 11-74.4-8
of the Tax Increment Allocation |
12 | | Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 of
the |
13 | | Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of
the |
14 | | equalized assessed valuation of the
district, the total |
15 | | initial equalized assessed valuation or the current
|
16 | | equalized assessed valuation, whichever is lower, shall be |
17 | | used until
such time as all redevelopment project costs |
18 | | have been paid. |
19 | | (b) The real property equalized assessed valuation for |
20 | | a school district
shall be adjusted by subtracting from the |
21 | | real property
value as equalized or assessed by the |
22 | | Department of Revenue for the
district an amount computed |
23 | | by dividing the amount of any abatement of
taxes under |
24 | | Section 18-170 of the Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a |
25 | | district
maintaining grades kindergarten through 12, by |
26 | | 2.30% for a district
maintaining grades kindergarten |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 322 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | through 8, or by 1.05% for a
district
maintaining grades 9 |
2 | | through 12 and adjusted by an amount computed by dividing
|
3 | | the amount of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) |
4 | | of Section 18-165 of
the Property Tax Code by the same |
5 | | percentage rates for district type as
specified in this |
6 | | subparagraph (b). |
7 | | (3) For the 1999-2000 school year and each school year |
8 | | thereafter, if a
school district meets all of the criteria of |
9 | | this subsection (G)(3), the school
district's Available Local |
10 | | Resources shall be calculated under subsection (D)
using the |
11 | | district's Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation |
12 | | as
calculated under this
subsection (G)(3). |
13 | | For purposes of this subsection (G)(3) the following terms |
14 | | shall have
the following meanings: |
15 | | "Budget Year": The school year for which general State |
16 | | aid is calculated
and
awarded under subsection (E). |
17 | | "Base Tax Year": The property tax levy year used to |
18 | | calculate the Budget
Year
allocation of general State aid. |
19 | | "Preceding Tax Year": The property tax levy year |
20 | | immediately preceding the
Base Tax Year. |
21 | | "Base Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of the |
22 | | equalized assessed
valuation utilized by the County Clerk |
23 | | in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the
limiting rate as |
24 | | calculated by the County Clerk and defined in the Property |
25 | | Tax
Extension Limitation Law. |
26 | | "Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 323 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the equalized assessed
valuation utilized by the County |
2 | | Clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by
the Operating |
3 | | Tax Rate as defined in subsection (A). |
4 | | "Extension Limitation Ratio": A numerical ratio, |
5 | | certified by the
County Clerk, in which the numerator is |
6 | | the Base Tax Year's Tax
Extension and the denominator is |
7 | | the Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension. |
8 | | "Operating Tax Rate": The operating tax rate as defined |
9 | | in subsection (A). |
10 | | If a school district is subject to property tax extension |
11 | | limitations as
imposed under
the Property Tax Extension |
12 | | Limitation Law, the State Board of Education shall
calculate |
13 | | the Extension
Limitation
Equalized Assessed Valuation of that |
14 | | district. For the 1999-2000 school
year, the
Extension |
15 | | Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a school district as
|
16 | | calculated by the State Board of Education shall be equal to |
17 | | the product of the
district's 1996 Equalized Assessed Valuation |
18 | | and the district's Extension
Limitation Ratio. Except as |
19 | | otherwise provided in this paragraph for a school district that |
20 | | has approved or does approve an increase in its limiting rate, |
21 | | for the 2000-2001 school year and each school year
thereafter,
|
22 | | the Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a |
23 | | school district as
calculated by the State Board of Education |
24 | | shall be equal to the product of
the Equalized Assessed |
25 | | Valuation last used in the calculation of general State
aid and |
26 | | the
district's Extension Limitation Ratio. If the Extension |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 324 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Limitation
Equalized
Assessed Valuation of a school district as |
2 | | calculated under
this subsection (G)(3) is less than the |
3 | | district's equalized assessed valuation
as calculated pursuant |
4 | | to subsections (G)(1) and (G)(2), then for purposes of
|
5 | | calculating the district's general State aid for the Budget |
6 | | Year pursuant to
subsection (E), that Extension
Limitation |
7 | | Equalized Assessed Valuation shall be utilized to calculate the
|
8 | | district's Available Local Resources
under subsection (D). For |
9 | | the 2009-2010 school year and each school year thereafter, if a |
10 | | school district has approved or does approve an increase in its |
11 | | limiting rate, pursuant to Section 18-190 of the Property Tax |
12 | | Code, affecting the Base Tax Year, the Extension Limitation |
13 | | Equalized Assessed Valuation of the school district, as |
14 | | calculated by the State Board of Education, shall be equal to |
15 | | the product of the Equalized Assessed Valuation last used in |
16 | | the calculation of general State aid times an amount equal to |
17 | | one plus the percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price |
18 | | Index for all Urban Consumers for all items published by the |
19 | | United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar |
20 | | year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the Equalized Assessed |
21 | | Valuation of new property, annexed property, and recovered tax |
22 | | increment value and minus the Equalized Assessed Valuation of |
23 | | disconnected property. New property and recovered tax |
24 | | increment value shall have the meanings set forth in the |
25 | | Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. |
26 | | Partial elementary unit districts created in accordance |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 325 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | with Article 11E of this Code shall not be eligible for the |
2 | | adjustment in this subsection (G)(3) until the fifth year |
3 | | following the effective date of the reorganization.
|
4 | | (3.5) For the 2010-2011 school year and each school year |
5 | | thereafter, if a school district's boundaries span multiple |
6 | | counties, then the Department of Revenue shall send to the |
7 | | State Board of Education, for the purpose of calculating |
8 | | general State aid, the limiting rate and individual rates by |
9 | | purpose for the county that contains the majority of the school |
10 | | district's Equalized Assessed Valuation. |
11 | | (4) For the purposes of calculating general State aid for |
12 | | the 1999-2000
school year only, if a school district |
13 | | experienced a triennial reassessment on
the equalized assessed |
14 | | valuation used in calculating its general State
financial aid |
15 | | apportionment for the 1998-1999 school year, the State Board of
|
16 | | Education shall calculate the Extension Limitation Equalized |
17 | | Assessed Valuation
that would have been used to calculate the |
18 | | district's 1998-1999 general State
aid. This amount shall equal |
19 | | the product of the equalized assessed valuation
used to
|
20 | | calculate general State aid for the 1997-1998 school year and |
21 | | the district's
Extension Limitation Ratio. If the Extension |
22 | | Limitation Equalized Assessed
Valuation of the school district |
23 | | as calculated under this paragraph (4) is
less than the |
24 | | district's equalized assessed valuation utilized in |
25 | | calculating
the
district's 1998-1999 general State aid |
26 | | allocation, then for purposes of
calculating the district's |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 326 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | general State aid pursuant to paragraph (5) of
subsection (E),
|
2 | | that Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation shall |
3 | | be utilized to
calculate the district's Available Local |
4 | | Resources. |
5 | | (5) For school districts having a majority of their |
6 | | equalized assessed
valuation in any county except Cook, DuPage, |
7 | | Kane, Lake, McHenry, or Will, if
the amount of general State |
8 | | aid allocated to the school district for the
1999-2000 school |
9 | | year under the provisions of subsection (E), (H), and (J) of
|
10 | | this Section is less than the amount of general State aid |
11 | | allocated to the
district for the 1998-1999 school year under |
12 | | these subsections, then the
general
State aid of the district |
13 | | for the 1999-2000 school year only shall be increased
by the |
14 | | difference between these amounts. The total payments made under |
15 | | this
paragraph (5) shall not exceed $14,000,000. Claims shall |
16 | | be prorated if they
exceed $14,000,000.
|
17 | | (H) Supplemental General State Aid. |
18 | | (1) In addition to the general State aid a school district |
19 | | is allotted
pursuant to subsection (E), qualifying school |
20 | | districts shall receive a grant,
paid in conjunction with a |
21 | | district's payments of general State aid, for
supplemental |
22 | | general State aid based upon the concentration level of |
23 | | children
from low-income households within the school |
24 | | district.
Supplemental State aid grants provided for school |
25 | | districts under this
subsection shall be appropriated for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 327 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | distribution to school districts as part
of the same line item |
2 | | in which the general State financial aid of school
districts is |
3 | | appropriated under this Section.
|
4 | | (1.5) This paragraph (1.5) applies only to those school |
5 | | years
preceding the 2003-2004 school year.
For purposes of this
|
6 | | subsection (H), the term "Low-Income Concentration Level" |
7 | | shall be the
low-income
eligible pupil count from the most |
8 | | recently available federal census divided by
the Average Daily |
9 | | Attendance of the school district.
If, however, (i) the |
10 | | percentage decrease from the 2 most recent federal
censuses
in |
11 | | the low-income eligible pupil count of a high school district |
12 | | with fewer
than 400 students exceeds by 75% or more the |
13 | | percentage change in the total
low-income eligible pupil count |
14 | | of contiguous elementary school districts,
whose boundaries |
15 | | are coterminous with the high school district,
or (ii) a high |
16 | | school district within 2 counties and serving 5 elementary
|
17 | | school
districts, whose boundaries are coterminous with the |
18 | | high school
district, has a percentage decrease from the 2 most |
19 | | recent federal
censuses in the low-income eligible pupil count |
20 | | and there is a percentage
increase in the total low-income |
21 | | eligible pupil count of a majority of the
elementary school |
22 | | districts in excess of 50% from the 2 most recent
federal |
23 | | censuses, then
the
high school district's low-income eligible |
24 | | pupil count from the earlier federal
census
shall be the number |
25 | | used as the low-income eligible pupil count for the high
school |
26 | | district, for purposes of this subsection (H).
The changes made |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 328 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to this paragraph (1) by Public Act 92-28 shall apply to
|
2 | | supplemental general State aid
grants for school years |
3 | | preceding the 2003-2004 school year that are paid
in fiscal |
4 | | year 1999 or thereafter
and to
any State aid payments made in |
5 | | fiscal year 1994 through fiscal year
1998 pursuant to |
6 | | subsection 1(n) of Section 18-8 of this Code (which was
|
7 | | repealed on July 1, 1998), and any high school district that is |
8 | | affected by
Public Act 92-28 is
entitled to a
recomputation of |
9 | | its supplemental general State aid grant or State aid
paid in |
10 | | any of those fiscal years. This recomputation shall not be
|
11 | | affected by any other funding. |
12 | | (1.10) This paragraph (1.10) applies to the 2003-2004 |
13 | | school year
and each school year thereafter through the |
14 | | 2016-2017 school year . For purposes of this subsection (H), the
|
15 | | term "Low-Income Concentration Level" shall, for each fiscal |
16 | | year, be the
low-income eligible
pupil count
as of July 1 of |
17 | | the immediately preceding fiscal year
(as determined by the |
18 | | Department of Human Services based
on the number of pupils
who |
19 | | are eligible for at least one of the following
low income |
20 | | programs: Medicaid, the Children's Health Insurance Program, |
21 | | TANF, or Food Stamps,
excluding pupils who are eligible for |
22 | | services provided by the Department
of Children and Family |
23 | | Services,
averaged over
the 2 immediately preceding fiscal |
24 | | years for fiscal year 2004 and over the 3
immediately preceding |
25 | | fiscal years for each fiscal year thereafter)
divided by the |
26 | | Average Daily Attendance of the school district. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 329 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this |
2 | | subsection (H) shall
be
provided as follows for the 1998-1999, |
3 | | 1999-2000, and 2000-2001 school years
only: |
4 | | (a) For any school district with a Low Income |
5 | | Concentration Level of at
least 20% and less than 35%, the |
6 | | grant for any school year
shall be $800
multiplied by the |
7 | | low income eligible pupil count. |
8 | | (b) For any school district with a Low Income |
9 | | Concentration Level of at
least 35% and less than 50%, the |
10 | | grant for the 1998-1999 school year shall be
$1,100 |
11 | | multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count. |
12 | | (c) For any school district with a Low Income |
13 | | Concentration Level of at
least 50% and less than 60%, the |
14 | | grant for the 1998-99 school year shall be
$1,500 |
15 | | multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count. |
16 | | (d) For any school district with a Low Income |
17 | | Concentration Level of 60%
or more, the grant for the |
18 | | 1998-99 school year shall be $1,900 multiplied by
the low |
19 | | income eligible pupil count. |
20 | | (e) For the 1999-2000 school year, the per pupil amount |
21 | | specified in
subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d) immediately |
22 | | above shall be increased to $1,243,
$1,600, and $2,000, |
23 | | respectively. |
24 | | (f) For the 2000-2001 school year, the per pupil |
25 | | amounts specified in
subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d) |
26 | | immediately above shall be
$1,273, $1,640, and $2,050, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 330 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | respectively. |
2 | | (2.5) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this |
3 | | subsection (H)
shall be provided as follows for the 2002-2003 |
4 | | school year: |
5 | | (a) For any school district with a Low Income |
6 | | Concentration Level of less
than 10%, the grant for each |
7 | | school year shall be $355 multiplied by the low
income |
8 | | eligible pupil count. |
9 | | (b) For any school district with a Low Income |
10 | | Concentration
Level of at least 10% and less than 20%, the |
11 | | grant for each school year shall
be $675
multiplied by the |
12 | | low income eligible pupil
count. |
13 | | (c) For any school district with a Low Income |
14 | | Concentration
Level of at least 20% and less than 35%, the |
15 | | grant for each school year shall
be $1,330
multiplied by |
16 | | the low income eligible pupil
count. |
17 | | (d) For any school district with a Low Income |
18 | | Concentration
Level of at least 35% and less than 50%, the |
19 | | grant for each school year shall
be $1,362
multiplied by |
20 | | the low income eligible pupil
count. |
21 | | (e) For any school district with a Low Income |
22 | | Concentration
Level of at least 50% and less than 60%, the |
23 | | grant for each school year shall
be $1,680
multiplied by |
24 | | the low income eligible pupil
count. |
25 | | (f) For any school district with a Low Income |
26 | | Concentration
Level of 60% or more, the grant for each |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 331 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | school year shall be $2,080
multiplied by the low income |
2 | | eligible pupil count. |
3 | | (2.10) Except as otherwise provided, supplemental general |
4 | | State aid
pursuant to this subsection
(H) shall be provided as |
5 | | follows for the 2003-2004 school year and each
school year |
6 | | thereafter: |
7 | | (a) For any school district with a Low Income |
8 | | Concentration
Level of 15% or less, the grant for each |
9 | | school year
shall be $355 multiplied by the low income |
10 | | eligible pupil count. |
11 | | (b) For any school district with a Low Income |
12 | | Concentration
Level greater than 15%, the grant for each |
13 | | school year shall be
$294.25 added to the product of $2,700 |
14 | | and the square of the Low
Income Concentration Level, all |
15 | | multiplied by the low income
eligible pupil count. |
16 | | For the 2003-2004 school year and each school year |
17 | | thereafter through the 2008-2009 school year only, the grant |
18 | | shall be no less than the
grant
for
the 2002-2003 school year. |
19 | | For the 2009-2010 school year only, the grant shall
be no
less |
20 | | than the grant for the 2002-2003 school year multiplied by |
21 | | 0.66. For the 2010-2011
school year only, the grant shall be no |
22 | | less than the grant for the 2002-2003
school year
multiplied by |
23 | | 0.33. Notwithstanding the provisions of this paragraph to the |
24 | | contrary, if for any school year supplemental general State aid |
25 | | grants are prorated as provided in paragraph (1) of this |
26 | | subsection (H), then the grants under this paragraph shall be |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 332 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | prorated.
|
2 | | For the 2003-2004 school year only, the grant shall be no |
3 | | greater
than the grant received during the 2002-2003 school |
4 | | year added to the
product of 0.25 multiplied by the difference |
5 | | between the grant amount
calculated under subsection (a) or (b) |
6 | | of this paragraph (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the |
7 | | grant received during the 2002-2003 school year.
For the |
8 | | 2004-2005 school year only, the grant shall be no greater than
|
9 | | the grant received during the 2002-2003 school year added to |
10 | | the
product of 0.50 multiplied by the difference between the |
11 | | grant amount
calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this |
12 | | paragraph (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the grant |
13 | | received during the 2002-2003 school year.
For the 2005-2006 |
14 | | school year only, the grant shall be no greater than
the grant |
15 | | received during the 2002-2003 school year added to the
product |
16 | | of 0.75 multiplied by the difference between the grant amount
|
17 | | calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this paragraph |
18 | | (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the grant received during |
19 | | the 2002-2003
school year. |
20 | | (3) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of |
21 | | more than 1,000
and less than 50,000 that qualify for |
22 | | supplemental general State aid pursuant
to this subsection |
23 | | shall submit a plan to the State Board of Education prior to
|
24 | | October 30 of each year for the use of the funds resulting from |
25 | | this grant of
supplemental general State aid for the |
26 | | improvement of
instruction in which priority is given to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 333 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | meeting the education needs of
disadvantaged children. Such |
2 | | plan shall be submitted in accordance with
rules and |
3 | | regulations promulgated by the State Board of Education. |
4 | | (4) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of |
5 | | 50,000 or more
that qualify for supplemental general State aid |
6 | | pursuant to this subsection
shall be required to distribute |
7 | | from funds available pursuant to this Section,
no less than |
8 | | $261,000,000 in accordance with the following requirements: |
9 | | (a) The required amounts shall be distributed to the |
10 | | attendance centers
within the district in proportion to the |
11 | | number of pupils enrolled at each
attendance center who are |
12 | | eligible to receive free or reduced-price lunches or
|
13 | | breakfasts under the federal Child Nutrition Act of 1966 |
14 | | and under the National
School Lunch Act during the |
15 | | immediately preceding school year. |
16 | | (b) The distribution of these portions of supplemental |
17 | | and general State
aid among attendance centers according to |
18 | | these requirements shall not be
compensated for or |
19 | | contravened by adjustments of the total of other funds
|
20 | | appropriated to any attendance centers, and the Board of |
21 | | Education shall
utilize funding from one or several sources |
22 | | in order to fully implement this
provision annually prior |
23 | | to the opening of school. |
24 | | (c) Each attendance center shall be provided by the
|
25 | | school district a distribution of noncategorical funds and |
26 | | other
categorical funds to which an attendance center is |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 334 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | entitled under law in
order that the general State aid and |
2 | | supplemental general State aid provided
by application of |
3 | | this subsection supplements rather than supplants the
|
4 | | noncategorical funds and other categorical funds provided |
5 | | by the school
district to the attendance centers. |
6 | | (d) Any funds made available under this subsection that |
7 | | by reason of the
provisions of this subsection are not
|
8 | | required to be allocated and provided to attendance centers |
9 | | may be used and
appropriated by the board of the district |
10 | | for any lawful school purpose. |
11 | | (e) Funds received by an attendance center
pursuant to |
12 | | this
subsection shall be used
by the attendance center at |
13 | | the discretion
of the principal and local school council |
14 | | for programs to improve educational
opportunities at |
15 | | qualifying schools through the following programs and
|
16 | | services: early childhood education, reduced class size or |
17 | | improved adult to
student classroom ratio, enrichment |
18 | | programs, remedial assistance, attendance
improvement, and |
19 | | other educationally beneficial expenditures which
|
20 | | supplement
the regular and basic programs as determined by |
21 | | the State Board of Education.
Funds provided shall not be |
22 | | expended for any political or lobbying purposes
as defined |
23 | | by board rule. |
24 | | (f) Each district subject to the provisions of this |
25 | | subdivision (H)(4)
shall submit an
acceptable plan to meet |
26 | | the educational needs of disadvantaged children, in
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 335 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | compliance with the requirements of this paragraph, to the |
2 | | State Board of
Education prior to July 15 of each year. |
3 | | This plan shall be consistent with the
decisions of local |
4 | | school councils concerning the school expenditure plans
|
5 | | developed in accordance with part 4 of Section 34-2.3. The |
6 | | State Board shall
approve or reject the plan within 60 days |
7 | | after its submission. If the plan is
rejected, the district |
8 | | shall give written notice of intent to modify the plan
|
9 | | within 15 days of the notification of rejection and then |
10 | | submit a modified plan
within 30 days after the date of the |
11 | | written notice of intent to modify.
Districts may amend |
12 | | approved plans pursuant to rules promulgated by the State
|
13 | | Board of Education. |
14 | | Upon notification by the State Board of Education that |
15 | | the district has
not submitted a plan prior to July 15 or a |
16 | | modified plan within the time
period specified herein, the
|
17 | | State aid funds affected by that plan or modified plan |
18 | | shall be withheld by the
State Board of Education until a |
19 | | plan or modified plan is submitted. |
20 | | If the district fails to distribute State aid to |
21 | | attendance centers in
accordance with an approved plan, the |
22 | | plan for the following year shall
allocate funds, in |
23 | | addition to the funds otherwise required by this
|
24 | | subsection, to those attendance centers which were |
25 | | underfunded during the
previous year in amounts equal to |
26 | | such underfunding. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 336 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | For purposes of determining compliance with this |
2 | | subsection in relation
to the requirements of attendance |
3 | | center funding, each district subject to the
provisions of |
4 | | this
subsection shall submit as a separate document by |
5 | | December 1 of each year a
report of expenditure data for |
6 | | the prior year in addition to any
modification of its |
7 | | current plan. If it is determined that there has been
a |
8 | | failure to comply with the expenditure provisions of this |
9 | | subsection
regarding contravention or supplanting, the |
10 | | State Superintendent of
Education shall, within 60 days of |
11 | | receipt of the report, notify the
district and any affected |
12 | | local school council. The district shall within
45 days of |
13 | | receipt of that notification inform the State |
14 | | Superintendent of
Education of the remedial or corrective |
15 | | action to be taken, whether by
amendment of the current |
16 | | plan, if feasible, or by adjustment in the plan
for the |
17 | | following year. Failure to provide the expenditure report |
18 | | or the
notification of remedial or corrective action in a |
19 | | timely manner shall
result in a withholding of the affected |
20 | | funds. |
21 | | The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and |
22 | | regulations
to implement the provisions of this |
23 | | subsection. No funds shall be released
under this |
24 | | subdivision (H)(4) to any district that has not submitted a |
25 | | plan
that has been approved by the State Board of |
26 | | Education.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 337 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (I) (Blank).
|
2 | | (J) (Blank).
|
3 | | (K) Grants to Laboratory and Alternative Schools. |
4 | | In calculating the amount to be paid to the governing board |
5 | | of a public
university that operates a laboratory school under |
6 | | this Section or to any
alternative school that is operated by a |
7 | | regional superintendent of schools,
the State
Board of |
8 | | Education shall require by rule such reporting requirements as |
9 | | it
deems necessary. |
10 | | As used in this Section, "laboratory school" means a public |
11 | | school which is
created and operated by a public university and |
12 | | approved by the State Board of
Education. The governing board |
13 | | of a public university which receives funds
from the State |
14 | | Board under this subsection (K) or subsection (g) of Section |
15 | | 18-8.15 of this Code may not increase the number of
students |
16 | | enrolled in its laboratory
school from a single district, if |
17 | | that district is already sending 50 or more
students, except |
18 | | under a mutual agreement between the school board of a
|
19 | | student's district of residence and the university which |
20 | | operates the
laboratory school. A laboratory school may not |
21 | | have more than 1,000 students,
excluding students with |
22 | | disabilities in a special education program. |
23 | | As used in this Section, "alternative school" means a |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 338 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | public school which is
created and operated by a Regional |
2 | | Superintendent of Schools and approved by
the State Board of |
3 | | Education. Such alternative schools may offer courses of
|
4 | | instruction for which credit is given in regular school |
5 | | programs, courses to
prepare students for the high school |
6 | | equivalency testing program or vocational
and occupational |
7 | | training. A regional superintendent of schools may contract
|
8 | | with a school district or a public community college district |
9 | | to operate an
alternative school. An alternative school serving |
10 | | more than one educational
service region may be established by |
11 | | the regional superintendents of schools
of the affected |
12 | | educational service regions. An alternative school
serving |
13 | | more than one educational service region may be operated under |
14 | | such
terms as the regional superintendents of schools of those |
15 | | educational service
regions may agree. |
16 | | Each laboratory and alternative school shall file, on forms |
17 | | provided by the
State Superintendent of Education, an annual |
18 | | State aid claim which states the
Average Daily Attendance of |
19 | | the school's students by month. The best 3 months'
Average |
20 | | Daily Attendance shall be computed for each school.
The general |
21 | | State aid entitlement shall be computed by multiplying the
|
22 | | applicable Average Daily Attendance by the Foundation Level as |
23 | | determined under
this Section.
|
24 | | (L) Payments, Additional Grants in Aid and Other Requirements. |
25 | | (1) For a school district operating under the financial |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 339 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | supervision
of an Authority created under Article 34A, the |
2 | | general State aid otherwise
payable to that district under this |
3 | | Section, but not the supplemental general
State aid, shall be |
4 | | reduced by an amount equal to the budget for
the operations of |
5 | | the Authority as certified by the Authority to the State
Board |
6 | | of Education, and an amount equal to such reduction shall be |
7 | | paid
to the Authority created for such district for its |
8 | | operating expenses in
the manner provided in Section 18-11. The |
9 | | remainder
of general State school aid for any such district |
10 | | shall be paid in accordance
with Article 34A when that Article |
11 | | provides for a disposition other than that
provided by this |
12 | | Article. |
13 | | (2) (Blank). |
14 | | (3) Summer school. Summer school payments shall be made as |
15 | | provided in
Section 18-4.3.
|
16 | | (M) (Blank). Education Funding Advisory Board. |
17 | | The Education Funding Advisory
Board, hereinafter in this |
18 | | subsection (M) referred to as the "Board", is hereby
created. |
19 | | The Board
shall consist of 5 members who are appointed by the |
20 | | Governor, by and with the
advice and consent of the Senate. The |
21 | | members appointed shall include
representatives of education, |
22 | | business, and the general public. One of the
members so |
23 | | appointed shall be
designated by the Governor at the time the |
24 | | appointment is made as the
chairperson of the
Board.
The |
25 | | initial members of the Board may
be appointed any time after |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 340 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the effective date of this amendatory Act of
1997. The regular |
2 | | term of each member of the
Board shall be for 4 years from the |
3 | | third Monday of January of the
year in which the term of the |
4 | | member's appointment is to commence, except that
of the 5 |
5 | | initial members appointed to serve on the
Board, the member who |
6 | | is appointed as the chairperson shall serve for
a term that |
7 | | commences on the date of his or her appointment and expires on |
8 | | the
third Monday of January, 2002, and the remaining 4 members, |
9 | | by lots drawn at
the first meeting of the Board that is
held
|
10 | | after all 5 members are appointed, shall determine 2 of their |
11 | | number to serve
for terms that commence on the date of their
|
12 | | respective appointments and expire on the third
Monday of |
13 | | January, 2001,
and 2 of their number to serve for terms that |
14 | | commence
on the date of their respective appointments and |
15 | | expire on the third Monday
of January, 2000. All members |
16 | | appointed to serve on the
Board shall serve until their |
17 | | respective successors are
appointed and confirmed. Vacancies |
18 | | shall be filled in the same manner as
original appointments. If |
19 | | a vacancy in membership occurs at a time when the
Senate is not |
20 | | in session, the Governor shall make a temporary appointment |
21 | | until
the next meeting of the Senate, when he or she shall |
22 | | appoint, by and with the
advice and consent of the Senate, a |
23 | | person to fill that membership for the
unexpired term. If the |
24 | | Senate is not in session when the initial appointments
are |
25 | | made, those appointments shall
be made as in the case of |
26 | | vacancies. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 341 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | The Education Funding Advisory Board shall be deemed |
2 | | established,
and the initial
members appointed by the Governor |
3 | | to serve as members of the
Board shall take office,
on the date |
4 | | that the
Governor makes his or her appointment of the fifth |
5 | | initial member of the
Board, whether those initial members are |
6 | | then serving
pursuant to appointment and confirmation or |
7 | | pursuant to temporary appointments
that are made by the |
8 | | Governor as in the case of vacancies. |
9 | | The State Board of Education shall provide such staff |
10 | | assistance to the
Education Funding Advisory Board as is |
11 | | reasonably required for the proper
performance by the Board of |
12 | | its responsibilities. |
13 | | For school years after the 2000-2001 school year, the |
14 | | Education
Funding Advisory Board, in consultation with the |
15 | | State Board of Education,
shall make recommendations as |
16 | | provided in this subsection (M) to the General
Assembly for the |
17 | | foundation level under subdivision (B)(3) of this Section and
|
18 | | for the
supplemental general State aid grant level under |
19 | | subsection (H) of this Section
for districts with high |
20 | | concentrations of children from poverty. The
recommended |
21 | | foundation level shall be determined based on a methodology |
22 | | which
incorporates the basic education expenditures of |
23 | | low-spending schools
exhibiting high academic performance. The |
24 | | Education Funding Advisory Board
shall make such |
25 | | recommendations to the General Assembly on January 1 of odd
|
26 | | numbered years, beginning January 1, 2001.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 342 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (N) (Blank).
|
2 | | (O) References. |
3 | | (1) References in other laws to the various subdivisions of
|
4 | | Section 18-8 as that Section existed before its repeal and |
5 | | replacement by this
Section 18-8.05 shall be deemed to refer to |
6 | | the corresponding provisions of
this Section 18-8.05, to the |
7 | | extent that those references remain applicable. |
8 | | (2) References in other laws to State Chapter 1 funds shall |
9 | | be deemed to
refer to the supplemental general State aid |
10 | | provided under subsection (H) of
this Section. |
11 | | (P) Public Act 93-838 and Public Act 93-808 make inconsistent |
12 | | changes to this Section. Under Section 6 of the Statute on |
13 | | Statutes there is an irreconcilable conflict between Public Act |
14 | | 93-808 and Public Act 93-838. Public Act 93-838, being the last |
15 | | acted upon, is controlling. The text of Public Act 93-838 is |
16 | | the law regardless of the text of Public Act 93-808. |
17 | | (Q) State Fiscal Year 2015 Payments. |
18 | | For payments made for State fiscal year 2015, the State |
19 | | Board of Education shall, for each school district, calculate |
20 | | that district's pro-rata share of a minimum sum of $13,600,000 |
21 | | or additional amounts as needed from the total net General |
22 | | State Aid funding as calculated under this Section that shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 343 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be deemed attributable to the provision of special educational |
2 | | facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this |
3 | | Code, in a manner that ensures compliance with maintenance of |
4 | | State financial support requirements under the federal |
5 | | Individuals with Disabilities Education Act. Each school |
6 | | district must use such funds only for the provision of special |
7 | | educational facilities and services, as defined in Section |
8 | | 14-1.08 of this Code, and must comply with any expenditure |
9 | | verification procedures adopted by the State Board of |
10 | | Education. |
11 | | (R) State Fiscal Year 2016 Payments. |
12 | | For payments made for State fiscal year 2016, the State |
13 | | Board of Education shall, for each school district, calculate |
14 | | that district's pro rata share of a minimum sum of $1 or |
15 | | additional amounts as needed from the total net General State |
16 | | Aid funding as calculated under this Section that shall be |
17 | | deemed attributable to the provision of special educational |
18 | | facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this |
19 | | Code, in a manner that ensures compliance with maintenance of |
20 | | State financial support requirements under the federal |
21 | | Individuals with Disabilities Education Act. Each school |
22 | | district must use such funds only for the provision of special |
23 | | educational facilities and services, as defined in Section |
24 | | 14-1.08 of this Code, and must comply with any expenditure |
25 | | verification procedures adopted by the State Board of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 344 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Education. |
2 | | (Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14; 99-2, eff. 3-26-15; 99-194, |
3 | | eff. 7-30-15; 99-523, eff. 6-30-16.) |
4 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-8.10) |
5 | | Sec. 18-8.10. Fast growth grants.
|
6 | | (a) If there has been an increase in a school district's |
7 | | student population over the most recent 2 school years of (i) |
8 | | over 1.5% in a district with over 10,000 pupils in average |
9 | | daily attendance (as defined in Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of |
10 | | this Code) or (ii) over 7.5% in any other district, then the |
11 | | district is eligible for a grant under this Section, subject to |
12 | | appropriation. |
13 | | (b) The State Board of Education shall determine a per |
14 | | pupil grant amount for each school district. The total grant |
15 | | amount for a district for any given school year shall equal the |
16 | | per pupil grant amount multiplied by the difference between the |
17 | | number of pupils in average daily attendance for the 2 most |
18 | | recent school years. |
19 | | (c) Funds for grants under this Section must be |
20 | | appropriated to the State Board of Education in a separate line |
21 | | item for this purpose. If the amount appropriated in any fiscal |
22 | | year is insufficient to pay all grants for a school year, then |
23 | | the amount appropriated shall be prorated among eligible |
24 | | districts. As soon as possible after funds have been |
25 | | appropriated to the State Board of Education, the State Board |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 345 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of Education shall distribute the grants to eligible districts. |
2 | | (d) If a school district intentionally reports incorrect |
3 | | average daily attendance numbers to receive a grant under this |
4 | | Section, then the district shall be denied State aid in the |
5 | | same manner as State aid is denied for intentional incorrect |
6 | | reporting of average daily attendance numbers under Section |
7 | | 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code.
|
8 | | (Source: P.A. 93-1042, eff. 10-8-04.) |
9 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15 new) |
10 | | Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-based funding for student success |
11 | | for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years. |
12 | | (a) General provisions. |
13 | | (1) The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by June |
14 | | 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten through |
15 | | grade 12 public education system with the capacity to ensure |
16 | | the educational development of all persons to the limits of |
17 | | their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of Article X of |
18 | | the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To accomplish that |
19 | | objective, this Section creates a method of funding public |
20 | | education that is evidence-based; is sufficient to ensure every |
21 | | student receives a meaningful opportunity to learn |
22 | | irrespective of race, ethnicity, sexual orientation, gender, |
23 | | or community-income level; and is sustainable and predictable. |
24 | | When fully funded under this Section, every school shall have |
25 | | the resources, based on what the evidence indicates is needed, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 346 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to: |
2 | | (A) provide all students with a high quality education |
3 | | that offers the academic, enrichment, social and emotional |
4 | | support, technical, and career-focused programs that will |
5 | | allow them to become competitive workers, responsible |
6 | | parents, productive citizens of this State, and active |
7 | | members of our national democracy; |
8 | | (B) ensure all students receive the education they need |
9 | | to graduate from high school with the skills required to |
10 | | pursue post-secondary education and training for a |
11 | | rewarding career; |
12 | | (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the achievement |
13 | | gap between at-risk and non-at-risk students by raising the |
14 | | performance of at-risk students and not by reducing |
15 | | standards; and |
16 | | (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to |
17 | | assume the primary responsibility to fund public education |
18 | | and simultaneously relieve the disproportionate burden |
19 | | placed on local property taxes to fund schools. |
20 | | (2) The evidence-based funding formula under this Section |
21 | | shall be applied to all Organizational Units in this State. As |
22 | | further defined and described in this Section, there are 4 |
23 | | major components of the evidence-based funding model: |
24 | | (A) First, the model calculates a unique adequacy |
25 | | target for each Organizational Unit in this State that |
26 | | considers the costs to implement research-based |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 347 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | activities, the unit's student demographics, and regional |
2 | | wage difference. |
3 | | (B) Second, the model calculates each Organizational |
4 | | Unit's local capacity, or the amount each Organizational |
5 | | Unit is assumed to contribute towards its adequacy target |
6 | | from local resources. |
7 | | (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding the |
8 | | State currently contributes to the Organizational Unit, |
9 | | and adds that to the unit's local capacity to determine the |
10 | | unit's overall current adequacy of funding. |
11 | | (D) Finally, the model's distribution method allocates |
12 | | new State funding to those Organizational Units that are |
13 | | least well-funded, considering both local capacity and |
14 | | State funding, in relation to their adequacy target. |
15 | | (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under this |
16 | | Section may apply those funds to any fund so received for which |
17 | | that Organizational Unit is authorized to make expenditures by |
18 | | law. |
19 | | (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall have |
20 | | the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4): |
21 | | "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection |
22 | | (b) of this Section. |
23 | | "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection |
24 | | (d) of this Section. |
25 | | "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph |
26 | | (3) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 348 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of subsection |
2 | | (g) of this Section. |
3 | | "Alternative School" means a public school that is created |
4 | | and operated by a regional superintendent of schools and |
5 | | approved by the State Board. |
6 | | "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
7 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
8 | | "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress |
9 | | monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments, in |
10 | | addition to the State accountability assessment, that assist |
11 | | teachers' needs in understanding the skills and meeting the |
12 | | needs of the students they serve. |
13 | | "Assistant principal" means a school administrator duly |
14 | | endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in this |
15 | | State. |
16 | | "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not |
17 | | meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating from |
18 | | elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need for |
19 | | vocational support or social services beyond that provided by |
20 | | the regular school program. All students included in an |
21 | | Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as well as all EL and |
22 | | disabled students attending the Organizational Unit, shall be |
23 | | considered at-risk students under this Section. |
24 | | "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means, for an |
25 | | Organizational Unit in a given school year, the greater of the |
26 | | average number of students (grades K through 12) reported to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 349 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit on |
2 | | October 1 and March 1, plus the special education |
3 | | pre-kindergarten students with services of at least more than 2 |
4 | | hours a day as reported to the State Board on December 1, in |
5 | | the immediately preceding school year or the average number of |
6 | | students (grades K through 12) reported to the State Board as |
7 | | enrolled in the Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, |
8 | | plus the special education pre-kindergarten students with |
9 | | services of
at least more than 2 hours a day as reported to the |
10 | | State Board on December 1, for each of the immediately |
11 | | preceding 3 school years. For the purposes of this definition, |
12 | | "enrolled in the Organizational Unit" means the number of |
13 | | students reported to the State Board who are enrolled in |
14 | | schools within the Organizational Unit that the student attends |
15 | | or would attend if not placed or transferred to another school |
16 | | or program to receive needed services. For the purposes of |
17 | | calculating "ASE", all students, grades K through 12, including |
18 | | those attending kindergarten for a half day, shall be counted |
19 | | as 1.0. Special education pre-kindergarten students shall be |
20 | | counted as 0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or has |
21 | | not collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment count by |
22 | | grade or a December 1 collection of special education |
23 | | pre-kindergarten students as of the effective date of this |
24 | | amendatory Act of the 100th General Assembly, it shall |
25 | | establish such collection for all future years. For any year |
26 | | where a count by grade level was collected only once, that |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 350 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | count shall be used as the single count available for computing |
2 | | a 3-year average ASE. School districts shall submit the data |
3 | | for the ASE calculation to the State Board within 45 days of |
4 | | the dates required in this Section for submission of enrollment |
5 | | data in order for it to be included in the ASE calculation. |
6 | | "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (7) of |
7 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
8 | | "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of this |
9 | | Section. |
10 | | "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used to |
11 | | calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State aid. |
12 | | "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the |
13 | | equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk in |
14 | | the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as calculated |
15 | | by the county clerk and defined in PTELL. |
16 | | "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary State |
17 | | aid is calculated and awarded under this Section. |
18 | | "Central office" means individual administrators and |
19 | | support service personnel charged with managing the |
20 | | instructional programs, business and operations, and security |
21 | | of the Organizational Unit. |
22 | | "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost |
23 | | differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional |
24 | | variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not |
25 | | educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the |
26 | | first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 351 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | CWI initially developed by the National Center for Education |
2 | | Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A & M University. |
3 | | In the fourth and subsequent years of Evidence-Based Funding |
4 | | implementation, the State Superintendent shall re-determine |
5 | | the CWI using a similar methodology to that identified in the |
6 | | Texas A & M University study, with adjustments made no less |
7 | | frequently than once every 5 years. |
8 | | "Computer technology and equipment" means computers |
9 | | servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers, |
10 | | instructional software, security software, curriculum |
11 | | management courseware, and other similar materials and |
12 | | equipment. |
13 | | "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading, |
14 | | English, writing, and language arts; history and social |
15 | | studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced |
16 | | Placement in high schools. |
17 | | "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in |
18 | | elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle and |
19 | | high schools. |
20 | | "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed |
21 | | teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to |
22 | | students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects. |
23 | | "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement tax |
24 | | funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the calendar year |
25 | | one year before the calendar year in which a school year |
26 | | begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the abolition of ad |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 352 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | valorem personal property tax and the replacement of revenues |
2 | | lost thereby, and amending and repealing certain Acts and parts |
3 | | of Acts in connection therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as |
4 | | amended (Public Act 81-1st S.S.-1). |
5 | | "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in |
6 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and calculated |
7 | | in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection (d) of this |
8 | | Section. |
9 | | "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national |
10 | | employment cost index for civilian workers in educational |
11 | | services in elementary and secondary schools on a cumulative |
12 | | basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding the fiscal year |
13 | | of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation. |
14 | | "EIS Data" means the employment information system data |
15 | | maintained by the State Board on educators within |
16 | | Organizational Units. |
17 | | "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision |
18 | | insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit, the |
19 | | costs associated with statutorily required payment of the |
20 | | normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher pensions, |
21 | | Social Security employer contributions, and Illinois Municipal |
22 | | Retirement Fund employer contributions. |
23 | | "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the |
24 | | definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of this |
25 | | Code participating in a program of transitional bilingual |
26 | | education or a transitional program of instruction meeting the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 353 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | requirements and program application procedures of Article 14C |
2 | | of this Code. For the purposes of collecting the number of EL |
3 | | students enrolled, the same collection and calculation |
4 | | methodology as defined above for "ASE" shall apply to English |
5 | | learners. |
6 | | "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources, and |
7 | | educational programs that have been identified through |
8 | | academic research as necessary to improve student success, |
9 | | improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and |
10 | | provide for other per student costs related to the delivery and |
11 | | leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the |
12 | | maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are specified |
13 | | in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section. |
14 | | "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided to |
15 | | an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section. |
16 | | "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs |
17 | | provided to students outside the regular school day before and |
18 | | after school or during non-instructional times during the |
19 | | school day. |
20 | | "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio in |
21 | | which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and the |
22 | | denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension. |
23 | | "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4) of |
24 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
25 | | "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of subsection |
26 | | (f) of this Section. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 354 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time |
2 | | equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant position at |
3 | | an Organizational Unit. |
4 | | "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection |
5 | | (g). |
6 | | "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance counselor |
7 | | who provides guidance and counseling support for students |
8 | | within an Organizational Unit. |
9 | | "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit district |
10 | | created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code. |
11 | | "Instructional assistant" means a core or special |
12 | | education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in the |
13 | | classroom and provides academic support to students. |
14 | | "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher or |
15 | | licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches continuous |
16 | | improvement in classroom instruction; provides instructional |
17 | | support to teachers in the elements of research-based |
18 | | instruction or demonstrates the alignment of instruction with |
19 | | curriculum standards and assessment tools; develops or |
20 | | coordinates instructional programs or strategies; develops and |
21 | | implements training; chooses standards-based instructional |
22 | | materials; provides teachers with an understanding of current |
23 | | research; serves as a mentor, site coach, curriculum |
24 | | specialist, or lead teacher; or otherwise works with fellow |
25 | | teachers, in collaboration, to use data to improve |
26 | | instructional practice or develop model lessons. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 355 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional |
2 | | materials for student instruction, including, but not limited |
3 | | to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory equipment, |
4 | | library books, and other similar materials. |
5 | | "Laboratory School" means a public school that is created |
6 | | and operated by a public university and approved by the State |
7 | | Board. |
8 | | "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a |
9 | | library information specialist or another individual whose |
10 | | primary responsibility is overseeing library resources within |
11 | | an Organizational Unit. |
12 | | "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection |
13 | | (c) of this Section. |
14 | | "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph (A) |
15 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
16 | | "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B) of |
17 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
18 | | "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
19 | | subsection (c) of this Section. |
20 | | "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit in a |
21 | | fiscal year, the higher of the average number of students for |
22 | | the prior school year or the immediately preceding 3 school |
23 | | years who, as of July 1 of the immediately preceding fiscal |
24 | | year (as determined by the Department of Human Services), are |
25 | | eligible for at least one of the following low income programs: |
26 | | Medicaid, the Children's Health Insurance Program, TANF, or |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 356 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Food Stamps, excluding pupils who are eligible for services |
2 | | provided by the Department of Children and Family Services. |
3 | | Until such time that grade level low-income populations become |
4 | | available, grade level low-income populations shall be |
5 | | determined by applying the low-income percentage to total |
6 | | student enrollments by grade level. The low-income percentage |
7 | | is determined by dividing the Low-Income Count by the Average |
8 | | Student Enrollment. |
9 | | "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services, |
10 | | facility and ground maintenance, facility operations, facility |
11 | | security, routine facility repairs, and other similar services |
12 | | and functions. |
13 | | "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (6) of |
14 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
15 | | "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all State |
16 | | funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in excess of the |
17 | | amount needed to fund the Base Funding Minimum for all |
18 | | Organizational Units in that school year. |
19 | | "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given school |
20 | | year, the amount of State funds that would be necessary to |
21 | | fully meet the Adequacy Target of an Operational Unit minus the |
22 | | Preliminary Resources available to each unit. |
23 | | "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified school |
24 | | nurse, in accordance with the rules established for nursing |
25 | | services by the State Board, who is an employee of and is |
26 | | available to provide health care-related services for students |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 357 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of an Organizational Unit. |
2 | | "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the |
3 | | previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes, |
4 | | except, Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital |
5 | | Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes. For |
6 | | Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the combined |
7 | | elementary and high school rates utilized in the previous year |
8 | | to extend property taxes for all purposes, except, Bond and |
9 | | Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital Improvement, and |
10 | | Vocational Education Building purposes. For all Organizational |
11 | | Units, the State Superintendent shall calculate and subtract |
12 | | from the Operating Tax Rate a transportation rate based on |
13 | | total expenses for transportation services under this Code, as |
14 | | reported on the most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil |
15 | | Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the Education |
16 | | and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and 4120 in the |
17 | | Transportation fund, less any corresponding fiscal year State |
18 | | of Illinois scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for |
19 | | prior years for regular, vocational, or special education |
20 | | transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or |
21 | | subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code divided by the |
22 | | Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational Unit's corresponding fiscal |
23 | | year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding net |
24 | | adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or special |
25 | | education transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section |
26 | | 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 358 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the total transportation expenses, as defined in this |
2 | | paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from the |
3 | | Operating Tax Rate. |
4 | | "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School, an |
5 | | Alternative School, or any public school district that is |
6 | | recognized as such by the State Board and that contains |
7 | | elementary schools typically serving kindergarten through 5th |
8 | | grades, middle schools typically serving 6th through 8th |
9 | | grades, or high schools typically serving 9th through 12th |
10 | | grades. The General Assembly acknowledges that the actual grade |
11 | | levels served by a particular Organizational Unit may vary |
12 | | slightly from what is typical. |
13 | | "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating the |
14 | | CWI in the region and original county in which an |
15 | | Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is located |
16 | | as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if the |
17 | | Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance with this |
18 | | paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational Unit CWI shall |
19 | | be increased to 0.9. Each county's current CWI value shall be |
20 | | adjusted based on the CWI value of that county's neighboring |
21 | | Illinois counties, to create a "weighted adjusted index value". |
22 | | This shall be calculated by summing the CWI values of all of a |
23 | | county's adjacent Illinois counties and dividing by the number |
24 | | of adjacent Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value |
25 | | of the original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois |
26 | | county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the number |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 359 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the original |
2 | | county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and the adjacent |
3 | | Illinois county average will be weighted at 0.75. If the number |
4 | | of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the original county's CWI |
5 | | value will be weighted at 0.33 and the adjacent Illinois county |
6 | | average will be weighted at 0.66. The greater of the county's |
7 | | current CWI value and its weighted adjusted index value shall |
8 | | be used as the Organizational Unit CWI. |
9 | | "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year |
10 | | immediately preceding the Base Tax Year. |
11 | | "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the |
12 | | equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk in |
13 | | the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating Tax Rate. |
14 | | "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph |
15 | | (2) of subsection (f) of this Section. |
16 | | "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
17 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
18 | | "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed to |
19 | | be employed as a principal in this State. |
20 | | "Professional development" means training programs for |
21 | | licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to, |
22 | | programs that assist in implementing new curriculum programs, |
23 | | provide data focused or academic assessment data training to |
24 | | help staff identify a student's weaknesses and strengths, |
25 | | target interventions, improve instruction, encompass |
26 | | instructional strategies for EL, gifted, or at-risk students, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 360 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | address inclusivity, cultural sensitivity, or implicit bias, |
2 | | or otherwise provide professional support for licensed staff. |
3 | | "Prototypical" means 450 special education |
4 | | pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students for |
5 | | an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students for a |
6 | | middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students for a high |
7 | | school. |
8 | | "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. |
9 | | "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection (d) |
10 | | of this Section. |
11 | | "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist, social |
12 | | worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff member who |
13 | | provides support to at-risk or struggling students. |
14 | | "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection |
15 | | (d) of this Section. |
16 | | "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular |
17 | | Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the |
18 | | Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI. |
19 | | "School site staff" means the primary school secretary and |
20 | | any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school. |
21 | | "Special education" means special educational facilities |
22 | | and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code. |
23 | | "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides |
24 | | instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects, |
25 | | including, but not limited to, art, music, physical education, |
26 | | health, driver education, career-technical education, and such |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 361 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | other subject areas as may be mandated by State law or provided |
2 | | by an Organizational Unit. |
3 | | "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School, safe |
4 | | school, Department of Juvenile Justice school, special |
5 | | education cooperative or entity recognized by the State Board |
6 | | as a special education cooperative, State-approved charter |
7 | | school, or alternative learning opportunities program that |
8 | | received direct funding from the State Board during the |
9 | | 2016-2017 school year through any of the funding sources |
10 | | included within the calculation of the Base Funding Minimum or |
11 | | Glenwood Academy. |
12 | | "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental general |
13 | | State aid funding received by an Organization Unit during the |
14 | | 2016-2017 school year pursuant to subsection (H) of Section |
15 | | 18-8.05 of this Code. |
16 | | "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy Targets |
17 | | of all Organizational Units. |
18 | | "State Board" means the State Board of Education. |
19 | | "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent of |
20 | | Education. |
21 | | "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by |
22 | | multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for that |
23 | | Organizational Unit creating a weighted value, summing all |
24 | | Organizational Unit's weighted values, and dividing by the |
25 | | total ASE of all Organizational Units, thereby creating an |
26 | | average weighted index. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 362 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | "Student activities" means non-credit producing |
2 | | after-school programs, including, but not limited to, clubs, |
3 | | bands, sports, and other activities authorized by the school |
4 | | board of the Organizational Unit. |
5 | | "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or |
6 | | teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational Unit |
7 | | and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on a per |
8 | | diem or per period-assignment basis replacing another staff |
9 | | member. |
10 | | "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs |
11 | | provided to students during the summer months outside of the |
12 | | regular school year. |
13 | | "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member who |
14 | | helps in supervising students of an Organizational Unit, but |
15 | | does so outside of the classroom, in situations such as, but |
16 | | not limited to, monitoring hallways and playgrounds, |
17 | | supervising lunchrooms, or supervising students when being |
18 | | transported in buses serving the Organizational Unit. |
19 | | "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection |
20 | | (g). |
21 | | "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined in |
22 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (g). |
23 | | "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate Funding", |
24 | | "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate Funding" are |
25 | | defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g). |
26 | | (b) Adequacy Target calculation. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 363 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the sum |
2 | | of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing Essential |
3 | | Elements, as calculated in accordance with this subsection (b), |
4 | | with the salary amounts in the Essential Elements multiplied by |
5 | | a Regionalization Factor calculated pursuant to paragraph (3) |
6 | | of this subsection (b). |
7 | | (2) The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro-rata |
8 | | basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each |
9 | | Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2), with |
10 | | investments and FTE positions pro-rata funded based on ASE |
11 | | counts in excess or less than the thresholds set forth in this |
12 | | paragraph (2). The method for calculating attributable |
13 | | pro-rata costs and the defined subgroups thereto are as |
14 | | follows: |
15 | | (A) Core class size investments. Each Organizational |
16 | | Unit shall receive the funding required to support that |
17 | | number of FTE core teacher positions as is needed to keep |
18 | | the respective class sizes of the Organizational Unit to |
19 | | the following maximum numbers: |
20 | | (1) For grades kindergarten through 3, the |
21 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding required to |
22 | | support one FTE core teacher position for every 15 |
23 | | Low-Income Count students in those grades and one FTE |
24 | | core teacher position for every 20 non-Low-Income |
25 | | Count students in those grades. |
26 | | (2) For grades 4 through 12, the Organizational |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 364 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Unit shall receive funding required to support one FTE |
2 | | core teacher position for every 20 Low-Income Count |
3 | | students in those grades and one FTE core teacher |
4 | | position for every 25 non-Low-Income Count students in |
5 | | those grades. |
6 | | The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a grade |
7 | | shall be determined by subtracting the Low-Income students |
8 | | in that grade from the ASE of the Organizational Unit for |
9 | | that grade. |
10 | | (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each |
11 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed to |
12 | | cover that number of FTE specialist teacher positions that |
13 | | correspond to the following percentages: |
14 | | (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an |
15 | | elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the number |
16 | | of the Organizational Unit's core teachers, as |
17 | | determined under subparagraph (A) of this paragraph |
18 | | (2); and |
19 | | (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a high |
20 | | school, then 33.33% of the number of the Organizational |
21 | | Unit's core teachers. |
22 | | (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each |
23 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed to |
24 | | cover one FTE instructional facilitator position for every |
25 | | 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
26 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 365 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | students of the Organizational Unit. |
2 | | (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments. |
3 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
4 | | to cover one FTE teacher position for each prototypical |
5 | | elementary, middle, and high school. |
6 | | (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each |
7 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed to |
8 | | cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to 5.70% of |
9 | | the minimum pupil attendance days required under Section |
10 | | 10-19 of this code for all full-time equivalent core, |
11 | | specialist, and intervention teachers, school nurses, |
12 | | special education teachers and instructional assistants, |
13 | | instructional facilitators, and summer school and |
14 | | extended-day teacher positions, as determined under this |
15 | | paragraph (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average |
16 | | salary for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the |
17 | | average salary of each instructional assistant position. |
18 | | (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each |
19 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed to |
20 | | cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450 combined ASE |
21 | | of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
22 | | kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE |
23 | | guidance counselor for each 250 grades 6 through 8 ASE |
24 | | middle school students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for |
25 | | each 250 grades 9 through 12 ASE high school students. |
26 | | (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 366 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse for each |
2 | | 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
3 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
4 | | students across all grade levels it serves. |
5 | | (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each Organizational |
6 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE for |
7 | | each 225 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
8 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5 |
9 | | students, plus one FTE for each 225 ASE middle school |
10 | | students, plus one FTE for each 200 ASE high school |
11 | | students. |
12 | | (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational Unit |
13 | | shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE librarian |
14 | | for each prototypical elementary school, middle school, |
15 | | and high school and one FTE aide or media technician for |
16 | | every 300 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
17 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
18 | | students. |
19 | | (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational Unit |
20 | | shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE principal |
21 | | position for each prototypical elementary school, plus one |
22 | | FTE principal position for each prototypical middle |
23 | | school, plus one FTE principal position for each |
24 | | prototypical high school. |
25 | | (K) Assistant principal investments. Each |
26 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 367 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | cover one FTE assistant principal position for each |
2 | | prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant |
3 | | principal position for each prototypical middle school, |
4 | | plus one FTE assistant principal position for each |
5 | | prototypical high school. |
6 | | (L) School site staff investments. Each Organizational |
7 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed for one FTE position |
8 | | for each 225 ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
9 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5 |
10 | | students, plus one FTE position for each 225 ASE middle |
11 | | school students, plus one FTE position for each 200 ASE |
12 | | high school students. |
13 | | (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit shall |
14 | | receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12 ASE. |
15 | | (N) Professional development investments. Each |
16 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of the |
17 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
18 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
19 | | students for trainers and other professional |
20 | | development-related expenses for supplies and materials. |
21 | | (O) Instructional material investments. Each |
22 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of the |
23 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
24 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
25 | | students to cover instructional material costs. |
26 | | (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational Unit |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 368 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE of |
2 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
3 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students student to cover |
4 | | assessment costs. |
5 | | (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments. |
6 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per student |
7 | | of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
8 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
9 | | students to cover computer technology and equipment costs. |
10 | | For the 2018-2019 school year and subsequent school years, |
11 | | Tier 1 and Tier 2 Organizational Units selected by the |
12 | | State Board through a request for proposals process shall, |
13 | | upon the State Board's approval of an Organizational Unit's |
14 | | one-to-one computing technology plan, receive an |
15 | | additional $285.50 per student of the combined ASE of |
16 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
17 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover computer |
18 | | technology and equipment costs. The State Board may |
19 | | establish additional requirements for Organizational Unit |
20 | | expenditures of funds received pursuant to this |
21 | | subparagraph (Q). It is the intent of this amendatory Act |
22 | | of the 100th General Assembly that all Tier 1 and Tier 2 |
23 | | districts that apply for the technology grant receive the |
24 | | addition to their Adequacy Target, subject to compliance |
25 | | with the requirements of the State Board. |
26 | | (R) Student activities investments. Each |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 369 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the following funding |
2 | | amounts to cover student activities: $100 per kindergarten |
3 | | through grade 5 ASE student in elementary school, plus $200 |
4 | | per ASE student in middle school, plus $675 per ASE student |
5 | | in high school. |
6 | | (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each |
7 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student of the |
8 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
9 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 for |
10 | | day-to-day maintenance and operations expenditures, |
11 | | including salary, supplies, and materials, as well as |
12 | | purchased services, but excluding employee benefits. The |
13 | | proportion of salary for the application of a |
14 | | Regionalization Factor and the calculation of benefits is |
15 | | equal to $352.92. |
16 | | (T) Central office investments. Each Organizational |
17 | | Unit shall receive $742 per student of the combined ASE of |
18 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
19 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover central |
20 | | office operations, including administrators and classified |
21 | | personnel charged with managing the instructional |
22 | | programs, business and operations of the school district, |
23 | | and security personnel. The proportion of salary for the |
24 | | application of a Regionalization Factor and the |
25 | | calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48. |
26 | | (U) Employee benefit investments. Each Organizational |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 370 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Unit shall receive 30% of the total of all |
2 | | salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target, |
3 | | excluding substitute teachers and student activities |
4 | | investments, to cover benefit costs. For central office and |
5 | | maintenance and operations investments, the benefit |
6 | | calculation shall be based upon the salary proportion of |
7 | | each investment. If at any time the responsibility for |
8 | | funding the employer normal cost of teacher pensions is |
9 | | assigned to school districts, then that amount certified by |
10 | | the Teachers' Retirement System of the State of Illinois to |
11 | | be paid by the Organizational Unit for the preceding school |
12 | | year shall be added to the benefit investment. For any |
13 | | fiscal year in which a school district organized under |
14 | | Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the |
15 | | employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that amount |
16 | | of its employer normal cost as certified by the Public |
17 | | School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago to |
18 | | be paid by the school district for the preceding school |
19 | | year that is statutorily required to cover employer normal |
20 | | costs shall be added to the 30% specified in this |
21 | | subparagraph (U). The Public School Teachers' Pension and |
22 | | Retirement Fund of Chicago shall submit such information as |
23 | | the State Superintendent may require for the calculations |
24 | | set forth in this subparagraph (U). |
25 | | (V) Additional investments in low-income students. In |
26 | | addition to and not in lieu of all other funding under this |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 371 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit shall receive |
2 | | funding based on the average teacher salary for grades K |
3 | | through 12 to cover the costs of: (i) one FTE intervention |
4 | | teacher (tutor) position for every 125 Low-Income Count |
5 | | students; (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for |
6 | | every 125 Low-Income Count students; (iii) one FTE extended |
7 | | day teacher position for every 120 Low-Income Count |
8 | | students; and (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position |
9 | | for every 120 Low-Income Count students. |
10 | | (W) Additional investments in EL students. In addition |
11 | | to and not in lieu of all other funding under this |
12 | | paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit shall receive |
13 | | funding based on the average teacher salary for grades K |
14 | | through 12 to cover the costs of: |
15 | | (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor) position |
16 | | for every 125 EL students; |
17 | | (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for every |
18 | | 125 EL students; |
19 | | (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position for |
20 | | every 120 EL students; |
21 | | (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position for |
22 | | every 120 EL students; and |
23 | | (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100 EL |
24 | | students. |
25 | | (X) Special education investments. Each Organizational |
26 | | Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 372 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | salary for grades K through 12 to cover special education |
2 | | as follows: |
3 | | (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141 combined |
4 | | ASE of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and |
5 | | all kindergarten through grade 12 students; |
6 | | (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every 141 |
7 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
8 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
9 | | students; and |
10 | | (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every |
11 | | 1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
12 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
13 | | students. |
14 | | (3) For calculating the salaries included within the |
15 | | Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall annually |
16 | | calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar using the |
17 | | employment information system data maintained by the State |
18 | | Board, limited to public schools only and excluding special |
19 | | education and vocational cooperatives, schools operated by the |
20 | | Department of Juvenile Justice, and charter schools, for the |
21 | | following positions: |
22 | | (A) Teacher for grades K through 8. |
23 | | (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12. |
24 | | (C) Teacher for grades K through 12. |
25 | | (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8. |
26 | | (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 373 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12. |
2 | | (G) Social worker. |
3 | | (H) Psychologist. |
4 | | (I) Librarian. |
5 | | (J) Nurse. |
6 | | (K) Principal. |
7 | | (L) Assistant principal. |
8 | | For the purposes of this paragraph (3),"teacher" includes core |
9 | | teachers, specialist and elective teachers, instructional |
10 | | facilitators, tutors, special education teachers, pupil |
11 | | support staff teachers, English learner teachers, extended-day |
12 | | teachers, and summer school teachers. Where specific grade data |
13 | | is not required for the Essential Elements, the average salary |
14 | | for corresponding positions shall apply. For substitute |
15 | | teachers, the average teacher salary for grades K through 12 |
16 | | shall apply. |
17 | | For calculating the salaries included within the Essential |
18 | | Elements for positions not included within EIS Data, the |
19 | | following salaries shall be used in the first year of |
20 | | implementation of Evidence-Based Funding: |
21 | | (i) school site staff, $30,000; and |
22 | | (ii) on-instructional assistant, instructional |
23 | | assistant, library aide, library media tech, or |
24 | | supervisory aide: $25,000. |
25 | | In the second and subsequent years of implementation of |
26 | | Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii) of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 374 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI. |
2 | | The salary amounts for the Essential Elements determined |
3 | | pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S) and (T), and (V) |
4 | | through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section |
5 | | shall be multiplied by a Regionalization Factor. |
6 | | (c) Local capacity calculation. |
7 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity represents |
8 | | an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute toward its |
9 | | Adequacy Target for purposes of the Evidence-Based Funding |
10 | | formula calculation. "Local Capacity" means either (i) the |
11 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target as calculated in |
12 | | accordance with paragraph (2) of this subsection (c) if its |
13 | | Real Receipts are equal to or less than its Local Capacity |
14 | | Target or (ii) the Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local |
15 | | Capacity, as calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of |
16 | | this subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local |
17 | | Capacity Target. |
18 | | (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an Organizational |
19 | | Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by multiplying its |
20 | | Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity Percentage. |
21 | | (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Percentage |
22 | | is the conversion of the Organizational Unit's Local |
23 | | Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is determined in accordance |
24 | | with subparagraph (B) of this paragraph (2), into a normal |
25 | | curve equivalent score to determine each Organizational |
26 | | Unit's relative position to all other Organizational Units |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 375 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | in this State. The calculation of Local Capacity Percentage |
2 | | is described in subparagraph (C) of this paragraph (2). |
3 | | (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio in a |
4 | | given year is the percentage obtained by dividing its |
5 | | Adjusted EAV by its Adequacy Target, with the resulting |
6 | | ratio further adjusted as follows: |
7 | | (i) for Organizational Units serving grades |
8 | | kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no |
9 | | further adjustments shall be made; |
10 | | (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades |
11 | | kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be multiplied |
12 | | by 9/13; |
13 | | (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades 9 |
14 | | through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be |
15 | | multiplied by 4/13; and |
16 | | (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a different |
17 | | grade configuration than those specified in items (i) |
18 | | through (iii) of this subparagraph (B), the State |
19 | | Superintendent shall determine a comparable adjustment |
20 | | based on the grades served. |
21 | | (C) Local Capacity Percentage converts each |
22 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio to a normal |
23 | | curve equivalent score to determine each Organizational |
24 | | Unit's relative position to all other Organizational Units |
25 | | in this State. The Local Capacity Percentage normal curve |
26 | | equivalent score for each Organizational Unit shall be |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 376 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | calculated using the standard normal distribution of the |
2 | | score in relation to the weighted mean and weighted |
3 | | standard deviation and Local Capacity Ratios of all |
4 | | Organizational Units. If the value assigned to any |
5 | | Organizational Unit is in excess of 90%, the value shall be |
6 | | adjusted to 90%. For Laboratory Schools, the Local Capacity |
7 | | Percentage shall be set at 10% in
recognition of the |
8 | | absence of EAV and resources from the public university |
9 | | that are allocated to
the Laboratory School. The weighted |
10 | | mean for the Local Capacity Percentage shall be determined |
11 | | by multiplying each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity |
12 | | Ratio times the ASE for the unit creating a weighted value, |
13 | | summing the weighted values of all Organizational Units, |
14 | | and dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units. |
15 | | The weighted standard deviation shall be determined by |
16 | | taking the square root of the weighted variance of all |
17 | | Organizational Units' Local Capacity Ratio, where the |
18 | | variance is calculated by squaring the difference between |
19 | | each unit's Local Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, |
20 | | then multiplying the variance for each unit times the ASE |
21 | | for the unit to create a weighted variance for each unit, |
22 | | then summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by |
23 | | the total ASE of all units. |
24 | | (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more than |
25 | | its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity shall equal |
26 | | an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated in accordance |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 377 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | with this paragraph (3). The Adjusted Local Capacity Target is |
2 | | calculated as the sum of the Organizational Unit's Local |
3 | | Capacity Target and its Real Receipts Adjustment. For |
4 | | Organizational Units with a Real Percent of Adequacy above 85%, |
5 | | the Real Receipts Adjustment equals the Organizational Unit's |
6 | | Real Receipts less its Local Capacity Target, with the |
7 | | resulting figure multiplied by the lesser of 100% or the |
8 | | difference between its Real Percent of Adequacy and 85%. For |
9 | | Organizational Units with a Real Percent of Adequacy of 85% or |
10 | | below, there is no Real Receipts Adjustment. |
11 | | As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of Adequacy" |
12 | | means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts, CPPRT, |
13 | | and Base Funding Minimum, with the resulting figure divided by |
14 | | the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target. |
15 | | (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for |
16 | | purposes of the Local Capacity calculation. |
17 | | (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the product |
18 | | of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV. An |
19 | | Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Operating Tax |
20 | | Rate for property within the Organizational Unit. |
21 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the Equalized |
22 | | Assessed Valuation, or EAV, of all taxable property of each |
23 | | Organizational Unit as of September 30 of the previous year in |
24 | | accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (d). The State |
25 | | Superintendent shall then determine the Adjusted EAV of each |
26 | | Organizational Unit in accordance with paragraph (4) of this |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 378 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | subsection (d), which Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the |
2 | | purposes of calculating Local Capacity. |
3 | | (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department of |
4 | | Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the value as |
5 | | equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue of all |
6 | | taxable property of every Organizational Unit, together with |
7 | | (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending taxes for the |
8 | | funds of the Organizational Unit as of September 30 of the |
9 | | previous year and (ii) the limiting rate for all Organizational |
10 | | Units subject to property tax extension limitations as imposed |
11 | | under PTELL. |
12 | | (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the |
13 | | equalized assessed value of all taxable property of each |
14 | | Organizational Unit situated entirely or partially within |
15 | | a county that is or was subject to the provisions of |
16 | | Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code (i) an |
17 | | amount equal to the total amount by which the homestead |
18 | | exemption allowed under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the |
19 | | Property Tax Code for real property situated in that |
20 | | Organizational Unit exceeds the total amount that would |
21 | | have been allowed in that Organizational Unit if the |
22 | | maximum reduction under Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in |
23 | | Cook County or $3,500 in all other counties in tax year |
24 | | 2003 or (II) $5,000 in all counties in tax year 2004 and |
25 | | thereafter and (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount |
26 | | for the taxable year of all additional exemptions under |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 379 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with a |
2 | | household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk of |
3 | | any county that is or was subject to the provisions of |
4 | | Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code shall |
5 | | annually calculate and certify to the Department of Revenue |
6 | | for each Organizational Unit all homestead exemption |
7 | | amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax |
8 | | Code and all amounts of additional exemptions under Section |
9 | | 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with a household |
10 | | income of $30,000 or less. It is the intent of this |
11 | | subparagraph (A) that if the general homestead exemption |
12 | | for a parcel of property is determined under Section 15-176 |
13 | | or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code rather than Section |
14 | | 15-175, then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected |
15 | | by the difference, if any, between the amount of the |
16 | | general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of |
17 | | property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax |
18 | | Code and the amount that would have been allowed had the |
19 | | general homestead exemption for that parcel of property |
20 | | been determined under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax |
21 | | Code. It is further the intent of this subparagraph (A) |
22 | | that if additional exemptions are allowed under Section |
23 | | 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with a household |
24 | | income of less than $30,000, then the calculation of EAV |
25 | | shall not be affected by the difference, if any, because of |
26 | | those additional exemptions. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 380 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational Unit |
2 | | within a redevelopment project area in respect to which a |
3 | | municipality has adopted tax increment allocation |
4 | | financing pursuant to the Tax Increment Allocation |
5 | | Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of the Illinois Municipal |
6 | | Code, or the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of |
7 | | the Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current EAV of |
8 | | real property located in any such project area which is |
9 | | attributable to an increase above the total initial EAV of |
10 | | such property shall be used as part of the EAV of the |
11 | | Organizational Unit, until such time as all redevelopment |
12 | | project costs have been paid, as provided in Section |
13 | | 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment Allocation Redevelopment |
14 | | Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 of the Industrial Jobs |
15 | | Recovery Law. For the purpose of the EAV of the |
16 | | Organizational Unit, the total initial EAV or the current |
17 | | EAV, whichever is lower, shall be used until such time as |
18 | | all redevelopment project costs have been paid. |
19 | | (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid |
20 | | Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the lesser of |
21 | | the equalized assessed valuation for property within the |
22 | | partial elementary unit district for elementary purposes, |
23 | | as defined in Article 11E of this Code, or the equalized |
24 | | assessed valuation for property within the partial |
25 | | elementary unit district for high school purposes, as |
26 | | defined in Article 11E of this Code. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 381 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the |
2 | | average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years or |
3 | | its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in the |
4 | | immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more compared |
5 | | to the 3-year average. In the event of Organizational Unit |
6 | | reorganization, consolidation, or annexation, the |
7 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the first 3 years after |
8 | | such change shall be as follows: the most current EAV shall be |
9 | | used in the first year, the average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV |
10 | | in the immediately preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or |
11 | | more compared to the 2-year average for the second year, and a |
12 | | 3-year average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year |
13 | | if the adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the |
14 | | 3-year average for the third year. |
15 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
16 | | paragraph (4), if an Organizational Unit has a PTELL EAV less |
17 | | than its Adjusted EAV as calculated in the remainder of this |
18 | | paragraph, the Organizational Unit's PTELL EAV shall serve as |
19 | | its Adjusted EAV. |
20 | | "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State Board |
21 | | for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as described in this |
22 | | paragraph (4). Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph |
23 | | (4), for an Organizational Unit that has approved or does |
24 | | approve an increase in its limiting rate, the PTELL EAV of an |
25 | | Organizational Unit shall be equal to the product of the |
26 | | equalized assessed valuation last used in the calculation of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 382 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code or |
2 | | Evidence-Based Funding under this Section and the |
3 | | Organizational Unit's Extension Limitation Ratio. If an |
4 | | Organizational Unit has approved or does approve an increase in |
5 | | its limiting rate, pursuant to Section 18-190 of the Property |
6 | | Tax Code, affecting the Base Tax Year, the PTELL EAV shall be |
7 | | equal to the product of the equalized assessed valuation last |
8 | | used in the calculation of general State aid under Section |
9 | | 18-8.05 of this Code or Evidence-Based Funding under this |
10 | | Section multiplied by an amount equal to one plus the |
11 | | percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price Index for |
12 | | All Urban Consumers for all items published by the United |
13 | | States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar year |
14 | | preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the equalized assessed |
15 | | valuation of new property, annexed property, and recovered tax |
16 | | increment value and minus the equalized assessed valuation of |
17 | | disconnected property. |
18 | | As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and |
19 | | "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set |
20 | | forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. |
21 | | (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation. |
22 | | (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding Minimum |
23 | | of an Organizational Unit, other than a Specially Funded Unit, |
24 | | shall be the amount of State funds distributed to the |
25 | | Organizational Unit during the 2016-2017 school year prior to |
26 | | any adjustments and specified appropriation amounts described |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 383 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | in this paragraph (1) from the following Sections, as |
2 | | calculated by the State Superintendent: Section 18-8.05 of this |
3 | | Code (general State aid); Section 5 of Article 224 of Public |
4 | | Act 99-524 (equity grants); Section 14-7.02b of this Code |
5 | | (funding for children requiring special education services); |
6 | | Section 14-13.01 of this Code (special education facilities and |
7 | | staffing), except for reimbursement of the cost of |
8 | | transportation pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section 14C-12 of |
9 | | this Code (English learners); and Section 18-4.3 of this Code |
10 | | (summer school), based on an appropriation level of |
11 | | $13,121,600. For a school district organized under Article 34 |
12 | | of this Code, the Base Funding Minimum also includes the funds |
13 | | allotted to the school district pursuant to Section 1D-1 of |
14 | | this Code attributable to funding programs authorized by the |
15 | | Sections of this Code listed in the preceding sentence. For |
16 | | Specially Funded Units, the Base Funding Minimum shall be the |
17 | | total amount of State funds allotted to the Specially Funded |
18 | | Unit during the 2016-2017 school year. The Base Funding Minimum |
19 | | for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. |
20 | | (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the Base |
21 | | Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially Funded |
22 | | Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of Evidence-Based |
23 | | Funding for the prior school year and (ii) the Base Funding |
24 | | Minimum for the prior school year. |
25 | | (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation. |
26 | | (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 384 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order to |
2 | | place such units into tiers for the purposes of the funding |
3 | | distribution system described in subsection (g) of this |
4 | | Section. Initially, an Organizational Unit's Preliminary |
5 | | Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy are calculated |
6 | | pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection (f). Then, an |
7 | | Organizational Unit's Final Resources and Final Percent of |
8 | | Adequacy are calculated to account for the Organizational |
9 | | Unit's poverty concentration levels pursuant to paragraphs (3) |
10 | | and (4) of this subsection (f). |
11 | | (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are |
12 | | equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and Base |
13 | | Funding Minimum. An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Percent |
14 | | of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary Resources |
15 | | divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%. |
16 | | (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an Organizational |
17 | | Unit's Final Resources are equal the sum of its Local Capacity, |
18 | | CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding Minimum. The Base Funding |
19 | | Minimum of each Specially Funded Unit shall serve as its Final |
20 | | Resources, except that the Base Funding Minimum for |
21 | | State-approved charter schools shall not include any portion of |
22 | | general State aid allocated in the prior year based on the per |
23 | | capita tuition charge times the charter school enrollment. |
24 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy is |
25 | | its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. A |
26 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is equal to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 385 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental Grant Funding, |
2 | | with the resulting figure added to the product of its |
3 | | Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary Percent of |
4 | | Adequacy. |
5 | | (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system. |
6 | | (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based Funding |
7 | | formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding equal to the |
8 | | sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's allocation of |
9 | | New State Funds determined pursuant to this subsection (g). To |
10 | | allocate New State Funds, the Evidence-Based Funding formula |
11 | | distribution system first places all Organizational Units into |
12 | | one of 4 tiers in accordance with paragraph (3) of this |
13 | | subsection (g), based on the Organizational Unit's Final |
14 | | Percent of Adequacy. New State Funds are allocated to each of |
15 | | the 4 tiers as follows: Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 40% of |
16 | | all New State Funds, Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 59% of all |
17 | | New State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all |
18 | | New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1% of |
19 | | all New State Funds. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 1 or |
20 | | Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to its |
21 | | Tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following sentence, |
22 | | multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate determined pursuant to |
23 | | paragraph (4) of this subsection (g). For Tier 1 and Tier 2, an |
24 | | Organizational Unit's Funding Gap equals the Tier's Target |
25 | | Ratio, as specified in paragraph (5) of this subsection (g), |
26 | | multiplied by the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 386 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the resulting amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final |
2 | | Resources and, for Tier 2 Organizational Units, its Tier 1 |
3 | | funding allocation. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or |
4 | | Tier 4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the |
5 | | product of its Adequacy Target and the Tier's Allocation Rate, |
6 | | as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g). |
7 | | (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all |
8 | | Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit |
9 | | shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3 |
10 | | Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational Unit |
11 | | shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE. Any Tier |
12 | | 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation per ASE below |
13 | | the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall get a funding |
14 | | allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3 funding allocation per |
15 | | ASE multiplied by the Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 |
16 | | Organizational Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be |
17 | | multiplied by the percentage calculated by dividing the |
18 | | original Tier 2 Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 |
19 | | Organizational Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation after |
20 | | adjusting districts' funding below Tier 3 levels. |
21 | | (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers as |
22 | | follows: |
23 | | (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units, except |
24 | | for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy less |
25 | | than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1 Target Ratio is |
26 | | the ratio level that allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 387 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be distributed, with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate determined |
2 | | pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection (g). |
3 | | (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all other |
4 | | Organizational Units, except for Specially Funded Units, |
5 | | with a Percent of Adequacy of less than 0.90. |
6 | | (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units, except |
7 | | for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of |
8 | | at least 0.90 and less than 1.0. |
9 | | (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units with a |
10 | | Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0 and Specially Funded |
11 | | Units, excluding Glenwood Academy. |
12 | | (4) The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 is |
13 | | determined as follows: |
14 | | (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 40%. |
15 | | (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
16 | | following equation: Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided by |
17 | | the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2 Organizational |
18 | | Units, unless the result of such equation is higher than |
19 | | 1.0. If the result of such equation is higher than 1.0, |
20 | | then the Tier 2 Allocation Rate is 1.0. |
21 | | (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
22 | | following equation: Tier 3
Aggregate Funding, divided by |
23 | | the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3 |
24 | | Organizational
Units. |
25 | | (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
26 | | following equation: Tier 4
Aggregate Funding, divided by |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 388 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4 |
2 | | Organizational
Units. |
3 | | (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows: |
4 | | (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that |
5 | | allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed with |
6 | | the Tier 1 Allocation Rate. |
7 | | (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90. |
8 | | (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0. |
9 | | (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is greater |
10 | | than 90%, than all Tier 1 funding shall be allocated to Tier 2 |
11 | | and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's funding may be identified. |
12 | | (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units |
13 | | receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any remaining |
14 | | New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and Tier 4 |
15 | | Organizational Units. |
16 | | (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood |
17 | | Academy, recognized by the State Board do not qualify for |
18 | | direct funding following the implementation of this amendatory |
19 | | Act of the 100th General Assembly from any of the funding |
20 | | sources included within the definition of Base Funding Minimum, |
21 | | the unqualified portion of the Base Funding Minimum shall be |
22 | | transferred to one or more appropriate Organizational Units as |
23 | | determined by the State Superintendent based on the prior year |
24 | | ASE of the Organizational Units. |
25 | | (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish a |
26 | | target for State funding that will keep pace with inflation and |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 389 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | continue to advance equity through the Evidence-Based Funding |
2 | | formula. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to: (i) the
sum of |
3 | | 1% of the State Adequacy Level, plus the ECI multiplied by the |
4 | | State
Adequacy Level, less (ii) the total increase in Real |
5 | | Receipts from the prior school year to the
current school year. |
6 | | The Minimum Funding Level may never be greater than the sum of |
7 | | the Preliminary Resources subtracted from the Adequacy Target |
8 | | for each Tier 1, Tier 2, and Tier 3 Organizational Unit. The |
9 | | General Assembly shall strive to provide sufficient |
10 | | appropriations to annually fund the Minimum Funding Level. |
11 | | (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the |
12 | | appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after |
13 | | implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units |
14 | | receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under |
15 | | paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held harmless by |
16 | | establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to the per pupil |
17 | | kindergarten through grade 12 funding received in accordance |
18 | | with this Section in the prior fiscal year. Reductions shall be
|
19 | | made to the Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units in |
20 | | Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
per pupil basis equivalent to the total |
21 | | number of the ASE in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded |
22 | | Organizational Units divided by the total reduction in State |
23 | | funding. The Base
Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to |
24 | | be applied to Tier 3 and Tier 4
Organizational Units and |
25 | | adjusted by the relative formula when increases in
|
26 | | appropriations for this Section resume. In no event may State |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 390 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | funding reductions to
Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 |
2 | | exceed an amount that would be less than the
Base Funding |
3 | | Minimum established in the first year of implementation of this
|
4 | | Section. If additional reductions are required, all school |
5 | | districts shall receive a
reduction by a per pupil amount equal |
6 | | to the aggregate additional appropriation
reduction divided by |
7 | | the total ASE of all Organizational Units. |
8 | | (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor adjustments |
9 | | to the distribution formulae set forth in this subsection (g) |
10 | | to account for the rounding of percentages to the nearest tenth |
11 | | of a percentage and dollar amounts to the nearest whole dollar. |
12 | | (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and |
13 | | district submission requirements. |
14 | | (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with |
15 | | appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the funding |
16 | | obligations created under this Section. |
17 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the Adequacy |
18 | | Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State Contribution |
19 | | Target for each Organizational Unit under this Section. The |
20 | | State Superintendent shall also certify the actual amounts of |
21 | | the New State Funds payable for each eligible Organizational |
22 | | Unit based on the equitable distribution calculation to the |
23 | | unit's treasurer, as soon as possible after such amounts are |
24 | | calculated, including any applicable adjusted charge-off |
25 | | increase. No Evidence-Based Funding shall be distributed |
26 | | within an Organizational Unit without the approval of the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 391 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | unit's school board. |
2 | | (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate and |
3 | | report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate |
4 | | financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the |
5 | | Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State |
6 | | Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for each |
7 | | Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds allocated for |
8 | | its students with disabilities. The State Superintendent shall |
9 | | calculate and report separately for each Organizational Unit |
10 | | the amount of funding and applicable FTE calculated for each |
11 | | Essential Element of the unit's Adequacy Target. |
12 | | (4) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be |
13 | | calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal year |
14 | | basis, with payments beginning in August and extending through |
15 | | June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys appropriated for |
16 | | each fiscal year shall be distributed in 22 equal payments at |
17 | | least 2 times monthly to each Organizational Unit. The State |
18 | | Board shall publish a yearly distribution schedule at its |
19 | | meeting in June. If moneys appropriated for any fiscal year are |
20 | | distributed other than monthly, the distribution shall be on |
21 | | the same basis for each Organizational Unit. |
22 | | (5) Any school district that fails, for any given school |
23 | | year, to maintain school as required by law or to maintain a |
24 | | recognized school is not eligible to receive Evidence-Based |
25 | | Funding. In case of non-recognition of one or more attendance |
26 | | centers in a school district otherwise operating recognized |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 392 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | schools, the claim of the district shall be reduced in the |
2 | | proportion that the enrollment in the attendance center or |
3 | | centers bears to the enrollment of the school district. |
4 | | "Recognized school" means any public school that meets the |
5 | | standards for recognition by the State Board. A school district |
6 | | or attendance center not having recognition status at the end |
7 | | of a school term is entitled to receive State aid payments due |
8 | | upon a legal claim that was filed while it was recognized. |
9 | | (6) School district claims filed under this Section are |
10 | | subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as |
11 | | otherwise provided in this Section. |
12 | | (7) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall |
13 | | calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its Base |
14 | | Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall be deemed |
15 | | attributable to the provision of special educational |
16 | | facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this |
17 | | Code, in a manner that ensures compliance with maintenance of |
18 | | State financial support requirements under the federal |
19 | | Individuals with Disabilities Education Act. An Organizational |
20 | | Unit must use such funds only for the provision of special |
21 | | educational facilities and services, as defined in Section |
22 | | 14-1.08 of this Code, and must comply with any expenditure |
23 | | verification procedures adopted by the State Board. |
24 | | (8) All Organizational Units in this State must submit |
25 | | annual spending plans by the end of September of each year to |
26 | | the State Board as part of the annual budget process, which |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 393 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | shall describe how each Organizational Unit will utilize the |
2 | | Base Minimum Funding and Evidence-Based funding it receives |
3 | | from this State under this Section with specific identification |
4 | | of the intended utilization of Low-Income, EL, and special |
5 | | education resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans |
6 | | of each Organizational Unit shall describe how the |
7 | | Organizational Unit expects to achieve student growth and how |
8 | | the Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as |
9 | | defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may, from |
10 | | time to time, identify additional requisites for |
11 | | Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual |
12 | | spending plans required under this subsection (h). The format |
13 | | and scope of annual spending plans shall be developed by the |
14 | | State Superintendent in conjunction with the Professional |
15 | | Review Panel. |
16 | | (9) No later than January 1, 2018, the State Superintendent |
17 | | shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for all Organizational |
18 | | Units to help in planning for adequacy funding under this |
19 | | Section. The State Superintendent shall submit the plan to the |
20 | | Governor and the General Assembly, as provided in Section 3.1 |
21 | | of the General Assembly Organization Act. The plan shall |
22 | | include recommendations for: |
23 | | (A) a framework for collaborative, professional, |
24 | | innovative, and 21st century learning environments using |
25 | | the Evidence-Based Funding model; |
26 | | (B) ways to prepare and support this State's educators |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 394 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | for successful instructional careers; |
2 | | (C) application and enhancement of the current |
3 | | financial accountability measures, the approved State plan |
4 | | to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds Act, and |
5 | | the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures in relation |
6 | | to student growth and elements of the Evidence-Based |
7 | | Funding model; and |
8 | | (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy |
9 | | funding system based on projected and recommended funding |
10 | | levels from the General Assembly. |
11 | | (i) Professional Review Panel. |
12 | | (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and |
13 | | review the implementation and effect of the Evidence-Based |
14 | | Funding model under this Section and to recommend continual |
15 | | recalibration and future study topics and modifications to the |
16 | | Evidence-Based Funding model. The Panel shall elect a |
17 | | chairperson and vice chairperson by a majority vote of the |
18 | | Panel and shall advance recommendations based on a majority |
19 | | vote of the Panel. A minority opinion may also accompany any |
20 | | recommendation of the majority of the Panel. The Panel shall be |
21 | | appointed by the State Superintendent, except as otherwise |
22 | | provided in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i) and include |
23 | | the following members: |
24 | | (A) Two appointees that represent district |
25 | | superintendents, recommended by a statewide organization |
26 | | that represents district superintendents. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 395 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (B) Two appointees that represent school boards, |
2 | | recommended by a statewide organization that represents |
3 | | school boards. |
4 | | (C) Two appointees from districts that represent |
5 | | school business officials, recommended by a statewide |
6 | | organization that represents school business officials. |
7 | | (D) Two appointees that represent school principals, |
8 | | recommended by a statewide organization that represents |
9 | | school principals. |
10 | | (E) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
11 | | recommended by a statewide organization that represents |
12 | | teachers. |
13 | | (F) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
14 | | recommended by another statewide organization that |
15 | | represents teachers. |
16 | | (G) Two appointees that represent regional |
17 | | superintendents of schools, recommended by organizations |
18 | | that represent regional superintendents. |
19 | | (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the |
20 | | State Superintendent. |
21 | | (I) Two independent experts recommended by public |
22 | | universities in this State. |
23 | | (J) One member recommended by a statewide organization |
24 | | that represents parents. |
25 | | (K) Two representatives recommended by collective |
26 | | impact organizations that represent major metropolitan |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 396 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | areas or geographic areas in Illinois. |
2 | | (L) One member from a statewide organization focused on |
3 | | research-based education policy to support a school system |
4 | | that prepares all students for college, a career, and |
5 | | democratic citizenship. |
6 | | (M) One representative from a school district |
7 | | organized under Article 34 of this Code. |
8 | | The State Superintendent shall ensure that the membership of |
9 | | the Panel includes representatives from school districts and |
10 | | communities reflecting the geographic, socio-economic, racial, |
11 | | and ethnic diversity of this State. The State Superintendent |
12 | | shall additionally ensure that the membership of the Panel |
13 | | includes representatives with expertise in bilingual education |
14 | | and special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff |
15 | | the Panel. |
16 | | (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the |
17 | | State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly shall |
18 | | be appointed as follows: one member of the House of |
19 | | Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of |
20 | | Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the |
21 | | President of the Senate, one member of the House of |
22 | | Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the House |
23 | | of Representatives, and one member of the Senate appointed by |
24 | | the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall be one |
25 | | additional member appointed by the Governor. All members |
26 | | appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor shall be |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 397 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | non-voting, ex officio members. |
2 | | (3) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent shall |
3 | | recalibrate the following per pupil elements of the Adequacy |
4 | | Target and applied to the formulas, based on the Panel's study |
5 | | of average expenses as reported in the most recent annual |
6 | | financial report: |
7 | | (A) gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph (2) of |
8 | | subsection (b) of this Section; |
9 | | (B) instructional materials under subparagraph (O) of |
10 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section; |
11 | | (C) assessment under subparagraph (P) of paragraph (2) |
12 | | of subsection (b) of this Section; |
13 | | (D) student activities under subparagraph (R) of |
14 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section; |
15 | | (E) maintenance and operations under subparagraph (S) |
16 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section; and |
17 | | (F) central office under subparagraph (T) of paragraph |
18 | | (2) of subsection (b) of this Section. |
19 | | (4) On a periodic basis, the Panel shall study all the |
20 | | following elements and make recommendations to the State Board, |
21 | | the General Assembly, and the Governor for modification of this |
22 | | Section: |
23 | | (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans |
24 | | referenced in subsection (h) paragraph (8) of this Section. |
25 | | (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section, to be |
26 | | studied by the Panel and reestablished by the State |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 398 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Superintendent every 5 years. |
2 | | (C) Maintenance and operations. Within 5 years after |
3 | | the implementation of this Section, the Panel shall make |
4 | | recommendations for the further study of maintenance and |
5 | | operations costs, including capital maintenance costs, and |
6 | | recommend any additional reporting data required from |
7 | | Organizational Units. |
8 | | (D) "At-risk student" definition. Within 5 years after |
9 | | the implementation of this Section, the Panel shall make |
10 | | recommendations for the further study and determination of |
11 | | an "at-risk student" definition. Within 5 years after the |
12 | | implementation of this Section, the Panel shall evaluate |
13 | | and make recommendations regarding adequate funding for |
14 | | poverty concentration under the Evidence-Based Funding |
15 | | model. |
16 | | (E) Benefits. Within 5 years after the implementation |
17 | | of this Section, the Panel shall make recommendations for |
18 | | further study of benefit costs. |
19 | | (F) Technology. The per pupil target for technology |
20 | | shall be reviewed every 3 years to determine whether |
21 | | current allocations are sufficient to develop 21st century |
22 | | learning in all classrooms in this State and supporting a |
23 | | one-to-one technological device program in each school. |
24 | | Recommendations shall be made no later than 3 years after |
25 | | the implementation of this Section. |
26 | | (G) Local Capacity Target. Within 3 years after the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 399 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | implementation of this Section, the Panel shall make |
2 | | recommendations for any additional data desired to analyze |
3 | | possible modifications to the Local Capacity Target, to be |
4 | | based on measures in addition to solely EAV and to be |
5 | | completed within 5 years after implementation of this |
6 | | Section. |
7 | | (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory |
8 | | Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning |
9 | | opportunities programs. By the beginning of the 2021-2022 |
10 | | school year, the Panel shall study and make recommendations |
11 | | regarding the funding levels for Alternative Schools, |
12 | | Laboratory Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning |
13 | | opportunities programs in this State. |
14 | | (I) Funding for college and career acceleration |
15 | | strategies. By the beginning of the 2021-2022 school year, |
16 | | the Panel shall study and make recommendations regarding |
17 | | funding levels to support college and career acceleration |
18 | | strategies in high school that have been demonstrated to |
19 | | result in improved secondary and postsecondary outcomes, |
20 | | including Advanced Placement, dual-credit opportunities, |
21 | | and college and career pathway systems. |
22 | | (J) Special education investments. By the beginning of |
23 | | the 2021-2022 school year, the Panel shall study and make |
24 | | recommendations on whether and how to account for |
25 | | disability types within the special education funding |
26 | | category. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 400 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (K) Early childhood investments. In collaboration with |
2 | | the Illinois Early Learning Council, the Panel shall |
3 | | include an analysis of what level of Preschool for All |
4 | | Children funding would be necessary to serve all children |
5 | | ages 0 through 5 years in the highest-priority service |
6 | | tier, as specified in paragraph (4.5) of subsection (a) of |
7 | | Section 2-3.71 of this Code, and an analysis of the |
8 | | potential cost savings that that level of Preschool for All |
9 | | Children investment would have on the kindergarten through |
10 | | grade 12 system. |
11 | | (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this |
12 | | Section, the Panel shall complete an evaluative study of the |
13 | | entire Evidence-Based Funding model, including an assessment |
14 | | of whether or not the formula is achieving State goals. The |
15 | | Panel shall report to the State Board, the General Assembly, |
16 | | and the Governor on the findings of the study. |
17 | | (6) Within 3 years after the implementation of this |
18 | | Section, the Panel shall evaluate and provide recommendations |
19 | | to the Governor and the General Assembly on the hold-harmless |
20 | | provisions of this Section found in the Base Funding Minimum. |
21 | | (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other |
22 | | laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section |
23 | | 18-8.05 of this Code shall be deemed to be references to |
24 | | evidence-based model formula funds or calculations under this |
25 | | Section.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 401 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-9) (from Ch. 122, par. 18-9)
|
2 | | Sec. 18-9. Requirement for special equalization and |
3 | | supplementary
State aid. If property comprising an aggregate |
4 | | assessed valuation equal to 6% or
more
of the total assessed |
5 | | valuation of all taxable property in a school district is
owned |
6 | | by a
person or corporation that is the subject of bankruptcy |
7 | | proceedings or that has
been
adjudged bankrupt and, as a result |
8 | | thereof, has not paid taxes on the
property, then the
district |
9 | | may amend its general State aid or evidence-based funding claim |
10 | | (i) back to the inception of the
bankruptcy,
not to exceed 6 |
11 | | years, in which time those taxes were not paid and (ii) for
|
12 | | each
succeeding year that those taxes remain unpaid, by adding |
13 | | to the claim an
amount
determined by multiplying the assessed |
14 | | valuation of the property on which taxes
have not
been paid due |
15 | | to the bankruptcy by the lesser of the total tax rate for the
|
16 | | district for the
tax year for which the taxes are unpaid or the |
17 | | applicable rate used in
calculating the
district's general |
18 | | State aid under paragraph (3) of subsection (D) of Section
|
19 | | 18-8.05 of
this Code or evidence-based funding under Section
|
20 | | 18-8.15 of
this Code, as applicable . If at any time a district |
21 | | that receives additional State aid under
this Section receives |
22 | | tax revenue from the property for the years that taxes were not
|
23 | | paid, the
district's next claim for State aid shall be reduced |
24 | | in an amount equal to the
taxes paid on
the property, not to |
25 | | exceed the additional State aid received under this Section.
|
26 | | Claims under this Section shall be filed on forms prescribed by |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 402 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the
State
Superintendent of Education, and the State |
2 | | Superintendent of Education, upon
receipt of
a claim, shall |
3 | | adjust the claim in accordance with the provisions of this |
4 | | Section.
Supplementary State aid for each succeeding year under |
5 | | this Section
shall be paid
beginning with the first general |
6 | | State aid or evidence-based funding claim paid after the |
7 | | district has
filed a
completed claim in accordance with this |
8 | | Section.
|
9 | | (Source: P.A. 95-496, eff. 8-28-07.)
|
10 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-12) (from Ch. 122, par. 18-12)
|
11 | | Sec. 18-12. Dates for filing State aid claims. The school |
12 | | board of
each school district, a regional office of education, |
13 | | a laboratory school, or a State-authorized charter school shall |
14 | | require teachers, principals, or
superintendents to furnish |
15 | | from records kept by them such data as it
needs in preparing |
16 | | and certifying to the State Superintendent of Education
its |
17 | | report of claims provided in Section
18-8.05 of this Code. The |
18 | | claim
shall be based on the latest available equalized assessed |
19 | | valuation and tax
rates, as provided in Section 18-8.05 or |
20 | | 18-8.15 , shall use the average
daily
attendance as determined |
21 | | by the method outlined in Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 ,
and shall |
22 | | be
certified and filed with the State Superintendent of |
23 | | Education by June 21
for districts and State-authorized charter |
24 | | schools with an
official
school calendar end date before June |
25 | | 15 or within 2 weeks following the
official school calendar end |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 403 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | date for districts, regional offices of education, laboratory |
2 | | schools, or State-authorized charter schools with a school year |
3 | | end date
of June 15 or later.
Failure to
so file by these |
4 | | deadlines constitutes a forfeiture of the right
to
receive |
5 | | payment by
the State until such claim is filed. The
State |
6 | | Superintendent of Education shall voucher
for payment those |
7 | | claims to the State Comptroller as provided in Section 18-11.
|
8 | | Except as otherwise provided in this Section, if any school |
9 | | district
fails to provide the minimum school term specified
in |
10 | | Section 10-19, the State aid claim for that year shall be |
11 | | reduced by the
State Superintendent of Education in an amount |
12 | | equivalent to 1/176 or .56818% for
each day less than the |
13 | | number of days required by this Code.
|
14 | | If
the State Superintendent of Education determines that |
15 | | the failure
to
provide the minimum school term was occasioned |
16 | | by an act or acts of God, or
was occasioned by conditions |
17 | | beyond the control of the school district
which posed a |
18 | | hazardous threat to the health and safety of pupils, the
State |
19 | | aid claim need not be reduced.
|
20 | | If a school district is precluded from providing the |
21 | | minimum hours of instruction required for a full day of |
22 | | attendance due to an adverse weather condition or a condition |
23 | | beyond the control of the school district that poses a |
24 | | hazardous threat to the health and safety of students, then the |
25 | | partial day of attendance may be counted if (i) the school |
26 | | district has provided at least one hour of instruction prior to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 404 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the closure of the school district, (ii) a school building has |
2 | | provided at least one hour of instruction prior to the closure |
3 | | of the school building, or (iii) the normal start time of the |
4 | | school district is delayed. |
5 | | If, prior to providing any instruction, a school district |
6 | | must close one or more but not all school buildings after |
7 | | consultation with a local emergency response agency or due to a |
8 | | condition beyond the control of the school district, then the |
9 | | school district may claim attendance for up to 2 school days |
10 | | based on the average attendance of the 3 school days |
11 | | immediately preceding the closure of the affected school |
12 | | building or, if approved by the State Board of Education, |
13 | | utilize the provisions of an e-learning program for the |
14 | | affected school building as prescribed in Section 10-20.56 of |
15 | | this Code. The partial or no day of attendance described in |
16 | | this Section and the reasons therefore shall be certified |
17 | | within a month of the closing or delayed start by the school |
18 | | district superintendent to the regional superintendent of |
19 | | schools for forwarding to the State Superintendent of Education |
20 | | for approval.
|
21 | | Other than the utilization of any e-learning days as |
22 | | prescribed in Section 10-20.56 of this Code, no exception to |
23 | | the requirement of providing a minimum school term may
be |
24 | | approved by the State Superintendent of Education pursuant to |
25 | | this Section
unless a school district has first used all |
26 | | emergency days provided for
in its regular calendar.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 405 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | If the State Superintendent of Education declares that an |
2 | | energy
shortage exists during any part of the school year for |
3 | | the State or a
designated portion of the State, a district may |
4 | | operate the school
attendance centers within the district 4 |
5 | | days of the week during the
time of the shortage by extending |
6 | | each existing school day by one clock
hour of school work, and |
7 | | the State aid claim shall not be reduced, nor
shall the |
8 | | employees of that district suffer any reduction in salary or
|
9 | | benefits as a result thereof. A district may operate all |
10 | | attendance
centers on this revised schedule, or may apply the |
11 | | schedule to selected
attendance centers, taking into |
12 | | consideration such factors as pupil
transportation schedules |
13 | | and patterns and sources of energy for
individual attendance |
14 | | centers.
|
15 | | Electronically submitted State aid claims shall be |
16 | | submitted by
duly authorized district individuals over a secure |
17 | | network
that is password protected. The electronic submission |
18 | | of a State aid
claim must be accompanied with an affirmation |
19 | | that all of the provisions
of Sections 18-8.05, 10-22.5, and |
20 | | 24-4 of this Code are
met in all respects.
|
21 | | (Source: P.A. 99-194, eff. 7-30-15; 99-657, eff. 7-28-16.)
|
22 | | (105 ILCS 5/26-16) |
23 | | Sec. 26-16. Graduation incentives program.
|
24 | | (a) The General Assembly finds that it is critical to |
25 | | provide options for children to succeed in school. The purpose |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 406 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of this Section is to provide incentives for and encourage all |
2 | | Illinois students who have experienced or are experiencing |
3 | | difficulty in the traditional education system to enroll in |
4 | | alternative programs. |
5 | | (b) Any student who is below the age of 20 years is |
6 | | eligible to enroll in a graduation incentives program if he or |
7 | | she: |
8 | | (1) is considered a dropout pursuant to Section 26-2a |
9 | | of this Code; |
10 | | (2) has been suspended or expelled pursuant to Section |
11 | | 10-22.6 or 34-19 of
this Code; |
12 | | (3) is pregnant or is a parent; |
13 | | (4) has been assessed as chemically dependent; or |
14 | | (5) is enrolled in a bilingual education or LEP |
15 | | program. |
16 | | (c) The following programs qualify as graduation |
17 | | incentives programs for students meeting the criteria |
18 | | established in this Section: |
19 | | (1) Any public elementary or secondary education |
20 | | graduation incentives program established by a school |
21 | | district or by a regional office of education. |
22 | | (2) Any alternative learning opportunities program |
23 | | established pursuant to Article 13B of this Code. |
24 | | (3) Vocational or job training courses approved by the |
25 | | State Superintendent of Education that are available |
26 | | through the Illinois public community college system. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 407 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Students may apply for reimbursement of 50% of tuition |
2 | | costs for one course per semester or a maximum of 3 courses |
3 | | per school year. Subject to available funds, students may |
4 | | apply for reimbursement of up to 100% of tuition costs upon |
5 | | a showing of employment within 6 months after completion of |
6 | | a vocational or job training program. The qualifications |
7 | | for reimbursement shall be established by the State |
8 | | Superintendent of Education by rule. |
9 | | (4) Job and career programs approved by the State |
10 | | Superintendent of Education that are available through |
11 | | Illinois-accredited private business and vocational |
12 | | schools. Subject to available funds, pupils may apply for |
13 | | reimbursement of up to 100% of tuition costs upon a showing |
14 | | of employment within 6 months after completion of a job or |
15 | | career program. The State Superintendent of Education |
16 | | shall establish, by rule, the qualifications for |
17 | | reimbursement, criteria for determining reimbursement |
18 | | amounts, and limits on reimbursement. |
19 | | (5) Adult education courses that offer preparation for |
20 | | high school equivalency testing. |
21 | | (d) Graduation incentives programs established by school |
22 | | districts are entitled to claim general State aid and |
23 | | evidence-based funding , subject to Sections 13B-50, 13B-50.5, |
24 | | and 13B-50.10 of this Code. Graduation incentives programs |
25 | | operated by regional offices of education are entitled to |
26 | | receive general State aid and evidence-based funding at the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 408 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | foundation level of support per pupil enrolled. A school |
2 | | district must ensure that its graduation incentives program |
3 | | receives supplemental general State aid, transportation |
4 | | reimbursements, and special education resources, if |
5 | | appropriate, for students enrolled in the program.
|
6 | | (Source: P.A. 98-718, eff. 1-1-15 .) |
7 | | (105 ILCS 5/27-8.1) (from Ch. 122, par. 27-8.1) |
8 | | (Text of Section before amendment by P.A. 99-927 ) |
9 | | Sec. 27-8.1. Health examinations and immunizations. |
10 | | (1) In compliance with rules and regulations which the |
11 | | Department of Public
Health shall promulgate, and except as |
12 | | hereinafter provided, all children in
Illinois shall have a |
13 | | health examination as follows: within one year prior to
|
14 | | entering kindergarten or the first grade of any public, |
15 | | private, or parochial
elementary school; upon entering the |
16 | | sixth and ninth grades of any public,
private, or parochial |
17 | | school; prior to entrance into any public, private, or
|
18 | | parochial nursery school; and, irrespective of grade, |
19 | | immediately prior to or
upon entrance into any public, private, |
20 | | or parochial school or nursery school,
each child shall present |
21 | | proof of having been examined in accordance with this
Section |
22 | | and the rules and regulations promulgated hereunder. Any child |
23 | | who received a health examination within one year prior to |
24 | | entering the fifth grade for the 2007-2008 school year is not |
25 | | required to receive an additional health examination in order |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 409 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to comply with the provisions of Public Act 95-422 when he or |
2 | | she attends school for the 2008-2009 school year, unless the |
3 | | child is attending school for the first time as provided in |
4 | | this paragraph. |
5 | | A tuberculosis skin test screening shall be included as a |
6 | | required part of
each health examination included under this |
7 | | Section if the child resides in an
area designated by the |
8 | | Department of Public Health as having a high incidence
of |
9 | | tuberculosis. Additional health examinations of pupils, |
10 | | including eye examinations, may be required when deemed |
11 | | necessary by school
authorities. Parents are encouraged to have |
12 | | their children undergo eye examinations at the same points in |
13 | | time required for health
examinations. |
14 | | (1.5) In compliance with rules adopted by the Department of |
15 | | Public Health and except as otherwise provided in this Section, |
16 | | all children in kindergarten and the second and sixth grades of |
17 | | any public, private, or parochial school shall have a dental |
18 | | examination. Each of these children shall present proof of |
19 | | having been examined by a dentist in accordance with this |
20 | | Section and rules adopted under this Section before May 15th of |
21 | | the school year. If a child in the second or sixth grade fails |
22 | | to present proof by May 15th, the school may hold the child's |
23 | | report card until one of the following occurs: (i) the child |
24 | | presents proof of a completed dental examination or (ii) the |
25 | | child presents proof that a dental examination will take place |
26 | | within 60 days after May 15th. The Department of Public Health |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 410 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | shall establish, by rule, a waiver for children who show an |
2 | | undue burden or a lack of access to a dentist. Each public, |
3 | | private, and parochial school must give notice of this dental |
4 | | examination requirement to the parents and guardians of |
5 | | students at least 60 days before May 15th of each school year.
|
6 | | (1.10) Except as otherwise provided in this Section, all |
7 | | children enrolling in kindergarten in a public, private, or |
8 | | parochial school on or after the effective date of this |
9 | | amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly and any student |
10 | | enrolling for the first time in a public, private, or parochial |
11 | | school on or after the effective date of this amendatory Act of |
12 | | the 95th General Assembly shall have an eye examination. Each |
13 | | of these children shall present proof of having been examined |
14 | | by a physician licensed to practice medicine in all of its |
15 | | branches or a licensed optometrist within the previous year, in |
16 | | accordance with this Section and rules adopted under this |
17 | | Section, before October 15th of the school year. If the child |
18 | | fails to present proof by October 15th, the school may hold the |
19 | | child's report card until one of the following occurs: (i) the |
20 | | child presents proof of a completed eye examination or (ii) the |
21 | | child presents proof that an eye examination will take place |
22 | | within 60 days after October 15th. The Department of Public |
23 | | Health shall establish, by rule, a waiver for children who show |
24 | | an undue burden or a lack of access to a physician licensed to |
25 | | practice medicine in all of its branches who provides eye |
26 | | examinations or to a licensed optometrist. Each public, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 411 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | private, and parochial school must give notice of this eye |
2 | | examination requirement to the parents and guardians of |
3 | | students in compliance with rules of the Department of Public |
4 | | Health. Nothing in this Section shall be construed to allow a |
5 | | school to exclude a child from attending because of a parent's |
6 | | or guardian's failure to obtain an eye examination for the |
7 | | child.
|
8 | | (2) The Department of Public Health shall promulgate rules |
9 | | and regulations
specifying the examinations and procedures |
10 | | that constitute a health examination, which shall include the |
11 | | collection of data relating to obesity
(including at a minimum, |
12 | | date of birth, gender, height, weight, blood pressure, and date |
13 | | of exam),
and a dental examination and may recommend by rule |
14 | | that certain additional examinations be performed.
The rules |
15 | | and regulations of the Department of Public Health shall |
16 | | specify that
a tuberculosis skin test screening shall be |
17 | | included as a required part of each
health examination included |
18 | | under this Section if the child resides in an area
designated |
19 | | by the Department of Public Health as having a high incidence |
20 | | of
tuberculosis.
The Department of Public Health shall specify |
21 | | that a diabetes
screening as defined by rule shall be included |
22 | | as a required part of each
health examination.
Diabetes testing |
23 | | is not required. |
24 | | Physicians licensed to practice medicine in all of its |
25 | | branches, licensed advanced
practice nurses, or licensed |
26 | | physician assistants shall be
responsible for the performance |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 412 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of the health examinations, other than dental
examinations, eye |
2 | | examinations, and vision and hearing screening, and shall sign |
3 | | all report forms
required by subsection (4) of this Section |
4 | | that pertain to those portions of
the health examination for |
5 | | which the physician, advanced practice nurse, or
physician |
6 | | assistant is responsible.
If a registered
nurse performs any |
7 | | part of a health examination, then a physician licensed to
|
8 | | practice medicine in all of its branches must review and sign |
9 | | all required
report forms. Licensed dentists shall perform all |
10 | | dental examinations and
shall sign all report forms required by |
11 | | subsection (4) of this Section that
pertain to the dental |
12 | | examinations. Physicians licensed to practice medicine
in all |
13 | | its branches or licensed optometrists shall perform all eye |
14 | | examinations
required by this Section and shall sign all report |
15 | | forms required by
subsection (4) of this Section that pertain |
16 | | to the eye examination. For purposes of this Section, an eye |
17 | | examination shall at a minimum include history, visual acuity, |
18 | | subjective refraction to best visual acuity near and far, |
19 | | internal and external examination, and a glaucoma evaluation, |
20 | | as well as any other tests or observations that in the |
21 | | professional judgment of the doctor are necessary. Vision and
|
22 | | hearing screening tests, which shall not be considered |
23 | | examinations as that
term is used in this Section, shall be |
24 | | conducted in accordance with rules and
regulations of the |
25 | | Department of Public Health, and by individuals whom the
|
26 | | Department of Public Health has certified.
In these rules and |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 413 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | regulations, the Department of Public Health shall
require that |
2 | | individuals conducting vision screening tests give a child's
|
3 | | parent or guardian written notification, before the vision |
4 | | screening is
conducted, that states, "Vision screening is not a |
5 | | substitute for a
complete eye and vision evaluation by an eye |
6 | | doctor. Your child is not
required to undergo this vision |
7 | | screening if an optometrist or
ophthalmologist has completed |
8 | | and signed a report form indicating that
an examination has |
9 | | been administered within the previous 12 months." |
10 | | (3) Every child shall, at or about the same time as he or |
11 | | she receives
a health examination required by subsection (1) of |
12 | | this Section, present
to the local school proof of having |
13 | | received such immunizations against
preventable communicable |
14 | | diseases as the Department of Public Health shall
require by |
15 | | rules and regulations promulgated pursuant to this Section and |
16 | | the
Communicable Disease Prevention Act. |
17 | | (4) The individuals conducting the health examination,
|
18 | | dental examination, or eye examination shall record the
fact of |
19 | | having conducted the examination, and such additional |
20 | | information as
required, including for a health examination
|
21 | | data relating to obesity
(including at a minimum, date of |
22 | | birth, gender, height, weight, blood pressure, and date of |
23 | | exam), on uniform forms which the Department of Public Health |
24 | | and the State
Board of Education shall prescribe for statewide |
25 | | use. The examiner shall
summarize on the report form any |
26 | | condition that he or she suspects indicates a
need for special |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 414 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | services, including for a health examination factors relating |
2 | | to obesity. The individuals confirming the administration of
|
3 | | required immunizations shall record as indicated on the form |
4 | | that the
immunizations were administered. |
5 | | (5) If a child does not submit proof of having had either |
6 | | the health
examination or the immunization as required, then |
7 | | the child shall be examined
or receive the immunization, as the |
8 | | case may be, and present proof by October
15 of the current |
9 | | school year, or by an earlier date of the current school year
|
10 | | established by a school district. To establish a date before |
11 | | October 15 of the
current school year for the health |
12 | | examination or immunization as required, a
school district must |
13 | | give notice of the requirements of this Section 60 days
prior |
14 | | to the earlier established date. If for medical reasons one or |
15 | | more of
the required immunizations must be given after October |
16 | | 15 of the current school
year, or after an earlier established |
17 | | date of the current school year, then
the child shall present, |
18 | | by October 15, or by the earlier established date, a
schedule |
19 | | for the administration of the immunizations and a statement of |
20 | | the
medical reasons causing the delay, both the schedule and |
21 | | the statement being
issued by the physician, advanced practice |
22 | | nurse, physician assistant,
registered nurse, or local health |
23 | | department that will
be responsible for administration of the |
24 | | remaining required immunizations. If
a child does not comply by |
25 | | October 15, or by the earlier established date of
the current |
26 | | school year, with the requirements of this subsection, then the
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 415 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | local school authority shall exclude that child from school |
2 | | until such time as
the child presents proof of having had the |
3 | | health examination as required and
presents proof of having |
4 | | received those required immunizations which are
medically |
5 | | possible to receive immediately. During a child's exclusion |
6 | | from
school for noncompliance with this subsection, the child's |
7 | | parents or legal
guardian shall be considered in violation of |
8 | | Section 26-1 and subject to any
penalty imposed by Section |
9 | | 26-10. This subsection (5) does not apply to dental |
10 | | examinations and eye examinations. If the student is an |
11 | | out-of-state transfer student and does not have the proof |
12 | | required under this subsection (5) before October 15 of the |
13 | | current year or whatever date is set by the school district, |
14 | | then he or she may only attend classes (i) if he or she has |
15 | | proof that an appointment for the required vaccinations has |
16 | | been scheduled with a party authorized to submit proof of the |
17 | | required vaccinations. If the proof of vaccination required |
18 | | under this subsection (5) is not submitted within 30 days after |
19 | | the student is permitted to attend classes, then the student is |
20 | | not to be permitted to attend classes until proof of the |
21 | | vaccinations has been properly submitted. No school district or |
22 | | employee of a school district shall be held liable for any |
23 | | injury or illness to another person that results from admitting |
24 | | an out-of-state transfer student to class that has an |
25 | | appointment scheduled pursuant to this subsection (5). |
26 | | (6) Every school shall report to the State Board of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 416 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Education by November
15, in the manner which that agency shall |
2 | | require, the number of children who
have received the necessary |
3 | | immunizations and the health examination (other than a dental |
4 | | examination or eye examination) as
required, indicating, of |
5 | | those who have not received the immunizations and
examination |
6 | | as required, the number of children who are exempt from health
|
7 | | examination and immunization requirements on religious or |
8 | | medical grounds as
provided in subsection (8). On or before |
9 | | December 1 of each year, every public school district and |
10 | | registered nonpublic school shall make publicly available the |
11 | | immunization data they are required to submit to the State |
12 | | Board of Education by November 15. The immunization data made |
13 | | publicly available must be identical to the data the school |
14 | | district or school has reported to the State Board of |
15 | | Education. |
16 | | Every school shall report to the State Board of Education |
17 | | by June 30, in the manner that the State Board requires, the |
18 | | number of children who have received the required dental |
19 | | examination, indicating, of those who have not received the |
20 | | required dental examination, the number of children who are |
21 | | exempt from the dental examination on religious grounds as |
22 | | provided in subsection (8) of this Section and the number of |
23 | | children who have received a waiver under subsection (1.5) of |
24 | | this Section. |
25 | | Every school shall report to the State Board of Education |
26 | | by June 30, in the manner that the State Board requires, the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 417 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | number of children who have received the required eye |
2 | | examination, indicating, of those who have not received the |
3 | | required eye examination, the number of children who are exempt |
4 | | from the eye examination as provided in subsection (8) of this |
5 | | Section, the number of children who have received a waiver |
6 | | under subsection (1.10) of this Section, and the total number |
7 | | of children in noncompliance with the eye examination |
8 | | requirement. |
9 | | The reported information under this subsection (6) shall be |
10 | | provided to the
Department of Public Health by the State Board |
11 | | of Education. |
12 | | (7) Upon determining that the number of pupils who are |
13 | | required to be in
compliance with subsection (5) of this |
14 | | Section is below 90% of the number of
pupils enrolled in the |
15 | | school district, 10% of each State aid payment made
pursuant to |
16 | | Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 to the school district for such year |
17 | | may be withheld
by the State Board of Education until the |
18 | | number of students in compliance with
subsection (5) is the |
19 | | applicable specified percentage or higher. |
20 | | (8) Children of parents or legal guardians who object to |
21 | | health, dental, or eye examinations or any part thereof, to |
22 | | immunizations, or to vision and hearing screening tests on |
23 | | religious grounds shall not be required to undergo the |
24 | | examinations, tests, or immunizations to which they so object |
25 | | if such parents or legal guardians present to the appropriate |
26 | | local school authority a signed Certificate of Religious |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 418 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Exemption detailing the grounds for objection and the specific |
2 | | immunizations, tests, or examinations to which they object. The |
3 | | grounds for objection must set forth the specific religious |
4 | | belief that conflicts with the examination, test, |
5 | | immunization, or other medical intervention. The signed |
6 | | certificate shall also reflect the parent's or legal guardian's |
7 | | understanding of the school's exclusion policies in the case of |
8 | | a vaccine-preventable disease outbreak or exposure. The |
9 | | certificate must also be signed by the authorized examining |
10 | | health care provider responsible for the performance of the |
11 | | child's health examination confirming that the provider |
12 | | provided education to the parent or legal guardian on the |
13 | | benefits of immunization and the health risks to the student |
14 | | and to the community of the communicable diseases for which |
15 | | immunization is required in this State. However, the health |
16 | | care provider's signature on the certificate reflects only that |
17 | | education was provided and does not allow a health care |
18 | | provider grounds to determine a religious exemption. Those |
19 | | receiving immunizations required under this Code shall be |
20 | | provided with the relevant vaccine information statements that |
21 | | are required to be disseminated by the federal National |
22 | | Childhood Vaccine Injury Act of 1986, which may contain |
23 | | information on circumstances when a vaccine should not be |
24 | | administered, prior to administering a vaccine. A healthcare |
25 | | provider may consider including without limitation the |
26 | | nationally accepted recommendations from federal agencies such |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 419 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | as the Advisory Committee on Immunization Practices, the |
2 | | information outlined in the relevant vaccine information |
3 | | statement, and vaccine package inserts, along with the |
4 | | healthcare provider's clinical judgment, to determine whether |
5 | | any child may be more susceptible to experiencing an adverse |
6 | | vaccine reaction than the general population, and, if so, the |
7 | | healthcare provider may exempt the child from an immunization |
8 | | or adopt an individualized immunization schedule. The |
9 | | Certificate of Religious Exemption shall be created by the |
10 | | Department of Public Health and shall be made available and |
11 | | used by parents and legal guardians by the beginning of the |
12 | | 2015-2016 school year. Parents or legal guardians must submit |
13 | | the Certificate of Religious Exemption to their local school |
14 | | authority prior to entering kindergarten, sixth grade, and |
15 | | ninth grade for each child for which they are requesting an |
16 | | exemption. The religious objection stated need not be directed |
17 | | by the tenets of an established religious organization. |
18 | | However, general philosophical or moral reluctance to allow |
19 | | physical examinations, eye examinations, immunizations, vision |
20 | | and hearing screenings, or dental examinations does not provide |
21 | | a sufficient basis for an exception to statutory requirements. |
22 | | The local school authority is responsible for determining if
|
23 | | the content of the Certificate of Religious Exemption
|
24 | | constitutes a valid religious objection.
The local school |
25 | | authority shall inform the parent or legal guardian of |
26 | | exclusion procedures, in accordance with the Department's |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 420 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | rules under Part 690 of Title 77 of the Illinois Administrative |
2 | | Code, at the time the objection is presented. |
3 | | If the physical condition
of the child is such that any one |
4 | | or more of the immunizing agents should not
be administered, |
5 | | the examining physician, advanced practice nurse, or
physician |
6 | | assistant responsible for the performance of the
health |
7 | | examination shall endorse that fact upon the health examination |
8 | | form. |
9 | | Exempting a child from the health,
dental, or eye |
10 | | examination does not exempt the child from
participation in the |
11 | | program of physical education training provided in
Sections |
12 | | 27-5 through 27-7 of this Code. |
13 | | (9) For the purposes of this Section, "nursery schools" |
14 | | means those nursery
schools operated by elementary school |
15 | | systems or secondary level school units
or institutions of |
16 | | higher learning. |
17 | | (Source: P.A. 98-673, eff. 6-30-14; 99-173, eff. 7-29-15; |
18 | | 99-249, eff. 8-3-15; 99-642, eff. 7-28-16.) |
19 | | (Text of Section after amendment by P.A. 99-927 ) |
20 | | Sec. 27-8.1. Health examinations and immunizations. |
21 | | (1) In compliance with rules and regulations which the |
22 | | Department of Public
Health shall promulgate, and except as |
23 | | hereinafter provided, all children in
Illinois shall have a |
24 | | health examination as follows: within one year prior to
|
25 | | entering kindergarten or the first grade of any public, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 421 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | private, or parochial
elementary school; upon entering the |
2 | | sixth and ninth grades of any public,
private, or parochial |
3 | | school; prior to entrance into any public, private, or
|
4 | | parochial nursery school; and, irrespective of grade, |
5 | | immediately prior to or
upon entrance into any public, private, |
6 | | or parochial school or nursery school,
each child shall present |
7 | | proof of having been examined in accordance with this
Section |
8 | | and the rules and regulations promulgated hereunder. Any child |
9 | | who received a health examination within one year prior to |
10 | | entering the fifth grade for the 2007-2008 school year is not |
11 | | required to receive an additional health examination in order |
12 | | to comply with the provisions of Public Act 95-422 when he or |
13 | | she attends school for the 2008-2009 school year, unless the |
14 | | child is attending school for the first time as provided in |
15 | | this paragraph. |
16 | | A tuberculosis skin test screening shall be included as a |
17 | | required part of
each health examination included under this |
18 | | Section if the child resides in an
area designated by the |
19 | | Department of Public Health as having a high incidence
of |
20 | | tuberculosis. Additional health examinations of pupils, |
21 | | including eye examinations, may be required when deemed |
22 | | necessary by school
authorities. Parents are encouraged to have |
23 | | their children undergo eye examinations at the same points in |
24 | | time required for health
examinations. |
25 | | (1.5) In compliance with rules adopted by the Department of |
26 | | Public Health and except as otherwise provided in this Section, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 422 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | all children in kindergarten and the second and sixth grades of |
2 | | any public, private, or parochial school shall have a dental |
3 | | examination. Each of these children shall present proof of |
4 | | having been examined by a dentist in accordance with this |
5 | | Section and rules adopted under this Section before May 15th of |
6 | | the school year. If a child in the second or sixth grade fails |
7 | | to present proof by May 15th, the school may hold the child's |
8 | | report card until one of the following occurs: (i) the child |
9 | | presents proof of a completed dental examination or (ii) the |
10 | | child presents proof that a dental examination will take place |
11 | | within 60 days after May 15th. The Department of Public Health |
12 | | shall establish, by rule, a waiver for children who show an |
13 | | undue burden or a lack of access to a dentist. Each public, |
14 | | private, and parochial school must give notice of this dental |
15 | | examination requirement to the parents and guardians of |
16 | | students at least 60 days before May 15th of each school year.
|
17 | | (1.10) Except as otherwise provided in this Section, all |
18 | | children enrolling in kindergarten in a public, private, or |
19 | | parochial school on or after the effective date of this |
20 | | amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly and any student |
21 | | enrolling for the first time in a public, private, or parochial |
22 | | school on or after the effective date of this amendatory Act of |
23 | | the 95th General Assembly shall have an eye examination. Each |
24 | | of these children shall present proof of having been examined |
25 | | by a physician licensed to practice medicine in all of its |
26 | | branches or a licensed optometrist within the previous year, in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 423 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | accordance with this Section and rules adopted under this |
2 | | Section, before October 15th of the school year. If the child |
3 | | fails to present proof by October 15th, the school may hold the |
4 | | child's report card until one of the following occurs: (i) the |
5 | | child presents proof of a completed eye examination or (ii) the |
6 | | child presents proof that an eye examination will take place |
7 | | within 60 days after October 15th. The Department of Public |
8 | | Health shall establish, by rule, a waiver for children who show |
9 | | an undue burden or a lack of access to a physician licensed to |
10 | | practice medicine in all of its branches who provides eye |
11 | | examinations or to a licensed optometrist. Each public, |
12 | | private, and parochial school must give notice of this eye |
13 | | examination requirement to the parents and guardians of |
14 | | students in compliance with rules of the Department of Public |
15 | | Health. Nothing in this Section shall be construed to allow a |
16 | | school to exclude a child from attending because of a parent's |
17 | | or guardian's failure to obtain an eye examination for the |
18 | | child.
|
19 | | (2) The Department of Public Health shall promulgate rules |
20 | | and regulations
specifying the examinations and procedures |
21 | | that constitute a health examination, which shall include an |
22 | | age-appropriate developmental screening, an age-appropriate |
23 | | social and emotional screening, and the collection of data |
24 | | relating to obesity
(including at a minimum, date of birth, |
25 | | gender, height, weight, blood pressure, and date of exam),
and |
26 | | a dental examination and may recommend by rule that certain |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 424 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | additional examinations be performed.
The rules and |
2 | | regulations of the Department of Public Health shall specify |
3 | | that
a tuberculosis skin test screening shall be included as a |
4 | | required part of each
health examination included under this |
5 | | Section if the child resides in an area
designated by the |
6 | | Department of Public Health as having a high incidence of
|
7 | | tuberculosis.
With respect to the developmental screening and |
8 | | the social and emotional screening, the Department of Public |
9 | | Health must develop rules and appropriate revisions to the |
10 | | Child Health Examination form in conjunction with a statewide |
11 | | organization representing school boards; a statewide |
12 | | organization representing pediatricians; statewide |
13 | | organizations representing individuals holding Illinois |
14 | | educator licenses with school support personnel endorsements, |
15 | | including school social workers, school psychologists, and |
16 | | school nurses; a statewide organization representing |
17 | | children's mental health experts; a statewide organization |
18 | | representing school principals; the Director of Healthcare and |
19 | | Family Services or his or her designee, the State |
20 | | Superintendent of Education or his or her designee; and |
21 | | representatives of other appropriate State agencies and, at a |
22 | | minimum, must recommend the use of validated screening tools |
23 | | appropriate to the child's age or grade, and, with regard to |
24 | | the social and emotional screening, require recording only |
25 | | whether or not the screening was completed. The rules shall |
26 | | take into consideration the screening recommendations of the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 425 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | American Academy of Pediatrics and must be consistent with the |
2 | | State Board of Education's social and emotional learning |
3 | | standards. The Department of Public Health shall specify that a |
4 | | diabetes
screening as defined by rule shall be included as a |
5 | | required part of each
health examination.
Diabetes testing is |
6 | | not required. |
7 | | Physicians licensed to practice medicine in all of its |
8 | | branches, licensed advanced
practice nurses, or licensed |
9 | | physician assistants shall be
responsible for the performance |
10 | | of the health examinations, other than dental
examinations, eye |
11 | | examinations, and vision and hearing screening, and shall sign |
12 | | all report forms
required by subsection (4) of this Section |
13 | | that pertain to those portions of
the health examination for |
14 | | which the physician, advanced practice nurse, or
physician |
15 | | assistant is responsible.
If a registered
nurse performs any |
16 | | part of a health examination, then a physician licensed to
|
17 | | practice medicine in all of its branches must review and sign |
18 | | all required
report forms. Licensed dentists shall perform all |
19 | | dental examinations and
shall sign all report forms required by |
20 | | subsection (4) of this Section that
pertain to the dental |
21 | | examinations. Physicians licensed to practice medicine
in all |
22 | | its branches or licensed optometrists shall perform all eye |
23 | | examinations
required by this Section and shall sign all report |
24 | | forms required by
subsection (4) of this Section that pertain |
25 | | to the eye examination. For purposes of this Section, an eye |
26 | | examination shall at a minimum include history, visual acuity, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 426 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | subjective refraction to best visual acuity near and far, |
2 | | internal and external examination, and a glaucoma evaluation, |
3 | | as well as any other tests or observations that in the |
4 | | professional judgment of the doctor are necessary. Vision and
|
5 | | hearing screening tests, which shall not be considered |
6 | | examinations as that
term is used in this Section, shall be |
7 | | conducted in accordance with rules and
regulations of the |
8 | | Department of Public Health, and by individuals whom the
|
9 | | Department of Public Health has certified.
In these rules and |
10 | | regulations, the Department of Public Health shall
require that |
11 | | individuals conducting vision screening tests give a child's
|
12 | | parent or guardian written notification, before the vision |
13 | | screening is
conducted, that states, "Vision screening is not a |
14 | | substitute for a
complete eye and vision evaluation by an eye |
15 | | doctor. Your child is not
required to undergo this vision |
16 | | screening if an optometrist or
ophthalmologist has completed |
17 | | and signed a report form indicating that
an examination has |
18 | | been administered within the previous 12 months." |
19 | | (2.5) With respect to the developmental screening and the |
20 | | social and emotional screening portion of the health |
21 | | examination, each child may present proof of having been |
22 | | screened in accordance with this Section and the rules adopted |
23 | | under this Section before October 15th of the school year. With |
24 | | regard to the social and emotional screening only, the |
25 | | examining health care provider shall only record whether or not |
26 | | the screening was completed. If the child fails to present |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 427 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | proof of the developmental screening or the social and |
2 | | emotional screening portions of the health examination by |
3 | | October 15th of the school year, qualified school support |
4 | | personnel may, with a parent's or guardian's consent, offer the |
5 | | developmental screening or the social and emotional screening |
6 | | to the child. Each public, private, and parochial school must |
7 | | give notice of the developmental screening and social and |
8 | | emotional screening requirements to the parents and guardians |
9 | | of students in compliance with the rules of the Department of |
10 | | Public Health. Nothing in this Section shall be construed to |
11 | | allow a school to exclude a child from attending because of a |
12 | | parent's or guardian's failure to obtain a developmental |
13 | | screening or a social and emotional screening for the child. |
14 | | Once a developmental screening or a social and emotional |
15 | | screening is completed and proof has been presented to the |
16 | | school, the school may, with a parent's or guardian's consent, |
17 | | make available appropriate school personnel to work with the |
18 | | parent or guardian, the child, and the provider who signed the |
19 | | screening form to obtain any appropriate evaluations and |
20 | | services as indicated on the form and in other information and |
21 | | documentation provided by the parents, guardians, or provider. |
22 | | (3) Every child shall, at or about the same time as he or |
23 | | she receives
a health examination required by subsection (1) of |
24 | | this Section, present
to the local school proof of having |
25 | | received such immunizations against
preventable communicable |
26 | | diseases as the Department of Public Health shall
require by |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 428 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | rules and regulations promulgated pursuant to this Section and |
2 | | the
Communicable Disease Prevention Act. |
3 | | (4) The individuals conducting the health examination,
|
4 | | dental examination, or eye examination shall record the
fact of |
5 | | having conducted the examination, and such additional |
6 | | information as
required, including for a health examination
|
7 | | data relating to obesity
(including at a minimum, date of |
8 | | birth, gender, height, weight, blood pressure, and date of |
9 | | exam), on uniform forms which the Department of Public Health |
10 | | and the State
Board of Education shall prescribe for statewide |
11 | | use. The examiner shall
summarize on the report form any |
12 | | condition that he or she suspects indicates a
need for special |
13 | | services, including for a health examination factors relating |
14 | | to obesity. The duty to summarize on the report form does not |
15 | | apply to social and emotional screenings. The confidentiality |
16 | | of the information and records relating to the developmental |
17 | | screening and the social and emotional screening shall be |
18 | | determined by the statutes, rules, and professional ethics |
19 | | governing the type of provider conducting the screening. The |
20 | | individuals confirming the administration of
required |
21 | | immunizations shall record as indicated on the form that the
|
22 | | immunizations were administered. |
23 | | (5) If a child does not submit proof of having had either |
24 | | the health
examination or the immunization as required, then |
25 | | the child shall be examined
or receive the immunization, as the |
26 | | case may be, and present proof by October
15 of the current |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 429 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | school year, or by an earlier date of the current school year
|
2 | | established by a school district. To establish a date before |
3 | | October 15 of the
current school year for the health |
4 | | examination or immunization as required, a
school district must |
5 | | give notice of the requirements of this Section 60 days
prior |
6 | | to the earlier established date. If for medical reasons one or |
7 | | more of
the required immunizations must be given after October |
8 | | 15 of the current school
year, or after an earlier established |
9 | | date of the current school year, then
the child shall present, |
10 | | by October 15, or by the earlier established date, a
schedule |
11 | | for the administration of the immunizations and a statement of |
12 | | the
medical reasons causing the delay, both the schedule and |
13 | | the statement being
issued by the physician, advanced practice |
14 | | nurse, physician assistant,
registered nurse, or local health |
15 | | department that will
be responsible for administration of the |
16 | | remaining required immunizations. If
a child does not comply by |
17 | | October 15, or by the earlier established date of
the current |
18 | | school year, with the requirements of this subsection, then the
|
19 | | local school authority shall exclude that child from school |
20 | | until such time as
the child presents proof of having had the |
21 | | health examination as required and
presents proof of having |
22 | | received those required immunizations which are
medically |
23 | | possible to receive immediately. During a child's exclusion |
24 | | from
school for noncompliance with this subsection, the child's |
25 | | parents or legal
guardian shall be considered in violation of |
26 | | Section 26-1 and subject to any
penalty imposed by Section |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 430 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 26-10. This subsection (5) does not apply to dental |
2 | | examinations, eye examinations, and the developmental |
3 | | screening and the social and emotional screening portions of |
4 | | the health examination. If the student is an out-of-state |
5 | | transfer student and does not have the proof required under |
6 | | this subsection (5) before October 15 of the current year or |
7 | | whatever date is set by the school district, then he or she may |
8 | | only attend classes (i) if he or she has proof that an |
9 | | appointment for the required vaccinations has been scheduled |
10 | | with a party authorized to submit proof of the required |
11 | | vaccinations. If the proof of vaccination required under this |
12 | | subsection (5) is not submitted within 30 days after the |
13 | | student is permitted to attend classes, then the student is not |
14 | | to be permitted to attend classes until proof of the |
15 | | vaccinations has been properly submitted. No school district or |
16 | | employee of a school district shall be held liable for any |
17 | | injury or illness to another person that results from admitting |
18 | | an out-of-state transfer student to class that has an |
19 | | appointment scheduled pursuant to this subsection (5). |
20 | | (6) Every school shall report to the State Board of |
21 | | Education by November
15, in the manner which that agency shall |
22 | | require, the number of children who
have received the necessary |
23 | | immunizations and the health examination (other than a dental |
24 | | examination or eye examination) as
required, indicating, of |
25 | | those who have not received the immunizations and
examination |
26 | | as required, the number of children who are exempt from health
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 431 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | examination and immunization requirements on religious or |
2 | | medical grounds as
provided in subsection (8). On or before |
3 | | December 1 of each year, every public school district and |
4 | | registered nonpublic school shall make publicly available the |
5 | | immunization data they are required to submit to the State |
6 | | Board of Education by November 15. The immunization data made |
7 | | publicly available must be identical to the data the school |
8 | | district or school has reported to the State Board of |
9 | | Education. |
10 | | Every school shall report to the State Board of Education |
11 | | by June 30, in the manner that the State Board requires, the |
12 | | number of children who have received the required dental |
13 | | examination, indicating, of those who have not received the |
14 | | required dental examination, the number of children who are |
15 | | exempt from the dental examination on religious grounds as |
16 | | provided in subsection (8) of this Section and the number of |
17 | | children who have received a waiver under subsection (1.5) of |
18 | | this Section. |
19 | | Every school shall report to the State Board of Education |
20 | | by June 30, in the manner that the State Board requires, the |
21 | | number of children who have received the required eye |
22 | | examination, indicating, of those who have not received the |
23 | | required eye examination, the number of children who are exempt |
24 | | from the eye examination as provided in subsection (8) of this |
25 | | Section, the number of children who have received a waiver |
26 | | under subsection (1.10) of this Section, and the total number |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 432 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of children in noncompliance with the eye examination |
2 | | requirement. |
3 | | The reported information under this subsection (6) shall be |
4 | | provided to the
Department of Public Health by the State Board |
5 | | of Education. |
6 | | (7) Upon determining that the number of pupils who are |
7 | | required to be in
compliance with subsection (5) of this |
8 | | Section is below 90% of the number of
pupils enrolled in the |
9 | | school district, 10% of each State aid payment made
pursuant to |
10 | | Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 to the school district for such year |
11 | | may be withheld
by the State Board of Education until the |
12 | | number of students in compliance with
subsection (5) is the |
13 | | applicable specified percentage or higher. |
14 | | (8) Children of parents or legal guardians who object to |
15 | | health, dental, or eye examinations or any part thereof, to |
16 | | immunizations, or to vision and hearing screening tests on |
17 | | religious grounds shall not be required to undergo the |
18 | | examinations, tests, or immunizations to which they so object |
19 | | if such parents or legal guardians present to the appropriate |
20 | | local school authority a signed Certificate of Religious |
21 | | Exemption detailing the grounds for objection and the specific |
22 | | immunizations, tests, or examinations to which they object. The |
23 | | grounds for objection must set forth the specific religious |
24 | | belief that conflicts with the examination, test, |
25 | | immunization, or other medical intervention. The signed |
26 | | certificate shall also reflect the parent's or legal guardian's |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 433 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | understanding of the school's exclusion policies in the case of |
2 | | a vaccine-preventable disease outbreak or exposure. The |
3 | | certificate must also be signed by the authorized examining |
4 | | health care provider responsible for the performance of the |
5 | | child's health examination confirming that the provider |
6 | | provided education to the parent or legal guardian on the |
7 | | benefits of immunization and the health risks to the student |
8 | | and to the community of the communicable diseases for which |
9 | | immunization is required in this State. However, the health |
10 | | care provider's signature on the certificate reflects only that |
11 | | education was provided and does not allow a health care |
12 | | provider grounds to determine a religious exemption. Those |
13 | | receiving immunizations required under this Code shall be |
14 | | provided with the relevant vaccine information statements that |
15 | | are required to be disseminated by the federal National |
16 | | Childhood Vaccine Injury Act of 1986, which may contain |
17 | | information on circumstances when a vaccine should not be |
18 | | administered, prior to administering a vaccine. A healthcare |
19 | | provider may consider including without limitation the |
20 | | nationally accepted recommendations from federal agencies such |
21 | | as the Advisory Committee on Immunization Practices, the |
22 | | information outlined in the relevant vaccine information |
23 | | statement, and vaccine package inserts, along with the |
24 | | healthcare provider's clinical judgment, to determine whether |
25 | | any child may be more susceptible to experiencing an adverse |
26 | | vaccine reaction than the general population, and, if so, the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 434 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | healthcare provider may exempt the child from an immunization |
2 | | or adopt an individualized immunization schedule. The |
3 | | Certificate of Religious Exemption shall be created by the |
4 | | Department of Public Health and shall be made available and |
5 | | used by parents and legal guardians by the beginning of the |
6 | | 2015-2016 school year. Parents or legal guardians must submit |
7 | | the Certificate of Religious Exemption to their local school |
8 | | authority prior to entering kindergarten, sixth grade, and |
9 | | ninth grade for each child for which they are requesting an |
10 | | exemption. The religious objection stated need not be directed |
11 | | by the tenets of an established religious organization. |
12 | | However, general philosophical or moral reluctance to allow |
13 | | physical examinations, eye examinations, immunizations, vision |
14 | | and hearing screenings, or dental examinations does not provide |
15 | | a sufficient basis for an exception to statutory requirements. |
16 | | The local school authority is responsible for determining if
|
17 | | the content of the Certificate of Religious Exemption
|
18 | | constitutes a valid religious objection.
The local school |
19 | | authority shall inform the parent or legal guardian of |
20 | | exclusion procedures, in accordance with the Department's |
21 | | rules under Part 690 of Title 77 of the Illinois Administrative |
22 | | Code, at the time the objection is presented. |
23 | | If the physical condition
of the child is such that any one |
24 | | or more of the immunizing agents should not
be administered, |
25 | | the examining physician, advanced practice nurse, or
physician |
26 | | assistant responsible for the performance of the
health |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 435 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | examination shall endorse that fact upon the health examination |
2 | | form. |
3 | | Exempting a child from the health,
dental, or eye |
4 | | examination does not exempt the child from
participation in the |
5 | | program of physical education training provided in
Sections |
6 | | 27-5 through 27-7 of this Code. |
7 | | (9) For the purposes of this Section, "nursery schools" |
8 | | means those nursery
schools operated by elementary school |
9 | | systems or secondary level school units
or institutions of |
10 | | higher learning. |
11 | | (Source: P.A. 98-673, eff. 6-30-14; 99-173, eff. 7-29-15; |
12 | | 99-249, eff. 8-3-15; 99-642, eff. 7-28-16; 99-927, eff. |
13 | | 6-1-17.)
|
14 | | (105 ILCS 5/27A-9)
|
15 | | Sec. 27A-9. Term of charter; renewal.
|
16 | | (a) For charters granted before January 1, 2017 ( the |
17 | | effective date of Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act of the |
18 | | 99th General Assembly , a charter may be granted for a period |
19 | | not less than 5 and not
more than
10
school years. For charters |
20 | | granted on or after January 1, 2017 ( the effective date of |
21 | | Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act of the 99th General |
22 | | Assembly , a charter shall be granted for a period of 5
school |
23 | | years. For charters renewed before January 1, 2017 ( the |
24 | | effective date of Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act of the |
25 | | 99th General Assembly , a charter may be renewed in incremental |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 436 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | periods not to exceed
5
school years. For charters renewed on |
2 | | or after January 1, 2017 ( the effective date of Public Act |
3 | | 99-840) this amendatory Act of the 99th General Assembly , a |
4 | | charter may be renewed in incremental periods not to exceed 10 |
5 | | school years; however, the Commission may renew a charter only |
6 | | in incremental periods not to exceed 5 years. Authorizers shall |
7 | | ensure that every charter granted on or after January 1, 2017 |
8 | | ( the effective date of Public Act 99-840) this amendatory Act |
9 | | of the 99th General Assembly includes standards and goals for |
10 | | academic, organizational, and financial performance. A charter |
11 | | must meet all standards and goals for academic, organizational, |
12 | | and financial performance set forth by the authorizer in order |
13 | | to be renewed for a term in excess of 5 years but not more than |
14 | | 10 years. If an authorizer fails to establish standards and |
15 | | goals, a charter shall not be renewed for a term in excess of 5 |
16 | | years. Nothing contained in this Section shall require an |
17 | | authorizer to grant a full 10-year renewal term to any |
18 | | particular charter school, but an authorizer may award a full |
19 | | 10-year renewal term to charter schools that have a |
20 | | demonstrated track record of improving student performance.
|
21 | | (b) A charter school renewal proposal submitted to the
|
22 | | local school board or the Commission, as the chartering entity,
|
23 | | shall contain:
|
24 | | (1) A report on the progress of the charter school in |
25 | | achieving the goals,
objectives, pupil performance |
26 | | standards, content standards, and other terms of
the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 437 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | initial approved charter proposal; and
|
2 | | (2) A financial statement that discloses the costs of |
3 | | administration,
instruction, and other spending categories |
4 | | for the charter school that is
understandable to the |
5 | | general public and that will allow comparison of those
|
6 | | costs to other schools or other comparable organizations, |
7 | | in a format required
by the State Board.
|
8 | | (c) A charter may be revoked
or not renewed if the local |
9 | | school board or the Commission, as the chartering
entity,
|
10 | | clearly demonstrates that the
charter school did any of the
|
11 | | following, or otherwise failed to comply with the requirements |
12 | | of this law:
|
13 | | (1) Committed a material violation of any of the |
14 | | conditions, standards, or
procedures set forth in the |
15 | | charter.
|
16 | | (2) Failed to meet or make reasonable progress toward |
17 | | achievement of the
content standards or pupil performance |
18 | | standards identified in the charter.
|
19 | | (3) Failed to meet generally accepted standards of |
20 | | fiscal management.
|
21 | | (4) Violated any provision of law from which the |
22 | | charter school was not
exempted.
|
23 | | In the case of revocation, the local school board or the |
24 | | Commission, as the chartering entity, shall notify the charter |
25 | | school in writing of the reason why the charter is subject to |
26 | | revocation. The charter school shall submit a written plan to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 438 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the local school board or the Commission, whichever is |
2 | | applicable, to rectify the problem. The plan shall include a |
3 | | timeline for implementation, which shall not exceed 2 years or |
4 | | the date of the charter's expiration, whichever is earlier. If |
5 | | the local school board or the Commission, as the chartering |
6 | | entity, finds that the charter school has failed to implement |
7 | | the plan of remediation and adhere to the timeline, then the |
8 | | chartering entity shall revoke the charter. Except in |
9 | | situations of an emergency where the health, safety, or |
10 | | education of the charter school's students is at risk, the |
11 | | revocation shall take place at the end of a school year. |
12 | | Nothing in Public Act 96-105 this amendatory Act of the 96th |
13 | | General Assembly shall be construed to prohibit an |
14 | | implementation timetable that is less than 2 years in duration. |
15 | | (d) (Blank).
|
16 | | (e) Notice of a local school board's decision to
deny, |
17 | | revoke , or not to
renew a charter shall be provided to the |
18 | | Commission and the State Board.
The Commission may reverse a |
19 | | local board's
decision
if the Commission finds
that the charter |
20 | | school or charter school proposal (i) is in compliance with
|
21 | | this Article, and (ii) is in the best interests of the students |
22 | | it is designed
to serve.
The Commission may condition the |
23 | | granting of an appeal on the acceptance by
the charter school |
24 | | of funding in an amount less than that requested in the
|
25 | | proposal submitted to the local school board.
Final decisions |
26 | | of the Commission shall be subject
to judicial review under the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 439 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Administrative Review Law.
|
2 | | (f) Notwithstanding other provisions of this Article, if |
3 | | the Commission
on appeal reverses a local board's decision
or |
4 | | if a charter school is
approved by referendum,
the Commission
|
5 | | shall act as the
authorized chartering entity for the charter |
6 | | school.
The Commission shall
approve the charter and shall |
7 | | perform all functions
under this
Article otherwise performed by |
8 | | the local school
board. The State Board shall determine whether |
9 | | the charter proposal approved by the Commission is consistent |
10 | | with the provisions of this Article and, if the approved |
11 | | proposal complies, certify the proposal pursuant to this |
12 | | Article. The State Board shall
report the aggregate number of |
13 | | charter school pupils resident in a school
district to that |
14 | | district
and shall notify the district
of the amount of
funding |
15 | | to be paid by the State Board to the charter school enrolling |
16 | | such
students.
The Commission shall require the
charter school |
17 | | to maintain accurate records of daily attendance that shall be
|
18 | | deemed sufficient to file claims under Section 18-8.05 or |
19 | | 18-8.15 notwithstanding any
other requirements of that Section |
20 | | regarding hours of instruction and teacher
certification.
The |
21 | | State Board shall withhold from funds otherwise due the |
22 | | district
the funds authorized by this Article to be paid to the |
23 | | charter school and shall
pay such amounts to the charter |
24 | | school.
|
25 | | (g) For charter schools authorized by the Commission, the |
26 | | Commission shall quarterly certify to the State Board the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 440 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | student enrollment for each of its charter schools. |
2 | | (h) For charter schools authorized by the Commission, the |
3 | | State Board shall pay directly to a charter school any federal |
4 | | or State aid attributable to a student with a disability |
5 | | attending the school. |
6 | | (Source: P.A. 98-739, eff. 7-16-14; 99-840, eff. 1-1-17; |
7 | | revised 10-27-16.)
|
8 | | (105 ILCS 5/27A-11)
|
9 | | Sec. 27A-11. Local financing.
|
10 | | (a) For purposes of the School Code, pupils enrolled in a |
11 | | charter school
shall be included in the pupil enrollment of the |
12 | | school district within which
the
pupil resides. Each charter |
13 | | school (i) shall determine the school district in
which each |
14 | | pupil who is enrolled in the charter school resides,
(ii) shall
|
15 | | report the aggregate number of pupils resident of a school |
16 | | district who are
enrolled in the charter school to the school |
17 | | district in which those pupils
reside, and (iii) shall maintain |
18 | | accurate records of daily attendance that
shall be deemed |
19 | | sufficient to file claims under Section 18-8 or 18-8.15 |
20 | | notwithstanding
any other requirements of that Section |
21 | | regarding hours of instruction and
teacher certification.
|
22 | | (b) Except for a charter school established by referendum |
23 | | under Section
27A-6.5, as part of a charter school contract, |
24 | | the charter school and the
local
school board shall agree on |
25 | | funding and any services to be provided by the
school district |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 441 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to the charter school.
Agreed funding that a charter school is |
2 | | to receive from the local school
board for a school year shall |
3 | | be paid in
equal quarterly installments with the payment of the
|
4 | | installment for the first quarter being made not later than |
5 | | July 1, unless the
charter establishes a different payment |
6 | | schedule. However, if a charter school dismisses a pupil from |
7 | | the charter school after receiving a quarterly payment, the |
8 | | charter school shall return to the school district, on a |
9 | | quarterly basis, the prorated portion of public funding |
10 | | provided for the education of that pupil for the time the |
11 | | student is not enrolled at the charter school. Likewise, if a |
12 | | pupil transfers to a charter school between quarterly payments, |
13 | | the school district shall provide, on a quarterly basis, a |
14 | | prorated portion of the public funding to the charter school to |
15 | | provide for the education of that pupil.
|
16 | | All services centrally or otherwise provided by the school |
17 | | district
including, but not limited to, rent, food services, |
18 | | custodial services,
maintenance,
curriculum, media services, |
19 | | libraries, transportation, and warehousing shall be
subject to
|
20 | | negotiation between a charter school and the local school board |
21 | | and paid
for out
of the revenues negotiated pursuant to this |
22 | | subsection (b); provided that the
local school board shall not |
23 | | attempt, by negotiation or otherwise, to obligate
a charter |
24 | | school to provide pupil transportation for pupils for whom a |
25 | | district
is not required to provide transportation under the |
26 | | criteria set forth in
subsection (a)(13) of Section 27A-7.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 442 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | In no event shall the funding be less than 75% or more than
|
2 | | 125% of the
school district's per capita student tuition |
3 | | multiplied by
the
number of students residing in the district |
4 | | who are enrolled in the charter
school. However, for charter |
5 | | agreements entered into on or after the effective date of this |
6 | | amendatory Act of the 100th General Assembly, in no event shall |
7 | | the funding be less than 97% or more than 103% of the school |
8 | | district's per capita student tuition multiplied by the number |
9 | | of students residing in the district who are enrolled in the |
10 | | charter school.
|
11 | | It is the intent of the General Assembly that funding and |
12 | | service agreements
under this subsection (b) shall be neither a |
13 | | financial incentive nor a
financial disincentive to the |
14 | | establishment of a charter school.
|
15 | | The charter school may set and collect reasonable fees. |
16 | | Fees collected
from students enrolled at a charter school shall |
17 | | be retained
by the charter school.
|
18 | | (c) Notwithstanding subsection (b) of this Section, the |
19 | | proportionate share
of State and federal resources generated by |
20 | | students with disabilities or staff
serving them shall be |
21 | | directed to charter schools enrolling those students by
their |
22 | | school districts or administrative units. The proportionate |
23 | | share of
moneys generated under other federal or State |
24 | | categorical aid programs shall be
directed to charter schools |
25 | | serving students eligible for that aid.
|
26 | | (d) The governing body of a charter school is authorized to |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 443 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | accept
gifts,
donations, or grants of any kind made to the |
2 | | charter school and to expend or
use gifts, donations, or grants |
3 | | in accordance with the conditions prescribed by
the donor; |
4 | | however, a gift, donation, or grant may not be accepted by the
|
5 | | governing body if it is subject to any condition contrary to |
6 | | applicable law or
contrary
to the terms of the contract between |
7 | | the charter school and the local school
board. Charter schools |
8 | | shall be encouraged to solicit and utilize community
volunteer |
9 | | speakers and other instructional resources when providing |
10 | | instruction
on the Holocaust and other historical events.
|
11 | | (e) (Blank).
|
12 | | (f) The Commission shall provide technical assistance to
|
13 | | persons and groups
preparing or revising charter applications.
|
14 | | (g) At the non-renewal or revocation of its charter, each
|
15 | | charter school
shall refund to the local board of education all |
16 | | unspent funds.
|
17 | | (h) A charter school is authorized to incur temporary, |
18 | | short
term debt to
pay operating expenses in anticipation of |
19 | | receipt of funds from the local
school board.
|
20 | | (Source: P.A. 98-640, eff. 6-9-14; 98-739, eff. 7-16-14; 99-78, |
21 | | eff. 7-20-15.)
|
22 | | (105 ILCS 5/29-5) (from Ch. 122, par. 29-5) |
23 | | Sec. 29-5. Reimbursement by State for transportation. Any |
24 | | school
district, maintaining a school, transporting resident |
25 | | pupils to another
school district's vocational program, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 444 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | offered through a joint agreement
approved by the State Board |
2 | | of Education, as provided in Section
10-22.22 or transporting |
3 | | its resident pupils to a school which meets the
standards for |
4 | | recognition as established by the State Board of Education
|
5 | | which provides transportation meeting the standards of safety, |
6 | | comfort,
convenience, efficiency and operation prescribed by |
7 | | the State Board of
Education for resident pupils in |
8 | | kindergarten or any of grades 1 through
12 who: (a) reside at |
9 | | least 1 1/2 miles as measured by the customary route of
travel, |
10 | | from the school attended; or (b) reside in areas where |
11 | | conditions are
such that walking constitutes a hazard to the |
12 | | safety of the child when
determined under Section 29-3; and (c) |
13 | | are transported to the school attended
from pick-up points at |
14 | | the beginning of the school day and back again at the
close of |
15 | | the school day or transported to and from their assigned |
16 | | attendance
centers during the school day, shall be reimbursed |
17 | | by the State as hereinafter
provided in this Section.
|
18 | | The State will pay the cost of transporting eligible pupils |
19 | | less the prior year
assessed valuation in a dual school |
20 | | district maintaining secondary
grades 9 to 12 inclusive times a |
21 | | qualifying rate of .05%; in elementary
school districts |
22 | | maintaining grades K to 8 times a qualifying rate of
.06%; and |
23 | | in unit districts maintaining grades K to 12, including |
24 | | optional elementary unit districts and combined high school - |
25 | | unit districts, times a qualifying
rate of .07%; provided that |
26 | | for optional elementary unit districts and combined high school - |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 445 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | unit districts, prior year assessed valuation for high school |
2 | | purposes, as defined in Article 11E of this Code, must be used. |
3 | | To be eligible to receive reimbursement in excess of 4/5
of the |
4 | | cost to transport eligible pupils, a school district shall have |
5 | | a
Transportation Fund tax rate of at least .12%. If a school |
6 | | district
does not have a .12% Transportation Fund tax rate, the |
7 | | amount of its
claim in excess of 4/5 of the cost of |
8 | | transporting pupils shall be
reduced by the sum arrived at by |
9 | | subtracting the Transportation Fund tax
rate from .12% and |
10 | | multiplying that amount by the district's prior year districts |
11 | | equalized or
assessed valuation, provided, that in no case |
12 | | shall said reduction
result in reimbursement of less than 4/5 |
13 | | of the cost to transport
eligible pupils.
|
14 | | The minimum amount to be received by a district is $16 |
15 | | times the
number of eligible pupils transported.
|
16 | | When calculating the reimbursement for transportation |
17 | | costs, the State Board of Education may not deduct the number |
18 | | of pupils enrolled in early education programs from the number |
19 | | of pupils eligible for reimbursement if the pupils enrolled in |
20 | | the early education programs are transported at the same time |
21 | | as other eligible pupils.
|
22 | | Any such district transporting resident pupils during the |
23 | | school day
to an area vocational school or another school |
24 | | district's vocational
program more than 1 1/2 miles from the |
25 | | school attended, as provided in
Sections 10-22.20a and |
26 | | 10-22.22, shall be reimbursed by the State for 4/5
of the cost |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 446 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | of transporting eligible pupils.
|
2 | | School day means that period of time which the pupil is |
3 | | required to be
in attendance for instructional purposes.
|
4 | | If a pupil is at a location within the school district |
5 | | other than his
residence for child care purposes at the time |
6 | | for transportation to school,
that location may be considered |
7 | | for purposes of determining the 1 1/2 miles
from the school |
8 | | attended.
|
9 | | Claims for reimbursement that include children who attend |
10 | | any school
other than a public school shall show the number of |
11 | | such children
transported.
|
12 | | Claims for reimbursement under this Section shall not be |
13 | | paid for the
transportation of pupils for whom transportation |
14 | | costs are claimed for
payment under other Sections of this Act.
|
15 | | The allowable direct cost of transporting pupils for |
16 | | regular, vocational,
and special education pupil |
17 | | transportation shall be limited to the sum of
the cost of |
18 | | physical examinations required for employment as a school bus
|
19 | | driver; the salaries of full or part-time drivers and school |
20 | | bus maintenance
personnel; employee benefits excluding |
21 | | Illinois municipal retirement
payments, social security |
22 | | payments, unemployment insurance payments and
workers' |
23 | | compensation insurance premiums; expenditures to independent
|
24 | | carriers who operate school buses; payments to other school |
25 | | districts for
pupil transportation services; pre-approved |
26 | | contractual expenditures for
computerized bus scheduling; the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 447 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | cost of gasoline, oil, tires, and other
supplies necessary for |
2 | | the operation of school buses; the cost of
converting buses' |
3 | | gasoline engines to more fuel efficient engines or to
engines |
4 | | which use alternative energy sources; the cost of travel to
|
5 | | meetings and workshops conducted by the regional |
6 | | superintendent or the
State Superintendent of Education |
7 | | pursuant to the standards established by
the Secretary of State |
8 | | under Section 6-106 of the Illinois Vehicle Code to improve the |
9 | | driving skills of
school bus drivers; the cost of maintenance |
10 | | of school buses including parts
and materials used; |
11 | | expenditures for leasing transportation vehicles,
except |
12 | | interest and service charges; the cost of insurance and |
13 | | licenses for
transportation vehicles; expenditures for the |
14 | | rental of transportation
equipment; plus a depreciation |
15 | | allowance of 20% for 5 years for school
buses and vehicles |
16 | | approved for transporting pupils to and from school and
a |
17 | | depreciation allowance of 10% for 10 years for other |
18 | | transportation
equipment so used.
Each school year, if a school |
19 | | district has made expenditures to the
Regional Transportation |
20 | | Authority or any of its service boards, a mass
transit |
21 | | district, or an urban transportation district under an
|
22 | | intergovernmental agreement with the district to provide for |
23 | | the
transportation of pupils and if the public transit carrier |
24 | | received direct
payment for services or passes from a school |
25 | | district within its service
area during the 2000-2001 school |
26 | | year, then the allowable direct cost of
transporting pupils for |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 448 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | regular, vocational, and special education pupil
|
2 | | transportation shall also include the expenditures that the |
3 | | district has
made to the public transit carrier.
In addition to |
4 | | the above allowable costs school
districts shall also claim all |
5 | | transportation supervisory salary costs,
including Illinois |
6 | | municipal retirement payments, and all transportation
related |
7 | | building and building maintenance costs without limitation.
|
8 | | Special education allowable costs shall also include |
9 | | expenditures for the
salaries of attendants or aides for that |
10 | | portion of the time they assist
special education pupils while |
11 | | in transit and expenditures for parents and
public carriers for |
12 | | transporting special education pupils when pre-approved
by the |
13 | | State Superintendent of Education.
|
14 | | Indirect costs shall be included in the reimbursement claim |
15 | | for districts
which own and operate their own school buses. |
16 | | Such indirect costs shall
include administrative costs, or any |
17 | | costs attributable to transporting
pupils from their |
18 | | attendance centers to another school building for
|
19 | | instructional purposes. No school district which owns and |
20 | | operates its own
school buses may claim reimbursement for |
21 | | indirect costs which exceed 5% of
the total allowable direct |
22 | | costs for pupil transportation.
|
23 | | The State Board of Education shall prescribe uniform |
24 | | regulations for
determining the above standards and shall |
25 | | prescribe forms of cost
accounting and standards of determining |
26 | | reasonable depreciation. Such
depreciation shall include the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 449 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | cost of equipping school buses with the
safety features |
2 | | required by law or by the rules, regulations and standards
|
3 | | promulgated by the State Board of Education, and the Department |
4 | | of
Transportation for the safety and construction of school |
5 | | buses provided,
however, any equipment cost reimbursed by the |
6 | | Department of Transportation
for equipping school buses with |
7 | | such safety equipment shall be deducted
from the allowable cost |
8 | | in the computation of reimbursement under this
Section in the |
9 | | same percentage as the cost of the equipment is depreciated.
|
10 | | On or before August 15, annually, the chief school |
11 | | administrator for
the district shall certify to the State |
12 | | Superintendent of Education the
district's claim for |
13 | | reimbursement for the school year ending on June 30
next |
14 | | preceding. The State Superintendent of Education shall check |
15 | | and
approve the claims and prepare the vouchers showing the |
16 | | amounts due for
district reimbursement claims. Each fiscal |
17 | | year, the State
Superintendent of Education shall prepare and |
18 | | transmit the first 3
vouchers to the Comptroller on the 30th |
19 | | day of September, December and
March, respectively, and the |
20 | | final voucher, no later than June 20.
|
21 | | If the amount appropriated for transportation |
22 | | reimbursement is insufficient
to fund total claims for any |
23 | | fiscal year, the State Board of Education shall
reduce each |
24 | | school district's allowable costs and flat grant amount
|
25 | | proportionately to make total adjusted claims equal the total |
26 | | amount
appropriated.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 450 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | For purposes of calculating claims for reimbursement under |
2 | | this Section
for any school year beginning July 1, 1998, or |
3 | | thereafter, the
equalized
assessed valuation for a school |
4 | | district used to compute reimbursement
shall be computed in the |
5 | | same manner as it is computed under paragraph (2) of
subsection |
6 | | (G) of Section 18-8.05.
|
7 | | All reimbursements received from the State shall be |
8 | | deposited into the
district's transportation fund or into the |
9 | | fund from which the allowable
expenditures were made.
|
10 | | Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school |
11 | | district receiving
a payment under this Section or under |
12 | | Section 14-7.02, 14-7.02b, or
14-13.01 of this Code may |
13 | | classify all or a portion of the funds that it
receives in a |
14 | | particular fiscal year or from general State aid pursuant to
|
15 | | Section 18-8.05 of this Code
as funds received in connection |
16 | | with any funding program for which it is
entitled to receive |
17 | | funds from the State in that fiscal year (including,
without |
18 | | limitation, any funding program referenced in this Section),
|
19 | | regardless of the source or timing of the receipt. The district |
20 | | may not
classify more funds as funds received in connection |
21 | | with the funding
program than the district is entitled to |
22 | | receive in that fiscal year for that
program. Any
|
23 | | classification by a district must be made by a resolution of |
24 | | its board of
education. The resolution must identify the amount |
25 | | of any payments or
general State aid to be classified under |
26 | | this paragraph and must specify
the funding program to which |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 451 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the funds are to be treated as received in
connection |
2 | | therewith. This resolution is controlling as to the
|
3 | | classification of funds referenced therein. A certified copy of |
4 | | the
resolution must be sent to the State Superintendent of |
5 | | Education.
The resolution shall still take effect even though a |
6 | | copy of the resolution has
not been sent to the State
|
7 | | Superintendent of Education in a timely manner.
No
|
8 | | classification under this paragraph by a district shall affect |
9 | | the total amount
or timing of money the district is entitled to |
10 | | receive under this Code.
No classification under this paragraph |
11 | | by a district shall
in any way relieve the district from or |
12 | | affect any
requirements that otherwise would apply with respect |
13 | | to
that funding program, including any
accounting of funds by |
14 | | source, reporting expenditures by
original source and purpose,
|
15 | | reporting requirements,
or requirements of providing services.
|
16 | | Any school district with a population of not more than |
17 | | 500,000
must deposit all funds received under this Article into |
18 | | the transportation
fund and use those funds for the provision |
19 | | of transportation services.
|
20 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
21 | | Section, the State Board of Education shall award to a school |
22 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000 inhabitants |
23 | | 3.9% of the funds appropriated by the General Assembly for any |
24 | | fiscal year for purposes of payments to school districts under |
25 | | this Section. |
26 | | (Source: P.A. 95-903, eff. 8-25-08; 96-1264, eff. 1-1-11 .)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 452 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-2.3) (from Ch. 122, par. 34-2.3)
|
2 | | Sec. 34-2.3. Local school councils - Powers and duties. |
3 | | Each local school
council shall have and exercise, consistent |
4 | | with the provisions of
this Article and the powers and duties |
5 | | of
the board of education, the following powers and duties:
|
6 | | 1. (A) To annually evaluate the performance of the |
7 | | principal of the
attendance
center
using a Board approved |
8 | | principal evaluation form, which shall include the
evaluation |
9 | | of
(i) student academic improvement, as defined by the
school |
10 | | improvement plan, (ii)
student absenteeism rates
at the school, |
11 | | (iii) instructional leadership, (iv) the effective
|
12 | | implementation of
programs, policies, or strategies to improve |
13 | | student academic achievement,
(v) school management, and (vi) |
14 | | any other factors deemed relevant by the local
school council, |
15 | | including, without limitation, the principal's communication
|
16 | | skills and ability to create and maintain a student-centered |
17 | | learning
environment, to develop opportunities for |
18 | | professional development, and to
encourage parental |
19 | | involvement and community partnerships to achieve school
|
20 | | improvement;
|
21 | | (B) to determine in the manner provided by subsection (c) |
22 | | of Section
34-2.2 and subdivision 1.5 of this Section whether |
23 | | the performance contract
of the principal shall be
renewed; and
|
24 | | (C) to directly select, in the manner provided by
|
25 | | subsection (c) of
Section 34-2.2, a new principal (including a |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 453 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | new principal to fill a
vacancy)
-- without submitting any list |
2 | | of candidates for that position to the
general superintendent |
3 | | as provided in paragraph 2 of this Section -- to
serve under a |
4 | | 4 year performance contract; provided that (i) the |
5 | | determination
of whether the principal's performance contract |
6 | | is to be renewed, based upon
the evaluation required by |
7 | | subdivision 1.5 of this Section, shall be made no
later than |
8 | | 150 days prior to the expiration of the current |
9 | | performance-based
contract of the principal, (ii) in cases |
10 | | where such performance
contract is not renewed -- a
direct |
11 | | selection
of a
new principal -- to serve under a 4 year |
12 | | performance contract shall be made by
the local school council |
13 | | no later than 45 days prior to the expiration of the
current |
14 | | performance contract of the principal, and (iii) a
selection by
|
15 | | the local school council of a new principal to fill a vacancy |
16 | | under a 4 year
performance contract shall be made within 90 |
17 | | days after the date such vacancy
occurs. A Council shall be |
18 | | required, if requested by the principal, to provide
in writing |
19 | | the reasons for the council's not renewing the principal's |
20 | | contract.
|
21 | | 1.5. The local school council's determination of whether to |
22 | | renew the
principal's contract shall be based on an evaluation |
23 | | to assess the educational
and administrative progress made at |
24 | | the school during the principal's current
performance-based |
25 | | contract. The local school council shall base its evaluation
on |
26 | | (i) student academic improvement, as defined by the school |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 454 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | improvement plan,
(ii) student absenteeism rates at the school, |
2 | | (iii) instructional leadership,
(iv) the effective |
3 | | implementation of programs, policies, or strategies to
improve |
4 | | student academic achievement, (v) school management, and (vi) |
5 | | any
other factors deemed relevant by the local school council, |
6 | | including, without
limitation, the principal's communication |
7 | | skills and ability to create and
maintain a student-centered |
8 | | learning environment, to develop opportunities for
|
9 | | professional development, and to encourage parental |
10 | | involvement and community
partnerships to achieve school |
11 | | improvement. If a local school council
fails to renew the |
12 | | performance contract of a principal rated by the general
|
13 | | superintendent, or his or her designee, in the previous years' |
14 | | evaluations as
meeting or exceeding expectations, the |
15 | | principal, within 15 days after the
local school council's |
16 | | decision not to renew the contract, may request a review
of the
|
17 | | local school council's principal non-retention decision by a |
18 | | hearing officer
appointed by the American Arbitration |
19 | | Association. A local school council
member or members or the |
20 | | general superintendent may support the principal's
request for |
21 | | review.
During the period of the hearing officer's review of |
22 | | the local school
council's decision on
whether or not to retain |
23 | | the principal, the local school council shall maintain
all |
24 | | authority
to search for and contract with a person to serve
as |
25 | | interim or acting
principal, or as the
principal of the |
26 | | attendance center under a 4-year performance contract,
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 455 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | provided that any performance contract entered into by the |
2 | | local school council
shall be voidable
or
modified in |
3 | | accordance with the decision of the hearing officer.
The |
4 | | principal may request review only once while at that
attendance |
5 | | center. If a local school council renews the contract of a
|
6 | | principal who failed to obtain a rating of "meets" or "exceeds |
7 | | expectations" in
the general superintendent's evaluation for |
8 | | the previous year, the general superintendent,
within 15
days |
9 | | after the local
school council's decision to renew the |
10 | | contract,
may request a review of
the local school council's |
11 | | principal retention decision by a hearing officer
appointed by |
12 | | the American Arbitration Association. The general |
13 | | superintendent may request a review only
once
for that |
14 | | principal at that attendance center. All requests to review the
|
15 | | retention or non-retention of a principal shall be submitted to |
16 | | the general
superintendent, who shall, in turn, forward such |
17 | | requests, within 14 days of
receipt, to the American |
18 | | Arbitration Association.
The general superintendent shall send |
19 | | a contemporaneous copy of the request
that was forwarded to the |
20 | | American Arbitration Association to the principal and
to each |
21 | | local school council member and shall inform the local school |
22 | | council
of its rights and responsibilities under the |
23 | | arbitration process, including the
local school council's |
24 | | right to representation and the manner and process by
which the |
25 | | Board shall pay the costs of the council's representation.
If |
26 | | the local school council retains the
principal and the general |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 456 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | superintendent requests a review of the retention
decision, the |
2 | | local school council and the general
superintendent shall be |
3 | | considered parties to the arbitration, a hearing officer shall
|
4 | | be
chosen between those 2
parties pursuant to procedures |
5 | | promulgated by the State Board of Education,
and the principal |
6 | | may retain counsel and participate in the arbitration. If the |
7 | | local school council does not retain the principal and
the |
8 | | principal requests a review of the retention decision, the |
9 | | local school
council and the principal shall be considered |
10 | | parties to the
arbitration and a hearing
officer shall be |
11 | | chosen between those 2 parties pursuant to procedures
|
12 | | promulgated by the State Board of Education.
The hearing shall |
13 | | begin (i)
within 45 days
after the initial request for review |
14 | | is submitted by the principal to the
general superintendent or |
15 | | (ii) if the
initial request for
review is made by the general |
16 | | superintendent, within 45 days after that request
is mailed
to |
17 | | the American Arbitration Association.
The hearing officer |
18 | | shall render a
decision within 45
days after the hearing begins |
19 | | and within 90 days after the initial request
for review.
The |
20 | | Board shall contract with the American
Arbitration Association |
21 | | for all of the hearing officer's reasonable and
necessary |
22 | | costs. In addition, the Board shall pay any reasonable costs
|
23 | | incurred by a local school council for representation before a |
24 | | hearing
officer.
|
25 | | 1.10. The hearing officer shall conduct a hearing, which |
26 | | shall include (i)
a review of the principal's performance, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 457 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | evaluations, and other evidence of
the principal's service at |
2 | | the school, (ii) reasons provided by the local
school council |
3 | | for its decision, and (iii) documentation evidencing views of
|
4 | | interested persons, including,
without limitation, students, |
5 | | parents, local school council members, school
faculty and |
6 | | staff, the principal, the general superintendent or his or her
|
7 | | designee, and members of the community. The burden of proof in |
8 | | establishing
that the local school council's decision was |
9 | | arbitrary and capricious shall be
on the party requesting the |
10 | | arbitration, and this party shall sustain the
burden by a |
11 | | preponderance of the evidence.
The hearing officer shall set |
12 | | the
local school council decision aside if that decision, in |
13 | | light of the record
developed at the hearing, is arbitrary and |
14 | | capricious. The decision of the
hearing officer may not be |
15 | | appealed to the Board or the State Board of
Education. If the |
16 | | hearing officer decides that the principal shall be
retained, |
17 | | the retention period shall not exceed 2 years.
|
18 | | 2. In the event (i) the local school council does not renew |
19 | | the
performance contract of the principal, or the principal |
20 | | fails to receive a
satisfactory rating as provided in |
21 | | subsection (h) of Section 34-8.3,
or the principal is
removed |
22 | | for cause during the term of his or her performance contract
in |
23 | | the manner provided by Section 34-85, or a vacancy in the |
24 | | position
of principal otherwise occurs prior to the expiration |
25 | | of the term of
a principal's performance contract, and (ii) the |
26 | | local school council
fails to directly select a new principal |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 458 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | to serve under a 4 year performance
contract,
the local school |
2 | | council in such event shall submit to the general
|
3 | | superintendent a list of 3 candidates -- listed in the local |
4 | | school
council's order of preference -- for the position of |
5 | | principal, one of
which shall be selected by the general |
6 | | superintendent to serve as
principal of the attendance center. |
7 | | If the general superintendent
fails or refuses to select one of |
8 | | the candidates on the list to serve as
principal within 30 days |
9 | | after being furnished with the candidate list,
the general |
10 | | superintendent shall select and place a principal on an interim
|
11 | | basis (i) for a period not to exceed one year or (ii) until the |
12 | | local school
council selects a new principal with 7 affirmative |
13 | | votes as
provided in subsection (c) of Section 34-2.2, |
14 | | whichever occurs first. If the
local school council
fails or |
15 | | refuses to select and appoint a new principal, as specified by
|
16 | | subsection (c) of Section 34-2.2, the general superintendent |
17 | | may select and
appoint a new principal on an interim basis for
|
18 | | an additional year or until a new contract principal is |
19 | | selected by the local
school council. There shall be no |
20 | | discrimination on the basis of
race, sex, creed, color or
|
21 | | disability unrelated to ability to perform in
connection with |
22 | | the submission of candidates for, and the selection of a
|
23 | | candidate to serve as principal of an attendance center. No |
24 | | person shall
be directly selected, listed as a candidate for, |
25 | | or selected to serve as
principal of an attendance center (i) |
26 | | if such person has been removed for cause
from employment by |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 459 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the Board or (ii) if such person does not hold a valid
|
2 | | administrative certificate issued or exchanged under Article |
3 | | 21 and
endorsed as required by that Article for the position of |
4 | | principal. A
principal whose performance contract is not |
5 | | renewed as provided under
subsection (c) of Section 34-2.2 may |
6 | | nevertheless, if otherwise qualified
and certified as herein |
7 | | provided
and if he or she has received a satisfactory rating as |
8 | | provided in subsection
(h) of Section 34-8.3, be included by a |
9 | | local school council as
one of the 3 candidates listed in order |
10 | | of preference on any candidate list
from which one person is to |
11 | | be selected to serve as principal of the
attendance center |
12 | | under a new performance contract. The initial candidate
list |
13 | | required to be submitted by a local school council to the |
14 | | general
superintendent in cases where the local school council |
15 | | does not renew the
performance contract of its principal and |
16 | | does not directly select a new
principal to serve under a 4 |
17 | | year performance contract shall be submitted
not later than
30 |
18 | | days prior to the expiration of the current performance |
19 | | contract. In
cases where the local school council fails or |
20 | | refuses to submit the candidate
list to the general |
21 | | superintendent no later than 30 days prior to the
expiration of |
22 | | the incumbent principal's contract, the general superintendent
|
23 | | may
appoint a principal on an interim basis for a period not to |
24 | | exceed one year,
during which time the local school council |
25 | | shall be able to select a new
principal with 7 affirmative |
26 | | votes as provided in subsection (c) of Section
34-2.2. In cases |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 460 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | where a principal is removed for cause or a
vacancy otherwise |
2 | | occurs in the position of principal and the vacancy is
not |
3 | | filled by direct selection by the local school council, the |
4 | | candidate
list shall be submitted by the local school council |
5 | | to the general
superintendent within 90 days after the date |
6 | | such
removal or
vacancy occurs.
In cases where the local school |
7 | | council fails or refuses to submit the
candidate list to the |
8 | | general superintendent within 90 days after the date of
the |
9 | | vacancy, the general superintendent may appoint a principal on |
10 | | an interim
basis for a period of one year, during which time |
11 | | the local school council
shall be able to select a new |
12 | | principal with 7 affirmative votes as provided in
subsection |
13 | | (c) of Section 34-2.2.
|
14 | | 2.5. Whenever a vacancy in the office of a principal occurs |
15 | | for any reason,
the vacancy shall be filled in the manner |
16 | | provided by this Section by the
selection of a new principal to |
17 | | serve under a 4 year performance contract.
|
18 | | 3. To establish additional criteria
to be included as part |
19 | | of
the
performance contract of its principal, provided that |
20 | | such additional
criteria shall not discriminate on the basis of |
21 | | race, sex, creed, color
or
disability unrelated to ability to |
22 | | perform, and shall not be inconsistent
with the uniform 4 year |
23 | | performance contract for principals developed by
the board as |
24 | | provided in Section 34-8.1 of the School Code
or with other |
25 | | provisions of this Article governing the
authority and |
26 | | responsibility of principals.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 461 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 4. To approve the expenditure plan prepared by the |
2 | | principal with
respect to all funds allocated and distributed |
3 | | to the attendance center by
the Board. The expenditure plan |
4 | | shall be administered by the principal.
Notwithstanding any |
5 | | other provision of this Act or any other law, any
expenditure |
6 | | plan approved and
administered under this Section 34-2.3 shall |
7 | | be consistent with and subject to
the terms of any contract for |
8 | | services with a third party entered into by the
Chicago School |
9 | | Reform Board of Trustees or the board under this Act.
|
10 | | Via a supermajority vote of 7 members of the local school |
11 | | council or 8
members of a high school local school council, the |
12 | | Council may transfer
allocations pursuant to Section 34-2.3 |
13 | | within funds; provided that such a
transfer is consistent with |
14 | | applicable law and
collective bargaining
agreements.
|
15 | | Beginning in fiscal year 1991 and in each fiscal year
|
16 | | thereafter, the
Board may reserve up to 1% of its total fiscal |
17 | | year budget for
distribution
on a prioritized basis to schools |
18 | | throughout the school system in order to
assure adequate |
19 | | programs to meet the needs of
special student populations as |
20 | | determined by the Board. This distribution
shall take into |
21 | | account the needs catalogued in the Systemwide Plan and the
|
22 | | various local school improvement plans of the local school |
23 | | councils.
Information about these centrally funded programs |
24 | | shall be distributed to
the local school councils so that their |
25 | | subsequent planning and programming
will account for these |
26 | | provisions.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 462 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Beginning in fiscal year 1991 and in each fiscal year |
2 | | thereafter, from
other amounts available in the applicable |
3 | | fiscal year budget, the board
shall allocate a lump sum amount |
4 | | to each local school based upon
such formula as the board shall |
5 | | determine taking into account the special needs
of the student |
6 | | body. The local school
principal shall develop an expenditure |
7 | | plan in consultation with the local
school council, the |
8 | | professional personnel leadership
committee and with all
other |
9 | | school personnel, which reflects the
priorities and activities |
10 | | as described in the school's local school
improvement plan and |
11 | | is consistent with applicable law and collective
bargaining |
12 | | agreements and with board policies and standards; however, the
|
13 | | local school council shall have the right to request waivers of |
14 | | board policy
from the board of education and waivers of |
15 | | employee collective bargaining
agreements pursuant to Section |
16 | | 34-8.1a.
|
17 | | The expenditure plan developed by the principal with |
18 | | respect to
amounts available from the fund for prioritized |
19 | | special needs programs
and the allocated lump sum amount must |
20 | | be approved by the local school council.
|
21 | | The lump sum allocation shall take into account the
|
22 | | following principles:
|
23 | | a. Teachers: Each school shall be allocated funds equal |
24 | | to the
amount appropriated in the previous school year for |
25 | | compensation for
teachers (regular grades kindergarten |
26 | | through 12th grade) plus whatever
increases in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 463 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | compensation have been negotiated contractually or through
|
2 | | longevity as provided in the negotiated agreement. |
3 | | Adjustments shall be
made due to layoff or reduction in |
4 | | force, lack of funds or work, change in
subject |
5 | | requirements, enrollment changes, or contracts with third
|
6 | | parties for the performance of services or to rectify
any |
7 | | inconsistencies with system-wide allocation formulas or |
8 | | for other
legitimate reasons.
|
9 | | b. Other personnel: Funds for other teacher |
10 | | certificated and
uncertificated personnel paid through |
11 | | non-categorical funds shall be
provided according to |
12 | | system-wide formulas based on student enrollment and
the |
13 | | special needs of the school as determined by the Board.
|
14 | | c. Non-compensation items: Appropriations for all |
15 | | non-compensation items
shall be based on system-wide |
16 | | formulas based on student enrollment and
on the special |
17 | | needs of the school or factors related to the physical
|
18 | | plant, including but not limited to textbooks, electronic |
19 | | textbooks and the technological equipment necessary to |
20 | | gain access to and use electronic textbooks, supplies, |
21 | | electricity,
equipment, and routine maintenance.
|
22 | | d. Funds for categorical programs: Schools shall |
23 | | receive personnel
and funds based on, and shall use such |
24 | | personnel and funds in accordance
with State and Federal |
25 | | requirements applicable to each
categorical program
|
26 | | provided to meet the special needs of the student body |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 464 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (including but not
limited to, Federal Chapter I, |
2 | | Bilingual, and Special Education).
|
3 | | d.1. Funds for State Title I: Each school shall receive
|
4 | | funds based on State and Board requirements applicable to |
5 | | each State
Title I pupil provided to meet the special needs |
6 | | of the student body. Each
school shall receive the |
7 | | proportion of funds as provided in Section 18-8 or 18-8.15 |
8 | | to
which they are entitled. These funds shall be spent only |
9 | | with the
budgetary approval of the Local School Council as |
10 | | provided in Section 34-2.3.
|
11 | | e. The Local School Council shall have the right to |
12 | | request the
principal to close positions and open new ones |
13 | | consistent with the
provisions of the local school |
14 | | improvement plan provided that these
decisions are |
15 | | consistent with applicable law and
collective bargaining
|
16 | | agreements. If a position is closed, pursuant to this |
17 | | paragraph, the local
school shall have for its use the |
18 | | system-wide average compensation for the
closed position.
|
19 | | f. Operating within existing laws and
collective |
20 | | bargaining agreements,
the local school council shall have |
21 | | the right to direct the principal to
shift expenditures |
22 | | within funds.
|
23 | | g. (Blank).
|
24 | | Any funds unexpended at the end of the fiscal year shall be |
25 | | available to
the board of education for use as part of its |
26 | | budget for the following
fiscal year.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 465 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 5. To make recommendations to the principal concerning |
2 | | textbook
selection and concerning curriculum developed |
3 | | pursuant to the school
improvement plan which is consistent |
4 | | with systemwide curriculum objectives
in accordance with |
5 | | Sections 34-8 and 34-18 of the School Code and in
conformity |
6 | | with the collective bargaining agreement.
|
7 | | 6. To advise the principal concerning the attendance and
|
8 | | disciplinary policies for the attendance center, subject to the |
9 | | provisions
of this Article and Article 26, and consistent with |
10 | | the uniform system of
discipline established by the board |
11 | | pursuant to Section 34-19.
|
12 | | 7. To approve a school improvement plan developed as |
13 | | provided in Section
34-2.4. The process and schedule for plan |
14 | | development shall be publicized
to the entire school community, |
15 | | and the community shall be afforded the
opportunity to make |
16 | | recommendations concerning the plan. At least twice a
year the |
17 | | principal and
local
school council shall report publicly on
|
18 | | progress and problems with respect to plan implementation.
|
19 | | 8. To evaluate the allocation of teaching resources and |
20 | | other
certificated and uncertificated staff to the attendance |
21 | | center to determine
whether such allocation is consistent with |
22 | | and in furtherance of
instructional objectives and school |
23 | | programs reflective of the school
improvement plan adopted for |
24 | | the attendance center; and to make
recommendations to the |
25 | | board, the general superintendent
and the
principal concerning |
26 | | any reallocation of teaching resources
or other staff whenever |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 466 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | the council determines that any such
reallocation is |
2 | | appropriate because the qualifications of any existing
staff at |
3 | | the attendance center do not adequately match or support
|
4 | | instructional objectives or school programs which reflect the |
5 | | school
improvement plan.
|
6 | | 9. To make recommendations to the principal and the general |
7 | | superintendent
concerning their respective appointments, after |
8 | | August 31, 1989, and in the
manner provided by Section 34-8 and |
9 | | Section 34-8.1,
of persons to fill any vacant, additional or |
10 | | newly created
positions for teachers at the attendance center |
11 | | or at attendance centers
which include the attendance center |
12 | | served by the local school council.
|
13 | | 10. To request of the Board the manner in which training |
14 | | and
assistance shall be provided to the local school council. |
15 | | Pursuant to Board
guidelines a local school council is |
16 | | authorized to direct
the Board of Education to contract with |
17 | | personnel or not-for-profit
organizations not associated with |
18 | | the school district to train or assist
council members. If |
19 | | training or assistance is provided by contract with
personnel |
20 | | or organizations not associated with the school district, the
|
21 | | period of training or assistance shall not exceed 30 hours |
22 | | during a given
school year; person shall not be employed on a |
23 | | continuous basis longer than
said period and shall not have |
24 | | been employed by the Chicago Board of
Education within the |
25 | | preceding six months. Council members shall receive
training in |
26 | | at least the following areas:
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 467 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 1. school budgets;
|
2 | | 2. educational theory pertinent to the attendance |
3 | | center's particular
needs, including the development of |
4 | | the school improvement plan and the
principal's |
5 | | performance contract; and
|
6 | | 3. personnel selection.
|
7 | | Council members shall, to the greatest extent possible, |
8 | | complete such
training within 90 days of election.
|
9 | | 11. In accordance with systemwide guidelines contained in |
10 | | the
System-Wide Educational Reform Goals and Objectives Plan, |
11 | | criteria for
evaluation of performance shall be established for |
12 | | local school councils
and local school council members. If a |
13 | | local school council persists in
noncompliance with systemwide |
14 | | requirements, the Board may impose sanctions
and take necessary |
15 | | corrective action, consistent with Section 34-8.3.
|
16 | | 12. Each local school council shall comply with the Open |
17 | | Meetings Act and
the Freedom of Information Act. Each local |
18 | | school council shall issue and
transmit to its school community |
19 | | a detailed annual report accounting for
its activities |
20 | | programmatically and financially. Each local school council
|
21 | | shall convene at least 2 well-publicized meetings annually with |
22 | | its entire
school community. These meetings shall include |
23 | | presentation of the
proposed local school improvement plan, of |
24 | | the proposed school expenditure
plan, and the annual report, |
25 | | and shall provide an opportunity for public
comment.
|
26 | | 13. Each local school council is encouraged to involve |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 468 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | additional
non-voting members of the school community in |
2 | | facilitating the council's
exercise of its responsibilities.
|
3 | | 14. The local school council may adopt a school
uniform or |
4 | | dress
code policy that governs the attendance center and that |
5 | | is
necessary to maintain the orderly process of a school |
6 | | function or prevent
endangerment of student health or safety, |
7 | | consistent with the policies and
rules of the Board of |
8 | | Education.
A school uniform or dress code policy adopted
by a |
9 | | local school council: (i) shall not be applied in such manner |
10 | | as to
discipline or deny attendance to a transfer student or |
11 | | any other student for
noncompliance with that
policy during |
12 | | such period of time as is reasonably necessary to enable the
|
13 | | student to acquire a school uniform or otherwise comply with |
14 | | the dress code
policy that is in effect at the attendance |
15 | | center into which the student's
enrollment is transferred; and |
16 | | (ii) shall include criteria and procedures under
which the |
17 | | local school council will accommodate the needs of or otherwise
|
18 | | provide
appropriate resources to assist a student from an |
19 | | indigent family in complying
with an applicable school uniform |
20 | | or dress code policy.
A student whose parents or legal |
21 | | guardians object on religious grounds to the
student's |
22 | | compliance with an applicable school uniform or dress code |
23 | | policy
shall not be required to comply with that policy if the |
24 | | student's parents or
legal guardians present to the local |
25 | | school council a signed statement of
objection detailing the |
26 | | grounds for the objection.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 469 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 15. All decisions made and actions taken by the local |
2 | | school council in
the exercise of its powers and duties shall |
3 | | comply with State and federal
laws, all applicable collective |
4 | | bargaining agreements, court orders and
rules properly |
5 | | promulgated by the Board.
|
6 | | 15a. To grant, in accordance with board rules and policies,
|
7 | | the use of assembly halls and classrooms when not otherwise |
8 | | needed,
including lighting, heat, and attendants, for public |
9 | | lectures, concerts, and
other educational and social |
10 | | activities.
|
11 | | 15b. To approve, in accordance with board rules and |
12 | | policies, receipts and
expenditures for all internal accounts |
13 | | of the
attendance center, and to approve all fund-raising |
14 | | activities by nonschool
organizations that use the school |
15 | | building.
|
16 | | 16. (Blank).
|
17 | | 17. Names and addresses of local school council members |
18 | | shall
be a matter of public record.
|
19 | | (Source: P.A. 96-1403, eff. 7-29-10.)
|
20 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-18) (from Ch. 122, par. 34-18)
|
21 | | Sec. 34-18. Powers of the board. The board shall exercise |
22 | | general
supervision and jurisdiction over the public education |
23 | | and the public
school system of the city, and, except as |
24 | | otherwise provided by this
Article, shall have power:
|
25 | | 1. To make suitable provision for the establishment and |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 470 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | maintenance
throughout the year or for such portion thereof |
2 | | as it may direct, not
less than 9 months, of schools of all |
3 | | grades and kinds, including normal
schools, high schools, |
4 | | night schools, schools for defectives and
delinquents, |
5 | | parental and truant schools, schools for the blind, the
|
6 | | deaf and persons with physical disabilities, schools or |
7 | | classes in manual training,
constructural and vocational |
8 | | teaching, domestic arts and physical
culture, vocation and |
9 | | extension schools and lecture courses, and all
other |
10 | | educational courses and facilities, including |
11 | | establishing,
equipping, maintaining and operating |
12 | | playgrounds and recreational
programs, when such programs |
13 | | are conducted in, adjacent to, or connected
with any public |
14 | | school under the general supervision and jurisdiction
of |
15 | | the board; provided that the calendar for the school term |
16 | | and any changes must be submitted to and approved by the |
17 | | State Board of Education before the calendar or changes may |
18 | | take effect, and provided that in allocating funds
from |
19 | | year to year for the operation of all attendance centers |
20 | | within the
district, the board shall ensure that |
21 | | supplemental general State aid or supplemental grant funds
|
22 | | are allocated and applied in accordance with Section 18-8 , |
23 | | or 18-8.05 , or 18-8.15 . To
admit to such
schools without |
24 | | charge foreign exchange students who are participants in
an |
25 | | organized exchange student program which is authorized by |
26 | | the board.
The board shall permit all students to enroll in |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 471 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | apprenticeship programs
in trade schools operated by the |
2 | | board, whether those programs are
union-sponsored or not. |
3 | | No student shall be refused admission into or
be excluded |
4 | | from any course of instruction offered in the common |
5 | | schools
by reason of that student's sex. No student shall |
6 | | be denied equal
access to physical education and |
7 | | interscholastic athletic programs
supported from school |
8 | | district funds or denied participation in
comparable |
9 | | physical education and athletic programs solely by reason |
10 | | of
the student's sex. Equal access to programs supported |
11 | | from school
district funds and comparable programs will be |
12 | | defined in rules
promulgated by the State Board of |
13 | | Education in
consultation with the Illinois High School |
14 | | Association.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this |
15 | | Article, neither the board
of education nor any local |
16 | | school council or other school official shall
recommend |
17 | | that children with disabilities be placed into regular |
18 | | education
classrooms unless those children with |
19 | | disabilities are provided with
supplementary services to |
20 | | assist them so that they benefit from the regular
classroom |
21 | | instruction and are included on the teacher's regular |
22 | | education
class register;
|
23 | | 2. To furnish lunches to pupils, to make a reasonable |
24 | | charge
therefor, and to use school funds for the payment of |
25 | | such expenses as
the board may determine are necessary in |
26 | | conducting the school lunch
program;
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 472 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 3. To co-operate with the circuit court;
|
2 | | 4. To make arrangements with the public or quasi-public |
3 | | libraries
and museums for the use of their facilities by |
4 | | teachers and pupils of
the public schools;
|
5 | | 5. To employ dentists and prescribe their duties for |
6 | | the purpose of
treating the pupils in the schools, but |
7 | | accepting such treatment shall
be optional with parents or |
8 | | guardians;
|
9 | | 6. To grant the use of assembly halls and classrooms |
10 | | when not
otherwise needed, including light, heat, and |
11 | | attendants, for free public
lectures, concerts, and other |
12 | | educational and social interests, free of
charge, under |
13 | | such provisions and control as the principal of the
|
14 | | affected attendance center may prescribe;
|
15 | | 7. To apportion the pupils to the several schools; |
16 | | provided that no pupil
shall be excluded from or segregated |
17 | | in any such school on account of his
color, race, sex, or |
18 | | nationality. The board shall take into consideration
the |
19 | | prevention of segregation and the elimination of |
20 | | separation of children
in public schools because of color, |
21 | | race, sex, or nationality. Except that
children may be |
22 | | committed to or attend parental and social adjustment |
23 | | schools
established and maintained either for boys or girls |
24 | | only. All records
pertaining to the creation, alteration or |
25 | | revision of attendance areas shall
be open to the public. |
26 | | Nothing herein shall limit the board's authority to
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 473 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | establish multi-area attendance centers or other student |
2 | | assignment systems
for desegregation purposes or |
3 | | otherwise, and to apportion the pupils to the
several |
4 | | schools. Furthermore, beginning in school year 1994-95, |
5 | | pursuant
to a board plan adopted by October 1, 1993, the |
6 | | board shall offer, commencing
on a phased-in basis, the |
7 | | opportunity for families within the school
district to |
8 | | apply for enrollment of their children in any attendance |
9 | | center
within the school district which does not have |
10 | | selective admission
requirements approved by the board. |
11 | | The appropriate geographical area in
which such open |
12 | | enrollment may be exercised shall be determined by the
|
13 | | board of education. Such children may be admitted to any |
14 | | such attendance
center on a space available basis after all |
15 | | children residing within such
attendance center's area |
16 | | have been accommodated. If the number of
applicants from |
17 | | outside the attendance area exceed the space available,
|
18 | | then successful applicants shall be selected by lottery. |
19 | | The board of
education's open enrollment plan must include |
20 | | provisions that allow low
income students to have access to |
21 | | transportation needed to exercise school
choice. Open |
22 | | enrollment shall be in compliance with the provisions of |
23 | | the
Consent Decree and Desegregation Plan cited in Section |
24 | | 34-1.01;
|
25 | | 8. To approve programs and policies for providing |
26 | | transportation
services to students. Nothing herein shall |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 474 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | be construed to permit or empower
the State Board of |
2 | | Education to order, mandate, or require busing or other
|
3 | | transportation of pupils for the purpose of achieving |
4 | | racial balance in any
school;
|
5 | | 9. Subject to the limitations in this Article, to |
6 | | establish and
approve system-wide curriculum objectives |
7 | | and standards, including graduation
standards, which |
8 | | reflect the
multi-cultural diversity in the city and are |
9 | | consistent with State law,
provided that for all purposes |
10 | | of this Article courses or
proficiency in American Sign |
11 | | Language shall be deemed to constitute courses
or |
12 | | proficiency in a foreign language; and to employ principals |
13 | | and teachers,
appointed as provided in this
Article, and |
14 | | fix their compensation. The board shall prepare such |
15 | | reports
related to minimal competency testing as may be |
16 | | requested by the State
Board of Education, and in addition |
17 | | shall monitor and approve special
education and bilingual |
18 | | education programs and policies within the district to
|
19 | | assure that appropriate services are provided in |
20 | | accordance with applicable
State and federal laws to |
21 | | children requiring services and education in those
areas;
|
22 | | 10. To employ non-teaching personnel or utilize |
23 | | volunteer personnel
for: (i) non-teaching duties not |
24 | | requiring instructional judgment or
evaluation of pupils, |
25 | | including library duties; and (ii) supervising study
|
26 | | halls, long distance teaching reception areas used |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 475 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | incident to instructional
programs transmitted by |
2 | | electronic media such as computers, video, and audio,
|
3 | | detention and discipline areas, and school-sponsored |
4 | | extracurricular
activities. The board may further utilize |
5 | | volunteer non-certificated
personnel or employ |
6 | | non-certificated personnel to
assist in the instruction of |
7 | | pupils under the immediate supervision of a
teacher holding |
8 | | a valid certificate, directly engaged in teaching
subject |
9 | | matter or conducting activities; provided that the teacher
|
10 | | shall be continuously aware of the non-certificated |
11 | | persons' activities and
shall be able to control or modify |
12 | | them. The general superintendent shall
determine |
13 | | qualifications of such personnel and shall prescribe rules |
14 | | for
determining the duties and activities to be assigned to |
15 | | such personnel;
|
16 | | 10.5. To utilize volunteer personnel from a regional |
17 | | School Crisis
Assistance Team (S.C.A.T.), created as part |
18 | | of the Safe to Learn Program
established pursuant to |
19 | | Section 25 of the Illinois Violence Prevention Act
of 1995, |
20 | | to provide assistance to schools in times of violence or |
21 | | other
traumatic incidents within a school community by |
22 | | providing crisis
intervention services to lessen the |
23 | | effects of emotional trauma on
individuals and the |
24 | | community; the School Crisis Assistance Team
Steering |
25 | | Committee shall determine the qualifications for |
26 | | volunteers;
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 476 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 11. To provide television studio facilities in not to |
2 | | exceed one
school building and to provide programs for |
3 | | educational purposes,
provided, however, that the board |
4 | | shall not construct, acquire, operate,
or maintain a |
5 | | television transmitter; to grant the use of its studio
|
6 | | facilities to a licensed television station located in the |
7 | | school
district; and to maintain and operate not to exceed |
8 | | one school radio
transmitting station and provide programs |
9 | | for educational purposes;
|
10 | | 12. To offer, if deemed appropriate, outdoor education |
11 | | courses,
including field trips within the State of |
12 | | Illinois, or adjacent states,
and to use school educational |
13 | | funds for the expense of the said outdoor
educational |
14 | | programs, whether within the school district or not;
|
15 | | 13. During that period of the calendar year not |
16 | | embraced within the
regular school term, to provide and |
17 | | conduct courses in subject matters
normally embraced in the |
18 | | program of the schools during the regular
school term and |
19 | | to give regular school credit for satisfactory
completion |
20 | | by the student of such courses as may be approved for |
21 | | credit
by the State Board of Education;
|
22 | | 14. To insure against any loss or liability of the |
23 | | board,
the former School Board Nominating Commission, |
24 | | Local School Councils, the
Chicago Schools Academic |
25 | | Accountability Council, or the former Subdistrict
Councils |
26 | | or of any member, officer, agent or employee thereof, |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 477 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | resulting
from alleged violations of civil rights arising |
2 | | from incidents occurring on
or after September 5, 1967 or |
3 | | from the wrongful or negligent act or
omission of any such |
4 | | person whether occurring within or without the school
|
5 | | premises, provided the officer, agent or employee was, at |
6 | | the time of the
alleged violation of civil rights or |
7 | | wrongful act or omission, acting
within the scope of his |
8 | | employment or under direction of the board, the
former |
9 | | School
Board Nominating Commission, the Chicago Schools |
10 | | Academic Accountability
Council, Local School Councils, or |
11 | | the former Subdistrict Councils;
and to provide for or |
12 | | participate in insurance plans for its officers and
|
13 | | employees, including but not limited to retirement |
14 | | annuities, medical,
surgical and hospitalization benefits |
15 | | in such types and amounts as may be
determined by the |
16 | | board; provided, however, that the board shall contract
for |
17 | | such insurance only with an insurance company authorized to |
18 | | do business
in this State. Such insurance may include |
19 | | provision for employees who rely
on treatment by prayer or |
20 | | spiritual means alone for healing, in accordance
with the |
21 | | tenets and practice of a recognized religious |
22 | | denomination;
|
23 | | 15. To contract with the corporate authorities of any |
24 | | municipality
or the county board of any county, as the case |
25 | | may be, to provide for
the regulation of traffic in parking |
26 | | areas of property used for school
purposes, in such manner |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 478 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | as is provided by Section 11-209 of The
Illinois Vehicle |
2 | | Code, approved September 29, 1969, as amended;
|
3 | | 16. (a) To provide, on an equal basis, access to a high
|
4 | | school campus and student directory information to the
|
5 | | official recruiting representatives of the armed forces of |
6 | | Illinois and
the United States for the purposes of |
7 | | informing students of the educational
and career |
8 | | opportunities available in the military if the board has |
9 | | provided
such access to persons or groups whose purpose is |
10 | | to acquaint students with
educational or occupational |
11 | | opportunities available to them. The board
is not required |
12 | | to give greater notice regarding the right of access to
|
13 | | recruiting representatives than is given to other persons |
14 | | and groups. In
this paragraph 16, "directory information" |
15 | | means a high school
student's name, address, and telephone |
16 | | number.
|
17 | | (b) If a student or his or her parent or guardian |
18 | | submits a signed,
written request to the high school before |
19 | | the end of the student's sophomore
year (or if the student |
20 | | is a transfer student, by another time set by
the high |
21 | | school) that indicates that the student or his or her |
22 | | parent or
guardian does
not want the student's directory |
23 | | information to be provided to official
recruiting |
24 | | representatives under subsection (a) of this Section, the |
25 | | high
school may not provide access to the student's |
26 | | directory information to
these recruiting representatives. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 479 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | The high school shall notify its
students and their parents |
2 | | or guardians of the provisions of this
subsection (b).
|
3 | | (c) A high school may require official recruiting |
4 | | representatives of
the armed forces of Illinois and the |
5 | | United States to pay a fee for copying
and mailing a |
6 | | student's directory information in an amount that is not
|
7 | | more than the actual costs incurred by the high school.
|
8 | | (d) Information received by an official recruiting |
9 | | representative
under this Section may be used only to |
10 | | provide information to students
concerning educational and |
11 | | career opportunities available in the military
and may not |
12 | | be released to a person who is not involved in recruiting
|
13 | | students for the armed forces of Illinois or the United |
14 | | States;
|
15 | | 17. (a) To sell or market any computer program |
16 | | developed by an employee
of the school district, provided |
17 | | that such employee developed the computer
program as a |
18 | | direct result of his or her duties with the school district
|
19 | | or through the utilization of the school district resources |
20 | | or facilities.
The employee who developed the computer |
21 | | program shall be entitled to share
in the proceeds of such |
22 | | sale or marketing of the computer program. The
distribution |
23 | | of such proceeds between the employee and the school |
24 | | district
shall be as agreed upon by the employee and the |
25 | | school district, except
that neither the employee nor the |
26 | | school district may receive more than 90%
of such proceeds. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 480 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | The negotiation for an employee who is represented by an
|
2 | | exclusive bargaining representative may be conducted by |
3 | | such bargaining
representative at the employee's request.
|
4 | | (b) For the purpose of this paragraph 17:
|
5 | | (1) "Computer" means an internally programmed, |
6 | | general purpose digital
device capable of |
7 | | automatically accepting data, processing data and |
8 | | supplying
the results of the operation.
|
9 | | (2) "Computer program" means a series of coded |
10 | | instructions or
statements in a form acceptable to a |
11 | | computer, which causes the computer to
process data in |
12 | | order to achieve a certain result.
|
13 | | (3) "Proceeds" means profits derived from |
14 | | marketing or sale of a product
after deducting the |
15 | | expenses of developing and marketing such product;
|
16 | | 18. To delegate to the general superintendent of
|
17 | | schools, by resolution, the authority to approve contracts |
18 | | and expenditures
in amounts of $10,000 or less;
|
19 | | 19. Upon the written request of an employee, to |
20 | | withhold from
the compensation of that employee any dues, |
21 | | payments or contributions
payable by such employee to any |
22 | | labor organization as defined in the
Illinois Educational |
23 | | Labor Relations Act. Under such arrangement, an
amount |
24 | | shall be withheld from each regular payroll period which is |
25 | | equal to
the pro rata share of the annual dues plus any |
26 | | payments or contributions,
and the board shall transmit |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 481 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | such withholdings to the specified labor
organization |
2 | | within 10 working days from the time of the withholding;
|
3 | | 19a. Upon receipt of notice from the comptroller of a |
4 | | municipality with
a population of 500,000 or more, a county |
5 | | with a population of 3,000,000 or
more, the Cook County |
6 | | Forest Preserve District, the Chicago Park District, the
|
7 | | Metropolitan Water Reclamation District, the Chicago |
8 | | Transit Authority, or
a housing authority of a municipality |
9 | | with a population of 500,000 or more
that a debt is due and |
10 | | owing the municipality, the county, the Cook County
Forest |
11 | | Preserve District, the Chicago Park District, the |
12 | | Metropolitan Water
Reclamation District, the Chicago |
13 | | Transit Authority, or the housing authority
by an employee |
14 | | of the Chicago Board of Education, to withhold, from the
|
15 | | compensation of that employee, the amount of the debt that |
16 | | is due and owing
and pay the amount withheld to the |
17 | | municipality, the county, the Cook County
Forest Preserve |
18 | | District, the Chicago Park District, the Metropolitan |
19 | | Water
Reclamation District, the Chicago Transit Authority, |
20 | | or the housing authority;
provided, however, that the |
21 | | amount
deducted from any one salary or wage payment shall |
22 | | not exceed 25% of the net
amount of the payment. Before the |
23 | | Board deducts any amount from any salary or
wage of an |
24 | | employee under this paragraph, the municipality, the |
25 | | county, the
Cook County Forest Preserve District, the |
26 | | Chicago Park District, the
Metropolitan Water Reclamation |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 482 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | District, the Chicago Transit Authority, or the
housing |
2 | | authority shall certify that (i) the employee has been |
3 | | afforded an
opportunity for a hearing to dispute the debt |
4 | | that is due and owing the
municipality, the county, the |
5 | | Cook County Forest Preserve District, the Chicago
Park |
6 | | District, the Metropolitan Water Reclamation District, the |
7 | | Chicago Transit
Authority, or the housing authority and |
8 | | (ii) the employee has received notice
of a wage deduction |
9 | | order and has been afforded an opportunity for a hearing to
|
10 | | object to the order. For purposes of this paragraph, "net |
11 | | amount" means that
part of the salary or wage payment |
12 | | remaining after the deduction of any amounts
required by |
13 | | law to be deducted and "debt due and owing" means (i) a |
14 | | specified
sum of money owed to the municipality, the |
15 | | county, the Cook County Forest
Preserve District, the |
16 | | Chicago Park District, the Metropolitan Water
Reclamation |
17 | | District, the Chicago Transit Authority, or the housing |
18 | | authority
for services, work, or goods, after the period |
19 | | granted for payment has expired,
or (ii) a specified sum of |
20 | | money owed to the municipality, the county, the Cook
County |
21 | | Forest Preserve District, the Chicago Park District, the |
22 | | Metropolitan
Water Reclamation District, the Chicago |
23 | | Transit Authority, or the housing
authority pursuant to a |
24 | | court order or order of an administrative hearing
officer |
25 | | after the exhaustion of, or the failure to exhaust, |
26 | | judicial review;
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 483 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 20. The board is encouraged to employ a sufficient |
2 | | number of
certified school counselors to maintain a |
3 | | student/counselor ratio of 250 to
1 by July 1, 1990. Each |
4 | | counselor shall spend at least 75% of his work
time in |
5 | | direct contact with students and shall maintain a record of |
6 | | such time;
|
7 | | 21. To make available to students vocational and career
|
8 | | counseling and to establish 5 special career counseling |
9 | | days for students
and parents. On these days |
10 | | representatives of local businesses and
industries shall |
11 | | be invited to the school campus and shall inform students
|
12 | | of career opportunities available to them in the various |
13 | | businesses and
industries. Special consideration shall be |
14 | | given to counseling minority
students as to career |
15 | | opportunities available to them in various fields.
For the |
16 | | purposes of this paragraph, minority student means a person |
17 | | who is any of the following:
|
18 | | (a) American Indian or Alaska Native (a person having |
19 | | origins in any of the original peoples of North and South |
20 | | America, including Central America, and who maintains |
21 | | tribal affiliation or community attachment). |
22 | | (b) Asian (a person having origins in any of the |
23 | | original peoples of the Far East, Southeast Asia, or the |
24 | | Indian subcontinent, including, but not limited to, |
25 | | Cambodia, China, India, Japan, Korea, Malaysia, Pakistan, |
26 | | the Philippine Islands, Thailand, and Vietnam). |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 484 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | (c) Black or African American (a person having origins |
2 | | in any of the black racial groups of Africa). Terms such as |
3 | | "Haitian" or "Negro" can be used in addition to "Black or |
4 | | African American". |
5 | | (d) Hispanic or Latino (a person of Cuban, Mexican, |
6 | | Puerto Rican, South or Central American, or other Spanish |
7 | | culture or origin, regardless of race). |
8 | | (e) Native Hawaiian or Other Pacific Islander (a person |
9 | | having origins in any of the original peoples of Hawaii, |
10 | | Guam, Samoa, or other Pacific Islands).
|
11 | | Counseling days shall not be in lieu of regular school |
12 | | days;
|
13 | | 22. To report to the State Board of Education the |
14 | | annual
student dropout rate and number of students who |
15 | | graduate from, transfer
from or otherwise leave bilingual |
16 | | programs;
|
17 | | 23. Except as otherwise provided in the Abused and |
18 | | Neglected Child
Reporting Act or other applicable State or |
19 | | federal law, to permit school
officials to withhold, from |
20 | | any person, information on the whereabouts of
any child |
21 | | removed from school premises when the child has been taken |
22 | | into
protective custody as a victim of suspected child |
23 | | abuse. School officials
shall direct such person to the |
24 | | Department of Children and Family Services,
or to the local |
25 | | law enforcement agency if appropriate;
|
26 | | 24. To develop a policy, based on the current state of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 485 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | existing school
facilities, projected enrollment and |
2 | | efficient utilization of available
resources, for capital |
3 | | improvement of schools and school buildings within
the |
4 | | district, addressing in that policy both the relative |
5 | | priority for
major repairs, renovations and additions to |
6 | | school facilities, and the
advisability or necessity of |
7 | | building new school facilities or closing
existing schools |
8 | | to meet current or projected demographic patterns within
|
9 | | the district;
|
10 | | 25. To make available to the students in every high |
11 | | school attendance
center the ability to take all courses |
12 | | necessary to comply with the Board
of Higher Education's |
13 | | college entrance criteria effective in 1993;
|
14 | | 26. To encourage mid-career changes into the teaching |
15 | | profession,
whereby qualified professionals become |
16 | | certified teachers, by allowing
credit for professional |
17 | | employment in related fields when determining point
of |
18 | | entry on teacher pay scale;
|
19 | | 27. To provide or contract out training programs for |
20 | | administrative
personnel and principals with revised or |
21 | | expanded duties pursuant to this
Act in order to assure |
22 | | they have the knowledge and skills to perform
their duties;
|
23 | | 28. To establish a fund for the prioritized special |
24 | | needs programs, and
to allocate such funds and other lump |
25 | | sum amounts to each attendance center
in a manner |
26 | | consistent with the provisions of part 4 of Section 34-2.3.
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 486 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Nothing in this paragraph shall be construed to require any |
2 | | additional
appropriations of State funds for this purpose;
|
3 | | 29. (Blank);
|
4 | | 30. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act or |
5 | | any other law to
the contrary, to contract with third |
6 | | parties for services otherwise performed
by employees, |
7 | | including those in a bargaining unit, and to layoff those
|
8 | | employees upon 14 days written notice to the affected |
9 | | employees. Those
contracts may be for a period not to |
10 | | exceed 5 years and may be awarded on a
system-wide basis. |
11 | | The board may not operate more than 30 contract schools, |
12 | | provided that the board may operate an additional 5 |
13 | | contract turnaround schools pursuant to item (5.5) of |
14 | | subsection (d) of Section 34-8.3 of this Code;
|
15 | | 31. To promulgate rules establishing procedures |
16 | | governing the layoff or
reduction in force of employees and |
17 | | the recall of such employees, including,
but not limited |
18 | | to, criteria for such layoffs, reductions in force or |
19 | | recall
rights of such employees and the weight to be given |
20 | | to any particular
criterion. Such criteria shall take into |
21 | | account factors including, but not be
limited to, |
22 | | qualifications, certifications, experience, performance |
23 | | ratings or
evaluations, and any other factors relating to |
24 | | an employee's job performance;
|
25 | | 32. To develop a policy to prevent nepotism in the |
26 | | hiring of personnel
or the selection of contractors;
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 487 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | 33. To enter into a partnership agreement, as required |
2 | | by
Section 34-3.5 of this Code, and, notwithstanding any |
3 | | other
provision of law to the contrary, to promulgate |
4 | | policies, enter into
contracts, and take any other action |
5 | | necessary to accomplish the
objectives and implement the |
6 | | requirements of that agreement; and
|
7 | | 34. To establish a Labor Management Council to the |
8 | | board
comprised of representatives of the board, the chief |
9 | | executive
officer, and those labor organizations that are |
10 | | the exclusive
representatives of employees of the board and |
11 | | to promulgate
policies and procedures for the operation of |
12 | | the Council.
|
13 | | The specifications of the powers herein granted are not to |
14 | | be
construed as exclusive but the board shall also exercise all |
15 | | other
powers that they may be requisite or proper for the |
16 | | maintenance and the
development of a public school system, not |
17 | | inconsistent with the other
provisions of this Article or |
18 | | provisions of this Code which apply to all
school districts.
|
19 | | In addition to the powers herein granted and authorized to |
20 | | be exercised
by the board, it shall be the duty of the board to |
21 | | review or to direct
independent reviews of special education |
22 | | expenditures and services.
The board shall file a report of |
23 | | such review with the General Assembly on
or before May 1, 1990.
|
24 | | (Source: P.A. 99-143, eff. 7-27-15.)
|
25 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-18.30)
|
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 488 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 34-18.30. Dependents of military personnel; no |
2 | | tuition charge. If, at the time of enrollment, a dependent of |
3 | | United States military personnel is housed in temporary housing |
4 | | located outside of the school district, but will be living |
5 | | within the district within 60 days after the time of initial |
6 | | enrollment, the dependent must be allowed to enroll, subject to |
7 | | the requirements of this Section, and must not be charged |
8 | | tuition. Any United States military personnel attempting to |
9 | | enroll a dependent under this Section shall provide proof that |
10 | | the dependent will be living within the district within 60 days |
11 | | after the time of initial enrollment. Proof of residency may |
12 | | include, but is not limited to, postmarked mail addressed to |
13 | | the military personnel and sent to an address located within |
14 | | the district, a lease agreement for occupancy of a residence |
15 | | located within the district, or proof of ownership of a |
16 | | residence located within the district. Non-resident dependents |
17 | | of United States military personnel attending school on a |
18 | | tuition-free basis may be counted for the purposes
of |
19 | | determining the apportionment of State aid provided under |
20 | | Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of this Code.
|
21 | | (Source: P.A. 95-331, eff. 8-21-07.)
|
22 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-43.1) (from Ch. 122, par. 34-43.1)
|
23 | | Sec. 34-43.1. (A) Limitation of noninstructional costs. It |
24 | | is the
purpose of this Section to establish for the Board of |
25 | | Education and the
general superintendent of schools |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 489 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | requirements and standards which maximize
the proportion of |
2 | | school district resources in direct support of
educational, |
3 | | program, and building maintenance and safety services for the
|
4 | | pupils of the district, and which correspondingly minimize the |
5 | | amount and
proportion of such resources associated with |
6 | | centralized administration,
administrative support services, |
7 | | and other noninstructional services.
|
8 | | For the 1989-90 school year and for all subsequent school |
9 | | years, the Board
of Education shall undertake budgetary and |
10 | | expenditure control actions which
limit the administrative |
11 | | expenditures of the Board of Education to levels,
as provided |
12 | | for in this Section, which represent an average of the
|
13 | | administrative expenses of all school districts in this State |
14 | | not subject
to Article 34.
|
15 | | (B) Certification of expenses by the State Superintendent |
16 | | of Education.
The State Superintendent of Education shall |
17 | | annually certify, on or before
May 1, to the Board of Education |
18 | | and the School Finance Authority, for the
applicable school |
19 | | year, the following information:
|
20 | | (1) the annual expenditures of all school districts of |
21 | | the State not
subject to Article 34 properly attributable |
22 | | to expenditure functions
defined by the rules and |
23 | | regulations of the State Board of Education as:
2210 |
24 | | (Improvement of Instructional Services); 2300 (Support |
25 | | Services -
General Administration) excluding, however, |
26 | | 2320 (Executive Administrative
Services); 2490 (Other |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 490 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Support Services - School Administration); 2500
(Support |
2 | | Services - Business); 2600 (Support Services - Central);
|
3 | | (2) the total annual expenditures of all school |
4 | | districts not subject to
Article 34 attributable to the |
5 | | Education Fund, the Operations, Building and
Maintenance |
6 | | Fund, the Transportation Fund and the Illinois Municipal
|
7 | | Retirement Fund of the several districts, as defined by the |
8 | | rules and
regulations of the State Board of Education; and
|
9 | | (3) a ratio, to be called the statewide average of |
10 | | administrative
expenditures, derived by dividing the |
11 | | expenditures certified pursuant to
paragraph (B)(1) by the |
12 | | expenditures certified pursuant to paragraph (B)(2).
|
13 | | For purposes of the annual certification of expenditures |
14 | | and ratios
required by this Section, the "applicable year" of |
15 | | certification shall
initially be the 1986-87 school year and, |
16 | | in sequent years, each
succeeding school year.
|
17 | | The State Superintendent of Education shall consult with |
18 | | the Board of
Education to ascertain whether particular |
19 | | expenditure items allocable to
the administrative functions |
20 | | enumerated in paragraph (B)(1) are
appropriately or |
21 | | necessarily higher in the applicable school district than
in |
22 | | the rest of the State due to noncomparable factors. The State
|
23 | | Superintendent shall also review the relevant cost proportions |
24 | | in other
large urban school districts. The State Superintendent |
25 | | shall also review
the expenditure categories in paragraph |
26 | | (B)(1) to ascertain whether they
contain school-level |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 491 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | expenses. If he or she finds that adjustments to the
formula |
2 | | are appropriate or necessary to establish a more fair and
|
3 | | comparable standard for administrative cost for the Board of |
4 | | Education or
to exclude school-level expenses, the State |
5 | | Superintendent shall recommend
to the School Finance Authority |
6 | | rules and regulations adjusting particular
subcategories in |
7 | | this subsection (B) or adjusting certain costs in
determining |
8 | | the budget and expenditure items properly attributable to the
|
9 | | functions or otherwise adjust the formula.
|
10 | | (C) Administrative expenditure limitations. The annual |
11 | | budget of the
Board of Education, as adopted and implemented, |
12 | | and the
related annual expenditures for the school year, shall |
13 | | reflect a limitation
on administrative outlays as required by |
14 | | the following provisions, taking
into account any adjustments |
15 | | established by the State Superintendent of
Education: (1) the |
16 | | budget and expenditures of the Board of Education for
the |
17 | | 1989-90 school year shall reflect a ratio of administrative
|
18 | | expenditures to total expenditures equal to or less than the |
19 | | statewide
average of administrative expenditures for the |
20 | | 1986-87 school year as
certified by the State Superintendent of |
21 | | Education pursuant to paragraph
(B)(3); (2) for the 1990-91 |
22 | | school year and for all subsequent school
years, the budget and |
23 | | expenditures of the Board of Education shall reflect
a ratio of |
24 | | administrative expenditures to total expenditures equal to or
|
25 | | less than the statewide average of administrative expenditures |
26 | | certified by
the State Superintendent of Education for the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 492 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | applicable year pursuant to
paragraph (B)(3); (3) if for any |
2 | | school year the budget of the Board of
Education reflects a |
3 | | ratio of administrative expenditures to total
expenditures |
4 | | which exceeds the applicable statewide average, the Board of
|
5 | | Education shall reduce expenditure items allocable to the |
6 | | administrative
functions enumerated in paragraph (B)(1) such |
7 | | that the Board of Education's
ratio of administrative |
8 | | expenditures to total expenditures is equal to or
less than the |
9 | | applicable statewide average ratio.
|
10 | | For purposes of this Section, the ratio of administrative |
11 | | expenditures to
the total expenditures of the Board of |
12 | | Education, as applied to the budget
of the Board of Education, |
13 | | shall mean: the budgeted expenditure items of
the Board of |
14 | | Education properly attributable to the expenditure functions
|
15 | | identified in paragraph (B)(1) divided by the total budgeted |
16 | | expenditures of
the Board of Education properly attributable to |
17 | | the Board of Education
funds corresponding to those funds |
18 | | identified in paragraph (B)(2),
exclusive of any monies |
19 | | budgeted for payment to the Public School Teachers'
Pension and |
20 | | Retirement System, attributable to payments due from the
|
21 | | General Funds of the State of Illinois.
|
22 | | The annual expenditure of the Board of Education for 2320
|
23 | | (Executive Administrative Services) for the 1989-90 school |
24 | | year shall be no
greater than the 2320 expenditure for the |
25 | | 1988-89 school year. The annual
expenditure of the Board of |
26 | | Education for 2320 for the 1990-91 school year
and each |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 493 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | subsequent school year shall be no greater than the 2320
|
2 | | expenditure for the immediately preceding school year or the |
3 | | 1988-89 school
year, whichever is less. This annual expenditure |
4 | | limitation may be
adjusted in each year in an amount not to |
5 | | exceed any change effective
during the applicable school year |
6 | | in salary to be paid under the collective
bargaining agreement |
7 | | with instructional personnel to which the Board is a
party and |
8 | | in benefit costs either required by law or such collective
|
9 | | bargaining agreement.
|
10 | | (D) Cost control measures. In undertaking actions to |
11 | | control or reduce
expenditure items necessitated by the |
12 | | administrative expenditure
limitations of this Section, the |
13 | | Board of Education shall give priority
consideration to |
14 | | reductions or cost controls with the least effect upon
direct |
15 | | services to students or instructional services for pupils, and |
16 | | upon
the safety and well-being of pupils, and, as applicable, |
17 | | with the
particular costs or functions to which the Board of |
18 | | Education is higher
than the statewide average.
|
19 | | For purposes of assuring that the cost control priorities |
20 | | of this
subsection (D) are met, the State Superintendent of |
21 | | Education shall, with
the assistance of the Board of Education, |
22 | | review the cost allocation
practices of the Board of Education, |
23 | | and the State Superintendent of
Education shall thereafter |
24 | | recommend to the School Finance Authority rules
and regulations |
25 | | which define administrative areas which most impact upon
the |
26 | | direct and instructional needs of students and upon the safety |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 494 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | and
well-being of the pupils of the district. No position |
2 | | closed shall be
reopened using State or federal categorical |
3 | | funds.
|
4 | | (E) Report of Audited Information. For the 1988-89 school |
5 | | year and for
all subsequent school years, the Board of |
6 | | Education shall file with the
State Board of Education the |
7 | | Annual Financial Report and its audit, as
required by the rules |
8 | | of the State Board of Education. Such reports shall
be filed no |
9 | | later than February 15 following the end of the school year of
|
10 | | the Board of Education, beginning with the report to be filed |
11 | | no later
than February 15, 1990 for the 1988-89 school year.
|
12 | | As part of the required Annual Financial Report, the Board |
13 | | of Education
shall provide a detailed accounting of the central |
14 | | level, district, bureau
and department costs and personnel |
15 | | included within expenditure functions
included in paragraph |
16 | | (B)(1). The nature and detail of the reporting
required for |
17 | | these functions shall be prescribed by the State Board of
|
18 | | Education in rules and regulations. A copy of this detailed |
19 | | accounting
shall also be provided annually to the School |
20 | | Finance Authority and the
public. This report shall contain a |
21 | | reconciliation to the board of
education's adopted budget for |
22 | | that fiscal year, specifically delineating
administrative |
23 | | functions.
|
24 | | If the information required under this Section is not |
25 | | provided by the
Board of Education in a timely manner, or is |
26 | | initially or subsequently
determined by the State |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 495 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Superintendent of Education to be incomplete or
inaccurate, the |
2 | | State Superintendent shall, in writing, notify the Board
of |
3 | | Education of reporting deficiencies. The Board of Education |
4 | | shall,
within 60 days of such notice, address the reporting |
5 | | deficiencies
identified. If the State Superintendent of |
6 | | Education does not receive
satisfactory response to these |
7 | | reporting deficiencies within 60 days, the
next payment of |
8 | | general State aid or evidence-based funding due the Board of |
9 | | Education under Section
18-8 or Section 18-8.15, as applicable , |
10 | | and all subsequent payments, shall be withheld by the State
|
11 | | Superintendent of Education until the enumerated deficiencies |
12 | | have
been addressed.
|
13 | | Utilizing the Annual Financial Report, the State |
14 | | Superintendent of
Education shall certify on or before May 1 to |
15 | | the School Finance Authority
the Board of Education's ratio of |
16 | | administrative expenditures to total
expenditures for the |
17 | | 1988-89 school year and for each succeeding school
year. Such |
18 | | certification shall indicate the extent to which the
|
19 | | administrative expenditure ratio of the Board of Education |
20 | | conformed to the
limitations required in subsection (C) of this |
21 | | Section, taking into account
any adjustments of the limitations |
22 | | which may have been recommended by the
State Superintendent of |
23 | | Education to the School Finance Authority. In
deriving the |
24 | | administrative expenditure ratio of the Chicago Board of
|
25 | | Education, the State Superintendent of Education shall utilize |
26 | | the
definition of this ratio prescribed in subsection (C) of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 496 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | this Section,
except that the actual expenditures of the Board |
2 | | of Education shall be
substituted for budgeted expenditure |
3 | | items.
|
4 | | (F) Approval and adjustments to administrative expenditure |
5 | | limitations.
The School Finance Authority organized under |
6 | | Article 34A shall monitor the
Board of Education's adherence to |
7 | | the requirements of this Section. As
part of its responsibility |
8 | | the School Finance Authority shall determine
whether the Board |
9 | | of Education's budget for the next school year, and the
|
10 | | expenditures for a prior school year, comply with the |
11 | | limitation of
administrative expenditures required by this |
12 | | Section. The Board of
Education and the State Board of |
13 | | Education shall provide such information
as is required by the |
14 | | School Finance Authority in order for the Authority
to |
15 | | determine compliance with the provisions of this Section. If |
16 | | the
Authority determines that the budget proposed by the Board |
17 | | of Education
does not meet the cost control requirements of |
18 | | this Section, the Board of
Education shall undertake budgetary |
19 | | reductions, consistent with the
requirements of this Section, |
20 | | to bring the proposed budget into compliance
with such cost |
21 | | control limitations.
|
22 | | If, in formulating cost control and cost reduction |
23 | | alternatives, the
Board of Education believes that meeting the |
24 | | cost control requirements of
this Section related to the budget |
25 | | for the ensuing year would impair the
education, safety, or |
26 | | well-being of the pupils of the school district, the
Board of |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 497 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Education may request that the School Finance Authority make
|
2 | | adjustments to the limitations required by this Section. The |
3 | | Board of
Education shall specify the amount, nature, and |
4 | | reasons for the relief
required and shall also identify cost |
5 | | reductions which can be made in
expenditure functions not |
6 | | enumerated in paragraph (B)(1), which would serve
the purposes |
7 | | of this Section.
|
8 | | The School Finance Authority shall consult with the State |
9 | | Superintendent
of Education concerning the reasonableness from |
10 | | an educational
administration perspective of the adjustments |
11 | | sought by the Board of
Education. The School Finance Authority |
12 | | shall provide an opportunity for
the public to comment upon the |
13 | | reasonableness of the Board's request. If,
after such |
14 | | consultation, the School Finance Authority determines that all
|
15 | | or a portion of the adjustments sought by the Board of |
16 | | Education are
reasonably appropriate or necessary, the |
17 | | Authority may grant such relief
from the provisions of this |
18 | | Section which the Authority deems appropriate.
Adjustments so |
19 | | granted apply only to the specific school year for which
the |
20 | | request was made.
|
21 | | In the event that the School Finance Authority determines |
22 | | that the Board
of Education has failed to achieve the required |
23 | | administrative expenditure
limitations for a prior school |
24 | | year, or if the Authority determines that
the Board of |
25 | | Education has not met the requirements of subsection (F), the
|
26 | | Authority shall make recommendations to the Board of Education |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 498 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | concerning
appropriate corrective actions. If the Board of |
2 | | Education fails to
provide adequate assurance to the Authority |
3 | | that appropriate corrective
actions have been or will be taken, |
4 | | the Authority may, within 60 days
thereafter, require the board |
5 | | to adjust its current budget to correct for
the prior year's |
6 | | shortage or may recommend to the members of the General
|
7 | | Assembly and the Governor such sanctions or remedial actions as |
8 | | will serve
to deter any further such failures on the part of |
9 | | the Board of Education.
|
10 | | To assist the Authority in its monitoring |
11 | | responsibilities, the Board of
Education shall provide such |
12 | | reports and information as are from time to
time required by |
13 | | the Authority.
|
14 | | (G) Independent reviews of administrative expenditures. |
15 | | The School
Finance Authority may direct independent reviews of |
16 | | the administrative and
administrative support expenditures and |
17 | | services and other
non-instructional expenditure functions of |
18 | | the Board of Education. The
Board of Education shall afford |
19 | | full cooperation to the School Finance
Authority in such review |
20 | | activity. The purpose of such reviews shall be
to verify |
21 | | specific targets for improved operating efficiencies of the |
22 | | Board
of Education, to identify other areas of potential |
23 | | efficiencies, and to
assure full and proper compliance by the |
24 | | Board of Education with all
requirements of this Section.
|
25 | | In the conduct of reviews under this subsection, the |
26 | | Authority may
request the assistance and consultation of the |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 499 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | State Superintendent of
Education with regard to questions of |
2 | | efficiency and effectiveness in
educational administration.
|
3 | | (H) Reports to Governor and General Assembly. On or before |
4 | | May 1, 1991
and no less frequently than yearly thereafter, the |
5 | | School Finance Authority
shall provide to the Governor, the |
6 | | State Board of Education, and the
members of the General |
7 | | Assembly an annual report, as outlined in Section
34A-606, |
8 | | which includes the following information: (1) documenting the
|
9 | | compliance or non-compliance of the Board of Education with the
|
10 | | requirements of this Section; (2) summarizing the costs, |
11 | | findings, and
recommendations of any reviews directed by the |
12 | | School Finance Authority,
and the response to such |
13 | | recommendations made by the Board of Education;
and (3) |
14 | | recommending sanctions or legislation necessary to fulfill the
|
15 | | intent of this Section.
|
16 | | (Source: P.A. 86-124; 86-1477.)
|
17 | | Section 50. The Educational Opportunity for Military |
18 | | Children Act is amended by changing Section 25 as follows: |
19 | | (105 ILCS 70/25)
|
20 | | Sec. 25. Tuition for children of active duty military |
21 | | personnel who are transfer students. If a student who is a |
22 | | child of active duty military personnel is (i) placed with a |
23 | | non-custodial parent and (ii) as a result of placement, must |
24 | | attend a non-resident school district, then the student must |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 500 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | not be charged the tuition of the school that the student |
2 | | attends as a result of placement with the non-custodial parent |
3 | | and the student must be counted in the calculation of average |
4 | | daily attendance under Section 18-8.05 or 18-8.15 of the School |
5 | | Code.
|
6 | | (Source: P.A. 98-673, eff. 6-30-14.) |
7 | | Section 60. The Childhood Hunger
Relief Act is amended by |
8 | | changing Section 15 as follows: |
9 | | (105 ILCS 126/15)
|
10 | | Sec. 15. School breakfast program.
|
11 | | (a) The board of education of each school district in
this |
12 | | State shall implement and operate a school breakfast program in |
13 | | the next school year, if a breakfast program
does not currently |
14 | | exist, in accordance with
federal guidelines in each school |
15 | | building within
its district in which at least 40% or more of |
16 | | the
students are eligible for free or reduced-price lunches |
17 | | based upon the current year's
October claim (for those schools |
18 | | that participate in the National School Lunch Program) or in |
19 | | which at least 40% or more of the students are classified as |
20 | | low-income according to the Fall Housing Data from the previous |
21 | | year (for those schools that do not participate in the National |
22 | | School Lunch Program).
|
23 | | (b) School districts may charge students who do not meet |
24 | | federal
criteria for free school meals
for the breakfasts |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 501 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | served to these students within the allowable
limits set by |
2 | | federal regulations.
|
3 | | (c) School breakfast programs established under this |
4 | | Section shall be
supported entirely by federal funds and |
5 | | commodities, charges to students
and other participants, and |
6 | | other available State and local resources,
including under the |
7 | | School Breakfast and Lunch Program Act.
Allowable costs for |
8 | | reimbursement to school districts, in accordance with the |
9 | | United States Department of Agriculture, include compensation |
10 | | of employees for the time devoted and identified specifically |
11 | | to implement the school breakfast program; the cost of |
12 | | materials acquired, consumed, or expended specifically to |
13 | | implement the school breakfast program; equipment and other |
14 | | approved capital expenditures necessary to implement the |
15 | | school breakfast program; and transportation expenses incurred |
16 | | specifically to implement and operate the school breakfast |
17 | | program. |
18 | | Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this |
19 | | Section, the State Board of Education shall award to a school |
20 | | district having a population exceeding 500,000 inhabitants |
21 | | 50.7% of the funds appropriated by the General Assembly for any |
22 | | fiscal year for purposes of payment of claims under this |
23 | | Section. |
24 | | (d) A school district shall be allowed to opt out a school |
25 | | or schools from the school breakfast program requirement of |
26 | | this Section if it is determined that, due to circumstances |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 502 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | specific to that school district, the expense
reimbursement |
2 | | would not fully cover the costs of implementing and operating a
|
3 | | school breakfast program. The school district shall petition |
4 | | its regional superintendent of schools by February 15 of each |
5 | | year to request to be exempt
from operating the school |
6 | | breakfast program in the school or schools in the next school |
7 | | year. The petition shall include all legitimate costs |
8 | | associated with implementing and operating a school breakfast |
9 | | program, the estimated reimbursement from State and federal |
10 | | sources, and any unique circumstances the school district can |
11 | | verify that exist that would cause the implementation and |
12 | | operation of such a program to be cost prohibitive. |
13 | | The regional superintendent of schools shall review the |
14 | | petition. In accordance with the Open Meetings Act, he or she |
15 | | shall convene a public hearing to hear testimony from the |
16 | | school district and interested community members. The regional |
17 | | superintendent shall, by March 15 of each year, inform the |
18 | | school district of his or her decision, along with the reasons |
19 | | why the exemption was granted or denied, in writing. The |
20 | | regional superintendent must also send notification to the |
21 | | State Board of Education detailing which schools requested an |
22 | | exemption and the results. If the regional superintendent |
23 | | grants an exemption to the school district, then the school |
24 | | district is relieved from the requirement to establish and |
25 | | implement a school breakfast program in the school or schools |
26 | | granted an exemption for the next school year. |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 503 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | If the regional superintendent of schools does not grant an |
2 | | exemption, then the school district shall implement and operate |
3 | | a school breakfast program in accordance with this Section by |
4 | | the first student attendance day of the next school year. |
5 | | However, the school district or a resident of the school |
6 | | district may by April 15 appeal the decision of the regional |
7 | | superintendent to the State Superintendent of Education. The |
8 | | State Superintendent shall hear appeals on the decisions of |
9 | | regional superintendents of schools no later than May 15 of |
10 | | each year. The State Superintendent shall make a final decision |
11 | | at the conclusion of the hearing on the school district's |
12 | | request for an exemption from the school breakfast program |
13 | | requirement. If the State Superintendent grants an exemption, |
14 | | then the school district is relieved from the requirement to |
15 | | implement and operate a school breakfast program in the school |
16 | | or schools granted an exemption for the next school year. If |
17 | | the State Superintendent does not grant an exemption, then the |
18 | | school district shall implement and operate a school breakfast |
19 | | program in accordance with this Section by the first student |
20 | | attendance day of the next school year.
|
21 | | A school district may not attempt to opt out a school or |
22 | | schools from the school breakfast program requirement of this |
23 | | Section by requesting a waiver under Section 2-3.25g of the |
24 | | School Code.
|
25 | | (Source: P.A. 96-158, eff. 8-7-09.) |
|
| | 10000HB2808ham001 | - 504 - | LRB100 11017 MLM 26370 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 95. No acceleration or delay. Where this Act makes |
2 | | changes in a statute that is represented in this Act by text |
3 | | that is not yet or no longer in effect (for example, a Section |
4 | | represented by multiple versions), the use of that text does |
5 | | not accelerate or delay the taking effect of (i) the changes |
6 | | made by this Act or (ii) provisions derived from any other |
7 | | Public Act. |
8 | | Section 97. Savings clause. Any repeal or amendment made by |
9 | | this Act shall not affect or impair any of the following: suits |
10 | | pending or rights existing at the time this Act takes effect; |
11 | | any grant or conveyance made or right acquired or cause of |
12 | | action now existing under any Section, Article, or Act repealed |
13 | | or amended by this Act; the validity of any bonds or other |
14 | | obligations issued or sold and constituting valid obligations |
15 | | of the issuing authority at the time this Act takes effect; the |
16 | | validity of any contract; the validity of any tax levied under |
17 | | any law in effect prior to the effective date of this Act; or |
18 | | any offense committed, act done, penalty, punishment, or |
19 | | forfeiture incurred or any claim, right, power, or remedy |
20 | | accrued under any law in effect prior to the effective date of |
21 | | this Act.
|
22 | | Section 99. Effective date. This Act takes effect upon |
23 | | becoming law.".
|